admin OSO_V3_R3.10.1_014
OpenScape Office V3 
Administrator Documentation
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9
Our Quality and Environmental Management Systems are
implemented according to the requirements of the ISO9001 and
ISO14001 standards and are certified by an external certification
company.

Copyright © Unify GmbH & Co. KG 03/2014 
Hofmannstr. 51, 81379 Munich/Germany
All rights reserved.
Reference No.: A31003-P1030-M100-14-A9
The information provided in this document contains merely general descriptions or
characteristics of performance which in case of actual use do not always apply as 
described or which may change as a result of further development of the products. 
An obligation to provide the respective characteristics shall only exist if expressly agreed in
the terms of contract.
Availability and technical specifications are subject to change without notice.
Unify, OpenScape, OpenStage and HiPath are registered trademarks of Unify GmbH & Co. KG.
All other company, brand, product and service names are trademarks or registered trademarks
of their respective holders.
unify.com
Contents
1 Introduction and Important Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.1 About this Documentation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.1.1 Documentation and Target Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.1.2 Structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.1.3 Types of Topics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.1.4 Display Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.2 Safety Information and Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.2.1 Warnings: Danger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.2.2 Warnings: Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.2.3 Warnings: Caution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.2.4 Warnings: Note . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.3 Important Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.3.1 Emergencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.3.2 Intended Use . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.3.3 Correct Disposal and Recycling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.3.4 Installation Standards and Guidelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.3.4.1 Connecting OpenScape Office MX to the Power Supply Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.3.4.2 Connecting OpenScape Office LX and OpenScape Office HX to the Power Supply Circuit . . . .
1.3.4.3 Shielded Cabling for LAN, WAN and DMZ Connections of OpenScape Office MX . . . . . . . . . . .
1.3.4.4 Marks (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.3.5 Notes on Electromagnetic and Radio Frequency Interference (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.3.6 Data Protection and Data Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.3.7 Technical Regulations and Conformity (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.3.7.1 CE Conformity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.3.7.2 Conformity with US and Canadian Standards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.3.7.3 Conformity with International Standards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.3.8 Operating Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.3.8.1 Operating Conditions for OpenScape Office MX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.3.8.2 Operating Conditions for OpenScape Office LX and OpenScape Office HX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
32
32
32
34
37
37
38
39
40
41
41
42
42
43
43
44
44
44
45
46
46
46
47
47
48
48
48
48
49
2 System Overview and Scenarios. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.1 System Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.1.1 OpenScape Office LX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.1.2 OpenScape Office MX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.1.3 OpenScape Office HX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.1.4 Communications Clients, Mobility Clients and Contact Center Clients. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.1.5 Supported Phones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.1.6 Infrastructure Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.1.7 Open Interfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.1.8 Recommended and Certified Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.1.9 Additional Links. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.2 Sample Scenarios . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.2.1 Sample Scenario for OpenScape Office LX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.2.2 Sample Scenario for OpenScape Office MX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.2.3 Sample Scenario for OpenScape Office HX. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
50
50
52
52
54
55
57
59
59
59
60
60
60
61
62
3 Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
3.1 OpenScape Office MX System Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
3
Contents
3.1.1 Motherboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
3.1.2 Slot and Access Designations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
3.2 Gateway Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
3.2.1 Not for U.S. and Canada: Gateway Module GMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
3.2.2 Not for U.S. and Canada: Gateway Module GMSA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
3.2.3 Not for U.S. and Canada: Gateway Module GME . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
3.2.4 For U.S. and Canada only: Gateway Module GMT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
3.2.5 Gateway Module GMAA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
3.2.6 Gateway Module GMAL. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
3.3 Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
3.3.1 Prerequisites for Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
3.3.2 Preparatory Steps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
3.3.2.1 How to Unpack the Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
3.3.2.2 How to Attach the Plastic Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
3.3.2.3 For U.S. and Canada only: How to Set Ground Start for an Analog Trunk Connection . . . . . . . . 87
3.3.2.4 How to Install Gateway Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
3.3.3 Installation Methods . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
3.3.3.1 How to Install the Communication System as a Standalone Unit (Desktop Operation) . . . . . . . . . 91
3.3.3.2 How to Mount the Communication System in a 19’’ Rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
3.3.4 Protective Grounding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
3.3.4.1 How to Provide Protective Grounding for the Communication System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
3.3.4.2 How to Check the Grounding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
3.3.5 Trunk Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
3.3.5.1 Not for U.S. and Canada: How to Set up the ISDN Point-to-Point Connection via the S0 Port . . . 98
3.3.5.2 Not for U.S. and Canada: How to Set up an ISDN Point-to-Multipoint Connection 
via the S0 Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
3.3.5.3 Not for U.S. and Canada: How to Set up an ISDN Primary Rate Interface via the S2M Port . . . 101
3.3.5.4 For U.S. and Canada Only: How to Set up the ISDN Primary Rate Interface via the 
T1 Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
3.3.5.5 How to Set up an Analog Trunk Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
3.3.6 Integration in the LAN Infrastructure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
3.3.6.1 How to Integrate OpenScape Office MX in a Basic Scenario . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
3.3.7 Connecting ISDN Phones and Analog Phones and Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
3.3.7.1 Not for U.S. and Canada: How to Connect ISDN Phones Directly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
3.3.7.2 Not for U.S. and Canada: How to Connect ISDN Phones via the S0 Bus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
3.3.7.3 How to Connect Analog Telephones and Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
3.3.8 Closing Activities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
3.3.8.1 How to Perform a Visual Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
3.4 Multibox Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
3.4.1 Details on Multibox Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
3.4.2 Configuring a multibox system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
3.4.2.1 How to Configure a Two-box System for the First Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
3.4.2.2 How to Configure a Three-box System for the First Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
3.4.2.3 How to Expand a One-box System to a Two-box System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
3.4.2.4 How to Expand a One-box System to a Three-box System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
3.4.2.5 How to Expand a Two-box System to a Three-box System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
3.4.2.6 How to Deconfigure a Multibox System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
4 Administration Concept . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
4.1 Web Based Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
4.1.1 Prerequisites for OpenScape Office Assistant. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
4.1.2 OpenScape Office Assistant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
4
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Contents
4.1.2.1 How to Log Into OpenScape Office Assistant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.1.2.2 How to Log out from OpenScape Office Assistant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.1.3 User Administration of OpenScape Office Assistant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.1.3.1 How to Add an Administrator. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.1.3.2 How to Edit Administrator Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.1.3.3 How to Change the Administrator Password. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.1.3.4 How to Delete an Administrator. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.1.4 Online Help . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.1.4.1 How to Call the Online Help . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.1.4.2 How to Invoke the Context-Sensitive Online Help. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.2 Wizards (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.2.1 Wizards – Basic Installation (LX/MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.2.2 Wizards – Network / Internet (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.2.3 Wizards – Telephones / Subscribers (LX/MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.2.4 Wizards – Central Telephony (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.2.5 Wizards – User Telephony (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.2.6 Wizards – UC Suite . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3 Expert mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.1 Expert Mode - Maintenance > Configuration (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.2 Expert Mode - Maintenance > Software Image (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.3 Expert Mode - Maintenance > Traces (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.4 Expert Mode - Maintenance > Events (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.5 Expert Mode - Maintenance > SNMP (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.6 Expert Mode - Maintenance > Admin Log (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.7 Expert Mode - Maintenance > Actions (LX/MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.8 Expert Mode - Maintenance > Platform Diagnostics (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.9 Expert Mode - Maintenance > Application Diagnostics (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.10 Experten-Modus – Telephony > Basic Settings (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.11 Expert Mode – Telephony > Security (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.12 Expert Mode – Telephony > Network Interfaces (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.13 Expert Mode – Telephony > Routing (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.14 Expert Mode – Telephony > Voice Gateway (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.15 Experten-Modus – Telephony > Stations (LX/MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.16 Expert Mode – Telephony > Incoming Calls (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.17 Expert Mode – Telephony > Trunks/Routing (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.18 Experten-Modus – Telephony > Classes of Service (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.19 Expert Mode – Telephony > Auxiliary Equipment (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.20 Experten-Modus – Telephony > Payload (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.21 Experten-Modus – Telephony > Statistics (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.22 Expert Mode – Applications > UC Suite . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.23 Expert mode – Applications > Web Services (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.4 Service Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.4.1 Service Center - Download Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.4.2 Service Center – Inventory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.4.3 Service Center – Software Update . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.4.4 Service Center – E-mail Forwarding. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.4.5 Service Center – Remote Access (LX/MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.4.6 Service Center – Restart / Reload. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.4.7 Service Center – Diagnostics > Status (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.4.8 Service Center – Diagnostics > Event Viewer (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.4.9 Service Center – Diagnostics > Trace . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
134
135
135
135
136
136
137
137
138
138
138
138
139
139
140
140
141
141
141
142
142
143
143
143
144
144
144
144
145
146
146
147
147
148
148
149
149
150
150
150
152
153
153
154
154
154
154
155
155
155
155
5
Contents
5 Installing OpenScape Office MX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
5.1 Installation Example for OpenScape Office MX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
5.1.1 Components of OpenScape Office MX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
5.1.2 IP Address Scheme . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
5.1.3 Dial Plan. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
5.2 Prerequisites for OpenScape Office MX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
5.3 Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
5.3.1 Preparatory Steps for OpenScape Office MX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
5.3.1.1 How to Start OpenScape Office MX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
5.3.1.2 How to Connect the Admin PC with OpenScape Office MX. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
5.3.2 Checking Functions of OpenScape Office MX with OpenScape Office Observer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
5.3.2.1 How to Copy OpenScape Office Observer to the Admin PC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
5.3.2.2 How to Start OpenScape Office Observer from the Admin PC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
5.3.3 Initial Installation of OpenScape Office MX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
5.3.3.1 How to Start the Initial Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
5.3.3.2 How to Define a System Name and IP Address. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
5.3.3.3 How to Enable the DHCP Server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
5.3.3.4 How to Define Country Settings, Date and Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
5.3.4 Basic Installation of OpenScape Office MX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
5.3.4.1 How to Start the Basic Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
5.3.4.2 How to Configure Country and Local Area Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
5.3.4.3 How to Configure Network Parameters (Optional) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
5.3.4.4 How to Configure Station Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172
5.3.4.5 How to Configure the ISDN Trunk Connection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174
5.3.4.6 How to Activate Internet Access. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
5.3.4.7 How to Deactivate Internet Telephony . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
5.3.4.8 How to Configure ISDN Stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
5.3.4.9 How to Configure Analog Stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
5.3.4.10 How to Configure IP Stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
5.3.4.11 How to Configure a Dial-in Number for Conferencing (Optional) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
5.3.4.12 How to Configure the Sending of E-mails (Optional) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
5.3.5 Closing Activities for OpenScape Office MX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
5.3.5.1 How to Enable Remote Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
5.3.5.2 How to Activate Licenses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
5.3.5.3 How to Provision the UC Suite for Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
5.3.5.4 How to Perform a Data Backup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
5.3.5.5 How to Configure an IP phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
6 Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
6.1 Prerequisites (LX/HX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
6.2 Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office (LX/HX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
6.3 Installation in a Virtualized Environment (LX/HX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
6.3.1 Time Synchronization of the Guest Operating System Linux (LX/HX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
6.3.1.1 How to Configure Time Synchronization for the Guest Operating System Linux . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
6.3.2 Use of Snapshots on Virtual Machines (VM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
6.4 Linux Security Aspects and RAID Array (LX/HX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
6.5 Initial Startup of the Linux Server (LX/HX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198
6.5.1 Initial Startup without a Software RAID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198
6.5.1.1 How to Install the Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office without a Software RAID . . . . . . . . . . 199
6.5.1.2 How to Configure the Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office without a Software RAID . . . . . . . 202
6.5.1.3 How to Install and Configure SLES 11 SP1 without a Software RAID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
6.5.2 Initial Startup with a Software RAID. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
6
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Contents
6.5.2.1 How to Deactivate the BIOS RAID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.5.2.2 How to Install the Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office with a Software RAID . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.5.2.3 How to Configure the Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office with a Software RAID . . . . . . . . .
6.5.2.4 How to Install and Configure SLES 11 SP1 with a Software RAID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.5.3 Configuring a Uniform Time Base (LX/HX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.5.3.1 How to Configure an SNTP Server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.6 Updates (LX/HX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.6.1 How to Register at the Linux Update Server (only for Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office) . . . .
6.6.2 How to Enable Automatic Online Updates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.6.3 How to Enable Online Updates Manually . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.7 Backup & Restore (LX/HX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.8 Used Ports (LX/HX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
209
210
210
213
218
218
219
220
221
221
222
222
7 Installing OpenScape Office LX. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.1 Installation Example for OpenScape Office LX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.1.1 Components of OpenScape Office LX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.1.2 IP Address Scheme . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.1.3 Dial Plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.2 Prerequisites for OpenScape Office LX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3 Initial Startup of OpenScape Office LX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.1 Preparatory Steps for OpenScape Office LX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.1.1 How to Install OpenScape Office . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.2 Checking Functions of OpenScape Office with OpenScape Office Observer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.2.1 How to Start OpenScape Office Observer from The Linux Server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.2.2 How to Copy OpenScape Office Observer to the Client PC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.2.3 How to Start OpenScape Office Observer from the Client PC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.3 Using the Linux DHCP Server (Optional) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.3.1 How to Enable the Linux DHCP Server. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.4 Initial Installation of OpenScape Office LX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.4.1 How to Start the Initial Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.4.2 How to Specify System Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.5 Basic Installation of OpenScape Office LX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.5.1 How to Start the Basic Installation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.5.2 How to Configure the Country Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.5.3 How to Configure Network Parameters (Optional) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.5.4 How to Configure Station Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.5.5 How to Add an ITSP for the Internet Telephony Point-to-Point Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.5.6 How to Enter Special Phone Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.5.7 How to Configure IP Stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.5.8 How to Configure a Dial-in Number for Conferencing (Optional) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.5.9 How to Configure the Sending of E-mails (Optional). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.6 Closing Activities for OpenScape Office LX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.6.1 How to Enable Remote Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.6.2 How to Activate Licenses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.6.3 How to Provision the UC Suite for Installation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.6.4 How to Perform a Data Backup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.6.5 How to Configure an IP phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.7 Uninstallation of OpenScape Office . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.7.1 How to Uninstall OpenScape Office . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
224
224
224
225
226
228
228
229
229
230
231
231
232
233
233
234
234
235
236
236
237
237
238
240
242
243
245
246
247
248
248
249
250
251
253
253
8 Installing OpenScape Office HX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
8.1 Installation Example for OpenScape Office HX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
8.1.1 Components of OpenScape Office HX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
7
Contents
8.2 Prerequisites for OpenScape Office HX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
8.3 Initial Startup of OpenScape Office HX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
8.3.1 Preparatory Steps for OpenScape Office HX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
8.3.1.1 How to Install OpenScape Office in the Graphical Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
8.3.1.2 How to Install OpenScape Office in Text Console Mode (Alternative) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258
8.3.1.3 Service Scripts of OpenScape Office . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
8.3.2 Checking Functions of OpenScape Office HX with OpenScape Office Observer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
8.3.2.1 How to Start OpenScape Office Observer from The Linux Server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
8.3.2.2 How to Copy OpenScape Office Observer to the Client PC. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
8.3.2.3 How to Start OpenScape Office Observer from the Client PC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
8.3.3 Using the Linux DHCP Server (Optional). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
8.3.3.1 How to Enable the Linux DHCP Server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263
8.3.4 Configuring HiPath 3000 for OpenScape Office HX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263
8.3.4.1 How to Load the CDB from HiPath 3000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264
8.3.4.2 How to Enter the IP Address for the Linux Server of OpenScape Office HX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265
8.3.4.3 How to Configure a Connection to an External SIP Registrar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265
8.3.4.4 How to Add IP Trunks for OpenScape Office HX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265
8.3.4.5 How to Configure Route 8 for OpenScape Office HX. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266
8.3.4.6 How to Activate LCR (Least Cost Routing) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267
8.3.4.7 How to Configure an Outside Line . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267
8.3.4.8 How to Set up the Dial Plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268
8.3.4.9 How to Define the Call Number for Accessing OpenScape Office . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
8.3.4.10 How to Enable E.164 Numbering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
8.3.4.11 How to Set the Plus Product Flags. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
8.3.4.12 How to Configure the Settings of the Voicemail Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
8.3.4.13 How to Configure Voicemail Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
8.3.4.14 How to Configure Virtual Stations for OpenScape Office . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
8.3.4.15 How to Configure the OpenScape Office Type for Virtual Stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271
8.3.4.16 How to Configure Call Destination Lists for Virtual Stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271
8.3.4.17 How to Transfer Settings to HiPath 3000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272
8.3.5 Connecting the Linux Server of OpenScape Office HX to HiPath 3000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272
8.3.5.1 How to Connect the Linux Server of OpenScape Office HX to HiPath 3000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
8.3.5.2 How to Check the Data Transfer with HiPath 3000 Manager E . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
8.3.6 Configuring OpenScape Office . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
8.3.6.1 How to Check the Data Transfer with OpenScape Office Assistant. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
8.3.7 Installing the UC Clients. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
8.3.8 Networking Multiple HiPath 3000 Systems with OpenScape Office HX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275
8.3.8.1 How to Set the “Networked CTI Domain” System Flag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
9 Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
9.1 Internet Access (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
9.1.1 Internet Access via an External Internet Router (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
9.1.1.1 How to Connect to the Internet Router . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
9.1.2 Internet Access via an Internet Modem (MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
9.1.2.1 How to Configure Internet Access via a Preconfigured ISP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
9.1.2.2 How to Configure Internet Access via the Standard ISP PPPoE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
9.1.2.3 How to Configure Internet Access via the Standard ISP PPTP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
9.1.3 WAN Port (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287
9.1.4 NAT (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287
9.1.4.1 How to Configure a NAT Rule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287
9.1.4.2 How to Configure NAT Rules with the NAT Table Editor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288
9.1.4.3 How to Delete a NAT Rule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
8
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Contents
9.1.5 DNS, Domain Name Service (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.1.5.1 How to Define External DNS Servers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.1.6 DynDNS (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.1.6.1 How to Configure the DynDNS Service. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.1.6.2 How to Define the Mail Exchanger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.1.7 IP Routing (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.1.7.1 How to Configure Default Routers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.1.7.2 How to Add a Static Route . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.1.7.3 How to Delete Static Routes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.1.7.4 How to Display the Address Resolution Protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.1.8 IP Mapping (MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.1.8.1 How to Edit the IP Mapping Netmask . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.1.8.2 How to Add an IP Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.1.8.3 How to Edit/Delete an IP Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.2 IP Telephony (Voice over IP, VoIP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.2.1 ITSP Requirements (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.2.2 Internet Telephony via a Station Connection (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.2.2.1 How to Configure a Predefined ITSP for the Internet Telephony User Connection . . . . . . . . . .
9.2.2.2 How to Add an ITSP for the Internet Telephony User Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.2.3 Internet Telephony via a Point-to-Point Connection (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.2.3.1 How to Configure a Predefined ITSP for the Internet Telephony System Connection . . . . . . . .
9.2.3.2 How to Add a New ITSP for the Internet Telephony System Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.2.4 STUN (Simple Traversal of UDP through NAT (LX/MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3 Outside Line (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.1 Trunks (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.1.1 How to Configure an ISDN Outside Line . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.1.2 How to Configure an Analog Outside Line . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.1.3 How to Display All Trunks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.1.4 How to Display Individual Trunks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.1.5 How to Change the Trunk Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.1.6 How to Assign an MSN to a Trunk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.1.7 How to Change the ISDN Protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.1.8 How to Change the B Channel Seizure Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.1.9 How to Change the Dialing Method. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.2 Routes (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.2.1 How to Change a Route Assignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.2.2 How to Change the Route Name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.2.3 How to Change the Seizure Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.2.4 How to Enter an Overflow Route. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.2.5 How to Configure the Type of Seizure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.2.6 How to Enter a PABX Number Incoming and Outgoing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.2.7 How to Configure Station Number Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.2.8 How to Configure Call Number Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.2.9 How to Configure the Direction Prefix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.2.10 How to Enter a Second CO Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.3 Prioritization for Exchange Line Seizure (LX/MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.3.1 How to Prioritize the Seizure of Exchange Lines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.4 Dial Tone Monitoring. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.4.1 How to Configure a Delay Period for Dial Tone Monitoring. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.4.2 How to Enable or Disable the Analysis of the Second Dial Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
289
290
290
291
292
292
293
294
294
294
295
295
295
296
296
297
298
298
302
306
306
309
313
313
314
315
316
317
317
317
318
318
319
319
319
322
322
323
323
323
324
324
325
325
326
326
326
327
328
328
9
Contents
10 Stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330
10.1 Dial Plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330
10.1.1 Default Dial Plan for OpenScape Office LX/MX. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332
10.1.1.1 How to Display the Dial Plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332
10.1.2 Individual Dial Plan for OpenScape Office LX/MX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332
10.1.2.1 How to Delete or Edit Default Phone Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 333
10.1.2.2 How to Edit Special Default Call Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 334
10.1.2.3 How to Import Call Numbers and Station Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 335
10.2 IP Stations and LAN Telephony (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 335
10.2.1 IP User . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 335
10.2.2 LAN Telephony Requirements (LX/MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336
10.2.3 IP Addresses (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 337
10.2.3.1 How to Change the OpenScape Office MX IP Address and Subnet Mask . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 337
10.2.3.2 How to Change the OpenScape Office LX IP Address and Subnet Mask . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338
10.2.3.3 How to Change the Internal IP Address Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338
10.2.3.4 How to Reset the Internal IP Address Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339
10.2.4 DHCP, Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339
10.2.4.1 How to Deactivate OpenScape Office MX DHCP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 340
10.2.4.2 How to Activate and Configure OpenScape Office MX DHCP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 340
10.2.4.3 How to Configure OpenScape Office MX as a DHCP Relay Agent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 341
10.2.4.4 How to Activate and Configure OpenScape Office LX DHCP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 342
10.2.4.5 How to Deactivate OpenScape Office LX DHCP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 343
10.2.5 IP Protocols (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 343
10.2.5.1 How to Configure H.323 Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345
10.2.5.2 How to Configure SIP Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345
10.2.6 Audio Codecs (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 346
10.2.6.1 How to Configure Audio Codec Parameters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 346
10.2.6.2 How to Assign Audio Codec Parameters to a Destination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347
10.2.7 RTP Payload for Telephony Tones According to RFC2833 (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347
10.2.7.1 How to Enable or Disable Transmission of DTMF Tones According to RFC2833 . . . . . . . . . . . 347
10.2.7.2 How to Enable or Disable Transmission of Fax/Modem Tones According to RFC2833 . . . . . . 348
10.2.8 Quality of Service (LX/MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 348
10.2.8.1 How to Configure Quality of Service (QoS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 350
10.2.8.2 How to Display AF/EF Codepoints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 350
10.2.9 CorNet-IP Security (LX/MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 350
10.2.9.1 How to Configure CorNet-IP Security. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351
10.2.9.2 How to Change the ID of the Internal Gatekeeper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 352
10.2.10 Key Programming (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 352
10.2.10.1 How to Program Function Keys on System Phones. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 353
10.3 ISDN Stations and Analog Stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 354
10.3.1 ISDN Stations (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 354
10.3.1.1 How to Configure the S0 Interface for ISDN Stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 356
10.3.1.2 How to Allow only Configured Numbers for MSNs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 356
10.3.2 Analog Stations (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 357
10.4 Users of the UC Suite . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 358
10.5 Virtual Stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 358
10.5.1 Virtual Stations for Mobility Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 358
10.5.2 Virtual stations for call forwarding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 358
10.6 Station and User Profiles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 359
10.7 Configuring Stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 359
10.7.1 Configuring Stations Using Wizards (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 360
10.7.1.1 How to Configure IP Stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 361
10
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Contents
10.7.1.2 How to Configure ISDN Stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.7.1.3 How to Configure Analog Stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.7.1.4 How to Define Station Names . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.7.2 Configuring Stations in Expert Mode (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.7.2.1 How to Configure Standard Parameters for a Station . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.7.2.2 How to Configure Standard Parameters for all Stations of a Station Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.7.2.3 How to Activate or Deactivate Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.7.2.4 How to Configure IP Parameters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.7.2.5 How to Define Class of Service Groups for Day and Night . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.7.2.6 How to Configure a Call Pickup Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.7.2.7 How to Display the Station Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.7.3 Configuring Users of the UC Suite . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.7.3.1 How to Configure Users of the UC Suite. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.7.3.2 How to Reset Users of the UC Suite . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.7.3.3 How to Configure Users of the UC Suite as Agents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.7.3.4 How to Configure Users of the UC Suite as Attendants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.7.3.5 How to Enable or Disable the Feature to Receive Voicemails for Users of the UC Suite . . . . .
10.7.3.6 How to Change the Presence Status for Users of the UC Suite . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.7.3.7 How to Reset the Password for Users of the UC Suite . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.7.3.8 How to Configure the Password Length for Users of the UC Suite. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.7.4 Exporting Subscriber Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.7.4.1 How to Export Station data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.8 Configuring Station and User Profiles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.8.1 Configuring Station Profiles (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.8.1.1 How to Create a New Station Profile. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.8.1.2 How to Display Station Profiles and their Members . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.8.1.3 How to Add Members to a Station Profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.8.1.4 How to Delete Members from a Station Profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.8.1.5 How to Export or Import a Single Station Profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.8.1.6 How to Change Values and Settings of a Station Profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.8.1.7 How to Export or Import All Station Profiles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.8.2 Configuring the User Profiles of UC Clients . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.8.2.1 How to Create a New User Profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.8.2.2 How to Display User Profiles and their Members . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.8.2.3 How to Add Members to a User Profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.8.2.4 How to Delete Members from a User Profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.8.2.5 How to Change the Values and Settings of a User Profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.8.2.6 How to Delete a User Profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
364
366
368
369
371
373
373
374
374
375
375
376
378
379
379
379
380
380
381
381
382
383
383
383
384
384
384
385
385
386
386
387
388
388
389
389
390
390
11 Licensing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11.1 Licensing Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11.1.1 License Server (Central License Server, CLS). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11.1.2 Grace Period. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11.1.3 MAC Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11.1.3.1 How to Check the MAC Address of OpenScape Office MX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11.1.3.2 How to Check the MAC Address of OpenScape Office LX/HX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11.1.4 Advanced Locking ID (LX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11.1.4.1 How to Check the Advanced Locking ID of OpenScape Office LX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11.1.5 Licensing Process using OpenScape Office MX as an Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11.2 Licenses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11.2.1 Basic Licenses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11.2.2 Extension Licenses. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
391
391
391
392
392
392
393
393
394
394
394
395
396
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
11
Contents
11.2.3 Licenses for Multimedia Contact Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398
11.2.4 Evaluation Licenses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 399
11.2.5 Upgrade Licenses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400
11.3 Activating and Updating Licenses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401
11.3.1 Activating Licenses (MX/LX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401
11.3.1.1 How to Activate a License using the License Authorization Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 402
11.3.1.2 How to Activate a License via a License File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 403
11.3.1.3 How to License IP Stations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 403
11.3.1.4 How to Check or Change the IP Address of the License Server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 404
11.3.1.5 How to Check or Change the Call Number for the ISDN Connection to the License Server . . . 404
11.3.2 Updating a License (MX/LX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 405
11.3.2.1 How to Update a License . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 406
11.4 Licensing in an Internetwork . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 406
11.4.1 Licensing Process in the Internetwork . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408
11.4.2 How to License an Internetwork. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409
11.4.3 How to Shift Licenses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 410
11.4.4 How to Combine License Files into a Network License File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 412
11.4.5 How to Change the Connection to the Central License Agent. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 413
11.4.6 How to Configure the Connection to the Local License Agent. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 413
11.5 License Information in OpenScape Office Assistant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 414
11.5.1 License Information without a Network (Standalone) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 414
11.5.1.1 How to Display Information on Licenses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 414
11.5.2 License Information in an Internetwork . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 414
11.5.2.1 How to Display Information on Bound Licenses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 415
11.5.2.2 How to Display Information on Unbound Licenses. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 415
12 Unified Communications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 416
12.1 UC Clients . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 416
12.1.1 myPortal for Desktop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 417
12.1.1.1 How to Customize the Alternative Modern User Interface for myPortal for Desktop . . . . . . . . . 417
12.1.1.2 How to Delete the Alternative Modern User Interface for myPortal for Desktop . . . . . . . . . . . . 418
12.1.2 myPortal for Outlook . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 418
12.1.3 myPortal for Zimbra . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 419
12.1.3.1 How to Provide the Zimlet for myPortal for Zimbra on the Zimbra Server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 419
12.1.4 myPortal for OpenStage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 419
12.1.5 Fax Printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 420
12.1.6 myAttendant. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 420
12.1.7 Prerequisites for UC PC Clients. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 420
12.1.8 Prerequisites for myPortal for Zimbra . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 424
12.1.9 Prerequisites for myPortal for OpenStage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 424
12.1.10 Silent installation/Uninstallation for UC PC Clients . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 425
12.1.10.1 How to Perform a Silent Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 426
12.1.10.2 How to Perform a Silent Uninstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 427
12.1.11 Automatic Updates. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 428
12.2 Presence Status and CallMe Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 429
12.2.1 Presence Status. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 429
12.2.1.1 How to Configure Exchange Calendar Integration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 432
12.2.2 CallMe Service. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 433
12.2.3 Status-based call forwarding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 434
12.2.4 Rule-Based Call Forwarding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 435
12.3 Directories and Journal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 436
12.3.1 Directories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 436
12
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Contents
12.3.1.1 How to Configure Directories for System Telephones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3.1.2 How to Enable or Disable the Integrated Public Exchange Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3.2 Internal Directory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3.2.1 How to Enable or Disable the Display of Analog Stations in the Internal Directory. . . . . . . . . .
12.3.3 External directory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3.3.1 External Directory: How to Import a CSV File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3.3.2 External Directory: How to Add Access to an External Database . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3.4 External Offline Directory (LDAP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3.4.1 How to Add the External Offline Directory (LDAP) for UC PC Clients. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3.4.2 How to Delete the External Offline Directory (LDAP) for UC PC Clients. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3.4.3 How to Add an External Offline Directory (LDAP) for System Telephones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3.5 System Directory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3.5.1 How to Activate or Deactivate the Display of a Subscriber in the System Directory . . . . . . . . .
12.3.6 Departments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3.6.1 How to Add a Department . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3.6.2 How to Assign Stations to a Department. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3.6.3 How to Edit a Department . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3.6.4 How to Remove a Department . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3.7 OpenScape Office Directory Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3.7.1 How to Enable or Disable the OpenScape Office Directory Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3.7.2 How to Restart the OpenScape Office Directory Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3.7.3 How to Configure the LDAP Password for Access to the OpenScape Office 
Directory Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3.7.4 How to Add an External Data Source for the OpenScape Office Directory Service . . . . . . . . .
12.3.7.5 How to Preview LDAP Search Results for the OpenScape Office Directory Service . . . . . . . .
12.3.7.6 How to Enable or Disable an External Data Source for the OpenScape Office 
Directory Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3.7.7 How to Delete an External Data Source for the OpenScape Office Directory Service . . . . . . .
12.3.7.8 How to Add the Data Output Mappings for the OpenScape Office Directory Service. . . . . . . .
12.3.7.9 How to Enable or Disable the Data Output Mappings for the OpenScape Office 
Directory Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3.7.10 How to Delete the Data Output Mappings for the OpenScape Office Directory Service. . . . .
12.3.8 Favorites List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3.9 Journal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3.9.1 How to Change the Maximum Retention Period for the Journal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.4 Calls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.4.1 Call Number Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.4.2 Desktop Dialer and Clipboard Dialer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.4.3 Screen pops . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.4.4 Record calls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.4.4.1 How to Activate or Deactivate the Recording of Calls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.4.4.2 How to Activate or Deactivate the Recording Announcement. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.4.4.3 How to Activate or Deactivate the Warning Tone for Recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.5 Conferences. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.5.1 Conference Management (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.5.1.1 How to Change the Dial-in Number for a Virtual Conference Room . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.5.1.2 How to Allow or Prevent Multiple External Conference Participants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.5.1.3 How to Activate and Deactivate the Conference Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.5.1.4 How to Change the Time Interval for the Automatic Termination of a Conference . . . . . . . . . .
12.5.1.5 How to Display the Details of a Conference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.5.1.6 How to Enable or Disable the Recording of Conferences (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.5.2 Ad-hoc conference (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
438
439
440
440
441
442
443
443
445
446
446
447
447
448
448
448
449
449
450
453
454
454
455
457
458
458
459
460
460
461
461
463
463
463
464
465
465
466
466
467
467
467
471
472
472
473
473
473
474
13
Contents
12.5.3 Scheduled Conference (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 475
12.5.4 Permanent Conference (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 477
12.5.5 Open Conference (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 478
12.5.6 Web Collaboration Integration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 479
12.5.6.1 How to Configure the Integration of Web Collaboration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 481
12.6 Voice and Fax Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 481
12.6.1 Voicemail Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 481
12.6.1.1 How to Configure a Callback from the Voicemail Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 484
12.6.1.2 How to Configure Station Numbers for Voicemail (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 484
12.6.1.3 How to Configure Call Forwarding to a Voicemail Box (LX/MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 484
12.6.1.4 How to Configure Parameters for the Voicemail Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 485
12.6.1.5 How to Configure Retention Periods for Voicemail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 485
12.6.1.6 How to Configure an Info for Received Voicemails (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 486
12.6.1.7 How to Configure a Mailbox Key to Check Voicemail (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 486
12.6.2 Voicemail Announcements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 487
12.6.2.1 How to Import Announcements for the Voicemail Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 488
12.6.2.2 How to Change the Language for Voicemail Announcements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 489
12.6.3 Phone Menu of the Voicemail Box. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 489
12.6.3.1 How to Call a Voicemail Box from an Internal Phone. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 491
12.6.3.2 How to Call a Voicemail Box from an External Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 491
12.6.4 Fax box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 492
12.6.4.1 How to Add a Fax Box for Stations (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 492
12.6.4.2 How to Add a Fax Box for Stations (HX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 493
12.6.5 Sending Fax Messages with Fax Printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 493
12.6.5.1 How to Add a Central Cover Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 494
12.6.5.2 How to Edit a Central Cover Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 495
12.6.5.3 How to Add a Header Line for the Fax Printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 495
12.6.5.4 How to Change the Header Line for Fax Printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 496
12.6.5.5 How to Delete the Header Line for Fax Printer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 496
12.6.6 Notification Service for Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 497
12.6.7 Sending E-mails. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 497
12.6.7.1 How to Configure the Sending of E-mails. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 498
12.6.8 SMS Template . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 499
12.6.8.1 How to Add an SMS Template . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 499
12.6.8.2 How to Edit an SMS Template . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 500
12.6.8.3 How to Remove an SMS Template . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 501
12.6.9 Fax over IP (T.38 Fax) (LX/MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 501
12.6.9.1 How Enable or Disable Fax over IP (T.38 Fax) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 502
12.7 Instant Messaging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 503
12.7.1 Instant Messaging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 503
12.7.1.1 How to Enable and Disable Instant Messaging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 504
12.8 AutoAttendant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 504
12.8.1 Central AutoAttendant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 505
12.8.2 Personal AutoAttendant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 505
12.8.3 Announcements for the AutoAttendant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 506
12.8.3.1 How to Import Announcements for the Central AutoAttendant. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 508
12.8.3.2 How to Record Announcements for the Central AutoAttendant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 508
12.8.4 Profiles for the AutoAttendant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 509
12.8.4.1 How to Configure a Profile for the Central AutoAttendant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 509
12.8.4.2 How to Delete a Profile for the Central AutoAttendant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 510
12.9 Attendant Console Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 511
12.9.1 Subscriber Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 511
14
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Contents
12.9.2 Message Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 511
13 Functions at the Telephone (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.1 Making Calls (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.1.1 Digit Dialing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.1.2 En-Bloc Dialing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.1.3 End-of-Dialing Recognition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.1.4 Editing the Telephone Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.1.4.1 How to Activate or Deactivate Editing of the Telephone Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.1.5 Redial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.1.5.1 How to Enable or Disable Automatic Redialing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.1.6 System Speed Dialing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.1.6.1 How to Add Speed Dial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.1.6.2 How to Import Speed Dials from a CSV File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.1.7 Individual Speed Dialing (ISD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.1.8 Direct Station Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.1.9 Speaker Calls / Direct Answering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.1.9.1 How to Enable or Disable the Prevention of Speaker Calls for Stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.1.10 Associated Dialing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.1.11 Trunk Queuing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.1.11.1 How to Activate or Deactivate Trunk Queuing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.1.12 Private Trunk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.2 Call Signaling, Calling Line ID (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.2.1 Different Call Signaling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.2.2 Calling Line Identification Presentation (CLIP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.2.2.1 How to Enable or Disable Configurable CLIP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.2.3 Calling Line Identification Restriction (CLIR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.2.3.1 How to Enable or Disable Station Number Suppression. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.2.4 Connected Line Identification Presentation (COLP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.2.4.1 How to Enable or Disable Connected Line Identification Presentation (COLP . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.2.5 Connected Line Identification Restriction (COLR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.2.6 CLIP No Screening (Transmission of Customer-Specific Phone Number Information) . . . . . . . . . .
13.2.6.1 How to Configure CLIP No Screening. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.2.7 CLIP for Analog Telephones. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.2.8 Ringer Cutoff. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.2.9 Translating Station Numbers to Names for System Speed Dialing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.3 Functions During a Call (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.3.1 Hold . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.3.2 Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.3.3 Consultation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.3.4 Toggle/Connect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.3.5 Transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.3.6 Automatic Recall. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.3.7 Call Monitoring (Selected Countries Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.3.7.1 How to Activate or Deactivate Call Monitoring for a Station . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.4 Controlling Availability (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.4.1 Call Forwarding on Busy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.4.2 Call Forwarding—No Answer (CFNA) With a Timeout (Fixed Call Forwarding) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.4.2.1 How to Configure Call Forwarding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.4.3 Call Forwarding (CF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.4.3.1 How to Enable or Disable Call Forwarding over Analog Trunks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
13.4.3.2 How to Enable or Disable Call Forwarding to the External Destination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
513
513
513
513
514
514
514
515
516
516
518
518
519
519
520
521
521
522
523
523
523
523
524
525
525
526
526
527
527
528
528
529
529
529
529
530
530
531
531
532
532
533
534
534
535
535
536
537
539
540
15
Contents
13.4.4 Call Forwarding After Timeout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 540
13.4.5 External Call Forwarding - No Answer (Not for U.S.). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 541
13.4.6 Ringing Assignment / Call Allocation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 541
13.4.6.1 How to Configure a Ringing Assignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 541
13.4.7 Rejecting Calls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 542
13.4.8 Deferring a Call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 542
13.4.9 Do Not Disturb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 542
13.5 Optimizing Communication (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 543
13.5.1 Callback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 543
13.5.2 Call Waiting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 544
13.5.2.1 How to Enable or Disable Call Waiting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 545
13.5.2.2 How to Enable or Disable Immediate Call Waiting (Camp On) by the Attendant Console . . . . . 546
13.5.3 Barge-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 546
13.5.3.1 How to Activate or Deactivate the Override Class of Service. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 547
13.5.4 Advisory Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 547
13.5.4.1 How to Edit Advisory Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 548
13.5.5 Message Texts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 548
13.5.5.1 How to Edit Message Texts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 549
13.5.6 Associated Services. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 549
13.5.6.1 How to Activate or Deactivate Associated Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 550
13.5.7 Reset activated features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 550
13.5.8 Procedures. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 551
14 Working in a Team (Groups) (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 553
14.1 Call Pickup Group, Group Call and Hunt Group (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 553
14.1.1 Call Pickup Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 553
14.1.2 Group Call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 555
14.1.3 Hunt Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 558
14.1.4 Configuring Call Pickup Groups, Group Calls and Hunt Groups using Wizards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 561
14.1.4.1 How to Configure a Call Pickup Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 562
14.1.4.2 How to Add or Delete a Member to or from a Call Pickup Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 563
14.1.4.3 How to Add Group Call (Group) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 563
14.1.4.4 How to Edit a Group Call (Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 565
14.1.4.5 How to Delete a Group Call (Group) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 565
14.1.4.6 How to Add or Delete a Member to or from a Group Call (Group) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 566
14.1.4.7 How to Add a Hunt Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 566
14.1.4.8 How to Change a Hunt Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 568
14.1.4.9 How to Delete a Hunt Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 568
14.1.4.10 How to Add or Delete a Member to or from a Hunt Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 569
14.1.5 Configuring Call Pickup Groups, Group Calls and Hunt Groups using Expert Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . 570
14.1.5.1 How to Enable or Disable the Display of a Caller’s Station Number and Name . . . . . . . . . . . . 570
14.1.5.2 How to Activate or Deactivate the Warning Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 571
14.1.5.3 How to Enable or Disable Call Pickup for Recalls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 571
14.1.5.4 How to Add a Group Call (RNA or Call Waiting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 572
14.1.5.5 How to Display or Edit a Group Call (RNA or Call Waiting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 572
14.1.5.6 How to Delete a Group Call (RNA or Call Waiting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 573
14.1.5.7 How to Add or Delete a Member to or from a Group Call (RNA or Call Waiting . . . . . . . . . . . . 573
14.1.5.8 How to Enable or Disable Do Not Disturb for a Group Member . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 574
14.2 Team Configuration / Team Group and Executive/Secretary or Top Group (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 574
14.2.1 Team Configuration / Team Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 575
14.2.2 Executive/Secretary or Top Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 578
14.2.3 Configuring Team Configurations / Team Groups and Executive/Secretary Functions / Top Groups
16
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Contents
using Wizards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.3.1 How to Add a Team Configuration / Team Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.3.2 How to Edit a Team Configuration / Team Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.3.3 How to Delete a Team Configuration / Team Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.3.4 How to Add an Executive/Secretary or Top Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.3.5 How to Edit an Executive/Secretary or Top Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.3.6 How to Delete an Executive / Secretary or Top Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.4 Configuring Team configurations / Team groups and Executive/Secretary functions / Top 
groups using Expert mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.4.1 How to Add or Delete a Member to or from a Team Configuration or Team Group . . . . . . . . .
14.2.4.2 How to Edit a Member of a Team Configuration / Team Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.4.3 How to Edit the Properties of Members in a Team Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.4.4 How to Change the Programmed Feature Keys for a Team Configuration / Team Group . . .
14.2.4.5 How to Add a Fax Box to a Team Configuration / Team Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.4.6 How to Add or Delete a Member to or from an Executive/Secretary or Top Group . . . . . . . . .
14.2.4.7 How to Edit a Member of an Executive/Secretary or Top Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.4.8 How to Edit the Properties of an Executive/Secretary or Top Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.4.9 How to Add a Fax Box to an Executive/Secretary or Top Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.3 Basic MULAP and Executive MULAP (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.3.1 Basic MULAP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.3.2 Executive MULAP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.3.3 Configuring Basic MULAPs and Executive MULAPs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.3.3.1 How to Add a Basic MULAP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.3.3.2 How to Display or Edit a Basic MULAP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.3.3.3 How to Delete a Basic MULAP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.3.3.4 How to Add or Delete a Member to or from a Basic MULAP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.3.3.5 How to Edit a Member of a Basic MULAP. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.3.3.6 How to Add an Executive MULAP. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.3.3.7 How to Display or Edit an Executive MULAP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.3.3.8 How to Delete an Executive MULAP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.3.3.9 How to Add or Delete a Member to or from an Executive MULAP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.3.3.10 How to Edit a Member of an Executive MULAP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.4 Voicemail Group and Fax Box Group (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.4.1 Voicemail Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.4.2 Fax Box Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.4.3 Configuring Voicemail Box Groups and Fax Box Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.4.3.1 How to Add a Voicemail Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.4.3.2 How to Display or Edit a Voicemail Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.4.3.3 How to Delete a Voicemail Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.4.3.4 How to Add or Delete a Member to a Voicemail Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.4.3.5 How to Edit a Member of a Voicemail Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.4.3.6 How to Configure a Fax Box Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.4.3.7 How to Display or Edit a Fax Box Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.4.3.8 How to Add or Delete a Member to a Fax Box Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.5 Speaker Call for Groups (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.5.1 Internal Paging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.5.2 Transfer to Group from Announcement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.6 UCD (Uniform Call Distribution) (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.6.1 Call Distribution / UCD Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.6.1.1 How to Configure Call Distribution / UCD Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.6.2 UCD Agents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.6.2.1 How to Add or Delete UCD Agents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
582
583
584
584
585
586
587
587
588
589
589
590
590
591
591
592
592
593
593
595
598
598
599
599
600
600
601
601
602
602
603
603
604
604
605
605
606
606
607
607
608
609
609
610
610
610
611
612
612
614
615
17
Contents
14.6.3 Wrap up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 616
14.6.3.1 How to Change the Automatic Wrap-Up Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 616
14.6.4 Call Prioritization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 616
14.6.4.1 How to Change Request Priorities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 617
14.6.5 Accepting UCD Calls Automatically . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 618
14.6.5.1 How to Change the Automatic Acceptance of UCD Calls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 618
14.6.6 UCD queue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 618
14.6.6.1 How to Change the UCD Queue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 619
14.6.7 UCD Overflow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 620
14.6.7.1 How to Change the UCD Overflow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 620
14.6.8 UCD Night Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 621
14.6.9 Announcements / Music on Hold for UCD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 622
14.6.9.1 How to Change Announcements / Music on Hold for UCD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 622
14.6.10 Transfer to UCD Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 623
14.6.10.1 How to Edit the Recall Time for Calls Transferred to UCD Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 623
14.6.11 Releasing UCD from Analog Lines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 624
14.6.11.1 How to Edit the Release Time for UCD Calls over Analog Trunks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 624
15 Call Routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 625
15.1 Toll and Call Restrictions (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 625
15.1.1 Selective Seizure of Exchange Lines (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 625
15.1.1.1 How to Configure the Code for the Selective Seizure of ISDN Trunks. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 625
15.1.1.2 How to Selectively Display Seized ISDN Trunks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 626
15.1.2 Classes of Service, Toll Restriction (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 626
15.1.2.1 How to Configure Toll Restriction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 628
15.1.2.2 How to Selectively Assign Classes of Service for Emergency Calls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 628
15.1.2.3 How to Assign Classes of Service via Allowed and Denied Lists. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 629
15.1.2.4 How to Display Allowed Lists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 629
15.1.2.5 How to Add a Phone Number to the Allowed List. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 630
15.1.2.6 How to Display Denied Lists. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 630
15.1.2.7 How to Add a Phone Number to the Denied List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 630
15.1.2.8 How to Edit the Analysis Filter for the Denied List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 631
15.1.3 CON Groups (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 631
15.1.3.1 CON Groups (Traffic Restriction Groups) (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 631
15.1.3.2 Assigning Speed-Dialing Numbers to CON Groups (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 632
15.1.3.3 How to Assign Stations to a CON Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 632
15.1.3.4 How to Assign a Trunk to a CON Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 633
15.1.3.5 How to Edit the CON Matrix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 633
15.2 Night Service and Intercept (LX/MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 634
15.2.1 Night Service (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 634
15.2.1.1 How to Assign Classes of Service for the Variable (Manual) Night Service. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 635
15.2.1.2 How to Delete Classes of Service for the Variable (Manual) Night Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 635
15.2.1.3 How to Configure a Holiday for the Fixed (Automatic) Night Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 636
15.2.1.4 How to Delete a Holiday for the Fixed (Automatic) Night Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 636
15.2.1.5 How to Edit the Classes of Service of a COS Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 637
15.2.1.6 How to Display Group Members of a COS Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 637
15.2.2 Intercept . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 637
15.2.2.1 How to Configure the Intercept Position and Intercept Criteria (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 639
15.2.2.2 How to Configure the Central Intercept Position (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 639
15.2.2.3 How to Configure the Telephone Lock Intercept (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 640
15.2.2.4 How to Configure the Intercept Announcement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 640
15.3 LCR (Least Cost Routing) (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 641
18
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Contents
15.3.1 LCR Functionality (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15.3.1.1 How to Select Digit Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15.3.2 LCR Dial Plan (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15.3.2.1 How to Edit the Dial Plan. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15.3.3 LCR Routing Tables (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15.3.3.1 How to Edit Routing Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15.3.4 LCR Class of Service (COS) (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15.3.4.1 How to Assign and Change an LCR Class of Service. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15.3.5 LCR Outdial Rules (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15.3.5.1 How to Edit the Outdial Rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15.3.6 Network Carriers (LX/MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15.4 Emergency Calls (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15.4.1 Hotline after Timeout / Hotline (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15.4.1.1 How to Configure and Change the Hotline Destination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15.4.1.2 How to Change the Hotline Timeout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15.4.1.3 How to Configure an Off-Hook Alarm after Timeout or Hotline for a Station . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15.4.2 Trunk Release for Emergency Call (LX/MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15.4.2.1 How to Activate and Deactivate Trunk Release for Emergency Call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15.4.3 For U.S. and Canada only: E911 Emergency Call Service (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15.4.3.1 How to Edit CLIP / Lin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15.4.4 Emergency Calls in Combination with Mobile Logon . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15.4.4.1 Configuring the Emergency Scenario . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15.5 Call Admission Control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15.5.1 Limiting the Number of Simultaneous Calls via an ITSP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15.5.2 Restricting the bandwidth requirements for gateway calls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15.5.3 Limiting the Number of Calls in Networking Scenarios. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
641
644
644
646
646
647
648
648
648
650
651
652
653
654
654
655
655
655
656
656
657
657
660
661
661
661
16 Multimedia Contact Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.1 Contact Center Clients . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.1.1 myAgent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.1.2 Prerequisites for myAgent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.1.3 myReports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.1.3.1 How to Reset the myReports Administrator Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.1.4 Prerequisites for myReports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.1.5 Notes on Using myAgent and UC Clients Simultaneously . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.2 Agents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.2.1 Agent Functions Independent of the Authorization Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.2.2 Preferred Agents. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.2.3 Agents in multiple queues . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.2.4 Contact Center Breaks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.3 Queues and Schedules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.3.1 Queues . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.3.2 Schedules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.3.3 Wrap up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.3.4 Grade of Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.3.5 Wallboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.3.6 Agent Callback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.4 VIP service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.4.1 VIP Caller Priority . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.4.2 VIP Call List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.5 Fallback solution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.6 Configuring the Contact Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
662
662
663
664
666
668
668
670
671
672
673
673
673
674
674
675
682
683
683
683
683
684
684
685
687
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
19
Contents
16.6.1 Example of an OpenScape Office MX Contact Center Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 688
16.6.1.1 How to Configure UCD Groups for the Sample Contact Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 690
16.6.1.2 How to Configure a Fallback Solution for the Sample Contact Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 691
16.6.1.3 How to Configure Subscribers as Agents for the Sample Contact Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 692
16.6.1.4 How to Add Announcements for the Sample Contact Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 693
16.6.1.5 How to Load Announcements for the Sample Contact Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 693
16.6.1.6 How to Add the Standard Schedule XYZ for the Sample Contact Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 694
16.6.1.7 How to Add the Standard Schedule Hotline for the Sample Contact Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 699
16.6.1.8 How to Add Queues for the Sample Contact Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 701
16.6.1.9 How to Assign Agents to Queues of the Sample Contact Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 703
16.6.2 Example of an OpenScape Office HX Contact Center Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 705
16.6.2.1 How to Configure UCD Groups for the Sample Contact Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 714
16.6.2.2 How to Configure a Fallback Solution for the Sample Contact Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 715
16.6.2.3 How to Configure Station Numbers to Appear on the Display of External Subscribers . . . . . . 716
16.6.2.4 How to Transfer Settings to HiPath 3000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 718
16.6.2.5 How to Configure Subscribers as Agents for the Sample Contact Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 718
16.6.2.6 How to Add Announcements for the Sample Contact Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 719
16.6.2.7 How to Load Announcements for the Sample Contact Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 720
16.6.2.8 How to Add a Timetable Schedule for the Sample Contact Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 720
16.6.2.9 How to Add a Free Call Schedule for the Sample Contact Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 726
16.6.2.10 How to Add Queues for the Sample Contact Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 728
16.6.2.11 How to Assign Agents to Queues of the Sample Contact Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 730
16.6.3 Configuration Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 732
16.6.3.1 How to Configure UCD Groups for the OpenScape Office MX Contact Center . . . . . . . . . . . . 732
16.6.3.2 How to Configure UCD Groups for the OpenScape Office HX Contact Center . . . . . . . . . . . . 733
16.6.3.3 How to Configure a Subscriber as an Agent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 734
16.6.3.4 How to Record Custom Announcements for the Contact Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 735
16.6.3.5 How to Load Custom Announcements for the Contact Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 736
16.6.3.6 How to Add a Schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 737
16.6.3.7 How to Edit a Schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 739
16.6.3.8 How to Delete a Schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 740
16.6.3.9 How to Save a Rule (CCV) as a PDF File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 741
16.6.3.10 How to Add a Queue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 742
16.6.3.11 How to Edit a Queue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 745
16.6.3.12 How to Delete Queues . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 747
16.6.3.13 How to Activate or Deactivate a Queue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 748
16.6.3.14 How to Configure a Pilot for Incoming Fax Messages in Queues . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 748
16.6.3.15 How to Define Target Values for the Grade Of Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 749
16.6.3.16 How to Define the VIP Caller Priority . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 749
16.6.3.17 How to Edit the VIP Call List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 750
16.6.3.18 How to Define Preferred Agents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 751
16.6.3.19 How to Delete Preferred Agents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 752
16.6.3.20 How to Add a Contact Center Break . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 752
16.6.3.21 How to Edit a Contact Center Break . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 753
16.6.3.22 How to Delete a Contact Center Break . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 753
16.6.3.23 How to Add a Wrapup Reason for a “Simple Wrapup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 753
16.6.3.24 How to Edit a Wrapup Reason for a “Simple Wrapup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 754
16.6.3.25 How to Delete a Wrapup Reason for a “Simple Wrapup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 754
16.6.3.26 How to Add a Wrapup Reason for a “Multiple Wrapup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 755
16.6.3.27 How to Edit a Wrapup Reason for a “Multiple Wrapup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 756
16.6.3.28 How to Delete a Wrapup Reason for a “Multiple Wrapup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 756
16.6.3.29 How to Assign an Agent to a Queue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 757
20
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Contents
16.6.3.30 How to Remove an Agent from the Queue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.7 Notes on Using the Contact Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.7.1 Using the Contact Center in a Communication System with IP Trunks and Outside Line . . . . . . . .
16.7.1.1 How to Assign Agents to a CON Group (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.7.1.2 How to Assign IP Trunks to a Separate CON Group (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.7.1.3 How to Assign Analog CO Trunks to a Separate CON Group (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.7.1.4 How to Define a CON Matrix (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.7.2 Restrictions on Operating the Contact Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.8 Notes on the Use of DECT Telephones (HiPath Cordless Office) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.9 Reports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.9.1 Predefined Report Templates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16.9.2 Report Designer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
758
758
758
759
759
760
760
761
763
764
765
766
17 Mobility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.1 Integrated Mobility Solution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.2 Mobility on the Road . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.2.1 myPortal for Mobile. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.2.1.1 Prerequisites for myPortal for Mobile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.2.2 Mobility Entry (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.2.3 Comparison between myPortal for Mobile and Mobility Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.2.4 Dependencies for myPortal for Mobile and Mobility Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.2.5 One Number Service (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.2.6 Dual-Mode Telephony (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.2.7 Configuring myPortal for Mobile and Mobility Entry (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.2.7.1 How to Integrate GSM Mobile Phones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.2.7.2 How to Integrate Dual-Mode Telephones for SIP Clients . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.2.7.3 How to Configure Mobile Phones for myPortal for Mobile. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.2.7.4 How to Change the Operating Mode for Mobile Phones. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.2.7.5 How to Configure Mobility Callback for Mobile Phones. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.2.7.6 How to Enable or Disable the Web Interface for Mobile Phones and Web Clients . . . . . . . . . .
17.2.7.7 How to Enable the Saving of Login Data in Mobile Phones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.2.7.8 How to Configure DSS Keys for Call Pickup between System Phones and Mobile Phones . .
17.2.7.9 How to Delete Mobile Phone Integration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.2.8 Configuring myPortal for Mobile and Mobility Entry (HX/HiPath 3000). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.2.8.1 How to Activate LCR (Least Cost Routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.2.8.2 How to Configure a MULAP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.2.8.3 How to Configure Mobility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.2.9 DISA (MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.2.9.1 How to Activate or Deactivate a DISA Class of Service for a Station . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.2.9.2 How to Configure a DISA Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.2.9.3 How to Configure the DISA Security Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.3 Mobility in the Office (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.3.1 IP Mobility / Desk Sharing (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.3.1.1 Mobile Logon (LX/MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.3.1.2 Flex Call/Mobile PIN (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.3.2 HiPath Cordless IP (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.3.3 WLAN Phones and Access Points (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.3.4 WLAN Requirements (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.4 Mobility at Home (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
767
767
768
768
770
772
774
776
778
779
779
780
781
782
783
783
784
785
785
786
786
786
787
788
788
789
790
790
791
791
792
792
793
793
793
794
18 Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 795
18.1 VPN (Virtual Private Network) (MX)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 795
18.1.1 LAN Requirements for a VPN (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 797
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
21
Contents
18.1.2 Connecting Teleworkers via a VPN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 799
18.1.2.1 How to Connect Teleworkers via a VPN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 800
18.1.2.2 How to Export and Import VPN Configuration Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 802
18.1.3 Networking Communication Systems via a VPN (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 803
18.1.3.1 How to Network two Systems via a VPN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 804
18.1.3.2 How to Connect Teleworkers to Networked Systems (via a VPN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 806
18.1.4 VPN - Security Mechanisms (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 808
18.1.5 VPN - Certificates (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 810
18.1.5.1 VPN - Lightweight CA - How to Generate Certificates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 811
18.1.5.2 VPN - Certificate Management - How to View a Certificate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 812
18.1.5.3 VPN - How to Import a Trusted CA Certificate (X.509) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 813
18.1.5.4 VPN - Peer Certificate - How to Generate a Certificate Signing Request (CSR . . . . . . . . . . . . 813
18.1.5.5 VPN - Peer Certificate - How to Generate a Certificate (PKCS#12 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 814
18.1.5.6 VPN - How to Import a Peer Certificate (PKCS#12). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 815
18.1.6 VPN - Clients (MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 815
18.1.6.1 NCP Client Settings (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 816
18.1.6.2 How to Provision the NCP Client . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 818
18.1.6.3 How to Activate and Deactivate the NCP Client. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 819
18.1.6.4 Microsoft Windows XP Client Settings (MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 819
18.1.6.5 How to Provision the Windows XP Client . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 822
18.1.6.6 How to Activate and Deactivate the Windows XP Client . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 823
18.1.6.7 How to Configure the Shrew Soft VPN Client to Connect Teleworkers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 823
18.1.6.8 How to Provision the Shrew Soft VPN Client for Teleworkers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 824
18.1.7 VPN Services (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 824
18.1.7.1 VPN - Active Services - How to Display all IPsec Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 824
18.1.7.2 VPN - Active Services - How to Display a Special IPsec Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 825
18.1.7.3 VPN - Configured Services - How to Display all IPsec Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 825
18.1.7.4 VPN - Configured Services - How to Edit the IPsec Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 826
18.1.7.5 VPN - Configured Services - How to Rename the IPsec Service. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 826
18.1.7.6 VPN - Configured Services - How to Delete the IPsec Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 827
18.1.8 VPN - Tunnel (MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 827
18.1.8.1 VPN - Active Tunnels - How to Display General Tunnel Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 827
18.1.8.2 VPN - Active Tunnels - How to Display Rules for all Tunnels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 828
18.1.8.3 VPN - Configured Tunnels - How to Display General Tunnel Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 828
18.1.8.4 VPN - Configured Tunnels - How to Display Rules for all Tunnels. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 829
18.1.8.5 VPN - How to Add a Configured Tunnel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 829
18.1.9 VPN - Rules (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 831
18.1.9.1 VPN - Active Rules - How to Display Rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 831
18.1.9.2 VPN - Active Rules - How to Display Special Rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 832
18.1.9.3 VPN - Configured Rules - How to Display all Rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 832
18.1.9.4 VPN - Configured Rules - How to Add a Rule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 833
18.1.9.5 VPN - How to Edit a Rule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 833
18.1.9.6 VPN - How to Add a Rule for the Opposite Direction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 834
18.1.9.7 VPN - How to Delete a Rule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 835
18.1.10 PKI Server (MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 835
18.1.10.1 VPN - How to Display PKI Servers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 835
18.1.10.2 VPN - How to Add a PKI Server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 836
18.1.11 Upgrading a VPN Configuration from V3.2 to V3.3 (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 836
18.1.11.1 How to Proceed if the VPN Configuration was Created using the Wizard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 836
18.1.11.2 How to Proceed if the VPN Configuration was Created using the Wizard and Expert Mode . . 837
18.1.11.3 How to Proceed if the VPN Configuration was Created using Expert Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 837
18.1.11.4 How to Import and Export VPN Topology Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 838
22
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Contents
18.1.11.5 How to Export VPN Teleworker Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.2 Firewall (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.2.1 Ports and Services (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.2.1.1 Port Administration and Port Forwarding (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.2.1.2 How to Edit Global Port Management Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.2.1.3 Opening Ports (MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.2.1.4 How to Configure the Opening of Ports. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.2.2 URL Blocker (MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.2.2.1 How to Configure the URL Blocker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.2.2.2 How to Disable Proxy Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.2.3 Expression Filter (Web Filter) (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.2.3.1 How to Configure a Web Filter (Expression Filter) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.2.4 Intrusion Detection System (IDS) (MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.2.4.1 How to Enable or Disable the Intrusion Detection System (IDS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.2.5 Services Administration (LX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.2.5.1 How to Add or Block Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.3 MAC and IP Address Filtering (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.3.1 How to Display MAC Address Filtering. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.3.2 How to Add a Rule for MAC Address Filtering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.3.3 How to Edit the Rule for MAC Address Filtering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.3.4 How to Delete all MAC Address Filtering Rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.3.5 How to Enable or Disable a MAC Address Filtering Rule. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.3.6 How to Display IP Address Filtering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.3.7 How to Add a Rule for IP Address Filtering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.3.8 How to Edit the Rule for IP Address Filtering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.3.9 How to Delete all IP Address Filtering Rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.3.10 How to Enable or Disable IP Address Filtering. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.4 Secure Administration (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.4.1 SSL (Secure Socket Layer) (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.4.1.1 SSL - How to Generate CA Certificates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.4.1.2 SSL - How to Generate Self-Signed Certificates. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.4.1.3 SSL - How to Import Trusted CA Certificates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.4.1.4 SSL - How to Generate Certificate Signing Requests (CSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.4.1.5 SSL - How to Import Server Certificates (PKCS#12) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.4.1.6 SSL - How to Display Certificates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.4.1.7 SSL - How to Delete Certificates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.4.1.8 SSL - How to Export Certificates (X.509) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.4.1.9 SSL - How to Import Updated Certificates (X.509) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.4.1.10 SSL - How to Activate Certificates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.4.2 Admin Log (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.4.2.1 How to Load the Admin Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.4.2.2 How to Change the Admin Log Language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.4.2.3 How to Delete an Admin Log on the Gateway . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.5 Security at the Phone. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.5.1 Central Lock Code, COS Changeover (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.5.2 Individual Lock Code (Locking the Phone) (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.5.2.1 How to Reset the System Telephone Lock Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.6 Signaling and Payload Encryption (SPE) (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.6.1 How to Enable or Disable SPE Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.6.2 How Change the SPE Security Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.6.3 How to Import an SPE Certificate and Private Key (PKCS#12) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.6.4 How to Import an SPE CA Certificate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
838
838
839
840
840
841
841
842
842
843
844
844
845
846
846
847
847
848
848
849
849
849
850
850
851
851
852
852
853
853
854
854
855
855
856
856
857
857
857
858
858
858
859
859
859
860
860
861
862
862
863
863
23
Contents
18.6.5 How to Enable or Disable SPE for a Station . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 864
18.7 Samba Share (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 864
18.7.1 How to Enable or Disable a SAMBA Share . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 865
18.7.2 How to Configure Write Protection for a Samba Share . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 865
18.7.3 How to Import a CSV File from a SAMBA Share into the External Directory. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 866
18.8 SIP Attack Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 867
19 Networking OpenScape Office . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 869
19.1 Network Plan. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 869
19.1.1 Homogeneous and Heterogeneous Networks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 870
19.1.2 Single and Multi-Gateway . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 870
19.1.3 Removing a Node from the Internetwork . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 871
19.2 Network-wide Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 872
19.2.1 Network-wide Features of UC Clients . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 872
19.2.2 Network-wide Voice Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 878
19.2.3 Central Intercept Position in the Internetwork (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 879
19.2.3.1 How to Configure a Central Intercept Position in the Multi-Gateway Internetwork . . . . . . . . . . . 880
19.3 Licensing an Internetwork . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 882
19.4 Networking Requirements. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 882
19.4.1 LAN Networking Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 883
19.4.2 WAN Networking Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 885
19.4.3 Dial Plan in the Network. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 887
19.5 Path Optimization (Path Replacement) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 888
19.5.1 How to Enable or Disable Path Optimization (Path Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 889
19.6 Networking Scenarios . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 889
19.6.1 General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 890
19.6.2 Scenario 1: Networking Multiple OpenScape Office MX Systems. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 891
19.6.3 Configuring Scenario 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 894
19.6.3.1 How to Configure the Basic Installation for Node 1 (Master) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 896
19.6.3.2 How to Configure Networking for Node 1 (Master). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 897
19.6.3.3 How to Configure the Basic Installation for Node 2 (Slave) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 898
19.6.3.4 How to Configure Networking for Node 2 (Slave). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 899
19.6.3.5 How to Verify the Networking Function for the Master . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 900
19.6.3.6 How to Configure Routes and Routing Parameters (ISDN Trunk for the Master) . . . . . . . . . . . 900
19.6.3.7 How to Configure Routes and Routing Parameters (Trk. Grp. 64) (Master) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 901
19.6.3.8 How to Configure Least Cost Routing (LCR) for the Network (Master) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 901
19.6.3.9 How to Configure Routes and Routing Parameters (Slave) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 903
19.6.3.10 How to Configure Least Cost Routing (LCR) for the Network (Slave) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 903
19.6.4 Scenario 2: Networking Multiple OpenScape Office HX Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 904
19.6.5 Configuring Scenario 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 907
19.6.5.1 How to Configure a Network of Multiple OpenScape Office HX Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 908
19.6.6 Scenario 3: Networking of OpenScape Office LX and OpenScape Office MX (Single Gateway) . . . 909
19.6.7 Configuring Scenario 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 912
19.6.7.1 How to Configure the Basic Installation for Node 1 (Master) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 916
19.6.7.2 How to Configure Networking for Node 1 (Master). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 917
19.6.7.3 How to Configure the Basic Installation for Node 2 (Slave) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 918
19.6.7.4 How to Configure Networking for Node 2 (Slave). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 919
19.6.7.5 How to Configure the Basic Installation for Node 3 (Slave) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 920
19.6.7.6 How to Configure Networking for Node 3 (Slave). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 921
19.6.7.7 How to Verify the Networking Function for the Master . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 922
19.6.7.8 How to Configure Least Cost Routing (LCR) for the Network (Node 3, Slave) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 922
19.6.7.9 How to Configure LCR for Networking (Node 2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 924
24
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Contents
19.6.7.10 How to Configure Routes and Routing Parameters (Node 1, Master) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.6.7.11 How to Configure Routes and Routing Parameters (Trk. Grp. 64, Node 1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.6.7.12 How to Configure LCR for Networking (Node 1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.6.8 Scenario 4: Networking Multiple OpenScape Office MX Systems with one OpenScape 
Office LX (Multi- Gateway) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.6.9 Configuring Scenario 4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.6.9.1 How to Configure the Basic Installation for Node 4 (LX, Master . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.6.9.2 How to Configure Networking for Node 4 (Master) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.6.9.3 How to Configure the Basic Installation for Node 1 (Slave) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.6.9.4 How to Configure Networking for Node 1 (Slave) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.6.9.5 How to Configure the Basic Installation for Node 2 (Slave) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.6.9.6 How to Configure Networking for Node 2 (Slave) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.6.9.7 How to Configure the Basic Installation for Node 3 (Slave) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.6.9.8 How to Configure Networking for Node 3 (Slave) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.6.9.9 How to Verify the Networking Function for the Master . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.6.9.10 How to Configure a Multi-Gateway for Node 4 (Master) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.6.9.11 How to Configure Routes and Routing Parameters (Node 1, Slave) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.6.9.12 How to Configure Least Cost Routing (LCR) for the Network (Node 1, Slave) . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.6.9.13 How to Configure Routes and Routing Parameters (Node 2, Slave) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.6.9.14 How to Configure Least Cost Routing (LCR) for the Network (Node 2, Slave) . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.6.9.15 How to Configure Least Cost Routing (LCR) for the Network (Node 3, Slave) . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.6.9.16 How to Configure Routes and Routing Parameters (Node 4, Master) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.6.9.17 How to Configure Least Cost Routing (LCR) for the Network (Node 4, Master) . . . . . . . . . . .
19.6.10 Scenario 5: Networking OpenScape Office LX/MX/HX and HiPath 3000. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.6.10.1 How to Configure OpenScape Office LX (Master . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.6.10.2 How to Configure OpenScape Office MX (Slave. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.6.10.3 How to Configure OpenScape Office HX (Slave . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.7 Synchronization Status in the Internetwork . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.7.1 Manual Synchronization in the Internetwork. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.7.2 How to Start Synchronization Manually . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.8 Survivability (Only LX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.8.1 How to Configure Survivability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
929
931
937
938
939
940
941
942
943
944
944
945
946
946
949
949
952
954
955
958
960
961
962
963
963
964
964
965
20 Application Connectivity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
20.1 XMPP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
20.1.1 How to Configure XMPP. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
20.2 Application Launcher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
20.2.1 Prerequisites for Application Launcher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
20.2.2 Profile with Configuration Data for Application Launcher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
20.2.2.1 How to Provide a Profile with Configuration Data for Application Launcher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
966
966
967
967
968
969
969
21 Auxiliary Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
21.1 Fax Devices and Fax Servers (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
21.1.1 How to Add an Analog Fax Device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
21.1.2 How to Add an ISDN Fax Device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
21.2 Entrance Telephone and Door Opener (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
21.2.1 How to Configure Entrance Telephones. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
21.3 OpenStage Gate View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
21.3.1 Legal Framework . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
21.3.2 Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
21.3.3 Function Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
21.3.4 Menu. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
21.3.5 Initial Setup of OpenStage Gate View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
970
970
971
971
972
972
973
973
973
974
975
976
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
926
926
927
25
Contents
21.3.5.1 How to Start the Server Software for the First Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 977
21.3.5.2 How to Change Your Administrator Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 977
21.3.5.3 How to Add a Camera . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 978
21.3.5.4 How to Add a Telephone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 978
21.3.5.5 How to Set up the Video Function at the Telephone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 979
21.3.6 OpenStage Gate View Video Recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 980
21.3.6.1 How to Set up Recordings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 981
21.3.6.2 How to Edit Existing Recordings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 982
21.3.7 OpenStage Gate View Entrance Telephone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 982
21.3.7.1 How to Set up the Entrance Telephone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 983
21.3.8 OpenStage Gate View User Management. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 983
21.3.8.1 How to Add a User . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 984
21.3.8.2 How to Edit User Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 984
21.3.8.3 How to Delete a User . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 985
21.3.9 OpenStage Gate View Server Administration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 985
21.3.9.1 How to Open the Administration Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 985
21.3.9.2 How to Display Software Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 986
21.3.9.3 How to Delete Server Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 986
21.3.9.4 How to Display and Save the Log File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 987
21.3.10 OpenStage Gate View Customizations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 987
21.3.10.1 How to Add a Camera manually . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 988
21.3.10.2 How to Delete a Camera . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 988
21.3.10.3 How to Add a Telephone Manually. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 989
21.3.10.4 How to Delete a Telephone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 989
21.3.10.5 How to Deactivate the OpenStage Gate View Server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 990
22 Accounting (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 991
22.1 Call Detail Recording (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 991
22.1.1 Call Detail Recording Central (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 991
22.1.1.1 How to Configure Call Charging Factors, Currency and Computing Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . 996
22.1.1.2 How to Activate or Deactivate the Display of the Last Four Digits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 997
22.1.1.3 How to Activate or Deactivate Incoming Call Logging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 997
22.1.1.4 How to Activate or Deactivate Call Duration Logging. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 997
22.1.1.5 How to Activate or Deactivate the Call Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 998
22.1.1.6 How to Activate or Deactivate Output MSN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 998
22.1.1.7 How to Activate or Deactivate the Decimal Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 999
22.1.1.8 How to Activate or Deactivate the Display of Amounts Instead of Units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 999
22.1.1.9 How to Enable or Disable Outgoing Call Logging without a Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1000
22.1.1.10 How to Define the IP Address of the TCP Client . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1000
22.1.2 Enabling or Disabling Call Detail Recording (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1000
22.1.2.1 How to Enable or Disable Central Call Charge Recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1001
22.1.3 Account Codes (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1001
22.1.3.1 How to Configure Account Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1002
22.1.3.2 How to Configure the Account Code Checking Procedure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1003
22.1.3.3 How to Activate or Deactivate Number Redial with ACCT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1003
22.2 Display of Call Charges and Call Duration (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1004
22.2.1 Advice of Charges at Station (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1004
22.2.2 Call Duration Display on Telephone (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1004
22.2.2.1 How to Activate or Deactivate Call Timer Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1005
22.2.3 Call-Charge Display with Currency (not for U.S.) (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1005
22.2.3.1 How to Configure the Call-Charge Display with Currency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1006
22.3 Cost Control (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1006
26
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Contents
22.3.1 Expensive Connection Route Advisory (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
22.3.1.1 How to Configure the Expensive Connection Route Advisory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
22.3.2 Toll Fraud Monitoring (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
22.3.2.1 How to Enable or Disable Toll Fraud Monitoring. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
22.4 Accounting Tools (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
22.4.1 Accounting Manager (LX/MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
22.4.2 Teledata Office (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1006
1007
1007
1007
1008
1008
1008
23 Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.1 Telephony Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.1.1 Date and Time (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.1.1.1 How to Configure the Date and Time Manually. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.1.1.2 How to Set the Time Zone. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.1.1.3 How to Configure the Date Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.1.2 SNTP (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.1.2.1 How to Obtain the Date and Time from an SNTP Server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.1.3 Telephone Logos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.1.3.1 How to Import a Phone Logo. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.1.3.2 How to Assign a Phone Logo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.1.3.3 How to Delete a Phone Logo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.1.4 Customized Display ( (LX/MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.1.4.1 How to Change the Customer-Specific Display (System Name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.1.5 Flexible Menus (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.1.5.1 How to Edit the Flexible Menu. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.1.6 Music on Hold (LX/MX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.1.6.1 How to Configure the Music on Hold Functionality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.1.6.2 How to Import Music on Hold . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.1.6.3 How to Change the Music on Hold for a Traffic Restriction Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.1.7 Music on Hold / Announcements Wizard (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.1.7.1 How to Configure Internal Music On Hold . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.1.8 Announcements (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.1.8.1 How to Configure Announcements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.1.9 User to User Signaling (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.1.10 Voice Channel Signaling Security (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.1.11 Time Parameters (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.1.12 Controlling Centrex Features (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.1.12.1 How to Enable or Disable the Control of Centrex Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.2 Backup and Restore . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.2.1 Backup Sets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.2.1.1 How to Display Backup Sets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.2.1.2 How to Delete Backup Sets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.2.2 Backup Media . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.2.2.1 How to Add a Backup Medium . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.2.2.2 How to Edit a Backup Medium . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.2.2.3 How to Delete a Backup Medium . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.2.3 Immediate Backup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.2.3.1 How to Save a Backup Set Immediately . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.2.4 Scheduled Backup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.2.4.1 How to Save a Backup Set with a Scheduled Backup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.2.5 Restore . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.2.5.1 How to Restore a Backup Set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.3 Updates and Upgrades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1009
1009
1009
1010
1010
1011
1011
1011
1012
1012
1013
1013
1013
1014
1014
1014
1015
1015
1016
1016
1017
1017
1018
1018
1019
1019
1019
1020
1020
1020
1021
1022
1022
1022
1023
1024
1024
1024
1025
1026
1026
1027
1027
1028
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
27
Contents
23.3.1 Using an Internal Web Server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1029
23.3.1.1 How to Configure Access to the Internal Web Server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1030
23.3.2 Updating OpenScape Office . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1030
23.3.2.1 How to Update OpenScape Office via a Web Server. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1031
23.3.2.2 How to Update OpenScape Office with an Image File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1032
23.3.3 Updating System Telephones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1033
23.3.3.1 How to Load Phone Software. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1033
23.3.3.2 How to Delete Phone Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1034
23.3.3.3 How to Enable or Disable Phone Software as the Default . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1034
23.3.3.4 How to Deploy Phone Software to a Phone Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1035
23.3.3.5 How to Deploy Phone Software to a Telephone. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1035
23.3.4 Software Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1036
23.3.4.1 How to Check the Software Status. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1036
23.3.5 Upgrading from OpenScape Office V2 LX/MX to OpenScape Office V3 LX/MX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1036
23.3.5.1 How to Back up Data from V2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1037
23.3.5.2 How to Perform an Update to V3 via a Web Server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1038
23.3.5.3 How to Perform an Update to V3 Using the Image File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1039
23.3.5.4 How to Activate the Upgrade License . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1040
23.3.5.5 How to Assign Comfort Plus User Licenses to IP Stations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1040
23.3.5.6 How to Update the Factory Default Image (Golden Image) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1041
23.3.6 Upgrading from OpenScape Office HX V2 to OpenScape Office V3 HX. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1041
23.3.6.1 How to Back up Data from OpenScape Office HX V2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1043
23.3.6.2 How to Clear the Connection between HiPath 3000 and OpenScape Office HX. . . . . . . . . . . 1043
23.3.6.3 How to Upgrade HiPath 3000 V8 to HiPath 3000 V9 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1044
23.3.6.4 How to Update Licenses. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1045
23.3.6.5 How to Configure IP Trunks for OpenScape Office HX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1046
23.3.6.6 How to Install SLES 11. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1047
23.3.6.7 How to Install OpenScape Office HX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1047
23.3.6.8 How to Load Data from OpenScape Office HX V2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1047
23.3.6.9 How to Restore the Connection between HiPath 3000 and OpenScape Office HX. . . . . . . . . 1047
23.3.7 Upgrading UC Clients from V2 to V3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1048
23.3.7.1 How to Upgrade UC Clients from V2 to V3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1048
23.4 Restart, Reload, Shutdown, Factory Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1049
23.4.1 Restarting OpenScape Office . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1049
23.4.1.1 How to Initiate a Restart of OpenScape Office . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1050
23.4.2 Reloading OpenScape Office . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1050
23.4.2.1 How to Initiate a Reload of OpenScape Office . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1051
23.4.3 Restarting the UC Suite . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1052
23.4.3.1 How to Initiate a Restart of the UC Suite . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1052
23.4.4 Restarting the Web Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1053
23.4.4.1 How to Restart the Web Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1053
23.4.5 Shutting Down the OpenScape Office MX Communication System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1053
23.4.5.1 How to Shut Down the penScape Office MX Communication System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1054
23.4.6 Factory Reset of the OpenScape Office MX Communication System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1054
23.4.6.1 How to Perform a Factory Reset of a One-box System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1055
23.4.6.2 How to Perform a Factory Reset of a Multi-box System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1056
23.4.7 System Behavior after Pressing the On/Off Switch (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1057
23.4.8 System Behavior after Unlocking the Module Release Latch of the Motherboard (MX) . . . . . . . . . 1059
23.4.9 System Behavior after Initiating a Reset via the Reset Switch (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1060
23.4.10 System Behavior after Initiating a Reload via the Reset Switch (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1061
23.5 Inventory Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1062
23.5.1 System Status (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1063
28
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Contents
23.5.1.1 How to Check the Network Status (Status of Interfaces) (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.5.1.2 How to Check the Station Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.5.1.3 How to Check the Status of the Connection Setup (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.5.1.4 How to Check the ITSP Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.5.1.5 How to Check the VPN Status (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.5.1.6 How to Display or Print the Dial Plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.5.1.7 How to Display IP Addresses (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.5.2 Inventory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.5.2.1 How to Check the Inventory of OpenScape Office MX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.5.2.2 How to Check the Inventory of OpenScape Office LX/HX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.5.3 Hardware Configuration (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.5.3.1 How to Display the Hardware Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.5.3.2 How to Replace one Gateway Module with Another . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.6 Automatic Actions ( (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.6.1 Garbage Collection Automatic Action . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.6.1.1 How to Edit the Garbage Collection Automatic Action . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.6.1.2 How to Start the Garbage Collection Automatic Action (Activate) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.6.1.3 How to Stop the Garbage Collection Automatic Action (Deactivate) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.6.2 DLS Notification Automatic Action . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.6.2.1 How to Edit the DLS Notification Automatic Action . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.6.2.2 How to Start the DLS Notification Automatic Action (Activate) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.6.2.3 How to Stop the DLS Notification Automatic Action (Deactivate) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.7 Monitoring and Maintenance of OpenScape Office . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.7.1 Checking the Network Connection (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.7.1.1 How to Ping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.7.1.2 How to Test the Trace Route . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.7.2 SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol) (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.7.2.1 How to Display all Communities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.7.2.2 How to Add a Community . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.7.2.3 How to Edit a Community . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.7.2.4 How to Delete a Community . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.7.2.5 How to Display Traps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.7.2.6 How to Display Details of a Trap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.7.3 Manual Actions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.7.3.1 How to Download Diagnostics Data / Diagnosis Logs from OpenScape Office LX/HX . . . . .
23.7.3.2 How to Download Diagnostics Data / Diagnosis Logs from OpenScape Office HX . . . . . . . .
23.7.3.3 How to Delete Diagnostics Data / Diagnosis Logs from OpenScape Office HX . . . . . . . . . .
23.7.4 Traces (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.7.4.1 How to Download Traces / Trace Logs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.7.4.2 How to Delete a Trace / Trace Log File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.7.4.3 How to Display all Trace Profiles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.7.4.4 How to Start a Trace Profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.7.4.5 How to Stop a Trace Profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.7.4.6 How to Display or Edit the Trace Format Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.7.4.7 How to Display or Edit the Trace Output Interfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.7.4.8 How to Display or Edit Digital Loopbacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.7.4.9 How to Display or Edit Event Viewer and Customer Trace Logs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.7.4.10 How to Download or Open the Event Viewer Log / Customer Trace Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.7.4.11 How to Clear the Event Viewer Log / Customer Trace Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.7.4.12 How to Start Call Monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.7.4.13 How to Display or Edit Call Monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.7.4.14 How to Stop Call Monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
1069
1070
1070
1070
1071
1071
1072
1072
1073
1074
1074
1075
1076
1076
1077
1077
1078
1078
1078
1079
1079
1080
1080
1080
1081
1081
1081
1083
1084
1084
1085
1085
1085
1086
1088
1088
1089
1089
1098
1099
1099
1099
1100
1100
1101
1101
1101
1102
1102
1103
1103
1104
29
Contents
23.7.4.15 How to Open Call Monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1104
23.7.4.16 How to Display or Edit the H.323 Stack Trace Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1104
23.7.4.17 How to Edit H.323 Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1105
23.7.4.18 How to Download or Open the H.323 Stack Trace Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1105
23.7.4.19 How to Clear the H.323 Trace Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1106
23.7.4.20 How to Display Details of a Trace Profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1106
23.7.4.21 How to Stop all Trace Profiles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1106
23.7.4.22 How to Add a Trace Profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1107
23.7.4.23 How to Display Trace Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1107
23.7.4.24 How to Display Details of a Trace Component . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1108
23.7.4.25 How to Start a Trace Component . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1108
23.7.4.26 How to Stop a Trace Component . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1108
23.7.4.27 How to Stop all Trace Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1109
23.7.4.28 How to Edit Trace Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1109
23.7.4.29 How to Start a TCP Dump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1109
23.7.4.30 How to Stop a TCP Dump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1110
23.7.4.31 How to Delete a TCP Dump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1110
23.7.4.32 How to Enable the RPCAP Daemon . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1110
23.7.4.33 How to Disable the RPCAP Daemon . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1111
23.7.5 Events (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1111
23.7.5.1 How to Edit Switch Event Logging via a LAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1112
23.7.5.2 How to Download the Event Log File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1113
23.7.5.3 How to Delete the Event Log File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1113
23.7.5.4 How to Edit E-Mail Settings for Events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1114
23.7.5.5 How to Display the Event Reaction Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1114
23.7.5.6 How to Edit the Reaction Settings for an Event . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1114
23.7.5.7 How to Edit the Reaction Settings for Multiple Events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1115
23.7.5.8 How to Download or Open Diagnosis Logs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1116
23.7.5.9 How to Clear Diagnosis Logs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1117
23.7.6 Configuration Data for Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1117
23.7.6.1 How to Generate Configuration Data for Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1118
23.8 Monitoring and Maintaining the UC Suite . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1119
23.8.1 Logging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1119
23.8.1.1 How to Enable or Disable Recording of System Logs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1120
23.8.1.2 How to Enable or Disable the Recording of Client Logs on a System-wide Basis . . . . . . . . . 1120
23.8.1.3 How to Enable or Disable the Recording of Client Logs on a Station-specific Basis . . . . . . . 1121
23.8.1.4 How to Configure the Storage Path for Client Log Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1122
23.8.1.5 How to Download the Client Logs of all Internal Stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1122
23.8.2 Notification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1123
23.8.2.1 How to Configure E-mail Notifications of System Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1125
23.8.3 Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1125
23.8.3.1 Performing System Maintenance Immediately . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1126
23.8.3.2 How to Configure the Time for Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1127
23.8.3.3 How to Configure Retention Periods for Log Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1127
23.8.3.4 Configuring the Retention Period for Contact Center Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1128
23.9 Remote Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1128
23.9.1 Remote Access (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1128
23.9.1.1 How to Enable Remote Access via ISDN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1129
23.9.1.2 How to Configure PCs with Microsoft Windows Vista for Remote Access via ISDN . . . . . . . . 1130
23.9.1.3 How to Configure PCs with Microsoft Windows 7 for Remote Access via ISDN . . . . . . . . . . . 1131
23.9.1.4 How to Enable Remote Access via Internet Access with a Fixed IP Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1132
23.9.1.5 How to Enable Remote Access via Internet Access without a Fixed IP Address . . . . . . . . . . 1133
30
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Contents
23.9.1.6 How to Disable Remote Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.9.2 SSDP (Smart Services Delivery Platform) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.9.2.1 How to Enable the SSDP Service Plugin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.9.2.2 How to Disable the SSDP Service Plugin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.9.2.3 How to Change the Partner ID of the SSDP Service Plugin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.9.2.4 How to Configure and Register the SSDP Service Plugin for a Customer Network 
with a Proxy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.9.2.5 How to Configure and Register the SSDP Service Plugin for a Customer Network 
without a Proxy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.9.3 Remote Service via VPN (MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.9.3.1 How to Configure the Remote Service via VPN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.9.4 PIN for Activating and Deactivating the Remote Service via VPN and the SSDP Service Plugin .
23.9.4.1 How to Configure a PIN for Activating and Deactivating the Remote Service via VPN 
and the SSDP Service Plugin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.9.5 Online User ( (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
23.9.5.1 How to Start the Online User . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1134
1134
1136
1136
1137
24 Appendix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
24.1 Languages Supported . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
24.2 Supported Standards (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
24.3 Configuration Limits and Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
24.4 Euro-ISDN Features (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
24.5 Features of the UC Clients that can be used with SIP Telephones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
24.6 SIP Features Supported by OpenScape Office . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
24.7 Codes for Activating and Deactivating Features (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
24.8 IP Protocols and Port Numbers Used . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
24.8.1 IP Protocols and Port Numbers for Server Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
24.8.2 IP Protocols and Port Numbers for Client Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
24.9 Interface Ranges for Subscriber Lines (MX ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
24.10 Standards and Attenuation Values for Trunk Connections (MX ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
24.11 System Flags (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
24.12 Station Flags (LX/MX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1144
1144
1145
1147
1160
1161
1162
1163
1173
1173
1180
1181
1182
1185
1191
1137
1139
1140
1140
1142
1142
1142
1143
25 Glossary. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1195
25.1 Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1195
Index. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1211
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
31
Introduction and Important Notes
About this Documentation
1 Introduction and Important Notes
This introduction provides you with an overview of the documentation structure.
The introduction should assist you in finding information on selected topics faster.
Before you begin with the installation and startup of the communication system,
make sure that you have carefully read the safety information and warnings as
well as the important notes.
INFO: The safety information and requirements inform you about
the safety and other requirements to be observed. The important
notes contain information on the emergency behavior, the
standards and guidelines for the installation, and the radio
frequency interference of the communication system. In addition,
you will also find details on and the proper disposal and recycling
of the communication system here.
Related Topics
1.1 About this Documentation
This document describes OpenScape Office™.
This document describes the UC communication systems OpenScape Office LX
and OpenScape Office MX as well as OpenScape Office HX and the UC Suite for
the HiPath 3000 communication system. The headers of the features contain an
identifier to show which feature applies to which system:
•
Headers identified with (LX) describe features for OpenScape Office LX.
•
Headers identified with (MX) describe features for OpenScape Office MX.
•
Headers identified with (HX) describe features for OpenScape Office HX.
•
Headers identified with (LX/MX) describe features for OpenScape Office LX
and OpenScape Office MX.
•
Headers without identifiers apply to all systems.
INFO: In this document, OpenScape Office LX and
OpenScape Office MX are both referred to generically as the
communication system.
Related Topics
1.1.1 Documentation and Target Groups
The documentation is intended for various target groups.
32
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Introduction and Important Notes
About this Documentation
Administrator and Service Documentation
•
OpenScape Office V3, Feature Description
This document describes all features and is intended for Sales and
customers. This document is an extract from the OpenScape Office V3,
Administrator documentation.
•
OpenScape Office V3, Getting Started
This document is included with the communication system. It provides a quick
overview of the initial installation of the communication system and is
intended for administrators. This document is an extract from the OpenScape
Office V3, Administrator documentation.
•
OpenScape Office V3, OpenScape Office LX, Installation Guide
This document describes the installation of the OpenScape Office V3 LX
communication system and is intended for administrators. This document is
an extract from the OpenScape Office V3, Administrator documentation.
•
OpenScape Office V3, OpenScape Office MX, Installation Guide
This document describes the installation of the OpenScape Office V3 MX
communication system and is intended for administrators. This document is
an extract from the OpenScape Office V3, Administrator documentation.
•
OpenScape Office V3, OpenScape Office HX, Installation Guide
This document describes the installation of the UC Suite for HiPath 3000 and
is intended for administrators. This document is an extract from the
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator documentation.
•
OpenScape Office V3, Linux, Installation Guide
This document describes the installation of Linux for OpenScape Office LX
und OpenScape Office MX communication systems and is intended for
administrators. This document is an extract from the OpenScape Office V3,
Administrator documentation.
•
OpenScape Office V3, Planning Guide
This document provides guidelines for the planning of
OpenScape Office V3 MX and OpenScape Office V3 LX and is intended for
project planners. This document is an extract from the OpenScape Office V3,
Administrator documentation.
•
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator documentation
This document provides a complete description of the hardware, installation,
configuration, operation, features and administration and is intended for
administrators. It includes all the contents of the documentation listed above.
The Administrator documentation is available in the system as online help.
Operating Manuals
•
OpenScape Office V3, myPortal for Desktop, User Guide
This document describes the installation, configuration and operation of the
integrated application myPortal for Desktop and is intended for the user.
•
OpenScape Office, myPortal for Outlook, User Guide
This document describes the installation, configuration and operation of the
integrated application myPortal for Outlook and is intended for the user.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
33
Introduction and Important Notes
About this Documentation
•
OpenScape Office V3, myPortal for Mobile/Tablet/Zimbra, User Guide
This document describes the configuration and operation of
myPortal for Mobile for mobile phones and tablet PCs and myPortal for
Zimbra and is intended for the user.
•
OpenScape Office V3, myPortal for OpenStage, User Guide
This document describes the configuration and operation of
myPortal for OpenStage and is intended for the user.
•
OpenScape Office V3, Fax Printer, User Guide
This document describes the installation, configuration and operation of the
integrated application OpenScape Office Fax Printer and is intended for the
user.
•
OpenScape Office V3, Application Launcher, User Guide
This document describes the installation, configuration and operation of
Application Launcher and is intended for the user.
•
OpenScape Office V3, myAgent, User Guide
This document describes the installation, configuration and operation of the
integrated application myAgent and is intended for the user.
•
OpenScape Office V3, myReports, User Guide
This document describes the installation, configuration and operation of the
integrated application myReports and is intended for the user.
•
OpenScape Office V3, myAttendant, User Guide
This document describes the installation, configuration and operation of
myAttendant and is intended for the user.
Related Topics
1.1.2 Structure
This section shows you how the content of this documentation is structured.
Section
Contents
Introduction and Important Notes
This introduction provides you with an overview of the documentation structure. The introduction should assist you in
finding information on selected topics faster. Before you
begin with the installation and startup of the communication
system, make sure that you have carefully read the safety
information and warnings as well as the important notes.
System Overview and
Scenarios
The System Overview provides you with an introduction to
the features of the communication system. The scenarios
depict typical deployment scenarios for selected topics.
Hardware and Installation The OpenScape Office MX communication system is a modof OpenScape Office MX ular system that can be deployed as a one-box system (consisting of a single OpenScape Office MX system box) or as a
multibox system (consisting of two or three OpenScape
Office MX system boxes). Every OpenScape Office MX system box is equipped with a motherboard and provides three
slots for installing optional gateway modules for the trunk and
station connections.
34
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Introduction and Important Notes
About this Documentation
Section
Administration Concept
Contents
The administration of OpenScape Office is performed using
web-based management (OpenScape Office Assistant). The
user administration of the web-based management allows
you to set up role-based administration.
Installing the Linux Server This section describes the prerequisites and initial startup of
the Linux server that is required to operate
OpenScape Office LX and OpenScape Office HX.
Installing OpenScape
Office LX
The initial installation of OpenScape Office LX with
OpenScape Office Assistant is described here with the aid of
a selected installation example.
Installing OpenScape
Office MX
The initial installation of OpenScape Office MX with
OpenScape Office Assistant is described here with the aid of
a selected installation example.
Installing OpenScape
Office HX
The initial installation of OpenScape Office Assistant is
described here with the aid of a selected basic scenario.
Connection to Service
Provider
The communication system supports different connections to
service providers for Internet access and Internet telephony
via an Internet Telephony Service Provider (ITSP, SIP Provider). OpenScape Office MX also provides access to outside
lines via ISDN or analog connections through optional gateway modules.
Station
A subscriber or station is a communication partner connected
to the communication system. In general, every station (apart
from virtual stations) is assigned a terminal. A terminal is, for
example, a telephone, a PC or fax device. The subscribers
can also be users of the OpenScape Office clients (e.g.,
users of myPortal for Outlook).
Licensing
Licensing is mandatory for the operation of OpenScape
Office. Following the initial startup, the licensing must be
completed within 30 days (called the Grace Period); otherwise, when this period expires, the system will only operate in
restricted emergency mode.
Unified Communications
Unified Communications offers features such as the Presence status and CallMe, conferencing (not with OpenScape
office HX), as well as voicemail and fax functionality in the
myPortal for Desktop and myPortal for Outlook clients. myAttendant also provides Attendant Console functions.
Functions at the Telephone
The communication system offers a comprehensive set of
telephony features extending from the usual features such as
hold, toggle/connect and consultation hold, etc., through various call signaling mechanisms, down to call transfers, call
deflections and call forwarding.
Working in a Team
(Groups)
Several features are provided by the communication system
to enable and facilitate working in a team. Besides call pickup
groups, group calls and hunt groups, this also includes
groups with team and executive/secretary functions as well
as voicemail box and fax box groups. The “UCD (Uniform
Call Distribution)” feature enables incoming calls to be uniformly distributed to a group of users (UCD group).
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
35
Introduction and Important Notes
About this Documentation
Section
Call Routing
Contents
The communication system offers Toll and Call Restrictions,
a Night Service, powerful LCR (Least Cost Routing) capabilities and different options for making emergency calls.
Multimedia Contact Cen- The OpenScape Office Contact Center is a powerful solution
ter
for the optimum distribution and handling of incoming calls,
faxes and e-mails. Intelligent skills-based distribution ensures
that callers are always connected to the best qualified
agents, regardless of which contact medium is used. A number of convenient functions for handling and wrapping up
calls, faxes and e-mails are offered to the Contact Center
agents via the myAgent application. myReports provides a
number of report templates for analyzing the Contact Center
operations.
36
Mobility
OpenScape Office provides integrated mobility solutions for
any business. This typically includes the integration of mobile
phones/smartphones, the usage of Cordless and WLAN
phones, etc., down to Desk Sharing and teleworking. Mobility
includes Mobility on the road, Mobility in the office and Mobility at home.
Security
The term security includes not only the security in a data network with secure access by users (via a VPN and secure
administration using SSL) and with restricted system access
(through firewalls, IP and MAC address filtering and a DMZ),
but also the security against unauthorized access at telephones (e.g., telephone locks).
Networking OpenScape
Office
OpenScape Office enables the networking of OpenScape
Office MX, OpenScape Office LX and OpenScape Office HX.
In this network-wide unified communications solution, subscribers can now use features such as the presence status,
voicemail, conferencing and much more in exactly the same
way as was originally possible with only a single OpenScape
Office communication system.
Auxiliary Equipment
Auxiliary equipment consists of external devices (such as a
fax device or door opener) that are connected to the interfaces of the communication system. Using an IP-enabled
camera, the video surveillance solution Gate View can be
deployed.
Application Connectivity
Application connectivity is supported by the system, e.g., with
XMPP and Application Launcher.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Introduction and Important Notes
About this Documentation
Section
Contents
Accounting
Accounting offers call detail recording, the display of call
charges and call duration, as well as cost control and
accounting tools.
Maintenance
OpenScape Office offers several maintenance options. This
includes changing the telephony settings, backing up and
restoring the configuration data, updating the software with
updates and upgrades and restarting/reloading functions. In
addition, appropriate functions to determine status and for
monitoring and maintenance are available. Remote access to
OpenScape Office is possible via different Remote Services.
Appendix
This appendix contains reference information such as the
supported languages, standards, configuration limits and
capacities, Euro-ISDN features, codes for enabling and disabling features, feature codes using DTMF and the IP protocols and port numbers used.
Related Topics
1.1.3 Types of Topics
The types of topics include concepts and operating instructions (tasks).
Type of topic
Contents
Title
Concept
Explains the “What”.
without a verb, e.g., Call Duration Display on Telephone.
Operating Instructions
Describes task-oriented application cases – i.e., the “How” –
and assumes familiarity with the
associated concepts.
Starts with “How to” followed by
a verb, e.g., How to Enable or
Disable the Call Duration Display
on a Telephone.
Related Topics
1.1.4 Display Conventions
This documentation uses a variety of methods to present different types of information.
Purpose
Appearance
Sample
User Interface Elements
Bold
Click OK.
Menu sequence
>
File > Exit
Special emphasis
Bold
Do not delete Name.
Cross-reference text
Italics
You will find more information in the topic Network.
Output
Monospace font, e.g., Courier
Command not found.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
37
Introduction and Important Notes
Safety Information and Warnings
Purpose
Appearance
Sample
Input
Monospace font, e.g., Courier
Enter LOCAL as the file
name.
Key combination
Monospace font, e.g., Courier
<Ctrl>+<Alt>+<Esc>
Work Steps and Substeps
Numbered and alphabetical
lists
• Configure the DSL
telephony stations with
the associated DID
phone numbers.
– Click Add.
– Enter the name of the
Internet telephony
station under Internet
Telephony Station.
Alternative Work Steps
Enumeration
• If you want to output
amounts, enable the
check box Display
amounts instead of
units.
• If you want to output
units, clear the check
box Display amounts
instead of units.
Related Topics
1.2 Safety Information and Warnings
Safety information and warnings indicate situations that can result in death, injury,
property damage, and/or data loss.
Work on the communication system and devices should only be performed by
personnel with proper qualifications.
Within the context of this safety information and these warnings, qualified
personnel are people who are authorized to ground and label systems, devices,
and trunks and put them into operation in compliance with the applicable safety
regulations and standards.
Make sure you have read and noted the following safety information and warnings
before installing and starting up the OpenScape Office LX or
OpenScape Office MX communication system.
Make sure you also read carefully and follow all safety information and warnings
printed on the communication system and devices.
Familiarize yourself with emergency numbers.
Types of Safety Information and Warnings
This documentation uses the following levels for the different types of safety information and warning:
38
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Introduction and Important Notes
Safety Information and Warnings
DANGER
DANGER
Indicates an immediately dangerous situation that will cause death or
serious injuries.
WARNING
WARNING
Indicates a universally dangerous situation that can cause death or serious
injuries.
CAUTION
CAUTION
Indicates a dangerous situation that can cause injuries.
Note: Indicates situations that can cause property damage and/
or data loss.
Additional symbols for specifying the source of danger more exactly
The following symbol is generally not used in this documentation, but may appear
on the devices or packaging.
ESD - electrostatically sensitive devices
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Important Notes
1.2.1 Warnings: Danger
“Danger” warnings indicate immediately dangerous situations that will cause
death or serious injury.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
39
Introduction and Important Notes
Safety Information and Warnings
DANGER
DANGER
Risk of electric shock through contact with live wires
•
Note: Voltages over 30 VAC (alternating current) or 60 VDC (direct current)
are dangerous.
•
Only personnel with proper qualifications or qualified electricians should
perform work on the low-voltage network (<1000 VAC), and all work must
comply with the national/local requirements for electrical connections.
•
Opening the case of an OpenScape Office MX system box is forbidden! The
case contains potentially dangerous circuits that are not protected. Opening
the case invalidates the warranty. Unify GmbH & Co. KG does not assume
any liability for damage arising from the illicit opening of the case.
Related Topics
1.2.2 Warnings: Warning
“Warnings” indicate universal dangerous situations that can cause death or
serious injury.
WARNING
WARNING
Risk of electric shock through contact with live wires
•
When using the OpenScape Office MX communication system in countries
with country-specific requirements (Finland, Canada, Norway, Sweden and
the USA), each OpenScape Office MX system box must be grounded with a
separate grounding wire. Before you start up the system and connect the
phones and phone lines, connect the communication system with a
permanent earthing conductor.
•
Only use systems, tools and equipment which are in perfect condition. Do not
use equipment with visible damage.
•
Replace the power cable immediately if it appears to be damaged.
•
The communication system should only be operated with an outlet that has
connected ground contacts.
•
During a thunderstorm, do not connect or disconnect communication lines
and do not install or remove gateway modules.
•
Disconnect all power supply circuits if you do not require power for certain
activities (for example, when changing cables). Disconnect all the communication system’s power plugs and make sure that the communication system
is not supplied by another power source (uninterrupted power supply unit, for
instance).
Related Topics
40
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Introduction and Important Notes
Safety Information and Warnings
1.2.3 Warnings: Caution
“Caution” warnings indicate a dangerous situation that can result in injury.
CAUTION
CAUTION
Risk of explosion caused by the incorrect replacement of batteries
The lithium battery should only be replaced with an identical battery or one recommended by the manufacturer.
CAUTION
CAUTION
Risk of fire
Only use communication lines with a conductor diameter of 0.4 mm (AWG 26) or
more.
CAUTION
CAUTION
General risk of injury or accidents in the workplace
Install cables in such a way that they do not pose a risk of an accident (tripping),
and cannot be damaged.
Related Topics
1.2.4 Warnings: Note
“Note” warnings are used to indicate situations that could result in property
damage and/or data loss.
The following contains important information on how to avoid property damage
and/or data loss:
•
When transporting and sending components of the communication system
(such as gateway modules, for example), please use appropriate packaging
to ensure the protection of electrostatic sensitive devices (ESD).
•
Use only original accessories. Failure to comply with this safety information
may damage the system equipment or violate safety and EMC regulations.
•
Sudden changes in temperature can result in condensing humidity. If the
communication system is transported from a cold environment to warmer
areas, for example, this could result in the condensation of humidity. Wait until
the equipment has adjusted to the ambient temperature and is completely dry
before starting it up.
•
Connect all cables only to the specified connection points.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
41
Introduction and Important Notes
Important Notes
•
Do not allow easily flammable materials to be stored in or near the room
where the communication system is installed.
•
If no emergency backup power supply is available or if no switchover to
emergency analog phones is possible in the event of a power failure, then no
emergency calls can be made via the communication system following a
power failure.
Related Topics
1.3 Important Notes
These important notes contain information on the emergency behavior, intended
use, and operating conditions of the communication system. In addition, you will
find details on the standards and guidelines for the installation, the radio
frequency interference of the OpenScape Office MX communication system, and
its proper disposal and recycling.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Safety Information and Warnings
1.3.1 Emergencies
This section provides information on how to proceed in an emergency.
What To Do In An Emergency
•
In the event of an accident, remain calm and controlled.
•
Always switch off the power supply before you touch an accident victim.
•
If you are not able to immediately switch off the power supply, only touch the
victim with non-conductive materials (such as a wooden broom handle), and
first of all try to isolate the victim from the power supply.
First Aid
•
Be familiar with basic first aid procedures for electrical shock. A fundamental
knowledge of the various resuscitation methods if the victim has stopped
breathing or if the victim’s heart is no longer beating, as well as first aid for
treating burns, is absolutely necessary in such emergencies.
•
If the victim is not breathing, immediately perform mouth-to-mouth or mouthto-nose resuscitation.
•
If you have appropriate training, immediately perform heart massage if the
victim’s heart is not beating.
Calling for Help
Immediately call an ambulance or an emergency physician. Provide the following
information in the following sequence:
•
42
Where did the accident happen?
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Introduction and Important Notes
Important Notes
•
What happened?
•
How many people were injured?
•
What type of injuries?
•
Wait for questions.
Reporting Accidents
•
Immediately report all accidents, near accidents and potential sources of
danger to your manager.
•
Report all electrical shocks, no matter how small.
Related Topics
1.3.2 Intended Use
The communication system may only be used as described in this documentation
and only in conjunction with add-on devices and components recommended and
approved by Unify GmbH & Co. KG.
Prerequisites for the intended use of the communication system include correct
transport, storage, assembly, startup, operation and maintenance of the system.
Related Topics
1.3.3 Correct Disposal and Recycling
Please read the information on the correct disposal and recycling of electrical and
electronic equipment and old batteries.
All electrical and electronic products should be disposed of separately from the municipal waste stream via designated collection facilities appointed by the government or the local
authorities. The correct disposal and separate collection of your
old appliance will help prevent potential negative consequences
for the environment and human health. It is a precondition for
reuse and recycling of used electrical and electronic equipment.
For more detailed information about disposal of your old appliance, please contact your city office, waste disposal service, the
shop where you purchased the product or your sales representative. The statements quoted above are only fully valid for
equipment which is installed and sold in the countries of the
European Union and is covered by the directive 2002/96/EC.
Countries outside the European Union may have other regulations regarding the disposal of electrical and electronic equipment.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
43
Introduction and Important Notes
Important Notes
Old batteries that bear this logo are recyclable and must be
included in the recycling process. Old batteries that are not recycled must be disposed of as hazardous waste in compliance
with all regulations.
Related Topics
1.3.4 Installation Standards and Guidelines
This section provides information on the specifications you must comply with
when connecting the communication system to the power supply circuit and when
using shielded cabling for LAN, WAN and DMZ connectors.
Related Topics
1.3.4.1 Connecting OpenScape Office MX to the Power Supply Circuit
The OpenScape Office MX communication system has been approved for
connection to TN-S power supply systems. They can also be connected to a TNC-S power supply system in which the PEN conductor is divided into a ground
wire and a neutral wire. TN-S and TN-C-S systems are defined in the IEC 364-3
standard.
Only qualified electricians should perform any work that may be required on the
low-voltage network. These installation activities to connect the
OpenScape Office MX communication system must be performed in compliance
with IEC 60364-1 and IEC 60364-4-41 or any corresponding legal norms or
national regulations (for example in the U.S. or Canada).
Related Topics
1.3.4.2 Connecting OpenScape Office LX and OpenScape Office HX to the Power
Supply Circuit
For information regarding the connection of OpenScape Office LX and
OpenScape Office HX to the power supply circuit, please refer to the manufacturer’s documentation for the server PC and the other components.
44
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Introduction and Important Notes
Important Notes
Only qualified electricians should perform any work that may be required on the
low-voltage network. These installation activities to connect the
OpenScape Office MX and OpenScape Office HX must be performed in
compliance with IEC 60364-1 and IEC 60364-4-41 or any corresponding legal
norms or national regulations (for example in the U.S. or Canada).
Related Topics
1.3.4.3 Shielded Cabling for LAN, WAN and DMZ Connections of OpenScape Office MX
Compliance with CE requirements on electromagnetic compatibility in
OpenScape Office MX communication systems and their LAN, WAN and DMZ
connections is subject to the following conditions:
•
The communication system may only be operated with shielded connection
cables. This means that a shielded Category-5 (CAT.5) cable with a length of
at least 3 m should be used between the shielded LAN, WAN and DMZ
sockets of the communication system and the building installation port or the
external active component port. The cable shield must be grounded at the
building installation end or the external active component end (connection to
the building’s potential equalization terminal).
•
A shielded Category-5 (CAT.5) cable should also be used for shorter connections with external active components (LAN switch or similar). However, the
active component must feature a shielded LAN connection with a grounded
shield connection (connection to the building’s potential equalization
terminal).
•
The shield properties of the cable components should at least satisfy the
requirements of the European standard EN 50173-1*) “Information technology
- Generic cabling systems” (and all references specified).***)
•
Building installations that are fitted with shielded symmetrical copper cables
throughout in accordance with the Class-D requirements**) of EN 50173-1
satisfy the above condition.***)
*) The European standard EN 50173-1 is derived from the international standard
ISO/IEC 11801.
**) Class-D is reached, for instance, if Category-5 (CAT.5) components (cables,
wall outlets, connection cables, etc.) are installed.
***) UTP cables (U.S. standard EIA/TIA 568 T) are the most widely used cables
on the North American market; this has the following implications for the LAN
connections in communication systems: The system may only be operated with
shielded connection cables. This means that a shielded Category-5 (CAT.5) cable
with a length of at least 3 m should be used between the shielded LAN, WAN and
DMZ sockets of the communication system and the building installation port or the
external active component port. The cable shield must be grounded at the
building installation end or the external active component end (connection to the
building’s potential equalization terminal).
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
45
Introduction and Important Notes
Important Notes
1.3.4.4 Marks (MX)
This device complies with the EU guideline 1999/5/EEC as confirmed by the CE certificate.
Related Topics
1.3.5 Notes on Electromagnetic and Radio Frequency Interference (MX)
Please note the information about the radio frequency interference of the
OpenScape Office MX communication system.
•
Not for U.S. and Canada
OpenScape Office MX is a Class B (EN 55022) device.
•
For U.S. and Canada only:
OpenScape Office MX is a Class A (EN 55022) device. Class A equipment
can cause radio frequency interference in residential areas. In such cases,
the providers of the communication system are required to take appropriate
counteractive measures.
Related Topics
1.3.6 Data Protection and Data Security
Please note the details below with respect to protecting data and ensuring
privacy.
This communication system processes and uses personal data for purposes such
as call detail recording, displays, and customer data acquisition.
In Germany, the processing and use of such data is subject to various regulations,
including those of the Federal Data Protection Law (Bundesdatenschutzgesetz,
BDSG). For other countries, please follow the appropriate national laws.
The aim of data protection is to protect the rights of individuals from being
adversely affected by use of their personal data.
In addition, the aim of data protection is to prevent the misuse of data when it is
processed and to ensure that one’s own interests and the interests of other parties
which need to be protected are not affected.
INFO: The customer is responsible for ensuring that the communication system is installed, operated and maintained in accordance with all applicable labor laws and regulations and all laws
and regulations relating to data protection, privacy and safe labor
environment.
Employees of Unify GmbH & Co. KG are bound to safeguard trade secrets and
personal data under the terms of the company’s work rules.
46
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Introduction and Important Notes
Important Notes
In order to ensure that the statutory requirements are consistently met during
service – whether on-site or remote – you should always observe the following
rules. You will not only protect the interests of your and our customers, you will
also avoid personal consequences.
A conscientious and responsible approach helps protect data and ensure privacy:
•
Ensure that only authorized persons have access to customer data.
•
Take full advantage of password assignment options; never give passwords
to an unauthorized person orally or in writing.
•
Ensure that no unauthorized person is able to process (store, modify,
transmit, disable, delete) or use customer data in any way.
•
Prevent unauthorized persons from gaining access to storage media such as
backup CDs or log printouts. This applies to service calls as well as to storage
and transport.
•
Ensure that storage media which are no longer required are completely
destroyed. Ensure that no sensitive documents are left unprotected.
•
Work closely with your customer contact; this promotes trust and reduces
your workload.
Related Topics
1.3.7 Technical Regulations and Conformity (MX)
Details on how the OpenScape Office MX communication system meets
conformity requirements can be found here.
Related Topics
1.3.7.1 CE Conformity
CE certification is based on the R&TTE Directive 99/5/EEC.
Standards reference
Safety
EN 60950-1
Electromagnetic Compatibility EN 55022: Class B (EMC, Emission ITE Residential
EMC
Environment)
EN 55024 (EMC, Immunity ITE Residential Environment)
EN 61000-3-2: Class A (EMC, Harmonic Current Emissions)
Electromagnetic Field EMF
EN 50371 (EMF, General Public Human Field Exposure)
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
47
Introduction and Important Notes
Important Notes
1.3.7.2 Conformity with US and Canadian Standards
Standards reference
Safety USA
UL 60950-1
Safety Canada
CSA-C22.2 NO. 60950-1-03
EMC Emission
FCC Part 15 Subpart B Class A
Transmission: USA
FCC Part 68
Transmission: Canada
CS-03
Related Topics
1.3.7.3 Conformity with International Standards
Standards reference
Safety
IEC 60950-1
Related Topics
1.3.8 Operating Conditions
Note the environmental and mechanical conditions for operating the communication system.
Related Topics
1.3.8.1 Operating Conditions for OpenScape Office MX
The environmental and mechanical conditions for operating the
OpenScape Office MX communication system are specified.
Environmental Operating Conditions
Operating limits:
48
•
Room temperature: + 5 to + 40 °C (41 to 104 °F)
•
Absolute humidity: 1 to 25 g H2O/m3
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Introduction and Important Notes
Important Notes
•
Relative humidity: 5 to 85%
Note: Damage caused by local temperature increases
Avoid exposing the communication system to direct sunlight and
other sources of heat.
Note: Damage caused by condensation due to humidity
Avoid any condensation of humidity on or in the communication
system before or during operation under all circumstances.
The communication system must be completely dry before you
put it into service.
Mechanical Operating Conditions
The communication system is intended for stationary use.
Related Topics
1.3.8.2 Operating Conditions for OpenScape Office LX and OpenScape Office HX
For details on the environmental and mechanical conditions for operating
OpenScape Office LX and OpenScape Office HX, please also refer to the
manufacturer documentation of the server PCs and the other components.
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
49
System Overview and Scenarios
System Overview
2 System Overview and Scenarios
The System Overview provides you with an introduction to the features of the
communication system. The scenarios depict typical deployment scenarios for
selected topics.
Related Topics
2.1 System Overview
OpenScape Office is the world’s first “All in One” Unified Communications (UC)
solution for single and multi-site SMBs that uniquely unifies voice communications with presence, mobility and office applications providing unsurpassed
business speed, agility and efficiency in a secure and reliable solution.
OpenScape Office offers:
•
UCC Networking
Network-wide UC features and functions (extended UC domain)
•
Mobility
UC Clients myPortal for Mobile and myPortal for OpenStage
•
Software UC
OpenScape Office LX/MX to support 500 users
•
Virtualization for small and medium size enterprises
OpenScape Office LX/HX Virtualization with VMware vSphere
•
Social networks
Google Chat Integration Presence Federation
OpenScape Office UC Solution
Voice
Mobility
UC
Messaging
Social
Media
Mobility
Contact
Center
Network Services
Session
Control
Presence
Federation
SIP-Q
Trunking
WLAN
Management
Call Data
Recording
Administration
Network-wide
and Licensing User Management
Scalability
OpenScape Office is available in the following variants:
•
Software UC solution OpenScape Office LX
–
50
Supports up to 500 users
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
System Overview and Scenarios
System Overview
–
•
•
OpenScape Office LX
SW running on Linux OS & standard server HW:
Virtualization opportunity with VMware vSphere
Carrier connectivity via broadband (ITSP, SIP Trunking)
All-in-one HW/SW UC platform OpenScape Office MX
–
Supports up to 150 users
–
All-in-one functionality comes pre-installed:
Analog and ISDN Subscribers
Carrier connectivity via broadband (ITSP), digital (ISDN) and analog lines
Server-based UC solution OpenScape Office HX for HiPath 3000
–
Supports up to 500 users
–
UC software running on Linux OS & standard server hardware
Virtualization opportunity with VMware vSphere
–
UC functions supported via OpenScape Office HX
Voice functions supported via HiPath 3000
OpenScape Office MX
Voice
Voice
Unified
Communications
Unified
Communications
Mobility
Mobility
Contact Center
Contact Center
Linux Server
Embedded Linux
OpenScape Office HX
UC
(w/o Conference)
Mobility
(myPortal for Mobile)
Contact Center
(HiPath 3800)
Linux Server
HiPath 3000
Voice
Voice Conference
Mobility
(Mobility Entry)
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
51
System Overview and Scenarios
System Overview
Networking
OpenScape Office is networkable for customers:
•
with multiple buildings on the company premises
•
with distributed locations
•
with migration from existing HiPath 3000
With OpenScape Office, networks with a maximum of 8 nodes and up to 1000
stations are supported.
UC Clients, Mobility Clients and Contact Center Clients
OpenScape Office offers the following UC clients with an intuitive user interface:
•
myPortal (UC User Portal)
–
myPortal for Desktop (UC Desktop Client)
–
myPortal for Outlook (UC Outlook Integration)
–
myPortal for Mobile/Tablet PC (Mobility Client for mobile phones and
tablet PCs)
–
myPortal for OpenStage (UC improvements for OpenStage 60/80)
•
myAttendant (UC Attendant Console)
•
myAgent (Contact Center Client)
•
myReports (Reports for Contact Center)
Related Topics
2.1.1 OpenScape Office LX
OpenScape Office HX is the software-based UC solution that is platformindependent and can be operated on a Linux server. OpenScape Office MX or
HiPath 3000 can be used as a gateway to the Central Office.
OpenScape Office LX
Installation variants
• Linux server certified for SUSE Linux Enterprise 11
Stations
• Max. 500 stations
• Max. 1000 stations through networking
• Max. 200 stations for mobile phone integration
Operating System
• Linux
Internet connection
• 1 Internet Service Provider (ISP)
• Four Internet Telephony Service Providers (ITSP)
Related Topics
2.1.2 OpenScape Office MX
OpenScape Office MX is the all-in-one unified communications solution that
offers not only modern VoIP (Voice over IP) features, but also the option of
connecting ISDN and analog devices directly to the communication system.
52
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
System Overview and Scenarios
System Overview
OpenScape Office MX
Installation variants
• As a standalone unit (desktop operation) or 19” rack mount;
space requirements in 19” rack for a system box = 1.5 rack
units
• Standalone communication system with max. 3 system
boxes (multibox system)
Stations
• Max. 150 stations, of which 148 are freely configurable
• Max. 50 stations per system box
• Max. 1000 stations through networking
• Max. 100 stations with mobile phone integration
Gateway Modules
• 3 slots per system box for the use of various gateway
modules
• Optional Gateway Modules
– GMS (not for U.S. and Canada) = Gateway module with
four S0 ports for the ISDN trunk connection or the ISDN
station connection
– GMSA (not for U.S. and Canada) = Gateway module with
four S0 ports for the ISDN trunk connection or ISDN station
connection and four a/b interfaces for the analog station
connection
– GME (not for U.S. and Canada) = Gateway module with
one S2M port for the ISDN Primary Rate Interface
– GMT (for U.S. and Canada only) = Gateway module with
one T1 interface for the ISDN Primary Rate Interface
– GMAA = Gateway module with four a/b interfaces for the
analog trunk connection and two a/b interfaces for the
analog station connection
– GMAL = Gateway module with eight a/b interfaces for the
analog station connection
Standard interfaces
(motherboard)
• One motherboard per system box with powerful AMD
Sempron CPU and 1 GB memory
• Standard interfaces
– 4 Gigabit LAN ports, internal (virtual LAN support, Layer 3
Routing, 802.1p L2 QoS)
– 1 Gigabit DMZ port (e.g., to securely integrate E-mail and
Web servers in the customer network)
– 1 Gigabit WAN port, external (e.g., for Internet access;
Internet access with up to 50 Mbit/ sec)
– 1 USB server
– 1 USB Control
Operating System
• Linux (embedded)
Internet connection
• 1 Internet Service Provider (ISP)
• Four Internet Telephony Service Providers (ITSP)
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
53
System Overview and Scenarios
System Overview
OpenScape Office MX
Dimensions (mm)
• Width = 440 mm
• Height = 66.5 mm (3.36 in)
• Depth = 350 mm
Power supply unit
The communication system is equipped for connection to the
power supply.
• Nominal input voltage: 110V to 240V, with a tolerance of (+/10%) -> 99V to 264V
• Nominal frequency: 50/60 Hz
Current draw
Max. 4A at 99V
Power consumption
Depending on the configuration, from 80 W to a maximum of
250 W per system box (also depends on configuration)
Battery buffering
UPS for 110V to 240V, capacity: 4 Ah (at 110V) * desired hours;
a UPS interface as with a PC is not present
Environmental Conditions
• Operating conditions: +5 to +40 °C (41 to 104 °F)
Color
Metallic blue / Silver front
• Humidity: 5 to 85%
Related Topics
2.1.3 OpenScape Office HX
OpenScape Office HX is the server-based UC solution for HiPath 3000 that can
be run on a Linux server. For voice communications, the features of the HiPath
3000 communication system are used.
Installation variants
• Linux server certified for SUSE Linux Enterprise 11
Stations
• Max. 500 stations
If every subscriber uses the fax box, the number of
subscribers is reduced to 250, since a maximum of 500
phone numbers can be created.
• Max. 1000 stations through networking
• Max. 100 stations for mobile phone integration
Operating System
• Linux
Supported communication systems
• HiPath 3000 V9 and later
Related Topics
54
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
System Overview and Scenarios
System Overview
2.1.4 Communications Clients, Mobility Clients and Contact Center Clients
With the Communications Clients myPortal and myAttendant, OpenScape Office
provides access to unified communications via an intuitive user interface. The
Mobility Clients (myPortal for Mobile/Tablet PC) offer access to UC on the move.
The contact center clients myAgent and myReports provide access to the contact
center functionality.
Communications Clients
Client
myPortal for Desktop
myPortal for Outlook
myAttendant
Technical Data
• Conferences (Ad-hoc, Scheduled, Permanent):
OpenScape Office MX: max. 5 conferences with max. 16
participants, max. 20 conference channels
OpenScape Office LX: max. 12 conferences with max. 16
participants, max. 40 conference channels
• Presence status (Office, Meeting, Sick, Break, Out of the
Office, Vacation, Lunch, Gone Home)
• Messages (Voicemail and Fax Box)
• Journal (Open, All, Missed, Answered, Internal, External,
Inbound, Outbound, Scheduled)
• Directories (Internal, External, Search)
• Personal AutoAttendant
• myAttendant: Up to 20 Attendant workplaces
myPortal for Zimbra
myPortal for Zimbra is integrated with the Zimbra e-mail program. The functionality is identical to myPortal for Mobile.
myPortal for OpenStage
myPortal for OpenStage can be used with the following telephones:
• OpenStage 60 V2 and later
• OpenStage 80 V2 and later
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
55
System Overview and Scenarios
System Overview
Mobility Clients
Client
myPortal for Mobile
myPortal for Tablet
Technical Data
myPortal for Mobile is optimized for presentation on Apple’s
iPhone and can also be used with several other mobile
phones. myPortal for Tablet is optimized for presentation on
Apple’s iPad and can also be used with several other tablet
PCs. Depending on which device and operating system is
used, the ease of use or function may be affected. The following requirements apply:
• Touch screen (recommended for ease of use)
• Min. display resolution of 240x320 pixels (myPortal for
Mobile)
• Min. display resolution of 800x480 pixels (myPortal for
Tablet); a minimum resolution of 1024x600 pixels is recommended
• Internet access
• Web browser with JavaScript enabled
• Support for the simultaneous transmission of voice and
data through mobile phones and the mobile network
• 3G data connection, for example, EDGE, UMTS, HSDPA
(recommended for smooth service). GPRS can lead to slow
page rendering.
• Flat rate data plan (recommended for cost reasons), since
data volumes of several 100 MB per month may be
involved, depending on usage.
Contact Center Clients
Client
myAgent
myReports
Technical Data
• Agents
MX one-box system: max. 10 agents
MX multibox system, LX and HX: max. 64 agents
• Calls per hour to the Contact Center
One-box system: max. 200 calls per hour
Multibox system: max. 500 calls per hour
• Max. 50 queues/groups
• Max. 64 supervisors
The sum of agents and supervisors must not exceed a
value of 64.
• Max. 1 myReports
56
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
System Overview and Scenarios
System Overview
Application Launcher
Client
Application Launcher
Technical Data
• Looking up call-related information on a phone number in
either the Directory Service or in system directories
• Configurable screen pops for incoming calls with callrelated information and buttons for user actions
• Launching Windows applications or web applications for
incoming and outgoing calls
• Transfer of call-related information to applications (e.g.,
phone number, name of the caller, customer ID)
• Max. 100 system connections
Related Topics
2.1.5 Supported Phones
OpenScape Office LX / MX enables telephony and UC via IP phones. Both analog
and ISDN telephones can be connected directly to OpenScape Office MX.
OpenScape Office HX also enables UC via TDM, a/b, DECT and WLAN
telephones. Phone calls made with OpenScape Office HX always occur via the
connected HiPath 3000.
IP phones
IP phones (HFA)
• OpenStage HFA
15, 20 E, 20, 20 G, 40, 40 G, 60, 60 G, 80, 80 G, 80 E
optiPoint 410/420 are supported
Key modules
• OpenStage Key Module, only for OpenStage 15, 40, 60 and
80
• OpenStage BLF 40 (Busy Lamp Field), only for OpenStage 40
PC clients (HFA)
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
• OpenScape Personal Edition (incl. video)
57
System Overview and Scenarios
System Overview
SIP phones / AP
adapter
myPortal for Desktop, myPortal for Outlook and myAttendant can
be used with SIP telephones that support RFC 3725.
The following devices have already been certified:
• OpenStage 15 S
• Mediatrix 4102S (for connecting 2 analog phones or Fax
devices)
• AP 1120 S (for connecting 2 analog phones or Fax devices)
The operation of other SIP devices must be certified within the
framework of the HiPath Ready program.
WLAN Phones
The optiPoint WL2 professional can be optionally connected and
operated via the following Access Points and Controllers:
• Enterasys Wireless Access Point AP 2630 (wireless with
internal antenna) and AP 2640 (wireless with external
antenna). No more than six WL2 professionals can be
connected to each access point (AP) and up to ten access
points can be operated.
• Enterasys Wireless Controller - Part No. C20 for larger configurations
Dual-mode mobile
phones
Dual-mode mobile phones are differentiated on the SIP protocol
level. The tested devices are:
• Nokia E52, E75
• Nokia N79, N85, N97
TDM telephones (HX via HiPath 3000)
TDM telephones
• OpenStage T
10 T, 15 T, 20 T, 30 T, 40 T, 60 T, 80 T
optiPoint 500 is supported
DECT phones (LX/MX)
HiPath Cordless IP
(DECT phones)
HiPath Cordless IP is a campus-wide mobility solution with the
following mobile components:
• Gigaset S3 professional
• Gigaset S4 professional
• Gigaset SL3 professional
• Gigaset M2 professional
DECT phones are integrated using SIP. The scope of features is
correspondingly restricted.
Analog and ISDN Stations (MX)
58
Analog telephones
at OpenScape Office MX
ISDN devices
at OpenScape Office MX
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
System Overview and Scenarios
System Overview
Add-on devices (MX)
•
Entrance telephone via ET-S adapter at OpenScape Office MX
Related Topics
2.1.6 Infrastructure Components
OpenScape Office supports the setup of a network infrastructure through the
connection of additional infrastructure components.
•
Enterasys switches (of the A2, B3 and D2 series) with and without Power over
Ethernet (PoE)
•
LAN switches from other vendors with or without Power over Ethernet (PoE)
•
Routers (e.g., DSL router, VPN router)
•
VPN Client (tested with Microsoft Standard Client and NCP Client)
•
UPS (uninterrupted power supply unit)
INFO: More Information can be found under:
http://wiki.unify.com
Related Topics
2.1.7 Open Interfaces
OpenScape Office provides open interfaces for the integration of external applications.
LX
MX
Physical Interfaces
LAN, USB, S0,
S2M, a/b
LAN
Logical Interfaces
CSTA protocol,
protocol for call
detail records,
SIP, DSS1
CSTA protocol,
protocol for call
detail records,
SIP, DSS1
http(s)
http(s)
HX
LAN
API (Microsoft TAPI 2.1), Web
Server Interface
Interface for integrating webbased applications
http(s)
Related Topics
2.1.8 Recommended and Certified Applications
OpenScape Office can be optionally supplied with different applications that can
be ordered and purchased separately. These are connected via LAN.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
59
System Overview and Scenarios
Sample Scenarios
OpenStage Gate View
OpenStage Gate View presents a camera image from the entrance area on an
OpenStage phone (only OpenStage 60/80 HFA) or iPhone.
Accounting (LX/MX)
•
Standard Evaluation
The Accounting Manager is supplied for the standard evaluation of call
charge data.
•
Professional Evaluation
Teledata Office combines cost management in the telecommunications area
with an analysis of the communication traffic.
HiPath TAPI 120/170
The HiPath TAPI 120/170 service provider is installed on a Windows server as
standardized interface software. For TAPI 120/170, an additional free CSTA
license must be ordered.
HiPath TAPI 170 is supported for networking throughout the network, i.e., the
external application is connected to a central network node.
CallBridge IP
TAPI service provider for phoning with PCs under MS Windows operating
systems via a LAN. CallBridge IP does not work in a VLAN configuration.
Related Topics
2.1.9 Additional Links
•
Internet:
http://www.unify.com
•
Partner portal:
https://www.unify.com/partnerportal/
•
Expert wiki for telephones, communication systems and UC:
http://wiki.unify.com
Related Topics
2.2 Sample Scenarios
The sample scenarios describe the basic scenarios for the installation of
OpenScape Office.
Related Topics
2.2.1 Sample Scenario for OpenScape Office LX
The sample scenario illustrates the standalone deployment of
OpenScape Office LX.
In this scenario, OpenScape Office LX offers:
60
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
System Overview and Scenarios
Sample Scenarios
•
Trunk connection via an Internet Telephony Service Provider (SIP Provider)
•
Internet access via an existing Internet router (e.g., DSL)
•
IP phones (OpenStage)
•
UC Clients (myPortal)
Internet
PSTN
P
PS
S
SIP Provider
LAN-Port
LAN Infrastructure incl.:
• LAN Switch
• Internet Router
• DHCP Server (DHCP ON)
UC Client
UC Client
OpenScape Office LX
(DHCP OFF)
IP Phone
100
IP Phone
101
Related Topics
2.2.2 Sample Scenario for OpenScape Office MX
The sample scenario illustrates the stand-alone deployment of
OpenScape Office MX.
In this scenario, OpenScape Office MX offers:
•
Trunk connection to the public network (PTSN) via ISDN
•
Internet access via an existing Internet router (e.g., DSL)
•
IP phones (OpenStage)
•
UC Clients (myPortal)
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
61
System Overview and Scenarios
Sample Scenarios
PSTN
PS
S
Internet P
PSTN/ISDN
S0
UPLINK
ADMIN
OpenScape Office MX
(DHCP ON)
LAN Infrastructure incl.:
• LAN Switch
• Internet Router
• DHCP Server (DHCP OFF)
UC Client
UC Client
IP Phone
100
Admin PC
IP Phone
101
Related Topics
2.2.3 Sample Scenario for OpenScape Office HX
The sample scenario illustrates the deployment of OpenScape Office HX as a
stand-alone unit with HiPath 3000.
In this scenario, OpenScape Office HX offers:
62
•
Voice communications via HiPath 3000 and trunk connection to the public
network (PTSN) via ISDN
•
Internet access via HG 1500 through an existing Internet router (e.g., DSL)
•
IP phones (OpenStage) at the HiPath 3000
•
UC clients (myPortal) via OpenScape Office HX
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
System Overview and Scenarios
Sample Scenarios
PSTN
PS
S
Internet P
PSTN/ISDN
HG 1500
00
LAN Infrastructure incl.:
• LAN Switch
• Internet Router
• DHCP Server (DHCP ON)
UC Client
UC Client
IP Phone
100
S0
HiPath 3000
OpenScape Office HX
(DHCP OFF)
IP Phone
101
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
63
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
OpenScape Office MX System Box
3 Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
The OpenScape Office MX communication system is a modular system that can
be deployed as a one-box system (consisting of a single OpenScape Office MX
system box) or as a multibox system (consisting of two or three OpenScape Office
MX system boxes). Every OpenScape Office MX system box is equipped with a
motherboard and provides three slots for installing optional gateway modules for
the trunk and station connections.
OpenScape Office MX can be installed as a standalone unit (desktop mode) or in
a 19’’ rack.
Related Topics
3.1 OpenScape Office MX System Box
Every OpenScape Office MX system box is equipped with a motherboard. The
motherboard is the central processing unit of a system box. In addition, three slots
are available for installing gateway modules.
The OpenScape Office MX communication system is based on a modular design
and can comprise up to three OpenScape Office MX system boxes, depending
on customer requirements.
A single-box system consists of a single OpenScape Office MX system box
known as the central box.
Multibox systems consist of two or three OpenScape Office MX system boxes:
one central box and one or two expansion boxes. The system boxes are interconnected using the LAN cable included in the delivery package for each system box.
In effect, the central box and expansion boxes consist of the same hardware, the
OpenScape Office MX system box. The distinction between a central box and an
expansion box is based purely on functionality. When configuring a multibox
system with the OpenScape Office Assistant, one system box is assigned the
function of the central box, another the function of expansion box 1 and, if present,
a third the function of expansion box 2.
WARNING
WARNING
Risk of electric shock through contact with live wires
When using the communication system in countries with country-specific requirements (Finland, Canada, Norway, Sweden and the USA), each
OpenScape Office MX system box must be grounded with a separate grounding
wire. Before you start up the system and connect the telephone lines, connect the
OpenScape Office MX system box(es) with a permanent earthing conductor.
64
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
OpenScape Office MX System Box
Figure: OpenScape Office MX System Box
On/Off Switch
Switching the system off and on again by using the On/Off switch causes the
system to be powered down and powered up again in an undefined state
(analogous to the situation when switching a PC on and off with the PC switch).
The system will be operational again after the startup.
INFO: An OpenScape Office MX system box may only be turned
off with the On/Off switch in emergencies.
For more information, see System Behavior after Pressing the On/Off Switch
(MX) ..
Related Topics
3.1.1 Motherboard
The motherboard is the central processing unit of an OpenScape Office MX
system box.
Figure: OpenScape Office MX Motherboard
Every OpenScape Office MX system box is equipped with a motherboard (slot 1).
Multibox systems are subject to higher system loads due to the increased number
of interfaces and stations. To ensure uniformly high performance, the system load
is internally distributed to the motherboards of all multibox systems. This load
balancing occurs automatically, depending on the system configuration.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
65
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
OpenScape Office MX System Box
Figure: Motherboard – Front View
Connectors
A motherboard provides the following ports (interfaces) in one-box and multibox
systems:
•
4 x LAN (10/100/1000 Mbit/s):
Table: One-box system – LAN connections (interfaces)
LAN (10/100/1000 Mbit/s)
Motherboard in Central Box (CB)
LAN interface 1 (ADMIN)
For connecting a service PC to administer the communication system.
LAN interface 2 (OUT)
Cannot be used during operation of the communication system.
LAN interface 3 (IN)
LAN interface 4 (UPLINK)
For linking into the LAN infrastructure of the customer, for connecting a WLAN Access Point, an
additional LAN switch or the direct connection of an
IP phone or PC client.
Table: Multibox system – LAN connections (interfaces)
LAN
Motherboard in Cen(10/100/
tral Box (CB)
1000 Mbit/s)
LAN interface 1
(ADMIN)
66
Motherboard in
Expansion box 1
(EB1)
Motherboard in
Expansion Box 2
(EB2) (if present)
For connecting a ser- Cannot be used during operation of the comvice PC to administer munication system.
the communication
system.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
OpenScape Office MX System Box
LAN
Motherboard in Cen(10/100/
tral Box (CB)
1000 Mbit/s)
LAN interFor the connection to
face 2 (OUT) EB1.
Motherboard in
Expansion box 1
(EB1)
Motherboard in
Expansion Box 2
(EB2) (if present)
• EB2 present: For
the connection to
EB2.
Cannot be used during operation of the
communication system.
• Cannot be used
during operation of
the communication system.
LAN interface 3 (IN)
Cannot be used during operation of the
communication system.
For the connection to
the CB.
For the connection to
EB1.
LAN interface 4
(UPLINK)
For linking into the
Cannot be used during operation of the comLAN infrastructure of munication system.
the customer, for connecting a WLAN
Access Point, an additional LAN switch or
the direct connection
of an IP phone or PC
client.
•
1 x DMZ (10/100/1000 Mbit/s), for “DMZ-like” (demilitarized zone) operation
To connect E-mail servers and Web servers
A demilitarized zone (DMZ), in conjunction with firewalls, represents a
logically protected network segment which houses a company’s publicly
accessible services, such as its e-mail and web servers. In this way, the DMZ
prevents external access to internal IT structures. With DMZ there are two
physically separated firewalls. The term “DMZ-like” is used for OpenScape
Office MX, since it has only one central firewall.
•
1 x WAN (10/100/1000 Mbit/s)
To connect to an ITSP, for example, using DSL (PPPOE or PPTP protocol).
The WAN can be connected to the DSL modem either directly or via a router.
Note: The WAN port may only be used for the Internet access. If
the WAN port is not used, is should be disabled.
Table: Assignment of the LAN, DMZ and WAN ports
RJ45 Jack, Pin
Signal
1
Tx +
Transmit +
2
Tx –
Transmit –
3
Rx +
Receive +
4
–
not used
5
–
not used
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Notes
67
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
OpenScape Office MX System Box
RJ45 Jack, Pin
Signal
Notes
6
Rx –
7
–
not used
8
–
not used
Receive –
Table: LEDs to display the status of the LAN, DMZ and WAN interfaces
LED
left
right
Status
Meaning
steady green light
link
flashing
activity
steady green light
1000 Mbps
steady orange light
100 Mbps
off
10 Mbps
•
1 x USB Control (USB 1.1 Slave)
To connect a PC for service and diagnostic purposes.
•
1 x USB Server (USB 2.0 Master)
For connecting an external hard disk or USB stick for backups and software
upgrades.
INFO: For multibox systems, only the USB server port of the
central box can be used.
Reset Switch
The motherboard’s front panel features a Reset switch:
•
Press reset switch < 10 sec.:
The OpenScape Office MX system box performs a controlled restart (similar
to pressing the Reset button on a PC). The system box will be operational
again after the startup.
INFO: The Reset (Restart) switch should only be used in
emergencies!
•
Press Reset switch > 10 sec.:
It causes the OpenScape Office MX system box to reload. The system box
reverts to the initial (default) state following startup. All country and customerspecific settings are lost (system country code = Germany). Country- and
customer-specific data backups can be reloaded once the basic settings have
been configured.
For more information on the function of the Reset switch, especially with respect
to the differences in behavior for one-box and multibox systems, see System
Behavior after Initiating a Reset via the Reset Switch (MX) and System Behavior
after Initiating a Reload via the Reset Switch (MX) .
68
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
OpenScape Office MX System Box
LEDs
The motherboard’s front panel features four LEDs that indicate the operating
states of the associated OpenScape Office MX system box:
•
Green LED:
–
Flashing = normal operating state
Figure: Green LED – Flash Rates in Normal Operating State
1
2
3
4
5
6
Seconds
on
off
Flash rate of a one-box system / the central box of a multibox system
1
2
3
4
5
6
Seconds
on
off
Flash rate of expansion box 1 of a multibox system
1
2
3
4
5
6
Seconds
on
off
Flash rate of expansion box 2 of a multibox system
–
•
Off = On/Off switch at position “0”; power outage or error
Red LED:
–
Off = normal operating state
– Blinking = Error
Note: The brief flashing of the red LED after the system has been switched on
or restarted signals a normal operating state during startup and does not
indicate an error.
•
Yellow LED:
On = the hard disk is being accessed
•
Blue LED:
On = Operating state “Shutdown”. Module release latch of the motherboard
pulled out until the first resistance is felt.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
69
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
OpenScape Office MX System Box
Module Release Latch
Note: Damage to the motherboard through removal or insertion
when the system box is active!
The motherboard can only be removed from a system box after
the associated system box has been shut down gracefully and
then turned off. The motherboard may only be inserted into a
system box when the system box has been turned off.
Figure: Module release latch of the motherboard
Pulling out the module release latch of a motherboard results in a controlled
shutdown of the associated OpenScape Office MX system box. All services are
stopped, and the current data is backed up. You may only slide the module
release latch until the first resistance is felt. On completing the shutdown, the blue
LED of the motherboard lights up (operating state “Shutdown”). It is only at this
point that you can safely switch off the system box and remove the motherboard.
To put the OpenScape Office MX system box back into service, the module
release latch must be pressed in until it is arrested at the motherboard and it clicks
into place. The On/Off switch must then be set to the position “I”.
For more information, see System Behavior after Unlocking the Module Release
Latch of the Motherboard (MX) ..
Related Topics
3.1.2 Slot and Access Designations
This section contains information on the slot designations in the OpenScape
Office MX system box and the accesses (ports) available in the gateway modules.
70
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
OpenScape Office MX System Box
Slot Designations
Each OpenScape Office MX system box provides three slots (slots 2 through 4)
for installing gateway modules (GM). The motherboard of the system box is
always installed in one slot (slot 1).
Note: Protection against radio frequency interference and
overheating
To ensure adequate protection and the dissipation of heat, the
system box should not be operated with an open slot. Slots in
which no gateway modules are installed must be closed with slot
covers.
Figure: OpenScape Office MX system box – Slot numbering
Slot 3 (GM)
Slot 4 (GM)
Slot 2 (GM)
Slot 1 (Motherboard)
Access Designations
The accesses available in the gateway modules are identified as follows in
OpenScape Office Assistant:
OpenScape Office MX system box no. – Slot no. – Interface type – Access no.
•
OpenScape Office MX system box no.: indicates the system box containing
the relevant access.
•
Slot no.: indicates the slot containing the relevant access.
•
Interface type: indicates the relevant access type.
•
Access no.: indicates the number of the relevant access.
Example of a communication system consisting of two OpenScape Office MX
system boxes:
Figure: Example of a Multibox system
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
71
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Gateway Modules
Slot 3 (GMSA)
4 x ab
1 2 3 4
4 x S0
1 2 3 4
Slot 4 (GMS)
4 x S0
1 2 3 4
Slot 2
Slot 1 (Motherboard)
Slot 3 (GMSA)
Slot 4 (GMS)
4 x ab
1 2 3 4
4 x S0
1 2 3 4
A
System Box 2
(Expansion Box)
System Box 1
(Central Box)
4 x S0
1 2 3 4
B
Slot 2
Slot 1 (Motherboard)
•
Access identified as A: 1–3–S0–3 = system box 1 – Slot 3 – S0 port – Access
3
•
Access identified as B: 1–3–a/b–2 = system box 1 – Slot 3 – a/b interface –
Access 2
Related Topics
3.2 Gateway Modules
Gateway modules provide interfaces for the trunk and station connections.
Each OpenScape Office MX system box provides three slots (slots 2 through 4)
for the custom installation of gateway modules (GM).
Types
The following gateway modules can be used:
72
•
GMS (not for U.S. and Canada) = Gateway module with four S0 ports for the
ISDN trunk connection or the ISDN station connection
•
GMSA (not for U.S. and Canada) = Gateway module with four S0 ports for the
ISDN trunk connection or ISDN station connection and four a/b interfaces for
the analog station connection
•
GME (not for U.S. and Canada) = Gateway module with one S2M port for the
ISDN Primary Rate Interface
•
GMT (for U.S. and Canada only) = Gateway module with one T1 interface for
the ISDN Primary Rate Interface
•
GMAA = Gateway module with four a/b interfaces for the analog trunk
connection and two a/b interfaces for the analog station connection
•
GMAL = Gateway module with eight a/b interfaces for the analog station
connection
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Gateway Modules
LEDs
The gateway modules described feature a front panel with two LEDs that indicate
the relevant module’s operating states:
•
Green LED:
Flashing = normal operating state
Off = On/Off switch at position “0”; power outage or error
On (briefly): startup phase
•
Red LED:
Off = normal operating state
Blinking = Error
Note: If a gateway module signals an error (red LED flashing),
the problem can often be resolved by simply removing and then
reinserting the gateway module. Note that the gateway module
should not be reinserted into the slot of the system box until at
least 150 seconds have passed. Otherwise, problems may arise
when starting up the gateway module.
As can be seen in the following figure, only the upper two recesses are equipped
with LEDs. The bottom two recesses have no function.
Figure: LEDs in gateway modules
Related Topics
3.2.1 Not for U.S. and Canada: Gateway Module GMS
The Gateway Module GMS provides four S0 ports (BRI 1 - 4) for the ISDN system
connection (ISDN trunk) or the ISDN station connection.
Figure: Gateway Module GMS
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
73
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Gateway Modules
WARNING
WARNING
Risk of electric shock through contact with live wires
When using the communication system in countries with country-specific requirements (Finland, Canada, Norway, Sweden and the USA), each
OpenScape Office MX system box must be grounded with a separate grounding
wire. Before you start up the system and connect the telephone lines, connect the
OpenScape Office MX system box(es) with a permanent earthing conductor.
Figure: GMS – Front Panel
The RJ45 jacks on the S0 ports each have four wires. ISDN trunk lines can be
directly connected (1:1 cable). For ISDN phones, the Receive and Transmit lines
must be swapped in each case.
The delivery package of the gateway module includes four S0 cables for the ISDN
trunk connection.
INFO: Lines for connecting ISDN phones may only exit the
building via an external upstream device that guarantees primary
overvoltage protection.
Table: GMS – Assignment of the S0 connections (BRI 1 - 4)
RJ45 Jack, Pin
Signal
Notes
1
–
not used
2
–
not used
3
Ta
Transmit +
4
Ra
Receive +
5
Rb
Receive –
6
Tb
Transmit –
7
–
not used
8
–
not used
Related Topics
3.2.2 Not for U.S. and Canada: Gateway Module GMSA
The Gateway Module GMSA provides four S0 ports (BRI 1 - 4) for the ISDN
system connection (ISDN trunk) or the ISDN station connection and four a/b interfaces (ANALOG SUBSCRIBER 1 - 4) for the analog station connection.
74
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Gateway Modules
The a/b interfaces for the analog station connection support the CLIP feature.
Figure: Gateway Module GMSA
WARNING
WARNING
Risk of electric shock through contact with live wires
When using the communication system in countries with country-specific requirements (Finland, Canada, Norway, Sweden and the USA), each
OpenScape Office MX system box must be grounded with a separate grounding
wire. Before you start up the system and connect the telephone lines, connect the
OpenScape Office MX system box(es) with a permanent earthing conductor.
The delivery package of the gateway module includes four S0 cables for the ISDN
trunk connection.
Figure: GMSA – Front Panel
•
S0 ports
The RJ45 jacks each have four wires. ISDN trunk lines can be directly
connected (1:1 cable). For ISDN phones, the Receive and Transmit lines
must be swapped in each case.
INFO: Lines for connecting ISDN phones may only exit the
building via an external upstream device that guarantees primary
overvoltage protection.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
75
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Gateway Modules
Table: GMSA – Assignment of the S0 connections (BRI 1 - 4)
•
RJ45 Jack, Pin
Signal
Notes
1
–
not used
2
–
not used
3
Ta
Transmit +
4
Ra
Receive +
5
Rb
Receive –
6
Tb
Transmit –
7
–
not used
8
–
not used
a/b interfaces
The RJ45 jacks each have two wires.
INFO: Lines for connecting analog devices (e.g., phones or fax
machines) must not leave the building.
The a/b interfaces supply a ring voltage of 45 Veff. Malfunctions can occur
depending on the phones connected.
If a higher ring voltage is required, the GMAL gateway module must be used.
The a/b interfaces of this gateway module supply a ring voltage of 70 Veff.
Table: GMSA – Assignment of the a/b connections (ANALOG SUBSCRIBER 1 - 4)
RJ45 Jack, Pin
Signal
Notes
1
–
not used
2
–
not used
3
–
not used
4
a
5
b
6
–
not used
7
–
not used
8
–
not used
Related Topics
3.2.3 Not for U.S. and Canada: Gateway Module GME
The Gateway module GME provides one S2M port for the ISDN Primary Rate
Interface.
76
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Gateway Modules
Figure: Gateway Module GME
WARNING
WARNING
Risk of electric shock through contact with live wires
When using the communication system in countries with country-specific requirements (Finland, Canada, Norway, Sweden and the USA), each
OpenScape Office MX system box must be grounded with a separate grounding
wire. Before you start up the system and connect the telephone lines, connect the
OpenScape Office MX system box(es) with a permanent earthing conductor.
INFO: A maximum of eight GME gateway modules may be used
in a multibox system consisting of three system boxes.
The delivery package of the gateway module includes a patch cable for the ISDN
Primary Rate Interface.
Figure: GME – Front Panel
A Primary Rate Interface features 30 bidirectional bearer channels (B-channels),
each with 64 Kbps, a signaling channel (D-channel) with 64 Kbps, and a synchronization channel with 64 Kbps = 2048 Kbps gross bandwidth. This connection is
mainly used by companies with high telephone traffic volumes to connect the
communication system to the ISDN trunk.
Table: GME – Assignment of the S2M Connection (PRI)
RJ45 Jack, Pin
Signal
1
Rb
B-wire, Receive
2
Ra
A-wire, Receive
3
–
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Notes
not used
77
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Gateway Modules
RJ45 Jack, Pin
Signal
Notes
4
Tb
B-wire, Transmit
5
Ta
B-wire, Transmit
6
–
not used
7
–
not used
8
–
not used
Related Topics
3.2.4 For U.S. and Canada only: Gateway Module GMT
The Gateway Module GMT provides one T1 interface for the ISDN Primary Rate
Interface.
Figure: Gateway Module GMT
WARNING
WARNING
Risk of electric shock through contact with live wires
When using the communication system in countries with country-specific requirements (Finland, Canada, Norway, Sweden and the USA), each
OpenScape Office MX system box must be grounded with a separate grounding
wire. Before you start up the system and connect the telephone lines, connect the
OpenScape Office MX system box(es) with a permanent earthing conductor.
Figure: GMT – Front Panel
A Primary Rate Interface connection features 24 bidirectional bearer channels (Bchannels), each with up to 64 Kbps per channel and a gross bandwidth of 1544
Kbps. This connection is mainly used by companies with high telephone traffic
volumes to connect the communication system to the ISDN trunk.
78
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Gateway Modules
The delivery package of the gateway module includes a T1 cable for the ISDN
Primary Rate Interface.
INFO: The DSX-1 interface (T1 interface) in OpenScape Office
MX must not be directly connected to the PSTN (Public Switched
Telephone Network). A Channel Service Unit (CSU) must be
installed between the communication system and the digital trunk
connection. The CSU must be approved according to FCC Part
68 and satisfy the ANSI directive T1.403. The CSU provides the
following features for OpenScape Office MX: Isolation and
overvoltage protection of the communication system, diagnostic
options in the event of a malfunction (such as signal loopback,
application of test signals and test patterns), line-up of the output
signal in compliance with the line lengths specified by the network
provider.
Table: GMT – Assignment of the T1 Connection (T1)
RJ45 Jack, Pin
Signal
Notes
1
Rb
B-wire, Receive
2
Ra
A-wire, Receive
3
–
4
Tb
B-wire, Transmit
5
Ta
B-wire, Transmit
6
–
not used
7
–
not used
8
–
not used
not used
Related Topics
3.2.5 Gateway Module GMAA
The Gateway Module GMAA provides two a/b interfaces for the analog station
connection (ANALOG SUBSCRIBER 1 - 4) and two a/b interfaces for the analog
trunk connection (ANALOG TRUNK 1 - 2).
The a/b interfaces for the analog trunk connection support call detail recording
with 12 kHz and 16 kHz pulses. The selection occurs automatically on setting the
language of the communication system.
The a/b interfaces for the analog trunk connection and the analog station
connection support the CLIP feature.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
79
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Gateway Modules
Figure: Gateway Module GMAA
WARNING
WARNING
Risk of electric shock through contact with live wires
When using the communication system in countries with country-specific requirements (Finland, Canada, Norway, Sweden and the USA), each
OpenScape Office MX system box must be grounded with a separate grounding
wire. Before you start up the system and connect the telephone lines, connect the
OpenScape Office MX system box(es) with a permanent earthing conductor.
Figure: GMAA – Front Panel
•
a/b interfaces for the analog station connection
The RJ45 jacks each have two wires.
INFO: Lines for connecting analog devices (e.g., phones or fax
machines) must not leave the building.
The a/b interfaces supply a ring voltage of 45 Veff. Malfunctions can occur
depending on the phones connected.
If a higher ring voltage is required, the GMAL gateway module must be used.
The a/b interfaces of this gateway module supply a ring voltage of 70 Veff.
80
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Gateway Modules
•
a/b interfaces for the analog trunk connection
The RJ45 jacks each have two wires. OpenScape Office MX supports analog
trunk connections with ground-start and loop-start signaling.
INFO: The installation regulations in the U.S. and Canada require
analog trunks to be connected using approved protectors as per
UL 497A or CSA C22.2 No. 226.
Table: GMAA – Assignment of the a/b interfaces (ANALOG SUBSCRIBER 1 - 2,
ANALOG TRUNK 1 - 4)
RJ45 Jack, Pin
Signal
Notes
1
–
not used
2
–
not used
3
–
not used
4
a
5
b
6
–
not used
7
–
not used
8
–
not used
Related Topics
3.2.6 Gateway Module GMAL
The Gateway Module GMAL provides eight a/b interfaces (ANALOG
SUBSCRIBER 1 - 8) for the analog station connection.
The a/b interfaces for the analog station connection support the CLIP feature.
Figure: Gateway Module GMAL
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
81
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
WARNING
WARNING
Risk of electric shock through contact with live wires
When using the communication system in countries with country-specific requirements (Finland, Canada, Norway, Sweden and the USA), each
OpenScape Office MX system box must be grounded with a separate grounding
wire. Before you start up the system and connect the telephone lines, connect the
OpenScape Office MX system box(es) with a permanent earthing conductor.
Figure: GMAL – Front Panel
The RJ45 jacks on the a/b (T/R) interfaces each have two wires. The a/b interfaces supply a ring voltage of 70 Veff.
INFO: Lines for connecting analog devices (e.g., phones or fax
machines) must not leave the building.
Table: GMAL – Assignment of the a/b connections (ANALOG SUBSCRIBER 1 - 8)
RJ45 Jack, Pin
Signal
Notes
1
–
not used
2
–
not used
3
–
not used
4
a
5
b
6
–
not used
7
–
not used
8
–
not used
Related Topics
3.3 Installation
Before the OpenScape Office MX communication system can be set up and
started for the first time, the hardware installation must be completed.
Install the hardware of the OpenScape Office MX communication system as
described below.
82
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
Make sure that you have carefully read and noted the details provided under
Safety Information and Warnings and under Important Notes before you begin
with the installation.
•
Preparatory Steps:
–
Unpacking the components
–
Attaching the plastic cover
–
For U.S. and Canada only: Setting ground start for analog trunk
connection
–
Installing gateway modules
•
Selecting the type of installation
•
Providing protective grounding for the communication system
•
Setting up one or more trunk connections of the communication system
•
Integration in the LAN Infrastructure
•
Connecting ISDN Phones and Analog Phones and Devices
•
Closing Activities:
–
Performing a visual inspection
Related Topics
3.3.1 Prerequisites for Installation
To install the OpenScape Office MX communication system, you will need some
specific tools and resources. Certain requirements must be observed when
selecting the installation site. Note that there are also some specific requirements
regarding the power supply when using the communication system in the United
States and Canada.
Tools and Resources
The following tools and resources are required:
•
TORX screwdriver, size T10
•
TORX screwdriver, size T25, for the screws at the ground wire connection of
an OpenScape Office MX system box.
•
For 19-inch rack mount only: Special cabinet screws, which are not included
in the delivery package of the communication system are needed to attach the
communication system to the 19’’ rack. You will need a suitable screwdriver
for these screws.
•
Digital multimeter for measuring voltage. To check ground connections, if
protective grounding is required for the system.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
83
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
Prerequisites for Selecting the Installation Site
WARNING
WARNING
Risk of electric shock through contact with live wires
When using the communication system in countries with country-specific requirements (Finland, Canada, Norway, Sweden and the USA), each
OpenScape Office MX system box must be grounded with a separate grounding
wire. Before you start up the system and connect the telephone lines, connect the
OpenScape Office MX system box(es) with a permanent earthing conductor.
The OpenScape Office MX communication system can be installed as a standalone unit or in a 19’’ rack.
The following aspects should be considered when selecting the installation site of
the communication system:
•
To guarantee sufficient ventilation for the communication system, you must
observe the following guidelines:
–
Standalone installation: A minimum clearance of 10 cm (4 in.) must be
maintained to the right and left of the case.
–
19” rack mount: The intake air temperature (i.e., the temperature of the air
sucked in by the fan) of an OpenScape Office MX system box must not
exceed a maximum of 40 °C (104 °F).
•
Do not expose the communication system to direct sources of heat (for
example, direct sunlight, radiators, etc.).
•
Do not expose the communication system to extremely dusty environments.
•
Avoid contact with chemicals.
•
Avoid all condensation of humidity on or in the communication system during
operation. The communication system must be completely dry before you put
it into service.
•
Note the environmental and mechanical conditions for operating the communication system (see Operating Conditions ).
•
The power cable connector must be readily accessible on every OpenScape
Office MX system box for quick disconnection from the power source at any
time.
For U.S. and Canada only: Prerequisites for Connecting the Power Supply
The power supply for the communication system must meet the following requirements:
•
84
Electrical Connection Specifications:
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
Nominal voltage
Nominal voltage
range
from
To
Nominal frequency
range
from
120 V AC/60 Hz 110 V AC 130 V AC 47 Hz
Terminal box
configuration
To
63 Hz
NEMA 5-15, 2pin, 3-wire,
grounded
•
The power source must not be more than 2 m (6 ft.) away from the communication system.
•
The power source must supply a voltage of 120 V AC (single-phase,
protected) at 47-63 Hz.
•
A local electric circuit must be used.
•
We recommend an overvoltage arrestor between the AC power and the
communication system.
Related Topics
3.3.2 Preparatory Steps
Before the actual installation, some preparatory steps such as unpacking the
supplied components, attaching the plastic cover and installing gateway modules
must be performed.
Related Topics
3.3.2.1 How to Unpack the Components
Proceed as follows to unpack the communication system and parts supplied:
Step by Step
1) Open the packaging without damaging the contents.
2) Check the components delivered against the packing slip to make sure
nothing is missing.
3) Report any shipping damage to the address indicated on the packing slip.
4) All packaging material must be disposed of in compliance with the relevant
country-specific requirements.
WARNING
WARNING
Risk of electric shock through contact with live wires
Only use systems, tools and equipment which are in perfect condition. Do not use
equipment with visible damage.
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
85
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
3.3.2.2 How to Attach the Plastic Cover
Mount the plastic cover included in the delivery package of an
OpenScape Office MX system box as follows:
Figure: Front and back side of the plastic cover
Step by Step
1) Insert the round dowel pins (1) of the plastic cover into the appropriate holes
in the front panel of the system box. Press the plastic cover into the front panel
until the clips (2) snap into place.
Figure: How to Install the Plastic Cover
2) Repeat this procedure for all additional system boxes of your communication
system.
Figure: Mounted plastic cover
Related Topics
86
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
3.3.2.3 For U.S. and Canada only: How to Set Ground Start for an Analog Trunk
Connection
OpenScape Office MX supports analog trunk connections with ground-start and
loop-start signaling via the GMAA gateway module.
In the default factory state, the GMAA module is set for the loop start signaling
method.
In order to set the ground start signaling method used in the USA and Canada,
two jumper settings on the GMAA gateway module must be modified.
WARNING
WARNING
Risk of electric shock through contact with live wires
When using the communication system in countries with country-specific requirements (Finland, Canada, Norway, Sweden and the USA), each
OpenScape Office MX system box must be grounded with a separate grounding
wire. Before you start up the system and connect the telephone lines, connect the
OpenScape Office MX system box(es) with a permanent earthing conductor.
Step by Step
1) Place the GMAA gateway module on a conducting surface with the
component side facing upward.
2) Change the settings for jumpers X104 and X105 as shown in the following
diagram.
Figure: Gateway module GMAA (component side) with jumpers X104 and X105
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
87
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
Jumper setting in factory state = Loop
Start
X104
X105
1
3
1
4
2
4
2
Front panel
3
X104 X105
Jumper setting = Ground Start
GMAA
X104
X105
3
1
3
1
4
2
4
2
3) Repeat the steps for all other GMAA gateway modules of your communication
system.
Related Topics
3.3.2.4 How to Install Gateway Modules
Each OpenScape Office MX system box provides three slots (slots 2 through 4)
for installing gateway modules (GM). The motherboard of the system box is
always installed in one slot (slot 1).
The three GM slots in the OpenScape Office MX system box are shipped exfactory with slot covers. To insert a gateway module, you must first remove the
slot cover.
Figure: OpenScape Office MX system box – Front view with mounted slot covers
INFO: For effective heat distribution within an
OpenScape Office MX system box, gateway modules must be
inserted first in slot 3, then slot 4, and finally slot 2.
88
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
Step by Step
1) Remove the slot cover on the slot you want to use by inserting a screwdriver
into the slot on the slot cover. Carefully pry the slot cover off the slot as illustrated in the figure below.
Figure: OpenScape Office MX system box – Removing a slot cover
2) Using the guide rails provided, slide the gateway module into the empty slot.
Figure: OpenScape Office MX system box – Installing a gateway module
3) Keeping the gateway module level, push it into to the slot until it is flush with
the front of the system box.
Figure: OpenScape Office MX system box – Installing a gateway module
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
89
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
4) Press the module release latch as illustrated in the figure below until it is
arrested at the gateway module.
Figure: OpenScape Office MX system box – Pressing in the module release latch
of a gateway module
5) Repeat steps 1 through 4 for all additional gateway modules and system
boxes of your communication system.
Note: Protection against radio frequency interference and
overheating
To ensure adequate protection and the dissipation of heat, the
system box should not be operated with an open slot. Slots in
which no gateway modules are installed must be closed with slot
covers.
Figure: Slot cover
INFO: To remove a gateway module, pull it out from the slot with
the help of the module release latch.
Related Topics
90
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
3.3.3 Installation Methods
The OpenScape Office MX communication system can be installed as a standalone unit (desktop mode) or in a 19’’ rack.
Select the suitable type of installation for your communication system in accordance with your requirements, while taking into account the Prerequisites for
Installation listed under Prerequisites for Installation . The formatting of <TEXT>
following a <p> is not supported. Wrap the <TEXT> that follows in a <p>.
Related Topics
3.3.3.1 How to Install the Communication System as a Standalone Unit (Desktop
Operation)
To install the system as a standalone unit (desktop operation), mount the four
rubber feet shipped with every OpenScape Office MX system box. This will help
prevent the sensitive top surfaces of the case from being scratched and stacked
system boxes from sliding around.
Step by Step
1) Attach the four adhesive rubber feet to the underside of the system box case,
one per corner (see figure below). The case has indentations to help position
the rubber feet precisely.
Figure: OpenScape Office MX system box – Bottom of case with mounted rubber
feet
2) Repeat this procedure for all additional system boxes of your communication
system.
Note: To ensure the safe operation of the OpenScape Office MX
communication system, the system boxes should not be moved
during operation!
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
91
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
Related Topics
3.3.3.2 How to Mount the Communication System in a 19’’ Rack
Prerequisites
•
You will need special cabinet screws to attach an OpenScape Office MX
system box to the 19’’ rack (contact your cabinet supplier).
To mount the system in a 19’’ rack, you will need to attach the brackets shipped
with each OpenScape Office MX system box using the appropriate screws.
Figure: Brackets with screws
Step by Step
1) Insert the bracket lugs into the slots provided on the right and left sides of the
system box case (as indicated by the arrows in figure below).
Figure: OpenScape Office MX system box - Inserting the bracket
2) Secure the bracket with three of the screws supplied.
92
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
Figure: OpenScape Office MX system box – Attached bracket
3) Attach the second bracket to the other side of the system box case.
4) Lift the system box into the 19’’ rack.
5) Attach the system box to each side of the 19” rack with the two brackets using
two screws per side (see diagram below).
Figure: OpenScape Office MX system box - 19’’ rack mount
6) Repeat steps 1 through 5 for all additional system boxes of your communication system.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
93
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
Figure: Two OpenScape Office MX system boxes in the 19’’ rack
Related Topics
3.3.4 Protective Grounding
The protective grounding provides a secure connection to the ground potential to
protect against dangerously high touch voltages in the event of a malfunction.
The OpenScape Office MX communication system is a Class 1 device and may
only be connected to grounded sockets on the power supply circuit. Only then can
a proper protective grounding of the communication system be guaranteed.
In accordance with country-specific requirements, a separate, permanently
connected protective earthing conductor provides an additional protective
grounding for the communication system and the connected telecommunications
network. The additional protective grounding can be basically installed even if this
is not mandated by national installation regulations.
94
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
WARNING
WARNING
Risk of electric shock through contact with live wires
•
When using the communication system in countries with country-specific
requirements (Finland, Canada, Norway, Sweden and the USA), each
OpenScape Office MX system box must be grounded with a separate
grounding wire.
•
Make sure that the ground wire is protected and strain-relieved (minimum
conductor cross section = 12 AWG/2.5 mm2). A minimum conductor cross
section of 10 AWG/4 mm2 is needed to block the effects of external factors if
the ground wire cannot be protected.
Note: The protective grounding is highly recommended even in
countries where this is not mandatory. To optimize the interference resistance of the communication system, the protective
grounding should always be provided.
Related Topics
3.3.4.1 How to Provide Protective Grounding for the Communication System
Prerequisites
•
A ground connection with a resistance of less than 2 ohms exists. Examples:
Main ground busbar, Ground field
•
For the 19’’ rack mount only: The 19” rack is grounded with a separate
grounding wire (green/yellow). The 19’’ rack is equipped with an equipotential
bonding strip at which every OpenScape Office MX system box can be
separately grounded.
DANGER
DANGER
Risk of electric shock through contact with live wires
Only personnel with proper qualifications or qualified electricians should perform
work on the low-voltage network (<1000 VAC) and all work must comply with the
national/local requirements for electrical connections.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
95
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
WARNING
WARNING
Risk of electric shock through contact with live wires
•
When using the communication system in countries with country-specific
requirements (Finland, Canada, Norway, Sweden and the USA), each
OpenScape Office MX system box must be grounded with a separate
grounding wire.
•
Make sure that the ground wire is protected and strain-relieved (minimum
conductor cross section = 12 AWG/2.5 mm2). A minimum conductor cross
section of 10 AWG/4 mm2 is needed to block the effects of external factors if
the ground wire cannot be protected.
The implementation rules specified in IEC 60364 and IEC 60950-1 must be
complied with during the installation.
Each system box must be protectively grounded separately as described in the
following steps:
Step by Step
1) Attach a separate ground wire to the system box’s ground terminal as
indicated in the following figure.
Figure: OpenScape Office MX system box – Ground wire connection
2) Select one of the following two options to connect this ground wire:
•
If the system box was installed as a standalone unit, connect the ground
wire to the ground connection (e.g., main ground busbar, grounding
panel) as illustrated in the Figure: Protective grounding for an
OpenScape Office MX system box (conceptual diagram). Make sure that
the ground wire laid is protected and strain-relieved.
•
If the system box was mounted in the 19’’ rack, connect the ground wire
with the equipotential bonding strip of the 19” rack. Make sure that the
ground wire is protected and strain-relieved.
Figure: Protective grounding for an OpenScape Office MX system box (conceptual
diagram)
96
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
Connection cable with connector
Fuse box
20 A
120 VAC, 60 Hz
Neutral ground
conductor
Power
supply
Ground wire connection
System box OpenScape Office MX
Recommendation: 12 AWG/2,5 mm2
conductor (solid wire or copper litz
wire) with a maximum length of 39 m
(126 feet); blank or green/yellow
Grounding point, for example main
ground busbar
In the power connection panel
that supplies power to the
communication system
Note: Single-point ground (SPG) indicated
3) Repeat this procedure for all additional system boxes of your communication
system.
Related Topics
3.3.4.2 How to Check the Grounding
Prerequisites
•
The OpenScape Office MX system box or system boxes are not yet
connected to the low-voltage network via the power cable.
•
A separate protective ground is connected for each individual
OpenScape Office MX system box.
Run the following test before startup to make sure that the communication
system’s protective grounding is working properly.
Step by Step
1) Select the appropriate method that applies to your system to check the ohmic
resistance on the ground connection to the communication system as follows:
•
If the system box was installed as a standalone unit, the measurement is
taken between the ground contact of a grounded power outlet of the home
installation (where the communication system is connected) and an
OpenScape Office MX system box.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
97
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
•
If the system box was mounted in the 19’’ rack, two measurements are
required. The first measurement is taken between the ground contact of
a grounded power outlet of the home installation and the equipotential
bonding strip in the 19’’ rack. The second measurement is taken between
the equipotential bonding strip in the 19’’ rack and an
OpenScape Office MX system box.
The result (reference value) of a measurement must be significantly less than
10 Ohms.
If you obtain some other results, contact a qualified electrician. The electrician
will need to check the equipotential bonding of the domestic installation and
ensure the low resistance grounding (ohmage) of the earthing conductors.
2) Repeat the measurement for all additional OpenScape Office MX system
boxes of your communication system.
Related Topics
3.3.5 Trunk Connection
The OpenScape Office MX communication system offers different options for
trunk connections and thus for access to the public communication network.
You can select the trunk connection or connections required for your communication system from the following options:
•
ISDN point-to-point connection via S0 interface (not for U.S. and Canada)
•
ISDN point-to-multipoint connection via S0 interface (not for U.S. and
Canada)
•
ISDN Primary Rate Interface via the S2M Interface (not for U.S. and Canada)
•
ISDN Primary Rate Interface via the T1 interface (not for U.S. and Canada)
•
Analog Trunk Connections
Related Topics
3.3.5.1 Not for U.S. and Canada: How to Set up the ISDN Point-to-Point Connection via
the S0 Port
Prerequisites
•
OpenScape Office MX is equipped with at least one of the following gateway
modules: GMS, GMSA
INFO: By default, the S0 ports BRI 1 - 4 are already configured
as point-to-point connections.
•
98
At least one ISDN point-to-point connection is available.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
WARNING
WARNING
Risk of electric shock through contact with live wires
When using the communication system in countries with country-specific requirements (Finland, Canada, Norway, Sweden and the USA), each
OpenScape Office MX system box must be grounded with a separate grounding
wire. Before you start up the system and connect the telephone lines, connect the
OpenScape Office MX system box(es) with a permanent earthing conductor.
CAUTION
CAUTION
Risk of fire
To reduce the risk of fire, you may only use communication cables with a
conductor diameter of at least 0.4mm (AWG 26) or larger.
Step by Step
1) Connect the desired S0 port (BRI 1 - 4) using an S0 cable (included in the
delivery package of the GMS and GMSA gateway modules) with the NTBA of
the ISDN point-to-point connection.
Figure: ISDN point-to-point connection
NTBA = Network Termination for ISDN Basic Rate Access
TAE = Telekommunikations-Anschluss-Einheit (German standard for telephone plugs and sockets)
2) If present, connect any further ISDN trunks to the communication system by
the same method.
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
99
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
3.3.5.2 Not for U.S. and Canada: How to Set up an ISDN Point-to-Multipoint Connection
via the S0 Port
Prerequisites
•
OpenScape Office MX is equipped with at least one of the following gateway
modules: GMS, GMSA
•
The S0 ports used for the ISDN point-to-multipoint connection must be
configured as a point-to-multipoint connection at startup. For more detailed
information on the procedure, see How to Configure the ISDN Trunk
Connection .
•
At least one ISDN point-to-multipoint connection is available.
WARNING
WARNING
Risk of electric shock through contact with live wires
When using the communication system in countries with country-specific requirements (Finland, Canada, Norway, Sweden and the USA), each
OpenScape Office MX system box must be grounded with a separate grounding
wire. Before you start up the system and connect the telephone lines, connect the
OpenScape Office MX system box(es) with a permanent earthing conductor.
CAUTION
CAUTION
Risk of fire
To reduce the risk of fire, you may only use communication cables with a
conductor diameter of at least 0.4mm (AWG 26) or larger.
Step by Step
1) Connect the desired S0 port (BRI 1 - 4) using an S0 cable (included in the
delivery package of the GMS and GMSA gateway modules) with the NTBA of
the ISDN point-to-multipoint connection.
Figure: ISDN point-to-multipoint connection
NTBA = Network Termination for ISDN Basic Rate Access
TAE = Telekommunikations-Anschluss-Einheit (German standard for telephone plugs and sockets)
100
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
2) If present, connect any further ISDN point-to-multipoint connections to the
communication system by the same method.
Related Topics
3.3.5.3 Not for U.S. and Canada: How to Set up an ISDN Primary Rate Interface via the
S2M Port
Prerequisites
•
OpenScape Office MX is equipped with at least one GME gateway module.
•
At least one ISDN Primary Rate Interface is available.
WARNING
WARNING
Risk of electric shock through contact with live wires
When using the communication system in countries with country-specific requirements (Finland, Canada, Norway, Sweden and the USA), each
OpenScape Office MX system box must be grounded with a separate grounding
wire. Before you start up the system and connect the telephone lines, connect the
OpenScape Office MX system box(es) with a permanent earthing conductor.
CAUTION
CAUTION
Risk of fire
To reduce the risk of fire, you may only use communication cables with a
conductor diameter of at least 0.4mm (AWG 26) or larger.
Step by Step
1) Connect the S2M port (PRI) to the NTPM of the ISDN Primary Rate Interface
with a patch cable (included in the delivery package of the GME gateway
module).
Figure: ISDN Primary Rate Interface S2M
NTPM = Network Termination for Primary Rate Multiplex Access
2) If present, connect any further ISDN Primary Rate Interfaces to the communication system by the same method.
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
101
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
3.3.5.4 For U.S. and Canada Only: How to Set up the ISDN Primary Rate Interface via the
T1 Interface
Prerequisites
•
OpenScape Office MX is equipped with at least one GMT gateway module.
•
On starting up the communication system, the system country code must be
set to USA. For more detailed information on the procedure, see How to
Define Country Settings, Date and Time .
•
At least one Channel Service Unit (CSU) that is approved as per FCC Part 68
and that satisfies the ANSI directive T1.403 is available. The DSX-1 interface
(T1 interface) of the OpenScape Office MX communication system must not
be directly connected to the PSTN (Public Switched Telephone Network). It is
essential that one CSU be installed between the communication system and
the digital trunk connection. The CSU provides the following features for
OpenScape Office MX: Isolation and overvoltage protection of the communication system, diagnostic options in the event of a malfunction (such as signal
loopback, application of test signals and test patterns), line-up of the output
signal in compliance with the line lengths specified by the network provider. A
CSU is not a delivery component of the OpenScape Office MX communication system.
•
At least one ISDN Primary Rate Interface is available.
WARNING
WARNING
Risk of electric shock through contact with live wires
When using the communication system in countries with country-specific requirements (Finland, Canada, Norway, Sweden and the USA), each
OpenScape Office MX system box must be grounded with a separate grounding
wire. Before you start up the system and connect the telephone lines, connect the
OpenScape Office MX system box(es) with a permanent earthing conductor.
CAUTION
CAUTION
Risk of fire
To reduce the risk of fire, you may only use communication cables with a
conductor diameter of at least 0.4mm (AWG 26) or larger.
Step by Step
1) Connecting the T1 Interface (T1) to the (Channel) Service Unit (CSU) with a
T1 cable (included in the delivery package of the GMT gateway module).
Figure: ISDN Primary Rate Interface T1
102
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
Channel Service Unit
2) If present, connect any further ISDN Primary Rate Interfaces with the communication system by the same method, i.e., via CSUs.
Related Topics
3.3.5.5 How to Set up an Analog Trunk Connection
Prerequisites
•
OpenScape Office MX is equipped with at least one GMAA gateway module.
•
An analog trunk connection with MSI (main station interface) signaling procedures (ground-start and loop-start signaling) is available.
•
For the U.S. and Canada only: There is at least one protector available as per
UL 497A or CSA C22.2 No. 226. The installation regulations require analog
trunks to be connected using approved protectors as per UL 497A or
CSA C22.2 No. 226.
WARNING
WARNING
Risk of electric shock through contact with live wires
When using the communication system in countries with country-specific requirements (Finland, Canada, Norway, Sweden and the USA), each
OpenScape Office MX system box must be grounded with a separate grounding
wire. Before you start up the system and connect the telephone lines, connect the
OpenScape Office MX system box(es) with a permanent earthing conductor.
CAUTION
CAUTION
Risk of fire
To reduce the risk of fire, you may only use communication cables with a
conductor diameter of at least 0.4mm (AWG 26) or larger.
Step by Step
1) Connect the desired a/b port (ANALOG TRUNK 1 - 4) to the TAE socket by
using a cable (RJ45 jack – TAE jack).
Figure: Analog Trunk Connections
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
103
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
2) If present, connect any further analog trunk connections to the communication system by the same method.
Related Topics
3.3.6 Integration in the LAN Infrastructure
The integration of OpenScape Office MX in an internal customer network
depends on the LAN infrastructure being used.
The following description of the installation is based on the so-called basic
scenario; see Installation Example for OpenScape Office MX .
An internal customer network with an Internet router (DSL router) is already
available in the basic scenario. Internet access is configured in the external
Internet router. OpenScape Office MX is connected to the existing customer
network via a LAN switch. The IP phones, PC clients, WLAN Access Points, etc.
are integrated in the internal customer network via one or more LAN switches and
obtain their IP addresses dynamically from the DHCP server of the communication system.
Related Topics
3.3.6.1 How to Integrate OpenScape Office MX in a Basic Scenario
Prerequisites
•
LAN port 4 (UPLINK) is available in the central box.
INFO: A LAN switch can only be connected using LAN port 4
(UPLINK) of the central box.
104
•
An internal customer network with a DSL router (Internet router) exists.
•
The LAN switch required for the connection of IP phones, PC clients, WLAN
access points, etc., is available.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
WARNING
WARNING
Risk of electric shock through contact with live wires
When using the communication system in countries with country-specific requirements (Finland, Canada, Norway, Sweden and the USA), each
OpenScape Office MX system box must be grounded with a separate grounding
wire. Before you start up the system and connect the telephone lines, connect the
OpenScape Office MX system box(es) with a permanent earthing conductor.
CAUTION
CAUTION
Risk of fire
To reduce the risk of fire, you may only use communication cables with a
conductor diameter of at least 0.4mm (AWG 26) or larger. The recommended
cable is a Cat.5 cable (screened/unscreened multi-element cables characterized
up to 100 MHz for horizontal and building backbone cables as per EN 50288).
These are specified with a conductor diameter from 0.4 mm to 0.8 mm.
Step by Step
1) Connect all IP phones, PC clients, WLAN Access Points, etc., with the LAN
switch.
When using a LAN switch with PoE (Power over Ethernet) functionality, no
separate power supply (e.g., through a power adapter) is required for the
connected IP telephones.
2) Connect LAN Port 4 (UPLINK) of the central box with the LAN switch to which
the IP phones, PC clients, WLAN Access Points, etc., and the DSL router
(Internet router) are connected by using a LAN cable.
Figure: Connecting a LAN Switch
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
105
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
… additional
IP phones,
PC clients or
WLAN Access Points
LAN switch
DSL router
DSL modem
TAE = Telekommunikations-Anschluss-Einheit (German standard for telephone plugs and sockets)
INFO: Refer to the installation instructions of the LAN Switch to
be connected.
For more information, see Installation Example for OpenScape Office MX ..
Related Topics
3.3.7 Connecting ISDN Phones and Analog Phones and Devices
The OpenScape Office MX communication system offers numerous options for
connecting ISDN phones and analog phones and devices.
Select the connection options required for your telephones and other devices:
•
Direct connection of ISDN phones (not for U.S. and Canada)
•
Connection of ISDN phones via the S0 bus (not for U.S. and Canada)
•
Connection of analog phones and devices
Related Topics
106
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
3.3.7.1 Not for U.S. and Canada: How to Connect ISDN Phones Directly
Prerequisites
•
OpenScape Office MX is equipped with at least one of the following gateway
modules: GMS, GMSA
•
The S0 ports used for the ISDN station connection must be configured at
startup as an internal S0 connection. For more detailed information on the
procedure, see How to Configure the ISDN Trunk Connection .
•
The ISDN phones to be connected must have a separate power source, e.g.,
via a power adapter. It is not possible to obtain power via the S0 ports of the
gateway modules.
•
For connecting ISDN phones outside the building only: There is at least one
external protective device that guarantees primary overvoltage protection.
Lines for connecting ISDN phones may only exit the building via an external
upstream device that guarantees primary overvoltage protection.
WARNING
WARNING
Risk of electric shock through contact with live wires
When using the communication system in countries with country-specific requirements (Finland, Canada, Norway, Sweden and the USA), each
OpenScape Office MX system box must be grounded with a separate grounding
wire. Before you start up the system and connect the telephone lines, connect the
OpenScape Office MX system box(es) with a permanent earthing conductor.
CAUTION
CAUTION
Risk of fire
To reduce the risk of fire, you may only use communication cables with a
conductor diameter of at least 0.4mm (AWG 26) or larger.
Step by Step
1) Connect the desired S0 port (BRI 1 - 4) to the ISDN phone by using a cable
with RJ45 jacks.
INFO: The S0 ports are wired for the direct connection of ISDN
trunk lines. For the S0 station connection, the receive and transmit
wires of the S0 cable supplied in the delivery package of the GMS
and GMSA gateway modules must be inverted or a crossover
ISDN patch cable must be used.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
107
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
Figure: Inverting the Receive and Transmit Wires for the S0 Station Connection line
Ta 3
3 Ra
Ra 4
4 Ta
Rb 5
5 Tb
Tb 6
6 Rb
T = Transmit / R = Receive
Figure: Connecting an ISDN Phone
ISDN phone
INFO: Refer to the installation instructions of the phone to be
connected.
2) If present, connect any further ISDN phones to the communication system by
the same method.
Related Topics
3.3.7.2 Not for U.S. and Canada: How to Connect ISDN Phones via the S0 Bus
Prerequisites
108
•
OpenScape Office MX is equipped with at least one of the following gateway
modules: GMS, GMSA
•
The S0 ports used for the ISDN station connection must be configured at
startup as an internal S0 connection. For more detailed information on the
procedure, see How to Configure the ISDN Trunk Connection .
•
Every individual ISDN phone (ISDN stations) must be assigned a unique
Multiple Subscriber Number (MSN). This assignment must be made in the
configuration menu of the ISDN station.
•
The ISDN phones to be connected must have a separate power source, e.g.,
via a power adapter. It is not possible to obtain power via the S0 ports of the
gateway modules.
•
For connecting ISDN phones outside the building only: There is at least one
external protective device that guarantees primary overvoltage protection.
Lines for connecting ISDN phones may only exit the building via an external
upstream device that guarantees primary overvoltage protection.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
WARNING
WARNING
Risk of electric shock through contact with live wires
When using the communication system in countries with country-specific requirements (Finland, Canada, Norway, Sweden and the USA), each
OpenScape Office MX system box must be grounded with a separate grounding
wire. Before you start up the system and connect the telephone lines, connect the
OpenScape Office MX system box(es) with a permanent earthing conductor.
CAUTION
CAUTION
Risk of fire
To reduce the risk of fire, you may only use communication cables with a
conductor diameter of at least 0.4mm (AWG 26) or larger.
Step by Step
1) Connect the desired S0 port (BRI 1 - 4) using an S0 cable (included in the
delivery package of the GMS and GMSA gateway modules) with the Mini
Western socket of the S0 bus.
2) Complete the wiring as shown in Figure: Example for Wiring of S0 Bus
Sockets.
3) Install terminating resistors (100 Ohm/0.25 W) in the last socket of the S0 bus.
4) Make sure that terminating resistors are only connected to the two ends of the
S0 bus. No terminating resistors are required for the other sockets of the S0
bus.
INFO: Since terminating resistors are already integrated into
OpenScape Office MX, the communication system forms one end
of an S0 bus.
Figure: Example for Wiring of S0 Bus Sockets
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
109
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
Mini-Western through-jack
(MW8)
OpenScape Office MX
(GMSA, GMS: S0 port
(BRI 1 - 4)) with permanently
integrated terminating resistors
Tb Rb Ra Ta
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
For ISDN phones, the Receive and
Transmit lines must be swapped in
each case.
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1. Mini-Western socket (MW8)
Rb Tb Ta Ra
6
5
4
3
Power via
power adapter
with RJ45 plug
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
2. Mini-Western socket (MW8)
Rb Tb Ta Ra
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
3. Mini-Western socket (MW8)
Rb Tb Ta Ra
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
8. Mini-Western socket (MW8)
Rb Tb Ta Ra
Terminating resistors
(100 Ohm/0.25 W)
in the last socket
INFO: Refer to the installation instructions of the phone to be
connected.
Related Topics
110
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
3.3.7.3 How to Connect Analog Telephones and Devices
Prerequisites
•
OpenScape Office MX is equipped with at least one of the following gateway
modules: GMAA, GMAL, GMSA
•
Any a/b interface used that is for the modem connection must be assigned the
station type Modem when setting up the system. For more detailed information on the procedure, see How to Configure Analog Stations .
•
In the case of a multibox system, the connection of a modem must occur via
the same system box at which the ITSP connection and/or trunk connection
are set up.
WARNING
WARNING
Risk of electric shock through contact with live wires
When using the communication system in countries with country-specific requirements (Finland, Canada, Norway, Sweden and the USA), each
OpenScape Office MX system box must be grounded with a separate grounding
wire. Before you start up the system and connect the telephone lines, connect the
OpenScape Office MX system box(es) with a permanent earthing conductor.
CAUTION
CAUTION
Risk of fire
To reduce the risk of fire, you may only use communication cables with a
conductor diameter of at least 0.4mm (AWG 26) or larger.
Step by Step
1) Connect the desired a/b port (ANALOG SUBSCRIBER) to the analog device
to be connected (phone, fax, modem, ET-S adapter for entrance telephone)
by using a cable with RJ45 jacks.
INFO: Lines for connecting analog devices (e.g., phones or fax
machines) must not leave the building.
Figure: How to Connect an Analog Device
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
111
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Installation
Example for the connection
of analog devices
(Fax, telephone)
INFO: Please see the specifications in the installation instructions
of the device to be connected, especially with regard to the ring
voltage. The a/b interfaces of the GMAA and GMSA gateway
modules supply a ring voltage of 45 Veff. Malfunctions can occur
depending on the device connected. If a higher ring voltage is
required, the connection must be made at the gateway module
GMAL. Its a/b interfaces supply a ring voltage of 70 Veff.
2) If present, connect any further analog devices to the communication system
by the same method.
Related Topics
3.3.8 Closing Activities
To finish the installation, a visual inspection must be performed to check all
connected cables and to verify the separate protective grounding of all the
OpenScape Office MX system boxes. In addition, the local power supply should
be tested with a digital multimeter.
Related Topics
3.3.8.1 How to Perform a Visual Inspection
Prerequisites
•
The OpenScape Office MX system box or system boxes are not yet
connected to the low-voltage network via the power cable.
•
The On/Off switch of every system box is set to position “0”.
Before you start up the communication system, perform the following inspections:
Step by Step
1) Ensure that all cables are correctly and securely connected.
If necessary, make sure that the connection cables are plugged in correctly.
112
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Multibox Systems
2) Ensure that all connection cables have been correctly laid and secured. Is
there any risk of tripping over a cable, for example?
If required, secure the connection cables properly.
3) For Finland, Canada, Norway, Sweden and the U.S. only: Check whether a
separate grounding wire is attached to the grounding clamp on every
OpenScape Office MX system box.
If required, complete the protective grounding as described under How to
Provide Protective Grounding for the Communication System .
Note: The protective grounding is highly recommended not just
in Finland, Canada, Norway, Sweden and the U.S., but also in
other countries where this is not mandatory. To optimize the interference resistance of the communication system, the protective
grounding should always be provided.
4) Check the local supply voltage using a digital multimeter.
The nominal input voltage range of the communication system is from 110
V AC to 240 V AC.
Next steps
After performing a visual inspection, you can begin with the initial setup of the
OpenScape Office MX communication system (see Installing OpenScape Office
MX ).
Related Topics
3.4 Multibox Systems
Multibox systems consist of two or three OpenScape Office MX system boxes:
one central box and one or two expansion boxes. A multibox system offers more
slots for gateway modules than a one-box system and thus supports higher
station configurations.
Maximum station configurations in one-box and multibox systems:
•
One-box system = maximum 50 stations
•
Multibox system consisting of two system boxes = maximum 100 stations
•
Multibox system consisting of three system boxes = maximum 150 stations
Related Topics
3.4.1 Details on Multibox Systems
The central box and expansion boxes of a multibox system consist of the same
hardware, the OpenScape Office MX system box. The distinction between a
central box and an expansion box is based purely on functionality. When configuring a multibox system with the OpenScape Office Assistant, one system box is
assigned the function of the central box, another the function of expansion box 1
and, if present, a third the function of expansion box 2.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
113
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Multibox Systems
A multibox system has a central database and is administered centrally.
Due to the increased number of system interfaces and subscribers, the system
load is higher. To ensure uniformly high performance, the system load is internally
distributed to the motherboards of all multibox systems. This load balancing
occurs automatically, depending on the system configuration.
INFO: When a multibox system is updated, only the central box
is supplied with the software image. Since the expansion boxes
load the new software from the central box, they do not require
any new image files.
After deconfiguring a multibox system, the individual system
boxes must be individually updated to the latest software status.
Related Topics
3.4.2 Configuring a multibox system .
This section provides information on the procedures for configuring multibox
systems including, for example, the initial configuration of a multibox system, the
reconfiguration of a one-box system to a mulltibox system and the deconfiguration of a multibox system.
INFO: A three-box system cannot be directly downgraded to a
two-box system!
In order to convert a Three-box system to a Two-box system, the Three-box
system must be first deconfigured. For more detailed information on the
procedure, see How to Deconfigure a Multibox System . After this is done, the
initial configuration of a two-box system must be repeated. For more detailed
information on the procedure, see How to Configure a Two-box System for the
First Time .
The customized data of the three-box system can no longer be used. The entire
administration of the two-box system must be repeated from the start.
Related Topics
3.4.2.1 How to Configure a Two-box System for the First Time
This information will enable an administrator to configure a two-box system from
two individual OpenScape Office MX system boxes in factory condition.
114
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Multibox Systems
Prerequisites
•
The hardware installation of the two OpenScape Office MX system boxes has
been completed.
•
All three system boxes have the latest software status of the
OpenScape Office MX V3 version.
•
The initial startup of the two system boxes was performed using
OpenScape Office Assistant. The default IP address 192.168.1.2 of both
system boxes was retained.
•
The system boxes are not interconnected via a cable.
Step by Step
1) Connect the admin PC and the OpenScape Office MX system box that is to
be configured as the central box. To do this, connect the LAN cable to the LAN
port on the admin PC and the ADMIN LAN port 1 on the system box.
2) Open the login page of OpenScape Office Assistant in your web browser
under the address https://192.168.1.2 and log in as an administrator
with the Advanced profile.
3) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
4) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Basic Installation.
5) Click Edit to start the Multibox System wizard.
6) Select the item Two-box system in the System drop-down list.
7) In the Box type: drop-down list, select the item Central box
8) Click OK & Next followed by OK.
A controlled shutdown is now performed for the system box. On completing
the shutdown, the blue LED of the motherboard lights up (operating state
“Shutdown”).
9) Click Finish.
10) Close your web browser to exit OpenScape Office Assistant.
11) As soon as the blue LED of the motherboard lights up, switch off the system
box (On/Off switch at position “0”).
12) Disconnect the LAN cable between the admin PC and the system box which
you just configured as the central box.
13) Connect the admin PC and OpenScape Office MX system box that is to be
configured as expansion box 1. To do this, connect the LAN cable to the LAN
port on the admin PC and the ADMIN LAN port 1 on the system box.
14) Repeat steps 2 through 6.
15) In the Box type: drop-down list, select the item Expansion box 1.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
115
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Multibox Systems
16) Click OK & Next followed by OK.
A controlled shutdown is now performed for the system box. On completing
the shutdown, the blue LED of the motherboard lights up (operating state
“Shutdown”).
INFO: A system box that is configured as an expansion box can
no longer be administered via its ADMIN LAN port 1. An
expansion box is administered as part of a multibox system via the
ADMIN LAN port 1 of the central box.
17) Click Finish.
18) Close your web browser to exit OpenScape Office Assistant.
19) As soon as the blue LED of the motherboard lights up, switch off the system
box (On/Off switch at position “0”).
20) Disconnect the LAN cable between the admin PC and the system box which
you just configured as Expansion Box 1.
21) Connect LAN port 2 (OUT) of the central box with LAN port 3 (IN) of expansion
box 1 by using the LAN cable (length = 28 inches) supplied with the delivery
package.
Figure: Two-box System – Connection Between Central Box and Expansion Box
INFO: The system boxes of a multibox system can be mounted
at a distance of up to 100 m from one another.
A cable to connect the system boxes must meet the following
minimum requirements: shielded twisted pair CAT.5 patch cable
with RJ45 jacks, assignment 1:1.
The maximum length of the cable is 100 meters. No hub or switch
may be connected between them.
22) Turn on both system boxes (On/Off switch at position “I”).
The system boxes are now started up and placed in the normal operating
state. On completing the startup, the green LEDs of the two motherboards
light up. The flash rate of the green LEDs differ. The red LEDs are off.
For more information, see Motherboard ..
116
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Multibox Systems
23) Connect the admin PC and the central box of the two-box system by
connecting the LAN cable to the LAN port on the admin PC and the ADMIN
LAN Port 1 on the central box.
24) Perform any further customized administration of the two-box system using
OpenScape Office Assistant.
INFO: If the text The central box of the multi-box
system is still configured as a one-box system
appears on the home page after logging into
OpenScape Office Assistant successfully, then the central box
has an invalid configuration.
If this occurs, close your Web browser to exit
OpenScape Office Assistant. Remove the system box connection
cable and repeat the initial configuration of the two-box system.
Related Topics
3.4.2.2 How to Configure a Three-box System for the First Time
This information will enable an administrator to configure a three-box system from
three individual OpenScape Office MX system boxes in factory condition.
Prerequisites
•
The hardware installation of the three OpenScape Office MX system boxes
has been completed.
•
All three system boxes have the latest software status of the
OpenScape Office V3 version.
•
The initial startup of the three system boxes was performed using
OpenScape Office Assistant. The default IP address 192.168.1.2 of all three
system boxes was retained.
•
The system boxes are not interconnected via a cable.
Step by Step
1) Connect the admin PC and the OpenScape Office MX system box that is to
be configured as the central box. To do this, connect the LAN cable to the LAN
port on the admin PC and the ADMIN LAN port 1 on the system box.
2) Open the login page of OpenScape Office Assistant in your web browser
under the address https://192.168.1.2 and log in as an administrator
with the Advanced profile.
3) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
4) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Basic Installation.
5) Click Edit to start the Multibox System wizard.
6) Select the item Three-box system in the System drop-down list.
7) In the Box type: drop-down list, select the item Central box
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
117
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Multibox Systems
8) Click OK & Next followed by OK.
A controlled shutdown is now performed for the system box. On completing
the shutdown, the blue LED of the motherboard lights up (operating state
“Shutdown”).
9) Click Finish.
10) Close your web browser to exit OpenScape Office Assistant.
11) As soon as the blue LED of the motherboard lights up, switch off the system
box (On/Off switch at position “0”).
12) Disconnect the LAN cable between the admin PC and the system box which
you just configured as the central box.
13) Connect the admin PC and OpenScape Office MX system box that is to be
configured as expansion box 1. To do this, connect the LAN cable to the LAN
port on the admin PC and the ADMIN LAN port 1 on the system box.
14) Repeat steps 2 through 6.
15) In the Box type: drop-down list, select the item Expansion box 1.
16) Click OK & Next followed by OK.
A controlled shutdown is now performed for the system box. On completing
the shutdown, the blue LED of the motherboard lights up (operating state
“Shutdown”).
INFO: A system box that is configured as an expansion box can
no longer be administered via its ADMIN LAN port 1. An
expansion box is administered as part of a multibox system via the
ADMIN LAN port 1 of the central box.
17) Click Finish.
18) Close your web browser to exit OpenScape Office Assistant.
19) As soon as the blue LED of the motherboard lights up, switch off the system
box (On/Off switch at position “0”).
20) Disconnect the LAN cable between the admin PC and the system box which
you just configured as Expansion Box 1.
21) Connect the admin PC and OpenScape Office MX system box that is to be
configured as expansion box 2. To do this, connect the LAN cable to the LAN
port on the admin PC and the ADMIN LAN port 1 on the system box.
22) Repeat steps 2 through 6.
23) In the Box type: drop-down list, select the item Expansion box 2.
118
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Multibox Systems
24) Click OK & Next followed by OK.
A controlled shutdown is now performed for the system box. On completing
the shutdown, the blue LED of the motherboard lights up (operating state
“Shutdown”).
INFO: A system box that is configured as an expansion box can
no longer be administered via its ADMIN LAN port 1. An
expansion box is administered as part of a multibox system via the
ADMIN LAN port 1 of the central box.
25) Click Finish.
26) Close your web browser to exit OpenScape Office Assistant.
27) As soon as the blue LED of the motherboard lights up, switch off the system
box (On/Off switch at position “0”).
28) Disconnect the LAN cable between the admin PC and the system box which
you just configured as Expansion Box 2.
29) Connect LAN port 2 (OUT) of the central box with LAN port 3 (IN) of expansion
box 1 by using the LAN cable (length = 28 inches) supplied with the delivery
package.
30) Connect LAN port 2 (OUT) of expansion box 1 with LAN port 3 (IN) of
expansion box 2 by using the LAN cable (length = 28 inches) supplied with
the delivery package.
Figure: Three-box system – Connection between central box, expansion box 1 and
expansion box 2
INFO: The system boxes of a multibox system can be mounted
at a distance of up to 100 m from one another.
A cable to connect the system boxes must meet the following
minimum requirements: shielded twisted pair CAT.5 patch cable
with RJ45 jacks, assignment 1:1.
The maximum length of the cable is 100 meters. No hub or switch
may be connected between them.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
119
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Multibox Systems
31) Turn on the three system boxes (On/Off switch at position “I”).
The system boxes are now started up and placed in the normal operating
state. On completing the startup, the green LEDs of the motherboard light up.
The flash rate of the green LEDs differ. The red LEDs are off.
For more information, see Motherboard ..
32) Connect the admin PC and the central box of the three-box system by
connecting the LAN cable to the LAN port on the admin PC and the ADMIN
LAN Port 1 on the central box.
33) Perform any further customized administration of the three-box system using
OpenScape Office Assistant.
INFO: If the text The central box of the multi-box
system is still configured as a one-box system
appears on the home page after logging into
OpenScape Office Assistant successfully, then the central box
has an invalid configuration.
If this occurs, close your Web browser to exit
OpenScape Office Assistant. Disconnect all system box
connection cables and repeat the initial configuration of the threebox system.
Related Topics
3.4.2.3 How to Expand a One-box System to a Two-box System
This information will enable an administrator to configure a two-box system from
an existing one-box system and an OpenScape Office MX system box in factory
condition. In this case, the system box of the existing one-box system becomes
the central box, and the new system box becomes expansion box 1.
Prerequisites
120
•
The hardware installation of the new OpenScape Office MX system box has
been completed.
•
The existing one-box system and the new system box have the latest
software status of the OpenScape Office MX V3 version.
•
The configuration data of the existing one-box system was saved in a backup
set.
•
The initial startup of the new system box was performed using
OpenScape Office Assistant. The standard IP address 192.168.1.2 was
retained.
•
The existing one-box system and the new system box are not interconnected
by cable.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Multibox Systems
Step by Step
1) Connect the admin PC and OpenScape Office MX system box that is to be
configured as expansion box 1. To do this, connect the LAN cable to the LAN
port on the admin PC and the ADMIN LAN port 1 on the system box.
2) Open the login page of OpenScape Office Assistant in your web browser
under the address https://192.168.1.2 and log in as an administrator
with the Advanced profile.
3) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
4) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Basic Installation.
5) Click Edit to start the Multibox System wizard.
6) Select the item Two-box system in the System drop-down list.
7) In the Box type: drop-down list, select the item Expansion box 1.
8) Click OK & Next followed by OK.
A controlled shutdown is now performed for the system box. On completing
the shutdown, the blue LED of the motherboard lights up (operating state
“Shutdown”).
9) Click Finish.
10) Close your web browser to exit OpenScape Office Assistant.
11) As soon as the blue LED of the motherboard lights up, switch off the system
box (On/Off switch at position “0”).
12) Disconnect the LAN cable between the admin PC and the system box which
you just configured as Expansion Box 1.
13) Connect the admin PC and the existing one-box system. To do this, connect
the LAN cable to the LAN port on the admin PC and the ADMIN LAN port 1
on the one-box system.
14) Open the login page of OpenScape Office Assistant in your web browser
under the IP address of the existing one-box system and log in as an administrator with the Advanced profile.
15) Repeat steps 3 through 6.
16) In the Box type: drop-down list, select the item Central box
17) Click OK & Next followed by OK.
A controlled shutdown is now performed for the system box. On completing
the shutdown, the blue LED of the motherboard lights up (operating state
“Shutdown”).
18) Click Finish.
19) Close your web browser to exit OpenScape Office Assistant.
20) As soon as the blue LED of the motherboard lights up, switch off the system
box (On/Off switch at position “0”).
21) Disconnect the LAN cable between the admin PC and the system box which
you just configured as the central box.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
121
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Multibox Systems
22) Connect LAN port 2 (OUT) of the central box with LAN port 3 (IN) of expansion
box 1 by using the LAN cable (length = 28 inches) supplied with the delivery
package.
Figure: Two-box System – Connection Between Central Box and Expansion Box
INFO: The system boxes of a multibox system can be mounted
at a distance of up to 100 m from one another.
A cable to connect the system boxes must meet the following
minimum requirements: shielded twisted pair CAT.5 patch cable
with RJ45 jacks, assignment 1:1.
The maximum length of the cable is 100 meters. No hub or switch
may be connected between them.
23) Turn on both system boxes (On/Off switch at position “I”).
The system boxes are now started up and placed in the normal operating
state. On completing the startup, the green LEDs of the two motherboards
light up. The flash rate of the green LEDs differ. The red LEDs are off.
For more information, see Motherboard ..
INFO: The new two-box system can be reached under the “old”
IP address of the one-box system.
24) Connect the admin PC and the central box of the two-box system by
connecting the LAN cable to the LAN port on the admin PC and the ADMIN
LAN Port 1 on the central box.
25) Open the login page of OpenScape Office Assistant in your web browser
under the IP address of the existing two-box system and log in as an administrator with the Advanced profile.
26) Click Data Backup on the navigation bar.
27) Click Data Backup > Restore in the navigation tree.
28) Activate the medium containing the backup set to be restored in the Devices
area.
29) Activate the backup set containing the configuration data to be restored in the
List of available backup sets area.
30) Click OK & Next. The recovery of the configuration data is started. The
progress of the restore process is displayed in a separate window.
122
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Multibox Systems
31) The restore was successful when the message Restore completed
successfully! appears. After the restore, the communication system
restarts automatically.
32) If required, perform any further customized administration of the two-box
system using OpenScape Office Assistant.
INFO: If the text The central box of the multi-box
system is still configured as a one-box system
appears on the home page after logging into
OpenScape Office Assistant successfully, then the central box
has an invalid configuration.
If this occurs, close your Web browser to exit
OpenScape Office Assistant. Remove the system box connection
cable and repeat the configuration of the two-box system.
Related Topics
3.4.2.4 How to Expand a One-box System to a Three-box System
This information will enable an administrator to configure a three-box system from
an existing one-box system and two OpenScape Office MX system boxes in
factory condition. In this case, the system box of the existing one-box system
becomes the central box, and the new system boxes become expansion box 1
and expansion box 2.
Prerequisites
•
The hardware installation of the new OpenScape Office MX system boxes
has been completed.
•
The existing one-box system and the new system boxes have the latest
software status of the OpenScape Office MX V3 version.
•
The configuration data of the existing one-box system was saved in a backup
set.
•
The initial startup of the new system boxes was performed using
OpenScape Office Assistant. The standard IP address 192.168.1.2 was
retained.
•
The existing one-box system and the new system box are not interconnected
by cable.
Step by Step
1) Connect the admin PC and OpenScape Office MX system box that is to be
configured as expansion box 1. To do this, connect the LAN cable to the LAN
port on the admin PC and the ADMIN LAN port 1 on the system box.
2) Open the login page of OpenScape Office Assistant in your web browser
under the address https://192.168.1.2 and log in as an administrator
with the Advanced profile.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
123
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Multibox Systems
3) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
4) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Basic Installation.
5) Click Edit to start the Multibox System wizard.
6) Select the item Three-box system in the System drop-down list.
7) In the Box type: drop-down list, select the item Expansion box 1.
8) Click OK & Next followed by OK.
A controlled shutdown is now performed for the system box. On completing
the shutdown, the blue LED of the motherboard lights up (operating state
“Shutdown”).
INFO: A system box that is configured as an expansion box can
no longer be administered via its ADMIN LAN port 1. An
expansion box is administered as part of a multibox system via the
ADMIN LAN port 1 of the central box.
9) Click Finish.
10) Close your web browser to exit OpenScape Office Assistant.
11) As soon as the blue LED of the motherboard lights up, switch off the system
box (On/Off switch at position “0”).
12) Disconnect the LAN cable between the admin PC and the system box which
you just configured as Expansion Box 1.
13) Connect the admin PC and OpenScape Office MX system box that is to be
configured as expansion box 2. To do this, connect the LAN cable to the LAN
port on the admin PC and the ADMIN LAN port 1 on the system box.
14) Repeat steps 2 through 6.
15) In the Box type: drop-down list, select the item Expansion box 2.
16) Click OK & Next followed by OK.
A controlled shutdown is now performed for the system box. On completing
the shutdown, the blue LED of the motherboard lights up (operating state
“Shutdown”).
INFO: A system box that is configured as an expansion box can
no longer be administered via its ADMIN LAN port 1. An
expansion box is administered as part of a multibox system via the
ADMIN LAN port 1 of the central box.
17) Click Finish.
18) Close your web browser to exit OpenScape Office Assistant.
19) As soon as the blue LED of the motherboard lights up, switch off the system
box (On/Off switch at position “0”).
124
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Multibox Systems
20) Disconnect the LAN cable between the admin PC and the system box which
you just configured as Expansion Box 2.
21) Connect the admin PC and the existing one-box system. To do this, connect
the LAN cable to the LAN port on the admin PC and the ADMIN LAN port 1
on the one-box system.
22) Open the login page of OpenScape Office Assistant in your web browser
under the IP address of the existing one-box system and log in as an administrator with the Advanced profile.
23) Repeat steps 3 through 6.
24) In the Box type: drop-down list, select the item Central box
25) Click OK & Next followed by OK.
A controlled shutdown is now performed for the system box. On completing
the shutdown, the blue LED of the motherboard lights up (operating state
“Shutdown”).
26) Click Finish.
27) Close your web browser to exit OpenScape Office Assistant.
28) As soon as the blue LED of the motherboard lights up, switch off the system
box (On/Off switch at position “0”).
29) Disconnect the LAN cable between the admin PC and the system box which
you just configured as the central box.
30) Connect LAN port 2 (OUT) of the central box with LAN port 3 (IN) of expansion
box 1 by using the LAN cable (length = 28 inches) supplied with the delivery
package.
31) Connect LAN port 2 (OUT) of expansion box 1 with LAN port 3 (IN) of
expansion box 2 by using the LAN cable (length = 28 inches) supplied with
the delivery package.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
125
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Multibox Systems
Figure: Three-box system – Connection between central box, expansion box 1 and
expansion box 2
INFO: The system boxes of a multibox system can be mounted
at a distance of up to 100 m from one another.
A cable to connect the system boxes must meet the following
minimum requirements: shielded twisted pair CAT.5 patch cable
with RJ45 jacks, assignment 1:1.
The maximum length of the cable is 100 meters. No hub or switch
may be connected between them.
32) Turn on the three system boxes (On/Off switch at position “I”).
The system boxes are now started up and placed in the normal operating
state. On completing the startup, the green LEDs of the motherboard light up.
The flash rate of the green LEDs differ. The red LEDs are off.
For more information, see Motherboard ..
INFO: The new three-box system can be reached under the “old
IP address” of the one-box system.
33) Connect the admin PC and the central box of the three-box system by
connecting the LAN cable to the LAN port on the admin PC and the ADMIN
LAN Port 1 on the central box.
34) Open the login page of OpenScape Office Assistant in your web browser
under the IP address of the three-box system and log in as an administrator
with the Advanced profile.
35) Click Data Backup on the navigation bar.
36) Click Data Backup > Restore in the navigation tree.
37) Activate the medium containing the backup set to be restored in the Devices
area.
38) Activate the backup set containing the configuration data to be restored in the
List of available backup sets area.
126
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Multibox Systems
39) Click OK & Next. The recovery of the configuration data is started. The
progress of the restore process is displayed in a separate window.
40) The restore was successful when the message Restore completed
successfully! appears. After the restore, the communication system
restarts automatically.
41) If required, perform any further customized administration of the three-box
system using OpenScape Office Assistant.
INFO: If the text The central box of the multi-box
system is still configured as a one-box system
appears on the home page after logging into
OpenScape Office Assistant successfully, then the central box
has an invalid configuration.
If this occurs, close your Web browser to exit
OpenScape Office Assistant. Disconnect all system box
connection cables and repeat the configuration of the three-box
system.
Related Topics
3.4.2.5 How to Expand a Two-box System to a Three-box System
This information will enable an administrator to configure a three-box system from
an existing two-box system and an OpenScape Office MX system box in factory
condition. The new system box becomes expansion box 2.
Prerequisites
•
The hardware installation of the new OpenScape Office MX system box has
been completed.
•
The existing two-box system and the new system box have the latest software
status of the OpenScape Office MX V3 version.
•
The configuration data of the existing two-box system was saved in a backup
set.
•
The initial startup of the new system box was performed using
OpenScape Office Assistant. The standard IP address 192.168.1.2 was
retained.
•
The existing two-box system and the new system box are not interconnected
by cable.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
127
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Multibox Systems
Step by Step
1) Connect the admin PC and OpenScape Office MX system box that is to be
configured as expansion box 2. To do this, connect the LAN cable to the LAN
port on the admin PC and the ADMIN LAN port 1 on the system box.
2) Open the login page of OpenScape Office Assistant in your web browser
under the address https://192.168.1.2 and log in as an administrator
with the Advanced profile.
3) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
4) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Basic Installation.
5) Click Edit to start the Multibox System wizard.
6) Select the item Three-box system in the System drop-down list.
7) In the Box type: drop-down list, select the item Expansion box 2.
8) Click OK & Next followed by OK.
A controlled shutdown is now performed for the system box. On completing
the shutdown, the blue LED of the motherboard lights up (operating state
“Shutdown”).
9) Click Finish.
10) Close your web browser to exit OpenScape Office Assistant.
11) As soon as the blue LED of the motherboard lights up, switch off the system
box (On/Off switch at position “0”).
12) Disconnect the LAN cable between the admin PC and the system box which
you just configured as Expansion Box 2.
13) Connect the admin PC and the existing two-box system. To do this, connect
the LAN cable to the LAN port on the admin PC and the ADMIN LAN port 1
on the central box of the two-box system.
14) Open the login page of OpenScape Office Assistant in your web browser
under the IP address of the existing two-box system and log in as an administrator with the Advanced profile.
15) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
16) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Basic Installation.
17) Click Edit to start the Multibox System wizard.
18) Select three-box system as the System.
19) Click OK & Next followed by OK.
The system boxes are now shut down gracefully (also called a controlled
shutdown) On completing the shutdown, the blue LED of the motherboard
lights up (operating state “Shutdown”).
20) Click Finish.
21) Close your web browser to exit OpenScape Office Assistant.
22) As soon as the blue LED of the motherboard lights up, switch off the system
box (On/Off switch at position “0”).
128
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Multibox Systems
23) Disconnect the LAN cable between the admin PC and the central box of the
two-box system.
24) Check the connection of the existing two-box system: LAN port 2 (OUT) of the
central box with LAN port 3 (IN) of expansion box 1.
25) Connect LAN port 2 (OUT) of expansion box 1 with LAN port 3 (IN) of
expansion box 2 by using the LAN cable (length = 28 inches) supplied with
the delivery package.
Figure: Three-box system – Connection between central box, expansion box 1 and
expansion box 2
INFO: The system boxes of a multibox system can be mounted
at a distance of up to 100 m from one another.
A cable to connect the system boxes must meet the following
minimum requirements: shielded twisted pair CAT.5 patch cable
with RJ45 jacks, assignment 1:1.
The maximum length of the cable is 100 meters. No hub or switch
may be connected between them.
26) Turn on the three system boxes (On/Off switch at position “I”).
The system boxes are now started up and placed in the normal operating
state. On completing the startup, the green LEDs of the motherboard light up.
The flash rate of the green LEDs differ. The red LEDs are off.
For more information, see Motherboard ..
INFO: The new three-box system can be reached under the “old
IP address” of the two-box system.
27) Connect the admin PC and the central box of the three-box system by
connecting the LAN cable to the LAN port on the admin PC and the ADMIN
LAN Port 1 on the central box.
28) Open the login page of OpenScape Office Assistant in your web browser
under the IP address of the three-box system and log in as an administrator
with the Advanced profile.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
129
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Multibox Systems
29) Click Data Backup on the navigation bar.
30) Click Data Backup > Restore in the navigation tree.
31) Activate the medium containing the backup set to be restored in the Devices
area.
32) Activate the backup set containing the configuration data to be restored in the
List of available backup sets area.
33) Click OK & Next. The recovery of the configuration data is started. The
progress of the restore process is displayed in a separate window.
34) The restore was successful when the message Restore completed
successfully! appears. After the restore, the communication system
restarts automatically.
35) If required, perform any further customized administration of the three-box
system using OpenScape Office Assistant.
INFO: If the text The central box of the multi-box
system is still configured as a one-box system
appears on the home page after logging into
OpenScape Office Assistant successfully, then the central box
has an invalid configuration.
If this occurs, close your Web browser to exit
OpenScape Office Assistant. Disconnect all system box
connection cables and repeat the configuration of the three-box
system.
Related Topics
3.4.2.6 How to Deconfigure a Multibox System
The information presented here enables an administrator to deconfigure an
existing multibox system (i.e., a two-box or three-box system). The system boxes
become central boxes.
Prerequisites
•
The system boxes of the existing multibox systems are interconnected by
cable.
•
The existing multibox system is in the normal operating state.
Step by Step
1) Connect the admin PC and the existing multibox system. To do this, connect
the LAN cable to the LAN port on the admin PC and the ADMIN LAN port 1
on the central box.
2) Open the login page of OpenScape Office Assistant in your web browser
under the IP address of the existing multi-box system and log in as an administrator with the Advanced profile.
130
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Hardware and Installation of OpenScape Office MX
Multibox Systems
3) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
4) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Basic Installation.
5) Click Edit to start the Multibox System wizard.
6) Enable the Resolve Multibox System: check box.
7) Click OK & Next followed by OK.
A controlled shutdown is now performed for the multibox system. On
completing the shutdown, the blue LED of the motherboard lights up
(operating state “Shutdown”).
8) Click Finish.
9) Close your web browser to exit OpenScape Office Assistant.
10) Turn off the system boxes (On/Off switch at position “0”).
11) Disconnect the LAN cable between the admin PC and the central box.
12) Disconnect all system box connection cables:
•
If you have deconfigured a Two-box system, remove the connection cable
between the central box and expansion box 1.
•
If you have deconfigured a Three-box system, disconnect the cable
between the central box and expansion box 1 and the cable between
expansion box 1 and expansion box 2.
INFO: This completes the deconfiguration of the multibox
system. The system boxes now have the properties of a central
box
The customized data of the multi-box system can no longer be
used.
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
131
Administration Concept
Web Based Management
4 Administration Concept
The administration of OpenScape Office is performed using web-based
management (OpenScape Office Assistant). The user administration of the webbased management allows you to set up role-based administration.
Related Topics
4.1 Web Based Management
Web based management occurs using OpenScape Office Assistant.
Related Topics
4.1.1 Prerequisites for OpenScape Office Assistant
In order to use OpenScape Office Assistant, the administration PC must have the
appropriate software installed.
Supported Web browsers:
•
Microsoft Internet Explorer 7 (Windows XP, Windows 2003 and Windows
Vista)
•
Microsoft Internet Explorer Version 8 in compatibility mode (Windows XP,
Windows 2003, Windows Vista and Windows 7)
•
Microsoft Internet Explorer 9 (Windows Vista and Windows 7)
•
Mozilla Firefox 4 (Windows XP, Windows 2003, Windows Vista, Windows 7
and Linux)
In addition, Java Edition 6 >= 1.6.031 must be installed.
Related Topics
4.1.2 OpenScape Office Assistant
OpenScape Office Assistant is the web-based application for the administration
of the system.
Language of the User Interface
You can select one of the following languages at login:
132
•
German
•
English
•
French
•
Italian
•
Dutch (The online help is only available in English)
•
Portuguese
•
Spanish
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Administration Concept
Web Based Management
User Interface Elements
1
2
3
•
Navigation bar (1)
The navigation is the primary navigation aid and always shows the same links
to main task centers, i.e., Home, Administrators, Setup (LX/MX), Expert
Mode, Data Backup, License Management (LX/MX) and Service Center.
When you click on one of these task centers, the associated navigation tree
opens in the navigation area, and the home page of the task center appears
in the workspace.
•
Navigation area (2)
The navigation area is the secondary aid and contains the navigation tree with
the menu items of the selected task center. The name of the selected task
center is displayed at the top of the navigation tree with expandable and
collapsible menu groups and menu items below it. Different menu items are
displayed in the menu groups, depending on the situation. Clicking on a menu
item displays the associated page in the workspace.
•
Workspace (3)
The workspace is where administration tasks are performed. It is usually
opened in a separate window. The number and selection of messages and
actions displayed depends on the menu item selected in the navigation tree.
In Expert Mode, the menu tree is displayed on the left in the workspace.
Navigating in the Menu Tree
The menu tree is a graphical interface component in the Expert Mode of
OpenScape Office Assistant. The menu tree contains expandable and collapsible
folders. These folders (e.g., Basic Settings) may, in turn, include further folders
(e.g., Call Charges) and elements (e.g., Call Charges - Output Format).
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
133
Administration Concept
Web Based Management
You can navigate in the menu tree by double-clicking on a folder (which toggles
its expanded or collapsed state).
Automatic Logout After Timeout
You are automatically logged off after 30 minutes of inactivity. You must log back
on to continue working with OpenScape Office Assistant. If you make some
changes and then take a break, to be on the safe side, you should reload the page
before making any further changes so that no changes are lost due the automatic
logout.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Backup and Restore
•
Licensing
4.1.2.1 How to Log Into OpenScape Office Assistant
Prerequisites
•
Your must have access to your user credentials (user name and password).
If not, obtain this from your administrator.
•
TLS 1.0 is enabled in your web browser settings.
Step by Step
1) Open the login page by entering the address: https://<IP address of
communication system> in your web browser. The default IP address is
192.168.1.2.
2) If the web browser prompts you to accept or install a security certificate,
please follow this instruction.
3) From the Language drop-down list, select the language in which
OpenScape Office Assistant is to be displayed. The Login page will be
displayed in the selected language.
4) Enter the User Name. “@system” is added automatically on exiting the field.
5) Enter your Password. Note case usage and the status of the Num key. The
password is shown with asterisks (*).
6) Click Login.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• How to Log out from OpenScape Office Assistant
134
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Administration Concept
Web Based Management
4.1.2.2 How to Log out from OpenScape Office Assistant
Step by Step
›
Click Logout at the top right of the screen.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• How to Log Into OpenScape Office Assistant
4.1.3 User Administration of OpenScape Office Assistant
You can configure and manage up to 16 administrators for
OpenScape Office Assistant. Every administrator is assigned a user profile that
specifies the scope of his or her authorization.
The users of OpenScape Office Assistant are also referred to as administrators.
The default administrator is [email protected] with the default password
“administrator” and has the user profile Advanced. This password must be
changed on logging in for the first time. The password for an administrator must
consist of at least 8 characters and a maximum of 128 characters, of which at
least one character must be a digit. In addition to letters and digits, a password
may include the following characters: !”#$%&’()*+,-./:;<=>[email protected][\]^_`{|}~
User profiles
OpenScape Office Assistant supports three permanently defined user profiles
with different authorizations for administrators with different levels of technical
expertise and tasks.
User profile
Know-how
Class of Service
Basic (not for
OpenScape
Office HX)
No knowledge of configuring the
system
certain wizards, e.g., for Key Programming, Music on Hold /
Announcements.
Advanced
Trained users
All wizards
Expert
Trained service technicians
All wizards and additional service
functions in Expert Mode
The Advanced and Expert user profiles are authorized to change the user names
and passwords of other administrators.
Related Topics
4.1.3.1 How to Add an Administrator
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
135
Administration Concept
Web Based Management
Step by Step
1) Click Administrators on the navigation bar.
2) Click Add....
3) Enter the following data: Login Name, First Name, Last Name, Password,
Retype Password.
4) Select the desired user profile from the User Role drop-down list.
5) Click OK & Next.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• How to Edit Administrator Data
•
How to Change the Administrator Password
•
How to Delete an Administrator
4.1.3.2 How to Edit Administrator Data
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant.
Step by Step
1) Click Administrators on the navigation bar.
2) Select the check box for the relevant administrator in the relevant Administrators List.
3) Click Edit.
4) Modify the relevant data.
5) Click OK & Next.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• How to Add an Administrator
•
How to Change the Administrator Password
•
How to Delete an Administrator
4.1.3.3 How to Change the Administrator Password
Prerequisites
•
136
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Administration Concept
Web Based Management
Step by Step
1) Click Administrators on the navigation bar.
2) Select the check box for the relevant administrator in the relevant Administrators List.
3) Click Edit.
4) Enter the new password in the Password and Retype Password fields.
5) Click OK & Next.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• How to Add an Administrator
•
How to Edit Administrator Data
•
How to Delete an Administrator
4.1.3.4 How to Delete an Administrator
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant.
Step by Step
1) Click Administrators on the navigation bar.
2) Select the check box for the relevant administrator in the relevant Administrators List.
3) Click Delete....
Related Topics
Related Topics
• How to Add an Administrator
•
How to Edit Administrator Data
•
How to Change the Administrator Password
4.1.4 Online Help
The integrated online help describes key concepts and operating instructions.
Navigation
The buttons in the online help provide the following functions:
•
Contents
provides you with an overview of the structure
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
137
Administration Concept
Wizards (LX/MX)
•
Index
provides direct access to a topic using keywords
•
Search
allows you to do a full-text search and selectively find all relevant topics
Related Topics
4.1.4.1 How to Call the Online Help
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant.
›
Click ?.
Step by Step
Related Topics
Related Topics
• How to Invoke the Context-Sensitive Online Help
4.1.4.2 How to Invoke the Context-Sensitive Online Help
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant.
›
Click Help.
Step by Step
Related Topics
Related Topics
• How to Call the Online Help
4.2 Wizards (LX/MX)
Wizards make it easy to install and configure the system. Only selected wizards
are available to customer administrators (with the Basic profile).
Related Topics
4.2.1 Wizards – Basic Installation (LX/MX)
The wizards under Basic Installation support the simple basic installation.
138
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Administration Concept
Wizards (LX/MX)
Menu item in the navigation area
Basic Installation
Wizards
Customer
administrator
Multibox System
-
Initial installation
-
Basic Installation
-
Licensing
-
Networking Configuration
-
Related Topics
4.2.2 Wizards – Network / Internet (LX/MX)
The wizards under Network / Internet support the simple configuration of
networks and the Internet access.
Menu item in the navigation
area
Network / Internet
Wizards
Customer
administrator
Network Configuration
-
Internet Configuration
-
VPN Configuration
-
Related Topics
4.2.3 Wizards – Telephones / Subscribers (LX/MX)
The wizards under Telephones / Subscribers support the simple configuration
of phones and subscribers.
Menu item in the navigation area
Telephones / Subscribers
Wizards
Customer
administrator
IP Telephones
-
ISDN devices
-
Analog Terminals
-
Key programming
x
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
139
Administration Concept
Wizards (LX/MX)
4.2.4 Wizards – Central Telephony (LX/MX)
The wizards under Central Telephony support the simple configuration of central
telephony features.
Menu item in the navigation area
Central Telephony
Wizards
Customer
administrator
CO Trunk ISDN / Analog
-
Internet Telephony
-
Voicemail
-
Directory / Speed Dialing
x
Call Detail Recording
x
Music on Hold / Announcements
x
Entrance Telephone (Door Opener)
-
Related Topics
4.2.5 Wizards – User Telephony (LX/MX)
The wizards under User Telephony support the simple configuration of user
telephony features.
Menu item in the navigation area
User Telephony
Wizards
Customer
administrator
Class of Service
-
Station Name and Release
x
Group call / Hunt group
-
Call Forwarding
-
Call pickup
-
Team Configuration
-
Mobile Phone Integration
-
Executive / Secretary
-
UCD
-
Attendant Console
-
Station Profiles
-
Related Topics
140
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Administration Concept
Expert mode
4.2.6 Wizards – UC Suite
The wizards under OpenScape Office support the simple configuration of the UC
Suite.
Menu item in the navigation
area
OpenScape Office
Wizards
Customer
administrator
Departments
-
Recorder
-
User Directory
-
Contact Center
-
File Upload
-
External directory
-
Fax Headlines
-
Groups
-
Conferencing
-
External Providers Config
-
Profiles
-
Templates
-
Schedules
-
Related Topics
4.3 Expert mode
Expert mode provides the administrator with several menus and functions to
configure and maintain the system.
Related Topics
4.3.1 Expert Mode - Maintenance > Configuration (LX/MX)
Under Configuration you will find a group of functions to load Music on Hold
(MoH), display the hardware configuration or manage a multi-box system, for
example.
The following functions can be accessed by the service technician under Configuration in Expert mode:
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
141
Administration Concept
Expert mode
Menu tree
see
Music on Hold
• Music on Hold (LX/MX)
Slot Modules
• Hardware Configuration (MX)
Multibox System
• Configuring a multibox system .
Port Administration
• Port Administration and Port Forwarding (MX)
Related Topics
4.3.2 Expert Mode - Maintenance > Software Image (LX/MX)
The functions for refreshing the gateway software and the phone images are
grouped together under Software image.
The following functions can be accessed by the service technician under
Software Image in Expert mode
•
Gateway Software
•
Phone Images
•
Phone Images via Internet
•
Phone Logo Images
Information on updating the software can be found under Updating OpenScape
Office .
Related Topics
4.3.3 Expert Mode - Maintenance > Traces (LX/MX)
Trace functions are grouped together under Traces. The administrator can start
and stop traces and change the trace settings.
INFO: Traces should only be activated by experienced service
technicians and only following consultation with Back-Level
Support. Activating traces can have a negative impact on system
performance.
The following functions can be accessed by the service technician under Traces
in Expert mode:
142
•
Trace Format Configuration
•
Trace output interface
•
Trace log
•
Digital Loopback
•
customer trace log
•
M5T Syslog Trace
•
M5T Trace Components
•
Secure Trace
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Administration Concept
Expert mode
•
Call Monitoring
•
H.323 Stack Trace
•
Trace Profiles
•
Trace Components
Information on Traces can be found under Traces (LX/MX) .
Related Topics
4.3.4 Expert Mode - Maintenance > Events (LX/MX)
The functions for displaying and controlling events are grouped together under
Events. These include event configuration, for instance, and e-mail settings.
The following functions can be accessed by the service technician under Events
in Expert mode:
•
Event Configuration
•
Event Log
•
E-mail
•
Reaction Table
•
Diagnosis Logs
Information on Events can be found under Events (LX/MX) .
Related Topics
4.3.5 Expert Mode - Maintenance > SNMP (LX/MX)
The functions for configuring communities and traps are grouped together under
SNMP. Communities are used to regulate SNMP data access authorizations.
Traps are generated if system problems occur to inform administrators of errors
and failures.
The following functions can be accessed by the service technician under SNMP
in Expert mode:
•
Communities
•
Traps
Information on SNMP can be found under SNMP (Simple Network Management
Protocol) (LX/MX) .
Related Topics
4.3.6 Expert Mode - Maintenance > Admin Log (LX/MX)
The administrator can use Admin Log to change the configuration (e.g., the
language) of the administration log.
The following functions can be accessed by the service technician under Admin
Log in Expert mode:
•
Configuration
•
Admin Log Data
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
143
Administration Concept
Expert mode
Information on the administration log can be found under Admin Log (MX) .
Related Topics
4.3.7 Expert Mode - Maintenance > Actions (LX/MX)
The functions supported by the administrator for frequent administration tasks
such as deleting log data are grouped together under Actions.
The following functions can be accessed by the service technician under Actions
in Expert mode:
Menu tree
see
Manual Actions
• Manual Actions
Automatic Actions
• Automatic Actions ( (LX/MX)
Related Topics
4.3.8 Expert Mode - Maintenance > Platform Diagnostics (LX/MX)
Platform Diagnostics Option (only for Development).
Related Topics
4.3.9 Expert Mode - Maintenance > Application Diagnostics (LX/MX)
Application Diagnostics Option (only for Development).
Related Topics
4.3.10 Experten-Modus – Telephony > Basic Settings (LX/MX)
Functions for configuring system flags, directory settings and speed dials,
DynDNS, Quality of Service, date and time, and call charges are grouped
together under Basic Settings.
The following functions can be accessed by the service technician under Basic
Settings in Expert mode:
144
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Administration Concept
Expert mode
Menu tree
System Flags (System)
see
• ISDN Stations (LX/MX)
• Trunk Queuing
• Calling Line Identification Presentation (CLIP)
• Conference Management (LX/MX)
• Trunks (MX)
• Networking OpenScape Office
• Account Codes (LX/MX)
Time Parameters (System)
Display (System)
• Time Parameters (LX/MX)
• Journal
• Voicemail Box
• Date and Time (LX/MX)
• Call Duration Display on Telephone (LX/MX)
DISA (System)
• DISA (MX)
Intercept/Attendant/Hotline
(System)
• Hotline after Timeout / Hotline (LX/MX)
LDAP (System)
• External Offline Directory (LDAP)
Texts (System)
• Intercept
• Advisory Messages
• Message Texts
Flexible Menu (System)
• Flexible Menus (LX/MX)
Speed Dials (System)
• Individual Speed Dialing (ISD)
Gateway
• Customized Display ( (LX/MX)
DynDNS
• DynDNS (MX)
AF/EF Code Points
• Quality of Service (LX/MX)
Quality of Service
• Quality of Service (LX/MX)
Date and Time
• Date and Time (LX/MX)
Port Management
• Ports and Services (LX/MX)
Call Charges
• Accounting (LX/MX)
Voicemail
• Voicemail Box
Related Topics
Related Topics
• System Flags (LX/MX)
4.3.11 Expert Mode – Telephony > Security (MX)
Security settings are grouped together under Security. These include settings for
firewalls, filters, VPN, and SSL.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
145
Administration Concept
Expert mode
The following functions can be accessed by the service technician under
Security in Expert mode:
Menu tree
see
MAC Address Filtering
• MAC and IP Address Filtering (MX)
IP Address Filtering
• MAC and IP Address Filtering (MX)
Deployment- und Licensing Cli- •
ent (DLSC)
Signaling and Payload Encryption (SPE)
• Signaling and Payload Encryption (SPE) (LX/
MX)
VPN
• VPN (Virtual Private Network) (MX)
SSL
• SSL (Secure Socket Layer) (MX)
Samba Share
• Samba Share (LX/MX)
Related Topics
4.3.12 Expert Mode – Telephony > Network Interfaces (MX)
Functions such as LAN, WAN (DSL) and DMZ interface configuration are
grouped together under Network Interfaces. The interfaces can be configured
separately.
The following functions can be accessed by the service technician under
Network Interfaces in Expert mode:
Menu tree
see
LAN
• IP Addresses (LX/MX)
WAN (DSL)
• Internet Access (MX)
DMZ
• Security
FTP Server
Preparatory effort for future versions.
DHCP
• DHCP, Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (LX/
MX)
Related Topics
4.3.13 Expert Mode – Telephony > Routing (MX)
Routing tables are managed under Routing. In small networks, a routing table
can be set up manually on every router by the administrator. In larger networks,
this task is automated with the help of a protocol that distributes routing information in the network.
The following functions can be accessed by the service technician under Routing
in Expert mode:
146
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Administration Concept
Expert mode
Menu tree
IP Routing
see
• DNS, Domain Name Service (MX)
• IP Routing (MX)
IP Mapping
• IP Mapping (MX)
NAT
• NAT (MX)
PSTN
• Expert Mode – Telephony > Routing (MX)
• Remote Access (MX)
LCR
• End-of-Dialing Recognition
• How to Activate and Deactivate Trunk Release
for Emergency Call
• LCR (Least Cost Routing) (LX/MX)
• Networking OpenScape Office
Related Topics
4.3.14 Expert Mode – Telephony > Voice Gateway (LX/MX)
The functions for IP telephony are grouped together under Voice Gateway.
The following functions can be accessed by the service technician under Voice
Gateway in Expert mode:
Menu tree
see
SIP Parameters
• IP Protocols (LX/MX)
Codec Parameters
• Audio Codecs (LX/MX)
Internet Telephony Service Pro- • IP Telephony (Voice over IP, VoIP)
vider
PBX
• Networking OpenScape Office
Related Topics
4.3.15 Experten-Modus – Telephony > Stations (LX/MX)
Functions for all stations are grouped together under Subscriber. These include
the name and phone number of the subscriber, for instance, as well as key
programming information.
The following functions can be accessed by the service technician under
Stations in Expert mode:
Menu tree
see
IP Clients (Stations)
• IP User
Analog Stations (Station)
• Analog Stations (LX/MX)
ISDN Stations (Stations)
• ISDN Stations (LX/MX)
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
147
Administration Concept
Expert mode
Menu tree
see
Virtual Stations (Stations)
• Virtual Stations
Application Suite (Station)
• Users of the UC Suite
DDI Extensions Overview (Stations)
• Configuring Stations in Expert Mode (LX/MX)
Mobility Entry (Stations)
• Virtual Stations for Mobility Entry
Key programming
• Key Programming (LX/MX)
Related Topics
4.3.16 Expert Mode – Telephony > Incoming Calls (LX/MX)
Call Management (CM) functions are grouped together under Incoming calls.
These include settings for groups, for instance, and call forwarding—no answer.
The following functions can be accessed by the service technician under
Incoming Calls in Expert mode:
Menu tree
Groups/Hunt groups
see
• Group Call
• Hunt Group
Mobility Entry groups
• myPortal for Mobile
Team/Top
• Team Configuration / Team Group
• Executive/Secretary or Top Group
Call Pickup
• Call Pickup Group
UCD
• UCD (Uniform Call Distribution) (LX/MX)
Call Forwarding
• Call Forwarding—No Answer (CFNA) With a
Timeout (Fixed Call Forwarding)
Related Topics
4.3.17 Expert Mode – Telephony > Trunks/Routing (LX/MX)
The functions for trunks and routes are grouped together under Trunks/Routing.
The following functions can be accessed by the service technician under Trunks/
Routing in Expert mode:
148
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Administration Concept
Expert mode
Menu tree
Trunks
see
• Trunks (MX)
• Networking OpenScape Office
Direction
• Call Signaling, Calling Line ID (LX/MX)
• Routes (MX)
• Networking OpenScape Office
QSIG Feature
assign MSN
• Trunks (MX)
Related Topics
4.3.18 Experten-Modus – Telephony > Classes of Service (LX/MX)
The trunk authorization functions (for instance, which calls can be set up by which
subscribers) are grouped together under Class of service.
The following functions can be accessed by the service technician under Classes
of Service in Expert mode:
Menu tree
see
Station
• Classes of Service, Toll Restriction (LX/MX)
Class of Service Groups
• Night Service (LX/MX)
Allowed lists
• Classes of Service, Toll Restriction (LX/MX)
Denied lists
• Classes of Service, Toll Restriction (LX/MX)
Night service
• Night Service (LX/MX)
CON Group Assignment
• CON Groups (LX/MX)
CON Matrix
• CON Groups (LX/MX)
Autom. night service
• Night Service (LX/MX)
Special Days
• Night Service (LX/MX)
Related Topics
4.3.19 Expert Mode – Telephony > Auxiliary Equipment (LX/MX)
The functions for auxiliary equipment such as Music on Hold (MoH) or for
connecting an entrance telephone/door opener at the system ports (trunks) are
grouped together under Auxiliary Equipment.
The following functions can be accessed by the service technician under
Auxiliary Equipment in Expert mode:
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
149
Administration Concept
Expert mode
Menu tree
Announcement
see
• Music on Hold (LX/MX)
• Announcements (LX/MX)
Entrance telephone (MX)
• Entrance Telephone and Door Opener (MX)
Related Topics
4.3.20 Experten-Modus – Telephony > Payload (LX/MX)
The functions for displaying and configuring port types and protocols are grouped
together under Payload.
The Service technician can access the following functions under Payload in
Expert mode:
•
Devices: collective name for stations, features, and functions that require
specific channels.
•
Protocols: transmission-specific parameters. The protocols should not be
changed!
•
Media Stream Control (MSC): monitors and manages streams and provides
for the transmission of media data between LAN and ISDN.
•
HW Modules: DSP channels (digital signal processors) for voice, modem and
fax.
Related Topics
4.3.21 Experten-Modus – Telephony > Statistics (LX/MX)
The functions for displaying statistics are grouped together under Statistics.
The service technician can access the following functions under Statistics in
Expert mode:
•
Device Statistics: Statistics on LAN Usage and SCN.
•
SNMP Statistics: statistics of the SNMP protocol with data and error data
from the network traffic.
•
Telephony Statistics: Statistics on Telephony.
Related Topics
4.3.22 Expert Mode – Applications > UC Suite
Under UC Suite you will find a group of unified communications functions such
as conferencing, departments and groups, configuring the external directory,
holiday and other schedules, the Contact Center and the server settings for the
UC Suite.
The following functions can be accessed by the service technician under UC
Suite in Expert mode:
150
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Administration Concept
Expert mode
Menu tree
User Directory
Description
Configuring Users for the UC Suite.
See also:
• Departments
• Stations
Departments
Configuring departments.
See also:
• Departments
Groups
Only existing groups for voice and fax messages can
now be edited here. The addition of new groups
occurs using Team functions.
See also:
• Voicemail Group and Fax Box Group (LX/MX)
Templates
Configuring the SMS template for SMS notification
See also:
• Notification Service for Messages
Configuring the user template for the AutoAttendant
See also:
• Central AutoAttendant
External directory
Importing a CSV file for an external directory.
See also:
• External directory
External Providers Config
Integrating an LDAP server in the external directory.
See also:
• External Offline Directory (LDAP)
Contact Center
Configuration of the Multimedia Contact Center
See also:
• Multimedia Contact Center
Schedules
Configuring schedules for the AutoAttendant.
See also:
• Schedules
File Upload
Loading of announcements for the AutoAttendant
and voicemail box as well as centralized fax cover
sheets.
See also:
• AutoAttendant
• Voice and Fax Messages
• Sending Fax Messages with Fax Printer
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
151
Administration Concept
Expert mode
Menu tree
Recorder
Description
Recording announcements for the AutoAttendant.
See also:
• AutoAttendant
Conferencing
Displaying the details of a scheduled phone conference (Meet-Me conference).
See also:
• Conference Management (LX/MX)
Site List
Configuring locations for networking.
Servers
Configuring business and office hours for AutoAttendant, the password length for applications and the
call number of the intercept position.
See also:
• Schedules
• Configuring Users of the UC Suite
• Intercept
Configuring the retention period for voicemails and
call information in the call journal.
See also:
• Voice and Fax Messages
• Journal
Configuring the parameters for the voicemail box
such as the language, playback order and message
length
See also:
• Voice and Fax Messages
Profiles
Central configuration of user settings for clients.
See also:
• Station and User Profiles
Fax Headlines
Configuring fax headers.
See also:
• Sending Fax Messages with Fax Printer
Holiday Schedules
Configuring holiday schedules for the AutoAttendant.
See also:
• Schedules
Related Topics
4.3.23 Expert mode – Applications > Web Services (LX/MX)
Configuration options for web interfaces, e.g., for web collaboration, can be found
under Web Services.
152
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Administration Concept
Service Center
The following functions can be accessed by the service technician under Web
Services in Expert mode:
Menu tree
XMPP
Description
Configuring XMPP.
See also:
• XMPP
Mobility/Web Clients
Configuring the interface for Mobility Clients, Web
Clients and the Application Launcher.
See also:
• Configuring myPortal for Mobile and Mobility Entry
(LX/MX)
Web Collaboration
Configuring the interface for Web Collaboration.
See also:
• Web Collaboration Integration
Related Topics
4.4 Service Center
The Service Center of OpenScape Office Assistant provides administrators with
software, documentation and other diagnostics functions.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Updates and Upgrades
•
Remote Access (MX)
•
Shutting Down the OpenScape Office MX Communication System
4.4.1 Service Center - Download Center
The Download Center provides documents, PC clients, tools and links to related
information.
The following documents are available:
•
Administrator Documentation
•
User Guides for Clients
•
Mobility Entry, Quick Reference Guide
•
TUI Menu Structure (Phone Menu of the Voicemail Box)
•
CSV Templates for Importing Station Data, Speed-Dial Numbers and Port
Data
The following PC clients are available (sometimes combined in one package):
•
myPortal for Desktop
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
153
Administration Concept
Service Center
•
myAttendant
•
myPortal for Outlook
•
myPortal for Zimbra
•
Fax Printer
•
myAgent
•
myReports
The following tools are available:
•
Application Launcher
•
Call Charge Manager (Accounting Manager)
•
ISDN message decoder
•
OSO Observer
Displays the operating state of the UC Suite under Windows.
•
Audio Wizard
Enables the creation of audio files for the voicemail box and central AutoAttendant with the mixing of two sources, e.g., background music and
announcements.
•
SNMP MIB
Related Topics
4.4.2 Service Center – Inventory
Inventory provides an overview of the basic configuration data of the system.
Related Topics
4.4.3 Service Center – Software Update
Software Update checks whether a software update is available on the web
server and performs the update.
Related Topics
4.4.4 Service Center – E-mail Forwarding
E-mail Forwarding enables the sending of e-mails with system messages from
the UC Suite to the administrator and e-mails with attached voicemail of fax
messages to subscribers.
Related Topics
4.4.5 Service Center – Remote Access (LX/MX)
Remote Access is used to configure access for the site-independent administration of the system.
154
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Administration Concept
Service Center
Related Topics
4.4.6 Service Center – Restart / Reload
Restart / Reload enables a restart of the system, optionally resetting it back to
factory settings.
Related Topics
4.4.7 Service Center – Diagnostics > Status (LX/MX)
Status provides status information on the network, subscribers, call setup, ITSP
and VPN.
See also
Related Topics
4.4.8 Service Center – Diagnostics > Event Viewer (LX/MX)
Event Viewer logs system events.
See also
Related Topics
4.4.9 Service Center – Diagnostics > Trace
Trace provides options for fault logging.
See also
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
155
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Installation Example for OpenScape Office MX
5 Installing OpenScape Office MX
The initial installation of OpenScape Office MX with OpenScape Office Assistant
is described here with the aid of a selected installation example.
Related Topics
5.1 Installation Example for OpenScape Office MX
The OpenScape Office MX installation example covers the following contents:
the trunk connection of the communication system via ISDN, Internet access via
an existing Internet router (e.g., DSL) and setting up analog stations and IP
stations (OpenStage). The detailed administration of the various features of
OpenScape Office MX can be found in later sections.
Related Topics
5.1.1 Components of OpenScape Office MX
The installation example for OpenScape Office MX includes the components
described below.
In the installation example for OpenScape Office MX, an internal network with an
Internet router is already available. Internet access is configured in the Internet
router. OpenScape Office MX is connected to the existing internal network via the
UPLINK port. The IP clients (IP phones, client PCs, WLAN Access Points, etc.)
are integrated in the LAN via one or more switches and obtain their IP addresses
dynamically from the DHCP server of OpenScape Office MX. If there is already
an existing DHCP server (e.g., the internal DHCP server of the Internet router), it
must be disabled. The admin PC is connected directly to the ADMIN port of
OpenScape Office MX. Since the DHCP server is used by OpenScape Office MX,
system phones can be automatically supplied with the latest software.
156
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Installation Example for OpenScape Office MX
PSTN
PS
S
Internet P
PSTN/ISDN
S0
UPLINK
ADMIN
LAN Infrastructure incl.:
• LAN Switch
• Internet Router
• DHCP Server (DHCP OFF)
UC Client
UC Client
IP Phone
100
OpenScape Office MX
(DHCP ON)
Admin PC
IP Phone
101
Related Topics
5.1.2 IP Address Scheme
An IP address scheme is a definition of how the IP addresses are used in the
internal network. It is, at the same time, also a list of all IP addresses that occur
in the internal network. It lists the IP addresses of PCs, servers, Internet routers,
IP phones, etc.
To provide a better overview of the assignment of IP addresses, an IP address
scheme should be created.
Example of an IP address scheme with the IP address range 192.168.1.” -x:
IP address range
192.168.1.1 to 192.168.1.19
192.168.1.1
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Clients
Clients with a fixed IP address
Internet router (gateway)
157
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Installation Example for OpenScape Office MX
IP address range
Clients
192.168.1.2
Communication system
192.168.1.10
E-mail server
192.168.1.50 to 192.168.1.254
PC clients & IP phones, also the IP address
range of the DHCP server; assignment
occurs automatically
The following IP address ranges are internally reserved and must not be used:
Connected IP address ranges
Description
10.0.0.1; 10.0.0.2
Reserved for the license server
10.186.237.65; 10.186.237.66
Reserved for remote ISDN
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Prerequisites for OpenScape Office MX
5.1.3 Dial Plan
A dial plan is a list of all phone numbers available in the OpenScape Office MX.
It comprises internal phone numbers, DID numbers, and group station numbers.
The dial plan should also contain the names of subscribers that can be assigned
phone numbers.
Default Dial Plan
In OpenScape Office MX, the internal station numbers are preset with default
values. These values can be adapted to suit individual requirements as needed.
Default Dial Plan of OpenScape Office MX:
Assignment of station numbers
158
Default phone numbers
Station numbers for IP stations (max. 297 + 3)
100 – 249 (+ 7070, 7080 and
7090)
Phone numbers for analog stations (25 preset / max. 96)
250 – 274
Phone Numbers for ISDN stations (25 preset / max. 48)
275 – 299
Station numbers for virtual stations (max. 70)
1025 – 1094
Announcement call numbers (max. 16)
#801 - #816
Station numbers for online users
7070
Call number for remote access
7080
Call number for automatic licensing
7090
Call number for voicemail
71
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Installation Example for OpenScape Office MX
Assignment of station numbers
Default phone numbers
Conference phone numbers (6 preset / max. 20)
7400 – 7404, 7430
Call number for parking
7405
AutoAttendant Phone Numbers (max. 20)
7410 – 7429
Seizure codes (6 preset / max. 64)
Seizure code 1 (external code)
0 = World / 9 = USA
Seizure code 2-6
80 – 84
Access Code for Music on Hold
#817
Station number for Attendant Console
9 = World / 0 = USA
Substitution for “#” (for service codes)
72
Substitution for “#” (for service codes)
73
Individual Dial Plan
An individual dial plan can be imported in OpenScape Office MX via a CSV file
during the initial startup.
Besides the names and phone numbers of subscribers, the CSV file also includes
additional subscriber data such as the license types and e-mail addresses of the
subscribers.
A sample CSV file with the appropriate explanations can be found in the
OpenScape Office Assistant Administration Program under Service Center >
Download Center > CSV Templates. You can also use the CSV file stored there
as a template for your data.
Structure of a CSV file:
•
Column A contains the call number (possible values: 0-9,*,#)
•
Column B contains the DID number (possible values: 0-9,*,#)
•
Column C contains the name (in the format First Name Last Name or
Last Name, First Name)
The name of a subscriber can consist of up to 16 characters, but must not
include any diacritical characters such as umlauts or special characters.
•
Column D contains the subscriber type (e.g., 1=System Client, 2=SIP User,
3=SIP Fax, 4=RAS User, 5=Analog, 6=Analog Fax, ...)
•
Column E contains the license type (<no entry> or 0=No Licence, 1=Comfort
User, 2=Comfort Plus User)
•
Column F contains the e-mail address
Users of the UC Suite are automatically sent an e-mail with a link to the installation file(s) if their respective e-mail addresses were imported via the CSV
file.
•
Column G contains the mobile number (possible values: 0-9,*,#)
•
Column H contains the private number (possible values: 0-9,*,#)
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
159
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Prerequisites for OpenScape Office MX
•
Column I contains the node ID (possible values: 0-999)
This column must be assigned a value; otherwise, no import will occur. If the
system is not networked, 0 must be entered here.
•
Column J contains the IP address of the second gateway
IMPORTANT:
CSV files must be available in ANSI/ASCII format.
CSV files of older OpenScape Office versions are not supported.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Prerequisites for OpenScape Office MX
•
How to Provision the UC Suite for Installation
•
Codes for Activating and Deactivating Features (LX/MX)
•
How to Configure Station Data
5.2 Prerequisites for OpenScape Office MX
Meeting the prerequisites for OpenScape Office MX ensures the proper operation
of OpenScape Office MX.
General
The following general prerequisites apply:
•
The LAN infrastructure of the internal IP network is present and usable.
•
The hardware is installed and connected properly.
•
Internet access is available through an Internet Service Provider.
•
The external DHCP server (e.g., the DHCP server of the Internet router) is
disabled. The DHCP server of OpenScape Office MX is used.
•
A GMS, GMSA, GME (not for U.S.) or GMT (for U.S. only) gateway module is
required along with an ISDN trunk connection or ISDN primary rate interface
in order to connect ISDN telephones.
•
To connect analog phones, the gateway module GMSA is required or
additionally either the GMAA or GMSL gateway module.
•
An IP address scheme exists and is known (see IP Address Scheme ).
•
A dial plan (also called a numbering plan) is present and known (see Dial
Plan ).
Admin PC
The following prerequisites must be fulfilled for the Administration PC (admin PC)
that is used for setting up the system and for the subsequent administration of
OpenScape Office MX:
160
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
•
Network interface:
The admin PC must be network-capable.
•
Java Runtime Environment 1.6 (or higher):
If an older version of the Java Runtime Environment is installed, you will need
to install an up-to-date version before you can start setting up the system.
•
Web browser:
The following web browsers are supported:
–
Microsoft Internet Explorer 6 (or higher)
Microsoft Internet Explorer 8 is only supported when opened in the
Compatibility View.
– Mozilla Firefox 2 (or higher)
“ActiveX controls and plug-ins” must be activated in the browser’s security
settings.
If an older version of the Web browser is installed, you will need to install an
up-to-date version before you can start setting up the system.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• IP Address Scheme
•
Dial Plan
5.3 Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
The initial setup described here covers the standard setup with
OpenScape Office Assistant based on the installation example described at the
outset.
The standard setup includes:
•
Configuring DHCP
•
Setting up the ISDN trunk connection
•
Setting up Internet access
•
Setting up IP stations
•
Setting up analog stations
•
Licensing
•
Configuring an IP phone
The standard setup does not include:
•
Configuring a multibox system
see Configuring a multibox system .
•
Configuring the analog trunk connection
see How to Configure an Analog Outside Line
•
Setting up ISDN stations
see How to Configure ISDN Stations
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
161
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
•
Configuring Internet Telephony
see IP Telephony (Voice over IP, VoIP)
More detailed information on the topics not described in this initial setup can be
found in the Administrator documentation under the relevant topic area.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Multibox Systems
•
Outside Line (MX)
•
How to Configure ISDN Stations
•
Remote Access (MX)
5.3.1 Preparatory Steps for OpenScape Office MX
The preparatory steps include starting up OpenScape Office MX and connecting
the admin PC.
Related Topics
5.3.1.1 How to Start OpenScape Office MX
OpenScape Office MX must be connected to the low voltage power supply and
activated before it can be put into service for the first time.
Prerequisites
•
The hardware was correctly installed.
•
For Brazil only: Additional lightning protection is required for Brazil. Consequently, in Brazil, the power supply of OpenScape Office MX must be passed
through a surge-protected outlet with overvoltage protection (reference
number C39334-Z7052-C33).
Step by Step
1) Connect the OpenScape Office MX with the power supply using the power
cord included in the delivery package.
2) Turn on OpenScape Office MX by setting the On/Off switch to the “I” position.
OpenScape Office MX will now be started up and placed in the normal
operating state. OpenScape Office MX may need up to 20 minutes for the first
bootup. During the startup process, OpenScape Office MX should not be
turned off.
On completing the startup, the green LED of the motherboard lights up for
longer than 10 seconds. The red LEDs are off.
Related Topics
162
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
5.3.1.2 How to Connect the Admin PC with OpenScape Office MX
In order to configure OpenScape Office MX, the admin PC and
OpenScape Office MX must be in the same subnet. The admin PC receives its IP
address from the DHCP server in the internal network.
Prerequisites
•
OpenScape Office MX is integrated in the internal network and operational.
Step by Step
1) Connect the admin PC for administration with a LAN cable directly to the
ADMIN port of OpenScape Office MX.
INFO: After the initial startup has been completed, the admin PC
can be integrated in the internal network via a switch.
2) Start the admin PC.
3) Check whether a dynamic IP address has been assigned to the PC. If not, you
will have to reconfigure the admin PC. To do this you must have Administrator
rights.
INFO: The IP settings described here apply to Windows XP. For
more detailed information on the configuration for other Windows
operating systems, please refer to the appropriate operating
system instructions.
a) Select Start > Control Panel and double-click Network Connections.
b) Right-click on the appropriate LAN connection and select the menu item
Properties.
c) On the General tab, use the left mouse button to select the Internet
Protocol (TCP/IP) entry for your network adapter and then click on
Properties.
d) Click the General and ensure that the radio button Obtain an IP address
automatically is enabled. If it is not, then activate it.
e) Close all open windows with OK.
Related Topics
5.3.2 Checking Functions of OpenScape Office MX with OpenScape Office
Observer
The OpenScape Office Observer program can be used to check whether
OpenScape Office MX is operational.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
163
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
In order to use the OSO Observer, the program must be copied from the Service
Center of OpenScape Office Assistant to the client PC in the internal network.
Related Topics
5.3.2.1 How to Copy OpenScape Office Observer to the Admin PC
Prerequisites
•
OpenScape Office MX has started.
•
The admin PC and OpenScape Office MX can communicate with one another
over the LAN.
Step by Step
1) Open the login page of OpenScape Office Assistant on the admin PC by
entering the following address in your web browser:
https://<IP address of OpenScape Office MX>, e.g., https://
192.168.1.2.
INFO: If OpenScape Office Assistant cannot be started, check
the LAN connection and repeat the call. If it still cannot be started,
check whether the IP address has been blocked by your firewall.
More detailed information can be found in the documentation of
your firewall
2) If the web browser prompts you to accept or install a security certificate,
please follow this instruction.
3) Use the Language choice list to select in which language the user interface
of OpenScape Office Assistant is to be displayed.
4) In the User Name field, enter the default user name [email protected] for access as an administrator.
INFO: If you press the tab key after entering administrator,
@system will be added automatically.
5) In the Password field, enter the default password administrator for
access as an administrator.
6) Click Login.
7) You are prompted to change the default password.
164
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
a) Reenter the default password administrator in the Password field.
b) Enter a new password in the New Password and Confirm New
Password fields to protect the system against misuse. Note case usage
and the status of the Num key. The password is displayed as a string of
asterisks (*).
INFO: The password must be at least 8 characters long and
include a digit. Make sure that you remember your new password.
8) Click again on Login.
9) Click Service Center on the navigation bar.
10) Click in the Software area on the item OSO Observer.
11) Save the file OsoObserver.jar on the admin PC in a directory of your
choice.
Related Topics
5.3.2.2 How to Start OpenScape Office Observer from the Admin PC
Prerequisites
•
The file OsoObserver.jar is stored on the admin PC.
Step by Step
1) Navigate on the admin PC to the storage path of the OpenScape Office
Observer.
2) Double-click on the file OsoObserver.jar. The OpenScape Office
Observer opens as a small window in the upper right corner of the screen.
3) Enter the IP address of OpenScape Office MX, e.g., 192.168.1.2, in the
field of the OpenScape Office Observer).
4) Click on Connect OSO.
5) Another window opens with the following contents:
•
IP address of OpenScape Office MX
•
Version number of the installed OpenScape Office MX software
•
Utilization of the hard disk and memory of OpenScape Office MX
6) In the window you will also be informed about the status of OpenScape Office
MX with an LED display:
•
Red LED: OpenScape Office MX is out of service
•
Green LED: OpenScape Office MX is operational.
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
165
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
5.3.3 Initial Installation of OpenScape Office MX
The Initial installation wizard of OpenScape Office Assistant is used to make the
basic settings for integration into the existing network.
Related Topics
5.3.3.1 How to Start the Initial Installation
Prerequisites
•
OpenScape Office MX has started.
•
The admin PC and OpenScape Office MX can communicate with one another
over the LAN.
Step by Step
1) Open the login page of OpenScape Office Assistant on the admin PC by
entering the following address in your web browser:
https://<IP address of OpenScape Office MX>, e.g., https://
192.168.1.2.
INFO: If OpenScape Office Assistant cannot be started, check
the LAN connection and repeat the call. If it still cannot be started,
check whether the IP address has been blocked by your firewall.
More detailed information can be found in the documentation of
your firewall
2) If the web browser prompts you to accept or install a security certificate,
please follow this instruction.
3) Use the Language choice list to select in which language the user interface
of OpenScape Office Assistant is to be displayed.
4) If OpenScape Office Assistant is being started for the first time:
166
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
a) In the User Name field, enter the default user name [email protected] for access as an administrator.
INFO: If you press the tab key after entering administrator,
@system will be added automatically.
b) In the Password field, enter the default password administrator for
access as an administrator.
c) Click Login.
d) Reenter the default password administrator in the Password field.
e) Enter a new password in the New Password and Confirm New
Password fields to protect the system against misuse. Note case usage
and the status of the Num key. The password is displayed as a string of
asterisks (*).
INFO: The password must be at least 8 characters long and
include a digit. Make sure that you remember your new password.
f)
Click again on Login.
5) If OpenScape Office Assistant has already been started at least once:
a) Enter the User Name and Password for access as an administrator.
b) Click Login.
6) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
7) Click Edit to start the Initial Installation wizard.
INFO: If the size of the browser window cannot display the
workspace in its entirety at low screen resolutions, a horizontal or
vertical scroll bar appears at the sides and can be used to scroll
to the required section.
Next steps
Perform initial installation as described in the following step-by-step instructions.
Fields that are not described here are preset for the default scenario and should
only be changed if they are not appropriate for your network data. For detailed
information, refer to the descriptions provided in the Administrator documentation
for the individual wizards.
Related Topics
5.3.3.2 How to Define a System Name and IP Address
The System settings window lets you define a name for OpenScape Office MX
and modify the IP address of OpenScape Office MX.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
167
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
Prerequisites
•
You know the internal IP address and subnet mask of your Internet router.
Step by Step
1) In the Display Logo field, enter a name of your choice for
OpenScape Office MX (e.g., OpenScape Office). This name is displayed on
system phones.
2) In the field OpenScape Office- IP address, enter an IP address that lies
within the IP address range of your Internet router (e.g., Internet router:
192.168.1.1, OpenScape Office MX: 192.168.1.2 or 192.168.1.10).
By default, the IP address 192.168.1.2 is entered here.
INFO: The IP address for must not be assigned to any other
existing network client, since this would result in an IP address
conflict.
3) Enter the subnet mask of your Internet router in the OpenScape Office Subnet Mask field. By default, the subnet mask will have been entered as
255.255.255.0.
4) Click OK & Next. You are taken to the DHCP Global Settings window.
Related Topics
5.3.3.3 How to Enable the DHCP Server
The DHCP Global Settings and DHCP Address Pool windows can be used to
enable the DHCP server and to define from which IP address range the DCP
server assigns IP addresses to the IP stations.
Prerequisites
•
The external DHCP server (e.g., the DHCP server of the Internet router) has
been disabled in the internal network.
Step by Step
1) Leave the Enable DHCP Server check box enabled.
2) Define subnet mask for the DHCP server:
•
If you changed the IP address values of OpenScape Office MX, enter the
changed subnet mask of OpenScape Office MX in the Subnet mask
field.
•
If you did not change the IP address values of OpenScape Office MX,
leave the preset default values in the Subnet mask field unchanged.
3) Enter the IP address of the Internet router in the Preferred Gateway and
Preferred Server fields.
4) Click OK & Next. The DHCP Address Pool window appears.
168
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
5) Adapt the values in the Subnet address, Netmask and Address Range
fields to the previously defined IP address values of OpenScape Office MX.
If the internal network uses static IP addresses (e.g., for a printer server), the
IP address range (DHCP address pool) must be selected so that the fixed IP
addresses are not included within this range.
Example:
Internet router: 192.168.1.1
Subnet address: 192.168.1.0
Subnet mask : 255.255.255.0
Printer Server: 192.168.1.10
DHCP address pool: 192.168.1.50 to 192.168.1.254
6) Click OK & Next. You are taken to the Basic Configuration window.
Related Topics
5.3.3.4 How to Define Country Settings, Date and Time
The Basic configuration window lets you select the country where
OpenScape Office MX is operated and specify the date and time settings.
Step by Step
1) In the System Country Code drop-down list, select the country where
OpenScape Office MX is operated.
2) In the Language for Customer Event Log field, enter the language in which
the customer event log is to be output.
3) If the date and time are not to be synchronized via an SNTP server, proceed
as follows:
a) Specify the desired time zone in the Timezone field.
b) Enter the current values for Date and Time.
INFO: The date and time are updated automatically when a
connection is set up via the ISDN trunk.
4) If the date and time are to be synchronized via an SNTP server, proceed as
follows:
a) Select the Date and Time via an external SNTP Server check box.
b) Enter the IP address or the DNS name of the SNTP server in the IP
Address / DNS Name of External Time Server field. The SNTP server
can be located on the internal network or the Internet.
c) From the drop-down list Poll Interval for External Time Server, select
after how many hours the Date and Time should be synchronized by the
SNTP Server.
5) Click OK & Next.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
169
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
6) The Initial installation wizard is closed. Click Finish.
For some configuration changes, OpenScape Office MX performs a reboot.
This can take a few minutes.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Date and Time (LX/MX)
5.3.4 Basic Installation of OpenScape Office MX
The Basic Installation wizard of OpenScape Office Assistant can be used to
make the most important settings for the operation of OpenScape Office MX.
Related Topics
5.3.4.1 How to Start the Basic Installation
Prerequisites
•
The Initial installation has been completed.
•
OpenScape Office MX is operational (top green LED flashing at 1-second
intervals).
Step by Step
1) If OpenScape Office MX has not performed a restart, skip to step 3.
2) If OpenScape Office MX has performed a reboot, log in to
OpenScape Office Assistant again:
a) Open the login page of OpenScape Office Assistant by entering the
following address in your web browser:
https://<IP-Adresse OpenScape Office MX>
The default IP address for OpenScape Office MX is 192.168.1.2, i.e.,
https://192.168.1.2, for example.
b) In the User Name field, enter the default user name [email protected] for access as an administrator.
c) Enter the password you defined at the initial installation in the Password
field.
d) Click Login.
e) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
3) Click Edit to start the Basic Installation wizard. An overview of existing
system boxes (Box) appears with the board (Slots) currently in use.
4) Click Next.
170
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
Next steps
Perform basic installation as described in the following step-by-step instructions.
Fields that are not described here are preset for the default scenario and should
only be changed if they are not appropriate for your network data. For detailed
information, refer to the descriptions provided in the Administrator documentation
for the individual wizards.
Related Topics
5.3.4.2 How to Configure Country and Local Area Codes
The entry of the country code is important for Internet telephony and Meet-Me
conferences.
Step by Step
1) In the Country Code field, enter the country code prefix, e.g., 49 for
Germany.
2) Enter the local area code, e.g., 89 for Munich, in the Local area code field.
3) If you have a point-to-point connection, enter the system phone number, e.g.,
722443 (your connection number) in the PABX number field.
Related Topics
5.3.4.3 How to Configure Network Parameters (Optional)
If OpenScape Office MX is to be integrated in a network (e.g., a network together
with OpenScape Office LX), then a node ID must be assigned to
OpenScape Office MX, and the station data must be configured uniquely across
the entire network.
Prerequisites
•
A CSV file with the station data exists.
Step by Step
1) If OpenScape Office MX is not to be integrated in a network, leave the
Networking Integration check box disabled (i.e., unchecked) and click on
OK & Next. You are taken to the Central Functions for Stations window
(see How to Configure Station Data ).
2) In order to integrate OpenScape Office MX in a network, you will need to
perform the following steps:
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
171
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
a) Select the Network Integration check box.
b) In the Node ID field for OpenScape Office MX, enter a node ID that is
unique in the internetwork (digits from 0 through 999 are possible).
c) Click OK & Next. You are taken to the Central Functions for Stations
window.
d) Since all station numbers must be unique in a network, the standard
station numbers must be deleted. Enable the Delete all station call
numbers radio button.
e) Enable the check box Delete all station numbers and click OK & Next.
You are taken to the Change preconfigured call and functional
numbers window.
f)
Adapt the preconfigured station numbers to the station numbers in the
network and click OK & Next. You are taken to the Import CSV file with
station data window.
g) Navigate to the storage location of the CSV file and click OK & Next. You
are taken to the ISDN Configuration window (How to Configure the ISDN
Trunk Connection .
Related Topics
5.3.4.4 How to Configure Station Data
If required, you can change the preconfigured call numbers for special functions,
delete all call numbers, or import previously defined station data via the Central
Functions for Stations window.
Step by Step
1) If you want to retain the preconfigured numbers (default dial plan), click Next.
You are taken to the ISDN Configuration window (How to Configure the
ISDN Trunk Connection ).
INFO: You can have an overview of all configured station
numbers displayed by enabling the radio button Display station
configuration and then clicking Execute function.
2) If you want to use a customized dial plan, you must delete the preset default
dial plan. To do this, proceed as follows:
172
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
a) Enable the radio button Delete All station call numbers.
b) Enable the check box Delete All Call Addresses.
c) Click Execute function.
d) Some station numbers and function codes may not be deleted. You can,
however, edit the preset values. To do this, enter the required values in
the fields.
e) Click OK. All station numbers and function codes, except for those
displayed, are deleted.
f)
Click Next. You are taken to the ISDN Configuration window.
3) If you want to edit the predefined station numbers for special functions, e.g.,
the function codes for conferences, proceed as follows:
a) Enable the radio button Change pre-configured call and functional
numbers.
b) Click Execute function.
c) Enter the desired call numbers in the fields and click OK.
INFO: The new call numbers are saved. The call numbers
configured here are not available to subscribers or groups.
d) Click Next. You are taken to the ISDN Configuration window.
4) If you want to import your station data with the help of a CSV file, delete all
existing station numbers first and then specify the path of your CSV file.
a) Enable the radio button Delete All station call numbers.
b) Enable the check box Delete all station call numbers.
c) Click on Execute function, followed by OK.
d) Enable the radio button Stations configuration by importing CSV file.
e) Click Execute function.
f)
Use Browse to select the created CSV file and click Open.
INFO: For details on the structure of a CSV file, see Dial Plan .
g) Click OK when finished. The station data is imported.
h) Click Next. You are taken to the ISDN Configuration window.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Dial Plan
•
How to Provision the UC Suite for Installation
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
173
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
5.3.4.5 How to Configure the ISDN Trunk Connection
You can configure the ISDN trunk connection in the ISDN Configuration window.
The ISDN trunk connection can be set up as an ISDN point-to-point connection
and/or an ISDN-point-to-multipoint connection. Depending on the gateway
module used, different S0 ports are available for this purpose. One or more S0
interfaces can also be configured as internal S0 connections in order to connect
ISDN phones.
Prerequisites
•
One of the GMS or GMSA gateway modules is inserted and operational.
Step by Step
1) To configure the ISDN trunk connection, clear the check box No call via ISDN
trunk line (S0).
INFO: Calls can also be conducted via an Internet Telephony
Service Provider; see IP Telephony (Voice over IP, VoIP) .
2) Specify the type of connection for the S0 ports:
•
For a point-to-point connection with DID numbers, enable the radio button
Point-to-point connection for the desired S0 port.
•
For a point-to-multipoint connection with MSNs, enable the radio button
Point-to-multipoint connection for the desired S0 port.
•
For connecting ISDN phones, enable the radio button Internal S0 connection
for the desired S0 port.
•
If an S0 port is not to be used, leave the radio button in its default setting.
3) Click OK & Next.
4) If you activated the Point-to-point connection radio button, proceed as
follows when entering the phone numbers assigned by your network provider:
a) In the Country Code field, enter the country code prefix, e.g., 49 for
Germany.
b) Enter the area code, e.g., 89 for Munich, in the Area Code field.
c) Enter the system phone number, e.g., 722443 (your connection number)
in the PABX number field.
d) Click OK & Next. If you have also activated the Point-to-multipoint
connection option, proceed with the next step; if not, you are automatically taken to the Internet access window.
5) If you activated the Point-to-multipoint connection radio button, proceed as
follows when entering the phone numbers assigned by your network provider:
174
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
a) Enter all phone numbers (MSNs) supplied by your provider in the ISDN
multiple subscriber numbers column. You can enter 10 MSNs for each
S0 port. Since you can configure up to four S0 ports as point-to-multipoint
connections, this list can contain up to 40 MSNs (4 x 10).
INFO: For details on assigning MSNs to individual stations, see
How to Configure ISDN Stations , How to Configure Analog
Stations and How to Configure IP Stations .
b) Click OK & Next. You are taken to the Configure Internet Access
window.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• How to Configure ISDN Stations
•
How to Configure Analog Stations
•
How to Configure IP Stations
•
How to Configure ISDN Stations
5.3.4.6 How to Activate Internet Access
The Configuration of Internet Access window can be used to activate Internet
access. To do this, the IP address of the Internet router and that of the DNS server
must be made known to OpenScape Office MX.
Prerequisites
•
The Internet access is already configured in the Internet router.
Step by Step
1) Disable the No Internet Access check box.
2) Activate the radio button TCP/IP at LAN Port 4 (UPLINK) via an external
router and click OK & Next.
3) Enter the IP address of the local DNS server (e.g., that of the Internet router,
192.168.1.1) or an Internet DNS server in the IP Address of DNS Server
field.
4) Enter the IP address of the external Internet router, i.e., 192.168.1.1, in the
IP Address of Default Router field.
5) Click OK & Next. You are taken to the Provider configuration and
activation for Internet Telephony window.
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
175
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
5.3.4.7 How to Deactivate Internet Telephony
The Provider configuration and activation for Internet telephony window can
be used to configure the Internet Telephony Service Provider (ITSP).
In this installation example, Internet telephony is not supported. Consequently,
the related configuration is skipped. For details on configuring Internet telephony,
see IP Telephony (Voice over IP, VoIP) .
Step by Step
1) To disable Internet telephony, leave the No call via Internet check box
unselected.
2) Click OK & Next. The configuration of the network and ISDN settings is now
completed.
3) Click OK & Next. You are taken to the Select a station - ISDN Devices
window.
Related Topics
5.3.4.8 How to Configure ISDN Stations
The Select a station - ISDN Devices window can be used to configure ISDN
stations (e.g., ISDN phones).
Prerequisites
•
The S0 ports to which the ISDN phones are to be connected must be
configured as internal S0ports (see How to Configure the ISDN Trunk
Connection ).
Step by Step
1) Configuration ISDN stations:
•
You should configure an ISDN station if you have connected an ISDN
phone. For more information, see How to Configure ISDN Stations ..
INFO: You can also configure an ISDN station after you complete
basic installation.
•
You do not need to configure any ISDN stations if you have not connected
an ISDN phone.
2) Click OK & Next. You are taken to the Select a station - A/B Phones
window.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• How to Configure the ISDN Trunk Connection
176
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
•
How to Configure the ISDN Trunk Connection
•
How to Configure ISDN Stations
5.3.4.9 How to Configure Analog Stations
The Select a station - A/B Phones window can be used to set up analog stations
(e.g., an analog phone or analog fax device).
Prerequisites
•
One of the GMSA or GMAL gateway modules is inserted, or the GMAA
gateway module (analog only) is also inserted.
Step by Step
1) If you want the internal call number to be automatically assigned to the station
as the direct inward dialing number, activate the radio button Take DID from
changed call number. Otherwise, leave the radio button unselected.
2) If you want a different direct inward dialing number for the station than the call
number, enter a DID number for the station under DID in the row of the desired
station:
•
Only for a point-to-point connection:
Click in the desired field and type in the DID number using the keyboard.
The DID number may also be identical to the internal station number.
•
Only for a point-to-multipoint connection:
Select an MSN in the desired field via the drop-down list. The station can
be internally reached via the internal station number 101, for example,
and externally via the MSN 654321.
•
For a point-to-point and point-to-multipoint connections:
Select the entry xxx - modifiable (xxx is the internal station number) via
the drop-down list in the desired field and type in the DID number using
the keyboard or select an MSN from the drop-down list.
3) Enter the internal station number for the subscriber under Call No in the
appropriate row of the desired subscriber. You can use the preset phone
number or assign some other free number.
4) In the row of the desired station, under Name, enter a name in the format
Last Name, First Name or First Name Last Name.
INFO: The name can consist of up to 16 characters, but must not
include any diacritical characters such as umlauts or special
characters.
5) Choose the desired Class of Service group in the row of the desired
subscriber from the Class of Service drop-down list.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
177
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
6) To add the subscriber to a call pickup group, select a call pickup group from
the Call pickup group drop-down list in the row of the desired subscriber.
7) Make the settings described under this step only if needed:
a) Click in the row of the desired analog station on the pencil icon Edit.
b) In the Clip/Lin field, enter a phone number (DID number or MSN) to be
displayed at the called party’s extension instead of the own phone number
in the case of an external call.
INFO: This feature must be released by the network provider.
c) Select the analog terminal type (Fax, for instance) from the Extension
Type drop-down list.
d) Do not change the default selection in the Language drop-down list. This
setting has no relevance for analog terminals.
e) From the Call signaling internal drop-down list, select and assign one of
a total of eight possible acoustic call signals for internal calls. The station
then will then send the modified ringing tone to other internal stations,
thus enabling its calls to be distinguished from other internal stations
(default: Ring type 1).
f)
From the Call signaling external drop-down list, select and assign one
of a total of three possible acoustic call signals for external calls (default:
Ring type 1).
g) Click OK & Next.
8) If you want to configure another analog station, repeat steps 3 through 7.
9) Click OK & Next. You are taken to the Select a station - LAN Phones
window.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• How to Configure the ISDN Trunk Connection
5.3.4.10 How to Configure IP Stations
The Select a station - LAN Phones window can be used to configure IP stations
(e.g., LAN phones and WLAN phones).
Prerequisites
•
178
A functional wireless LAN network is needed to operate WLAN phones.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
Step by Step
1) If you want the internal call number to be automatically assigned to the station
as the direct inward dialing number, activate the radio button Take DID from
changed call number. Otherwise, leave the radio button unselected.
2) If you want a different direct inward dialing number for the station than the call
number, enter a DID number for the station under DID in the row of the desired
station:
•
Only for a point-to-point connection:
Click in the desired field and type in the DID number using the keyboard.
The DID number may also be identical to the internal station number.
•
Only for a point-to-multipoint connection:
Select an MSN in the desired field via the drop-down list. The station can
be internally reached via the internal station number 101, for example,
and externally via the MSN 654321.
•
For a point-to-point and point-to-multipoint connections:
Select the entry xxx - modifiable (xxx is the internal station number) via
the drop-down list in the desired field and type in the DID number using
the keyboard or select an MSN from the drop-down list.
3) Enter the internal station number for the subscriber under Call No in the
appropriate row of the desired subscriber. You can use the preset phone
number or assign some other free number.
4) In the row of the desired station, under Name, enter a name in the format
Last Name, First Name or First Name Last Name.
INFO: The name can consist of up to 16 characters, but must not
include any diacritical characters such as umlauts or special
characters.
5) Select the type of IP station (e.g., “System Client” or “SIP Client”) from the
Type drop-down list in the row of the desired station.
6) From the License Type drop-down list in the row of the desired station, select
whether the IP station is to be operated as a Comfort User or a Comfort Plus
User. The IP station will only be operational if one of the two license types has
been selected. For details on the different functional scopes offered by the two
license types, see Licenses .
INFO: You can use this procedure to configure as many Comfort
User and Comfort Plus User stations as the number of licenses
purchased. In the Licensed column you will see if the subscriber
is successfully licensed.
7) If you want to set up a fax box for the subscriber (which can be used with the
UC clients myPortal for Desktop or myPortal for Outlook, for example, but
is only possible as Comfort Plus Users), proceed as follows:
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
179
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
a) In the row of the desired station, in the Fax No. field, enter the desired
internal fax number at which the user can receive internal fax messages.
b) If you want to configure a DID number for the fax box, enter the desired
external fax number under which the subscriber can receive external fax
messages in the Fax Direct Inward Dialing field in the row of the desired
subscriber.
8) Choose the desired Class of Service group in the row of the desired
subscriber from the Class of Service drop-down list.
9) To add the subscriber to a call pickup group, select a call pickup group from
the Call pickup group drop-down list in the row of the desired subscriber.
10) Make the settings described under this step only if needed:
a) Click in the row of the desired IP station on the pencil icon Edit.
b) In the Clip/Lin field, enter a phone number (DID number or MSN) to be
displayed at the called party’s extension instead of the own phone number
in the case of an external call.
INFO: This feature must be released by the network provider.
c) Select the language for the menu controls on the phone from the
Language drop-down list.
d) From the Call signaling internal drop-down list, select and assign one of
a total of eight possible acoustic call signals for internal calls. The station
then will then send the modified ringing tone to other internal stations,
thus enabling its calls to be distinguished from other internal stations
(default: Ring type 1).
e) From the Call signaling external drop-down list, select and assign one
of a total of three possible acoustic call signals for external calls (default:
Ring type 1).
f)
Click OK & Next.
11) If you want to configure another IP station, repeat steps 3 through 10.
12) Click OK & Next. A list of all configured stations appears. This list is effectively a dial plan.
In addition, you will see how many user Comfort User or Comfort Plus User
licenses are available and how many of those are already being used. The
number of configured license types includes all the configured stations for the
license type. Consequently, there could be more stations configured as
Comfort Plus Users, for example, than the number of licenses available for it.
13) Click Print to print out the data of the configured stations.
14) Then click OK & Next. You are taken to the Edit Meet-Me Conference
Settings window.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• How to Configure the ISDN Trunk Connection
180
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
•
Licenses
5.3.4.11 How to Configure a Dial-in Number for Conferencing (Optional)
The Edit Meet-Me Conference Settings window can be used to define the call
numbers and the conference dial-in numbers for conferences.
Step by Step
1) If required, change the predefined number for the conference in the Call
number field.
2) Enter the dial-in number (conference DID) for the conference with which
subscribers can dial into the existing conference in the Direct inward dialing
field. The dial-in number may only include the digits 0-9.
3) Click OK & Next. You are taken to the Edit E-Mail Forwarding window.
INFO: For more information, see Scheduled Conference (LX/
MX) ..
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Scheduled Conference (LX/MX)
5.3.4.12 How to Configure the Sending of E-mails (Optional)
The Edit E-Mail Forwarding window can be used to define the E-mail server via
which OpenScape Office MX should forward the e-mails. Voicemails, fax
messages and internal system messages can then be sent via this E-mail server
to one or several different configurable e-mail addresses.
Prerequisites
•
An e-mail account with a password exists with an e-mail provider, and you
know the access data for this account.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
181
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
Step by Step
1) Enter the Outgoing mail server (SMTP) for the e-mail server to be used for
sending e-mails, e.g., smtp.web.de. Ask your e-mail provider for the
outgoing mail server if required.
INFO: In some cases, the sending of e-mails does not work
because the name of the outgoing mail server cannot be resolved.
To fix this problem, you must start the e-mail sending function via
Service Center > E-mail Forwarding and then enter the IP
address of the outgoing mail server instead of its name.
2) If a secure connection is required, enable the corresponding check box. If
required, check with your e-mail provider whether this option needs to be
enabled.
3) Enter the User Name of the e-mail account, e.g.,: john.doe.
4) Enter the Password for the e-mail account and repeat it in the Confirm
Password field.
INFO: Entering the e-mail server is important if an e-mail with a
link to the installation file(s) is to be automatically sent to the users
of the UC Suite (see How to Provision the UC Suite for
Installation ).
5) Enter the E-mail Address, for example: [email protected]
6) If you want to test the entered e-mail settings immediately, proceed as follows:
a) Click Test Connection.
b) Under Send to e-mail address, enter the e-mail address of any e-mail
box that you can access. The test e-mail will be sent to that e-mail
address.
c) Under Subject in the e-mail, enter a descriptive text so that you can
identify the e-mail in your e-mail inbox.
d) Click Send Test E-mail. The e-mail settings are verified, and the e-mail is
sent to the specified e-mail address.
e) Check whether the e-mail has arrived in your e-mail inbox.
f)
If the e-mail was sent correctly, proceed to the next step.
g) If the e-mail delivery failed, click Back and correct your e-mail settings
(starting with step 1).
7) Click OK & Next followed by Finish. The basic installation is finished. Before
you perform the backup mentioned in the wizard, you should activate the
licenses.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• How to Provision the UC Suite for Installation
182
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
•
How to Provision the UC Suite for Installation
5.3.5 Closing Activities for OpenScape Office MX
After the initial installation and the basic installation with
OpenScape Office Assistant have been completed, some important settings must
still be made for the operation of OpenScape Office MX.
Related Topics
5.3.5.1 How to Enable Remote Access
The Remote Access wizard can be used to provide authorized service technicians with access to the communication system via the Internet connection. This
ensures that support is available when solving administration tasks or performing
troubleshooting.
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
•
You have a port number which can be used for Internet access to the communication system by the service technician. This port number must not be
blocked by a firewall.
Step by Step
1) Click Service Center on the navigation bar.
2) Click on Remote Access in the navigation tree.
3) Click on Remote Access to start the Remote Access wizard.
4) Activate the radio button Remote access: on to enable remote access.
5) Enable the radio button Remote Access via: Internet to enable remote
access via the Internet.
6) Enter the port number you want to use for remote access in the Port Number
field.
7) Click OK & Next followed by Finish.
Related Topics
5.3.5.2 How to Activate Licenses
The basic license supplied with OpenScape Office MX and all additional licenses
procured must be activated within a period of 30 days. The time period begins
with the first activation of OpenScape Office MX. After this time period expires,
OpenScape Office MX will only operate in restricted mode. You can also
complete the licensing at some later time within this time period.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
183
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
Prerequisites
•
You are logged into OpenScape Office Assistant, and the wizard for the basic
installation has been completed. You know the LAC (License Authorization
Code) for releasing the license and have a user ID and password for
accessing the license server. You need Internet access to connect to the
license server.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Basic Installation.
3) Click Edit to start the Licensing wizard.
4) Enter the appropriate LAC in the License Authorization Code (LAC) field.
5) Select the check box to access the license server and enter the user name
and password in the User Name and Password fields.
6) Click OK & Next. The connection to the license server is established and the
license is released.
Related Topics
5.3.5.3 How to Provision the UC Suite for Installation
The UC Suite consists of the UC clients myPortal for Desktop,
myPortal for Outlook, myPortal for Zimbra, myAttendant and Fax Printer
and the Contact Center clients myAgent and myReports. The installation files for
the clients are stored on the hard disk of OpenScape Office and can be made
available to the IP stations automatically or manually.
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant.
INFO: In order to use myPortal for Outlook, myPortal for
Zimbra, myAttendant, myAgent and myReports, additional
licenses are required.
184
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
Step by Step
1) To enable the installation files to be provided automatically to an IP station,
make sure that the following steps have been performed:
a) The e-mail addresses of the IP stations and the associated subscriber
data must have either been already imported via a CSV file (see How to
Configure Station Data ) or entered later under Expert mode > Applications > UC Suite > User Directory.
b) An e-mail server must be entered (see How to Configure the Sending of
E-mails (Optional) ).
INFO: You can also enter an E-mail server later under Service
Center > E-mail Forwarding.
All IP subscribers whose e-mail addresses are known receive an e-mail with
a link to the installation directory of the clients and Getting Started Instructions. The installation folder also includes a Readme file with information on
installing the software on client PCs.
2) If the required steps for automatic notification are not fulfilled, you can also
make the installation files available manually. To do this, proceed as follows:
a) Click Service Center on the navigation bar.
b) In the navigation tree, click Download Center.
c) Click on the desired client and save the zipped installation files on a
shared network drive.
d) Click on the documentation of the desired client and save the documentation file on a shared network drive.
e) Send the zipped installation files and the documentation file to the users
of the UC Suite by e-mail or inform the users about the storage location
of these files.
f)
The zip file with the installation files also includes a Readme file. Notify
the users that the installation of the clients must be performed in accordance with the installation notes in the Readme file.
g) Only for myPortal for Zimbra: Download the ZIP file of the zimlet for
myPortal for Zimbra and then upload the zimlet to the Zimbra server
(https://<IP-address of the Zimbra server>) with the option
Flush Zimlet cache.
INFO: The Zimbra server must be able to reach the communication system via port 8801.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Dial Plan
•
How to Configure the Sending of E-mails (Optional)
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
185
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
•
How to Configure Station Data
•
How to Configure the Sending of E-mails (Optional)
5.3.5.4 How to Perform a Data Backup
All previous changes to OpenScape Office MX must be backed up. The backup
can be saved as a backup set on the internal hard disk of OpenScape Office MX
or on a USB storage device.
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant. For a backup to a USB
storage device (USB stick or USB hard disk), the USB device must be
connected to the USB Server port.
INFO: For details on backing up to an FTP server, see Backup
and Restore .
Step by Step
1) Click Data Backup on the navigation bar.
2) In the navigation tree, click Backup - Immediate.
3) Enter a comment for the backup set in the Comment field in the Name area
so that the backup set can be easily identified if needed later for a restore.
Avoid the use of diacritical characters such as umlauts and special characters
in your input.
4) Activate the target drive on which the backup set is to be saved in the Devices
area.
5) Click OK & Next. The progress of the backup process is displayed in a
separate window.
6) The backup was successful if the message Backup completed successfully! appears. Click Finish.
7) If you are using a USB stick as the backup medium, wait until the LED of the
USB stick stops blinking. This ensures that the backup has been successfully
saved on the USB stick. You can then safely remove the USB stick.
8) This completes the initial setup with OpenScape Office Assistant. Exit
OpenScape Office Assistant by clicking on the Logout link on the top right of
the screen and the close the window.
INFO: If a new software version of OpenScape Office MX is
available, you will be notified about this on the home page of
OpenScape Office Assistant, provided the Internet connection
was set up correctly. If a new software version is available,
perform a full update (see Updating OpenScape Office ).
186
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Backup and Restore
•
Updating OpenScape Office
5.3.5.5 How to Configure an IP phone
To enable an IP phone to register at OpenScape Office MX, the defined call
number and IP address of OpenScape Office MX must be entered at the phone,
and the settings for the Deployment Service may need to be changed.
Prerequisites
•
The IP phone is connected to the internal network and operational.
INFO: The configuration described here uses an OpenStage 40/
60/80 system telephone as an example. The same settings must
also be made for an SIP phone. For more information, refer to the
manual supplied with your SIP phone.
Step by Step
1) To reach the administration mode of the system telephone, press the appropriate key for the Settings/Applications menu on the phone.
2) Scroll through the Settings options until Admin and confirm this with the
OK key.
3) Enter the administration password (123456 by default) and confirm your
selection with the OK key.
4) Scroll to Network and confirm your selection with the OK key.
5) If you are using the DHCP server of OpenScape Office MX in the internal
network, skip Point 5.
6) If you are not using the DHCP server of OpenScape Office MX in the internal
network, you will need to enter the IP address of the Deployment Server
(DLS) so that the software of the system telephone can be updated automatically. This applies only to system telephones. Proceed as follows:
a) Scroll to Update service (DLS) and confirm your selection with the
OK key.
b) Scroll to DLS address and confirm your selection with the OK key.
c) Specify the IP address of OpenScape Office MX (default: 192.168.1.2)
as the Deployment Server and confirm your selection with the OK key.
d) Scroll to Save & Exit and confirm your selection with the OK key.
7) Scroll to IP configuration and confirm your selection with the OK key.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
187
Installing OpenScape Office MX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office MX
8) Scroll to Route (default) and confirm your selection with the OK key.
9) Specify the IP address of OpenScape Office MX (default: 192.168.1.2)
and confirm your selection with the OK key.
10) Scroll to Save & Exit and confirm your selection with the OK key.
11) Navigate one menu level back with the Back key.
12) Scroll to System and confirm your selection with the OK key.
13) Scroll to Identity and confirm your selection with the OK key.
14) Scroll to Terminal number and confirm your selection with the OK key.
15) Enter the phone number set and confirm your selection with the OK key.
16) Scroll to Save & Exit and confirm your selection with the OK key.
17) Navigate one menu level back with the Back key.
18) If the system telephone needs to be restarted due to the changes made, the
menu item Restart will appear in the Admin menu. Confirm the Restart
with the OK key and then also confirm Yes with the OK key. The system
telephone performs a reboot and logs in to OpenScape Office MX.
Related Topics
188
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Prerequisites (LX/HX)
6 Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
This section describes the prerequisites and initial startup of the Linux server that
is required to operate OpenScape Office LX and OpenScape Office HX.
The two following Linux variants can be installed on the server PC (Linux server):
•
Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office (Recommended)
The Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office is supplied as the operating
system for the Linux server together with the software for OpenScape Office.
It includes SUSE Linux Enterprise Server 11 Service Pack 1 in the 32 bit
version (SLES 11 SP1 32-bit), which is specially adapted to OpenScape
Office. The advantage of this Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office is that no
license fees are required for the operating system, and updates are specially
customized for OpenScape Office and installed automatically by the Linux
Update Server. For more information, see Linux Appliance for
OpenScape Office (LX/HX) and Updates (LX/HX) .
•
SLES 11 SP1 32 Bit
If desired, the regular SLES 11 SP1 version (32- bit) or some other version of
SLES 11 SP1 (32 bit) that was optimized by the PC manufacturer may also
be installed. However, in such cases, some software packages (RPMs) of the
SLES 11 SP1 DVD that are needed for OpenScape Office may have to be
additionally installed, and no special update support designed for OpenScape
Office will be possible.
Related Topics
6.1 Prerequisites (LX/HX)
The prerequisites and general constraints for the operation of OpenScape Office
HX or OpenScape Office LX on the Linux server (the server PC) are described
below.
Hardware
The server PC must satisfy the following minimum requirements:
•
Equipped for 24/7 operation.
•
Certified by the PC manufacturer for SLES 11 SP1 32 Bit
•
OpenScape Office must be the only application running on it (apart from the
virus scanner)
•
At least a dual-core processor with 1.5 GHz or higher per core (recommended: 2.0 GHz or higher per core)
•
At least 2 GB RAM (recommended: 4 GB RAM)
•
Hard disk with at least 100 GB (recommended: 200 GB or more)
•
DVD drive, keyboard, mouse
•
Screen resolution: 1024x768 or higher
The installation can be performed even if the minimum requirements are not
satisfied; however, this could result in problems during operation.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
189
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Prerequisites (LX/HX)
When upgrading from older OpenScape Office versions to the current version, it
should be checked whether the existing server PC meets the minimum requirements.
Software
The OpenScape Office software and the required Linux operating system version
are shipped on two separate DVDs.
The following software is required for the initial startup:
•
DVD with OpenScape Office LX/HX software
•
DVD with Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office (recommended)
Some PC manufacturers offer their own optimized Linux installation disks for their
server PC models. These can be used if they support the Linux version SLES 11
SP1 32 bit.
You can also use the commercial SLES 11 SP1 32-bit version, but the Linux
Appliance OpenScape Office is recommended.
SLES 11 SP1 32-bit Certification
The server PC must be certified for SLES 11 SP1 32 Bit.
Novell offers PC manufacturers a certification program called “YES” for the certification of their server PCs. The results can be found on the Internet at:
http://developer.novell.com/yessearch/Search.jsp
If no certification is available, the PC manufacturer must be asked whether the
server PC is compatible with SLES 11 SP1 32 Bit. If any additional hardware (e.g.,
a network or graphics card) that is incompatible with SLES 11 SP1 32 Bit is
installed, a suitable driver must be obtained from the card vendor, regardless of
the certification. If no driver is available, the corresponding card must be replaced
by a model that is compatible with SLES 11 SP1 Bit.
Registering with Novell (not necessary when using Linux Appliance for
OpenScape Office)
Registration with Novell is not required when using Linux Appliance for
OpenScape Office, since all security patches and software updates are made
available via the Linux Update Server (Central Update Server) in this case. The
Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office includes free software updates for a period
of 3 years (extendable to 6 years) as of the time when the software is activated.
Registration at Novell is recommended when using the conventional SLES 11
SP1 32 bit version. Although the installation and operation of SLES 11 SP1 32 Bit
is possible without registration, it is still necessary to register with Novell using the
supplied activation code to obtain security patches and software updates. A
customer account with Novell is required for this purpose. It is recommended that
the customer account be set up before the Linux installation.
Infrastructure
The internal network must satisfy the following conditions:
•
190
LAN with at least 100 Mbps and IPv4
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Prerequisites (LX/HX)
•
Uniform time base (e.g., via an NTP server)
•
Fixed IP address for the server PC
Internet access
The Linux server must have Internet access for:
•
Security patches and general Linux software updates
•
Linux software updates specifically customized for OpenScape Office
In addition, it must be clarified in advance whether or not OpenScape Office
should have access to the Internet.
OpenScape Office requires an Internet connection for:
•
OpenScape Office software updates
•
OpenScape Office features such as Internet telephony, for example
•
Remote Service (SSDP)
This requires access to the Internet to be set up in OpenScape Office.
E-mail Server (Optional)
OpenScape Office requires access to an e-mail server to receive and send emails. To do this, the access data for the e-mail server must be entered in
OpenScape Office, and the appropriate accounts (IP address, URL, login data of
the e-mail server) must be set up in the e-mail server.
If the e-mail functionality within OpenScape Office is not used, this data need not
be collected.
Internet Telephony, VoIP (Optional)
If Internet telephony is used within OpenScape Office, then OpenScape Office will
require access to the Internet and to an Internet Telephony Service Provider (SIP
Provider) for SIP telephony over the Internet. To do this, the appropriate accounts
must be obtained from the SIP Provider, and the access data for the SIP Provider
(IP address, URL, login data of the SIP Provider) must be set up in
OpenScape Office.
Network Configuration
During the Linux installation, you will be prompted for the network configuration
details. Consequently, it is advisable to create an IP address scheme containing
all network components and their IP addresses before the network configuration.
The following is an example of an IP address scheme with the IP address range
192.168.3.x: The parameters shown in bold are the minimum mandatory
specifications required during the Linux installation.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
191
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office (LX/HX)
Parameters
Sample values
External DHCP server or Linux DHCP server
DHCP server of the Internet router
(external)
DHCP address range
192.168.3.50 through
192.168.3.254
Subnet mask of the network or network segment 255.255.255.0
Fixed IP address of the Linux server
192.168.3.10
This IP address must be outside the DHCP range.
Internet router
192.168.3.1
Server with fixed IP address (optional), e.g., e-mail
server
192.168.3.20
Clients with fixed IP address (optional)
192.168.3.1 through 192.168.3.49
This IP address must be outside the DHCP range.
Default Gateway, i.e., the Internet router in the
example
192.168.3.1
DNS Server (i.e., the Internet router in the example) 192.168.3.1
Domain name when using a DNS server (e.g., the customer.com
Internet domain name
Name of the OpenScape Office server
osolx or osohx
The name can be freely selected, but should be coordinated with the network administrator.
If the actual network data is not available at time of installation, the network should
be configured with the data of this sample network.
After the successful installation of Linux, the network data can be edited at any
time with YaST and adapted to the network.
Skipping the network configuration is not recommended, since the subsequent
installation of OpenScape Office cannot be successfully completed without a fully
configured network.
Related Topics
6.2 Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office (LX/HX)
The Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office is an SLES 11 SP1 32-bit version that
has been optimized for OpenScape Office. The software packages (RPM)
required for OpenScape Office are already included in the Linux Appliance for
OpenScape Office and are automatically installed with it.
192
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office (LX/HX)
The software updates for the Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office are not
obtained from the Novell server but from the Linux Update Server (Central Update
Server). All updates made available there are tested for compatibility with the
OpenScape Office software in advance.
Initial Startup Procedure
To start up the Linux server with Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office the first
time, you will need the license authorization code (LAC), the activation code and
an Internet connection. The license authorization code identifies the customer
order, including the licenses. These licenses authorize the use of OpenScape
Office. The activation code authorizes the use of Update Services on the Linux
Update Server.
1. License Authorization Code (LAC):
On purchasing OpenScape Office LX or OpenScape Office HX, the customer
receives a license authorization code. The information on the licenses
purchased (basic licenses and extension licenses, if any) are stored in the
database of the Central License Server (CLS).
2. Installation of Linux and OpenScape Office:
The customer or service technician installs the Linux Appliance for
OpenScape Office and then the OpenScape Office application, including
OpenScape Office Assistant. The activation period for OpenScape Office
begins (period of 30 days in which the licensing of OpenScape Office must be
completed).
3. Licensing:
•
Online Licensing
Using OpenScape Office Assistant, the customer or service technician
transmits the license authorization code to the Central License Server
(CLS) via the Internet. Together with the LAC, the MAC address of the
server PC (or the Advanced Locking ID in a virtual environment) is used
for license activation. The CLS generates a license file from this data and
the activation code. The CLS sends the license file back to OpenScape
Office Assistant, which then activates the acquired licenses. The
customer or service technician logs in at the Central License Server (CLS)
and makes a note of the activation code.
•
Offline Licensing
The customer or service technician logs in at the Central License Server
(CLS) and enters the license authorization code there along with the MAC
address of the server PC (or the Advanced Locking ID in a virtual
environment). The CLS generates a license file from this data and the
activation code. The customer or service technician notes down the
activation code, downloads the license file and copies it into OpenScape
Office Assistant. OpenScape Office Assistant then actives the purchased
licenses.
4. Logging in at the Linux Update Server with the activation code:
After the installation of Linux and OpenScape Office, the customer or service
technician enters the activation code under Linux and thus registers at the
Linux Update Server to activate the Update Service. From the time of
activation, the customer has 3 years of update support for the Linux Appliance
for OpenScape Office.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
193
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Installation in a Virtualized Environment (LX/HX)
Related Topics
6.3 Installation in a Virtualized Environment (LX/HX)
OpenScape Office LX and OpenScape Office HX can run in a virtualized
environment.
To set up a virtualized environment, the virtualization software (host operating
system) must be first installed and configured on the server PC. Linux is then
installed as a guest operating system. Finally, the OpenScape Office software is
installed within the Linux operating system.
For licensing in a virtualized environment, an Advanced Locking ID is generated
and used for OpenScape Office LX instead of the MAC address. For OpenScape
Office HX, the licensing occurs exactly as in a non-virtualized environment using
HiPath 3000 Manager E.
The following virtualization software has been released:
•
VMware vSphere Version 4 or Version 5
For details on the hardware requirements of the physical server PC, refer to
the “VMware Compatibility Guide and the “VMware Management Resource
Guide” at www.vmware.com.
To determine the hardware requirements at the physical server PC, VMware
offers an online search function for certified and tested hardware under “Compatibility Guides” on their Internet homepage at:
http://www.vmware.com/resources/guides.html
The description of the installation and configuration of the virtualization software
is not part of this documentation. The installation process for Linux and
OpenScape Office in a virtualized environment is exactly the same as for a direct
installation on the server PC.
The following minimum requirements must be configured for Linux and
OpenScape Office in the virtualized environment:
Parameters
194
VM Settings
Guest Operating System
Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office
or SLES 11 SP1 32 Bit
VM HD Capacity
200 GB
Virtual Disk Mode
Default
Virtual Disk Format Type
Thin Provisioning
vCPUs
2
vCPUs Shares (High/Normal)
High
vCPU Reservation
2 GHz
vCPU Limit
Unlimited
VM Memory
2 GB
VM Memory Shares (High/Normal)
Normal
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Installation in a Virtualized Environment (LX/HX)
Parameters
VM Settings
VM Memory Reservation
2 GB
VM Memory Limit
Unlimited
Number of vNICs
1
VMware Manual MAC Used
NO
Virtual Network Adapter Support
YES, vmxnet3 driver
VMware Tools Installation
YES
The VM (Virtual Machine) may utilize the CPU up to 70%; values above that can
result in erratic behavior.
The following VMware vSphere features are supported:
•
Thin Provisioning
•
High Availability (HA)
•
VMotion
•
Data Recovery (VDR)
•
DRS (Automatic VMotion)
•
Storage VMotion
The following VMware vSphere features are not supported:
•
Fault tolerance
The screen saver for the virtualized environment must be disabled.
Related Topics
6.3.1 Time Synchronization of the Guest Operating System Linux (LX/HX)
The time synchronization (uniform time base for date and time) between the host
operating system VMware vSphere and the guest operating system Linux must
be disabled. The uniform time base should be obtained by the guest operating
system via an NTP server.
Related Topics
6.3.1.1 How to Configure Time Synchronization for the Guest Operating System Linux
Step by Step
1) Right-click in the VMware client vSphere Client on the guest operating
system Linux and select the menu item Edit Settings.
2) Under the Virtual Machine Properties on the Options tab, disable the option
Synchronize guest time with host under the VMware Tools entry in the
Advanced area.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
195
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Installation in a Virtualized Environment (LX/HX)
3) Edit the NTP settings for the guest operating system Linux in the ./etc/
ntp.conf file as follows in accordance with the parameters shown in bold:

************************************************
… 
tinker panic 0 
# server 127.127.1.0 
# local clock (LCL) 
# fudge 127.127.1.0 stratum 10 
# LCL is unsynchronized 
… 
server 0.de.pool.ntp.org iburst 
restrict 0.de.pool.ntp.org 
restrict 127.0.0.1 
restrict default kod nomodify notrap 
… 
************************************************

INFO: The NTP server de.pool.ntp.org is an example and may
need to be replaced by an NTP server address that can be
reached by the guest operating system Linux.
Related Topics
6.3.2 Use of Snapshots on Virtual Machines (VM)
Snapshots can be a valuable maintenance mechanism, for example, to perform
a fast rollback to a predefined operating state of the VM after a mass distribution
script has failed.
•
Snapshots cannot be created during normal operation. While a snapshot is
being taken, the current operating state of the virtual machine is frozen.
Consequently, connected devices and applications such as IP phones or the
UC clients can lose the connection to the server.
•
Snapshots can cause internal server processes to lose their synchronization,
which means that the stable operation of the communication system can then
no longer be guaranteed. A server reboot following the snapshot should
therefore also be planned within the maintenance timeframe.
•
Previous snapshots should not remain on the production environment during
normal operation.
•
Snapshots can be taken during a planned maintenance window or within the
framework of the installation.
•
Snapshots are used internally by backup tools such as VDP or VDR. It must
be ensured that these backup operations are schedules outside of business
hours and that the snapshots generated by these tools are deleted at the end
of the operation.
More information regarding snapshots can be found the VMware knowledge base
(KB). A good starting point is the KB article 1025279 – Best Practices for virtual
machine snapshots in the VMware environment (http://kb.vmware.com/
kb/1025279).
196
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Linux Security Aspects and RAID Array (LX/HX)
6.4 Linux Security Aspects and RAID Array (LX/HX)
The security of the Linux server can be enhanced by observing all Linux security
aspects and by using a RAID array.
Firewall
When connected to the Internet, a firewall is needed to prevent unauthorized
access from outside to the OpenScape Office Server. After installing Linux, the
Linux firewall is enabled. The installation program of OpenScape Office adjusts
the firewall to enable the operation of OpenScape Office. The ports for
OpenScape Office are opened, and all other ports are closed. All
OpenScape Office services, except for OSO CSTA (CSTA interface) and SSH
(Secure Shell), are released.
If an external firewall is used in the network, the Linux firewall must be disabled,
and the addresses and ports required for OpenScape Office must be opened (see
Used Ports (LX/HX) ).
Virus Scanners
A virus scanner is not included in the Linux installation package. When connected
to the Internet, the virus scanner Trend Micro Server Protect for Linux is recommended. The current version of this virus scanner can be obtained from the
Release Notes of the used OpenScape Office version if required.
In order to prevent potential performance problems resulting from the use of the
virus scanner, the regular disk scans should be scheduled for times when
OpenScape Office is not being used or is only used at a minimum.
Intrusion Detection System (AppsAmor)
The OpenScape Office HX installation routine does not make any changes to the
Linux Intrusion Detection System (AppsArmor). The default settings of the Linux
installation are used. No further settings are required for the operation of
OpenScape Office.
During the installation of OpenScape Office LX, the integrated intrusion detection
system (AppsArmor) is updated and activated. No further settings are required for
the operation of OpenScape Office.
Redundancy
Recommendations for Improving Reliability (Redundancy):
•
Two hard disks in a RAID 1 array.
•
Second power supply for the Linux server
•
Uninterruptible power supply
When using IP phones, the LAN switches and IP phones should also be
connected to an uninterruptible power supply.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
197
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Initial Startup of the Linux Server (LX/HX)
RAID1 Array
In a RAID1 array, the contents of the first hard drive are mirrored on the second
hard drive. If one hard drive fails, the system continues to run on the second hard
drive.
A RAID array may be set up as a software RAID or hardware RAID (BIOS RAID
or hardware RAID controller).
For specific details on performing an installation with a software RAID, see Initial
Startup with a Software RAID .
A hardware RAID frequently requires a separate driver that is not included in the
Linux operating system. This driver is usually provided by the PC manufacturer
and must be installed according to manufacturer’s instructions. If the driver is not
compatible with the Linux version or if no Linux driver is offered, the hardware
RAID cannot be used. The description of hardware-based RAID systems is not
part of this documentation. In such cases, please contact the manufacturer for the
appropriate Linux drivers and configuration details.
Related Topics
6.5 Initial Startup of the Linux Server (LX/HX)
The initial startup of the Linux server includes the complete installation and configuration of the Linux operating system for the use of OpenScape Office, depending
on whether or not the server PC is using a software RAID.
This guide describes two installation options:
•
Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office (Recommended)
Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office is supplied together with the
OpenScape Office LX/HX software and includes an SLES 11 SP1 32 Bit
version that is specially customized for OpenScape Office. The installation is
therefore specially adapted to OpenScape Office. For updates and security
patches, registration occurs at the Linux Update Server, and no registration at
Novell is required.
•
SLES 11 SP1 32 Bit
The commercial SLES 11 SP1 32-bit version must be purchased separately.
It is important to ensure that the network settings and hard disk partitioning
are carried out as described here. In order to provide the commercial version
of SLES 11 SP1 32 Bit with updates and security patches, registration with
Novell is required. This can be configured during the installation of SLES 11
SP1 32 bit. However, it is advisable to do this before the installation.
The initial startup for the English interface is described here. The installation and
configuration can, of course, also be performed in a different interface language.
Related Topics
6.5.1 Initial Startup without a Software RAID
The initial startup of the Linux server without a software RAID includes the Linux
installation and configuration, while taking into account that no software RAID is
being used.
198
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Initial Startup of the Linux Server (LX/HX)
You have the following options:
•
Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office without a Software RAID
a) Install the Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office without a software RAID
With this variant, SLES 11 SP1 32 Bit is installed with the customized
settings required to start OpenScape Office for the first time.
b) Configure the Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office without a software
RAID
After completing the customized installation successfully, the operating
system for OpenScape Office is configured.
•
Install and configure SLES 11 SP1 without a software RAID
With this variant, SLES 11 SP1 32 Bit is installed. The required settings for
OpenScape Office are made during the installation and configuration.
Linux Partitions
The hard drive must be partitioned during the initial start-up as follows:
Partition
Type
Size
File system
Mount
Notes
Partition 1
Primary Parti- 1-2 GB
tion
Swap
swap
corresponds to the
size of the working
memory
Partition 2
Primary Parti- 20 GB
tion
Ext3
/
for the Linux operating system
Partition 3
Primary Parti- Rest
tion
Ext3
/home
for OpenScape Office
INFO: The installation routine of OpenScape Office checks these
partition sizes and may reject the installation.
INFO: Some server PCs require an additional boot partition. If
Linux suggests a boot partition, it should be accepted in the
proposed size.
Related Topics
6.5.1.1 How to Install the Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office without a Software RAID
Prerequisites
•
The BIOS setup of the Linux server is set so that the server will boot from the
DVD.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
199
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Initial Startup of the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Step by Step
1) Insert the Linux Appliance DVD for OpenScape Office into the DVD drive and
boot up the system from the DVD. The Startup window of the Linux installation
appears.
2) Press the F3 key and select an appropriate screen resolution (e.g., 1280 x
1024).
3) Select the menu item Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office V11 and
confirm this by pressing the Enter key. The setup is loaded into the RAM. This
can take a some time.
4) In the Language window, select English (US) as the user interface language
and click Next.
5) Read through the license agreement and accept the license terms by
enabling the check box Yes, I Agree to the License Agreement. You
purchased the license for the Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office together
with OpenScape Office LX or OpenScape Office HX. Then click Next.
6) In the Keyboard Configuration window, select the desired country for the
keyboard layout and click Next.
7) Configure the settings for the host name and domain name in the Hostname
and Domain Name window.
a) If desired, change the proposed host name under Hostname (to osolx
or osohx, for example).
b) If desired, change the proposed domain name under Domain Name (to
<customer>.com, for example).
c) Clear the Change Hostname via DHCP check box.
d) Clear the Assign HostName to Loopback IP check box.
e) Then click Next.
8) Click in the Network Configuration II window on Network Interfaces.
9) Configure the network card:
a) Select the desired network card in the Overview window and click on
Edit. The MAC address of the network card selected here is assigned
later in the licensing process to the individual licenses.
b) Enable the radio button Statically assigned IP Address.
c) Under IP Address, enter the assigned IP address of the Linux server
(e.g., 192.168.3.10. The IP address must conform to the IP address
scheme of your internal network and must not have been assigned to any
network client, since this would otherwise result in an IP address conflict.
d) Under Subnet Mask, enter the assigned subnet mask of the Linux server
(e.g., 255.255.255.0. The subnet mask must match the IP address
scheme of your internal network.
e) Then click Next.
10) Specify the DNS server and the default gateway.
200
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Initial Startup of the Linux Server (LX/HX)
a) In the Network Settings window, click on the Host name/DNS tab.
b) Enter the IP address of the DNS server under Name Server 1. If no DNS
server is available in the internal network, enter the IP address of the
Internet router (e.g., 192.168.3.1).
c) In the Network Settings window, click on the Routing tab.
d) Under Default Gateway, enter the IP address of the Internet router (for
example:. 192.168.3.1).
e) Click OK.
11) Click in the Network Configuration window on Next.
12) In the Password for the System Administrator “root” window, enter a
password for the system administrator with the “root” profile in the Password
for root User and Confirm Password fields. The password should comply
with conventional security policies (i.e., have at least 8 characters, at least
one lowercase letter, at least one uppercase letter, at least one number and
at least one special character).
13) Then click Next.
14) Activate the radio button Local (/etc/passwd) in the User Authentication
Method window and click Next.
15) Create a new user with restricted privileges in the New Local User window.
This is required so that you are not logged in as “root” with all administrator
privileges during normal operation.
a) Enter the full name of the user under User’s Full Name, e.g., John Doe.
b) Enter a freely selectable name under Username, e.g., john2000.
c) Enter a password for the user under Password and Confirm Password.
The password should comply with conventional security policies (i.e.,
have at least 8 characters, at least one lowercase letter, at least one
uppercase letter, at least one number and at least one special character).
d) Make sure that the Receive System Mail and Automatic Login check
boxes are cleared.
e) Click Next. The setup is completed.
16) Log in as a user.
a) Enter the user name defined earlier under User Name and click Log In.
b) Enter the password defined earlier under Password and click Log In. The
basic installation of Linux is complete.
Next steps
Configure the Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office without a software RAID or
with a software RAID.
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
201
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Initial Startup of the Linux Server (LX/HX)
6.5.1.2 How to Configure the Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office without a Software
RAID
Prerequisites
•
The basic installation of Linux was completed successfully. The Linux server
is operational.
Step by Step
1) Double-click on the Live Installer icon on the desktop.
2) Enter the password for the system administrator with the “root” profile and
click Continue. This configuration program YaST2 is started, and the system
configuration is displayed.
3) Click in the Live Installation Settings window on Partitioning.
4) Activate the radio button Custom Partitioning (for experts) and click Next.
5) Navigate in the System View menu tree to Hard Disks > sda.
6) Delete all partitions (sda1, sda2, etc.) by marking the partition, clicking on
Delete, and then confirming the Delete operation with Yes.
7) Create a swap partition:
a) Click on Add, activate the Primary Partition radio button, and then click
Next.
b) Under Custom Size, enter the size of the swap partition. As a rule, the
swap partition corresponds to the size of the working memory (e.g.: with
2 GB RAM, the swap partition should be set to 2 GB, with the entry: 2GB).
c) Click Next.
d) In the File system drop-down list, select Swap and click on Finish.
8) Create the partition for the Linux operating system:
a) Click on Add, activate the Primary Partition radio button, and then click
Next.
b) Under Custom Size, enter the partition size (e.g., 20 GB are sufficient Input: +20GB) and click Next.
c) Enable the Format partition radio button and select the item Ext3 in the
File system drop-down list.
d) Enable the Mount partition radio button and select the item / in the
Mount Point drop-down list.
e) Click Finish.
9) Set up the partition for OpenScape Office:
202
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Initial Startup of the Linux Server (LX/HX)
a) Click on Add, activate the Primary Partition radio button, and then click
Next.
b) Under Custom Size, enter the partition size (the suggested value corresponds to the remaining space on the hard disk) and click Next.
c) Enable the Format partition radio button and select the item Ext3 in the
File system drop-down list.
d) Enable the Mount partition radio button and select the item /home in the
Mount Point drop-down list.
e) Click Finish.
10) Click Accept. The partitioning data is saved; the actual partitioning of the hard
disk occurs later. You are returned to the Live Installation Settings window.
11) Click in the Live Installation Settings window on Time Zone.
12) In the Clock and Time Zone window, clear the Hardware Clock Set To UTC
check box.
13) Select the desired region in the Region drop-down list and the desired time
zone in the Time Zone drop-down list.
14) Set the date and time with Change and click Accept.
15) Click on Accept and then on Install.
16) Confirm the repartitioning the hard disk with Install. This repartitioning takes
a few minutes.
17) Wait until the message for a restart appears in YaST2. Then click in the
message window on OK.
18) Restart the PC. The Startup window of Linux appears.
19) Remove the DVD from the DVD drive and select the item Boot from Hard
Disk in the Startup window of Linux.
20) Log in as a system administrator with the “root” profile.
a) Under User Name, enter the user name root of the system administrator
and click Log In.
b) Enter the password that was defined earlier for the system administrator
with the “root” profile under Password and click Log In. The Linux configuration is now complete.
Next steps
Configure an SNTP server (for a uniform time base).
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
203
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Initial Startup of the Linux Server (LX/HX)
6.5.1.3 How to Install and Configure SLES 11 SP1 without a Software RAID
Prerequisites
•
The BIOS setup of the Linux server is set so that the server will boot from the
DVD.
•
To register with Novell, Internet access and the activation code are required.
Step by Step
1) Insert the SUSE Linux Enterprise Sever 11 SP1 (32 bit) DVD into the DVD
drive and boot up the system from the DVD. The Startup window of the Linux
installation appears.
2) Press the F3 key and select an appropriate screen resolution (e.g., 1280 x
1024).
3) Select the menu item Installation and confirm this by pressing the Enter key.
4) In the Welcome window, select the country settings for the Linux operating
system:
a) Select English (US) as the user interface language in the Language
drop-down list.
b) Select the keyboard layout for the desired country from the Keyboard
Layout drop-down list.
5) Read through the license agreement and accept the license terms by
enabling the check box I Agree to the License Terms. You purchased the
license for SLES 11 together with OpenScape Office LX or OpenScape Office
HX. Then click Next.
6) Click in the Media Check window on Start Check to check the DVD for any
existing read errors. Then click Next.
7) Activate the New Installation option in the Installation Mode window and
click Next.
8) In the Clock and Time Zone window, select the desired region in the Region
drop-down list and the desired time zone in the Time Zone drop-down list.
9) Set the date and time with Change and click Next.
10) In the Server Base Scenario window, enable the option Physical Machine
and click Next.
11) Click in the Installation Settings window on Partitioning.
12) Activate the radio button Custom Partitioning (for experts) and click Next.
13) Navigate in the System View menu tree to Hard Disks > sda.
14) Delete all partitions (sda1, sda2, etc.) by marking the partition, clicking on
Delete, and then confirming the Delete operation with Yes.
15) Create a swap partition:
204
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Initial Startup of the Linux Server (LX/HX)
a) Click on Add, activate the Primary Partition radio button, and then click
Next.
b) Under Custom Size, enter the size of the swap partition. As a rule, the
swap partition corresponds to the size of the working memory (e.g.: with
2 GB RAM, the swap partition should be set to 2 GB, with the entry: 2GB).
c) Click Next.
d) In the File system drop-down list, select Swap and click on Finish.
16) Create the partition for the Linux operating system:
a) Click on Add, activate the Primary Partition radio button, and then click
Next.
b) Under Custom Size, enter the partition size (e.g., 20 GB are sufficient Input: +20GB) and click Next.
c) Enable the Format partition radio button and select the item Ext3 in the
File system drop-down list.
d) Enable the Mount partition radio button and select the item / in the
Mount Point drop-down list.
e) Click Finish.
17) Set up the partition for OpenScape Office:
a) Click on Add, activate the Primary Partition radio button, and then click
Next.
b) Under Custom Size, enter the partition size (the suggested value corresponds to the remaining space on the hard disk) and click Next.
c) Enable the Format partition radio button and select the item Ext3 in the
File system drop-down list.
d) Enable the Mount partition radio button and select the item /home in the
Mount Point drop-down list.
e) Click Finish.
18) Click Accept. The hard disk is now partitioned. After this has occurred, the
Installation Settings window is displayed again.
19) Click Install.
20) Accept the license terms for the Agfa Monotype Corporation Font Software
with I Agree and click on Install. The installation of the Linux operating
system takes about 20 - 30 minutes. A restart is then performed.
21) Select the item Boot from Hard Disk in the Startup window of Linux.
22) After the Linux server is up, enter the password for the system administrator
with the “root” profile. The password should comply with conventional security
policies (i.e., have at least 8 characters, at least one lowercase letter, at least
one uppercase letter, at least one number and at least one special character).
Then click Next.
23) Configure the settings for the host name and domain name:
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
205
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Initial Startup of the Linux Server (LX/HX)
a) If desired, change the proposed host name under Hostname (to osolx
or osohx, for example).
b) If desired, change the proposed domain name under Domain Name (to
<customer>.com, for example).
c) Clear the Change Hostname via DHCP check box.
d) Clear the Assign HostName to Loopback IP check box.
e) Then click Next.
24) Click in the Network Configuration window on Network Interfaces.
25) Configure the network card:
a) Select the desired network card in the Overview window and click on
Edit. The MAC address of the network card selected here is assigned
later in the licensing process to the individual licenses.
b) Enable the radio button Statically assigned IP Address.
c) Under IP Address, enter the assigned IP address of the Linux server
(e.g., 192.168.3.10. The IP address must conform to the IP address
scheme of your internal network and must not have been assigned to any
network client, since this would otherwise result in an IP address conflict.
d) Under Subnet Mask, enter the assigned subnet mask of the Linux server
(e.g., 255.255.255.0. The subnet mask must match the IP address
scheme of your internal network.
e) Then click Next.
26) Specify the DNS server and the default gateway.
a) In the Network Settings window, click on the Host name/DNS tab.
b) Enter the IP address of the DNS server under Name Server 1. If no DNS
server is available in the internal network, enter the IP address of the
Internet router (e.g., 192.168.3.1).
c) In the Network Settings window, click on the Routing tab.
d) Under Default Gateway, enter the IP address of the Internet router (for
example:. 192.168.3.1).
e) Click OK.
27) Click in the Network Configuration window on Next.
28) Activate the radio button Yes, Test Connection to the Internet via in the
Test Internet Connection window and select the network card via which the
Internet connection is to be set up.
29) Click Next.
30) After the test succeeds, click Next.
31) Register with Novell for patches and software updates:
206
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Initial Startup of the Linux Server (LX/HX)
a) In the Novell Customer Center Configuration window, enable the
option Configure now (Recommended) and click Next. You will be
redirected to the Novell web page.
b) Enter your e-mail address and activation code there. After a successful
registration, the update window appears.
c) Click on Run Update.
d) Select what you want to install from the list of patches (exception: Service
Packs may not be installed) and click Accept. The updates are
downloaded and installed.
32) Then click Next.
33) Click in the Network Services Configuration window on Next., since no
changes are required at the CA Management and the OpenLDAP server.
34) Activate the radio button Local (/etc/passwd) in the User Authentication
Method window and click Next.
35) Create a new user with restricted privileges. This is required so that you are
not logged in as “root” with all administrator privileges during normal
operation.
a) Enter the full name of the user under User’s Full Name, e.g., John Doe.
b) Enter a freely selectable name under Username, e.g., john2000.
c) Enter a password for the user under Password and Confirm Password.
The password should comply with conventional security policies (i.e.,
have at least 8 characters, at least one lowercase letter, at least one
uppercase letter, at least one number and at least one special character).
d) Make sure that the Receive System Mail and Automatic Login check
boxes are cleared.
e) Click Next.
36) Click in the Release Notes window on Next.
37) Confirm the test of the graphics card with OK.
38) Verify the hardware configuration in the Hardware configuration window. As
a rule, the hardware is automatically recognized correctly, and nothing needs
to be configured here. If you want to change some settings, this can be done
via the change button.
39) Click Next.
40) If you leave the check box Clone This System for AutoYAST enabled in the
Installation Competed window, all the configuration settings made here will
be saved to a file (requires approx. 1-2 minutes). This enables further Linux
servers to be quickly and conveniently installed with the same configuration
settings.
41) Click Finish.
42) Log in as the “root” user:
43) The Linux installation is complete. Remove the DVD from the DVD drive.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
207
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Initial Startup of the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Next steps
Configure an NTP server (for a uniform time base).
Related Topics
6.5.2 Initial Startup with a Software RAID
The initial startup of the Linux server with a software RAID includes the Linux
installation and configuration, while taking into account that a software RAID is
being used.
You have the following options:
•
Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office with a software RAID
a) Disabling the BIOS RAID
If a RAID array is to be set up via a software RAID, any integrated RAID
BIOS that may be present on the motherboard of the server PC must be
first disabled in the BIOS.
b) Install the Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office without a software RAID
With this variant, SLES 11 SP1 32 Bit is installed with the customized
settings required to start OpenScape Office for the first time.
c) Configure the Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office without a software
RAID
After completing the customized installation successfully, the operating
system for OpenScape Office is configured.
•
SLES 11 SP1 with a software RAID
a) Disabling the BIOS RAID
If a RAID array is to be set up via a software RAID, any integrated RAID
BIOS that may be present on the motherboard of the server PC must be
first disabled in the BIOS.
b) Installing and configuring SLES 11 SP1 with a software RAID
With this variant, SLES 11 SP1 32 Bit is installed. The required settings
for OpenScape Office are made during the installation and configuration.
Linux Partitions
The hard drive must be partitioned during the initial start-up as follows:
Partition
208
Type
Size
File system
Mount
Notes
Partition 1
Primary Parti- 1-2 GB
tion
Swap
swap
corresponds to the
size of the working
memory
Partition 2
Primary Parti- 20 GB
tion
Ext3
No mount
point
for the Linux operating system
Partition 3
Primary Parti- Rest
tion
Ext3
No mount
point
for OpenScape Office
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Initial Startup of the Linux Server (LX/HX)
The mount points are assigned after the partitioning when setting up the RAID
system.
INFO: The installation routine of OpenScape Office checks these
partition sizes and may reject the installation.
INFO: Some server PCs require an additional boot partition. If
Linux suggests a boot partition during the installation, it should be
accepted in the proposed size.
Related Topics
6.5.2.1 How to Deactivate the BIOS RAID
Prerequisites
•
An integrated RAID controller (BIOS RAID) is available on the motherboard
of the PC.
Step by Step
1) Restart the PC. During the startup, you will see whether the BIOS RAID has
been enabled. If the BIOS RAID is not enabled, skip to step 3.
2) Disable the active BIOS RAID:
a) Press the appropriate key combination at the right time during the startup
to enter BIOS RAID setup. The combination will be shown to you during
the startup (e.g., CTRL M for LSI MegaRAID BIOS).
b) Clear the BIOS RAID configuration. Example for LSI MegaRAID BIOS:
Management Menu > Configure > Configuration Menu > Clear Configuration.
c) Exit the setup of the BIOS RAID and restart the PC.
3) Disable the RAID configuration in the BIOS setup of the PC:
a) Press the appropriate key (e.g., F2 or DEL) at the right time during the
startup to enter BIOS setup of the PC.
b) Disable the SATA RAID. Example for a Phoenix BIOS: Advanced >
Advanced System Configuration > SATA RAID Disabled.
c) Save your changes and exit the BIOS setup of your PC (with the F10 key,
for example).
4) Restart the PC.
Next steps
Install the Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office with a software RAID or install
and configure SLES 11 SP1 with a software RAID.
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
209
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Initial Startup of the Linux Server (LX/HX)
6.5.2.2 How to Install the Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office with a Software RAID
Prerequisites
•
Any possibly existing hardware RAID is disabled.
The basic installation of Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office with a software
RAID does not differ from the basic installation of Linux Appliance for
OpenScape Office without a software RAID. The instructions for the basic installation can be found under How to Install the Linux Appliance for OpenScape
Office without a Software RAID .
The subsequent configuration of Linux including the disk partitioning depends on
whether or not a software RAID is being used and is described later in this section
(see How to Configure the Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office with a Software
RAID ).
Related Topics
6.5.2.3 How to Configure the Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office with a Software
RAID
Prerequisites
•
Any possibly existing hardware RAID is disabled.
•
The basic installation of Linux was completed successfully. The Linux server
is operational.
Step by Step
1) Double-click on the Live Installer icon on the desktop.
2) Enter the password for the system administrator with the “root” profile and
click Continue. This configuration program YaST2 is started, and the system
configuration is displayed.
3) Click in the Live Installation Settings window on Partitioning.
4) Activate the radio button Custom Partitioning (for experts) and click Next.
5) Partition the two hard disks:
a) Navigate in the System View menu tree to Hard Disks > sda (first hard
disk of the software RAID).
b) Delete all partitions (sda1, sda2, etc.) by marking the partition, clicking on
Delete, and then confirming the Delete operation with Yes.
c) Partition the first hard disk by using the Add button.
Use the following data for the partitioning:
210
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Initial Startup of the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Partition 1
Primary Partition
2 GB
Format Swap,
Mount Point = swap,
fstab Option = Device name
Partition 2
Primary Partition
20 GB
Format Ext3, no Mount Point
Partition 3
Primary Partition
Rest
Format Ext3, no Mount Point
d) Navigate in the System View menu tree to Hard Disks > sdb (second
hard disk of the software RAID).
e) Complete steps b and c for the second hard disk as well.
6) Specify the software RAID settings:
a) Select the menu item RAID and click on Add RAID.
b) Select RAID 1 (Mirroring).
c) Select the two partitions sda2 and sdb2 in the Available Devices area on
the left and transfer them with Add to the Selected Devices area on the
right.
d) Click Next.
e) Confirm the default value for the Chunk Size with Next.
f)
In the next window, select the mount point “/” for the first RAID device (/
dev/md0) and click Finish.
g) Then click on Add Raid again.
h) Select RAID 1 (Mirroring).
i)
Select the two partitions sda3 and sdb3 in the Available Devices area on
the left and transfer them with Add to the Selected Devices area on the
right.
j)
Click Next.
k) Confirm the default value for the Chunk Size with Next.
l)
In the next window, select the mount point “/home” for the second RAID
device (/dev/md1) and click Finish.
7) Click Accept. The partitioning data is saved; the actual partitioning of the hard
disk occurs later. You are returned to the Live Installation Settings window.
8) Specify the Boot Loader settings:
a) Click on Booting and then on Boot Loader Installation.
b) Clear the Boot from Boot Partition check box.
c) Select the Boot from Master Boot Record and Boot from Root
Partition check boxes.
d) Click on Boot-Loader Options.
e) Select the Set active Flag in Partition Table for Boot Partition and
Write generic Boot Code to MBR check boxes.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
211
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Initial Startup of the Linux Server (LX/HX)
9) Click OK to confirm your selection. You are returned to the Live Installation
Settings window.
10) Click in the Live Installation Settings window on Time Zone.
11) In the Clock and Time Zone window, clear the Hardware Clock Set To UTC
check box.
12) Select the desired region in the Region drop-down list and the desired time
zone in the Time Zone drop-down list.
13) Set the date and time with Change and click Accept.
14) Click on Accept and then on Install.
15) Confirm the repartitioning the hard disk with Install. This repartitioning takes
a few minutes.
16) Wait until the message for a restart appears in YaST2. Then click in the
message window on OK.
17) Restart the PC. The Startup window of Linux appears.
18) Remove the DVD from the DVD drive and select the item Boot from Hard
Disk in the Startup window of Linux.
19) Log in as a system administrator with the “root” profile.
a) Under User Name, enter the user name root of the system administrator
and click Log In.
b) Enter the password that was defined earlier for the system administrator
with the “root” profile under Password and click Log In.
20) To enable the PC to start from both hard disks, the following adaptations are
needed (based on this example of a software RAID with the hard disks sda
and sdb):
a) Open a root shell and run the following commands there:
grub --device-map=/boot/grub/device.map
root (hd0,1)
setup (hd0)
root (hd1,1)
setup (hd1)
quit
21) The Linux configuration is now complete.
Next steps
Configure an NTP server (for a uniform time base).
Related Topics
212
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Initial Startup of the Linux Server (LX/HX)
6.5.2.4 How to Install and Configure SLES 11 SP1 with a Software RAID
Prerequisites
•
Any possibly existing hardware RAID is disabled.
•
The BIOS setup of the Linux server is set so that the server will boot from the
DVD.
•
To register with Novell, Internet access and the activation code are required.
Step by Step
1) Insert the SUSE Linux Enterprise Sever 11 SP1 (32 bit) DVD into the DVD
drive and boot up the system from the DVD. The Startup window of the Linux
installation appears.
2) Press the F3 key and select an appropriate screen resolution (e.g., 1280 x
1024).
3) Select the menu item Installation and confirm this by pressing the Enter key.
4) In the Welcome window, select the country settings for the Linux operating
system:
a) Select English (US) as the user interface language in the Language
drop-down list.
b) Select the keyboard layout for the desired country from the Keyboard
Layout drop-down list.
5) Read through the license agreement and accept the license terms by
enabling the check box I Agree to the License Terms. You purchased the
license for SLES 11 together with OpenScape Office LX or OpenScape Office
HX. Then click Next.
6) Click in the Media Check window on Start Check to check the DVD for any
existing read errors. Then click Next.
7) Activate the New Installation option in the Installation Mode window and
click Next.
8) In the Clock and Time Zone window, select the desired region in the Region
drop-down list and the desired time zone in the Time Zone drop-down list.
9) Set the date and time with Change and click Next.
10) In the Server Base Scenario window, enable the option Physical Machine
and click Next.
11) Click in the Installation Settings window on Partitioning.
12) Activate the radio button Custom Partitioning (for experts) and click Next.
13) Partition the two hard disks:
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
213
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Initial Startup of the Linux Server (LX/HX)
a) Navigate in the System View menu tree to Hard Disks > sda (first hard
disk of the software RAID).
b) Delete all partitions (sda1, sda2, etc.) by marking the partition, clicking on
Delete, and then confirming the Delete operation with Yes.
c) Partition the first hard disk by using the Add button.
Use the following data for the partitioning:
Partition 1
Primary Partition
2 GB
Format Swap,
Mount Point = swap,
fstab Option = Device name
Partition 2
Primary Partition
20 GB
Format Ext3, no Mount Point
Partition 3
Primary Partition
Rest
Format Ext3, no Mount Point
d) Navigate in the System View menu tree to Hard Disks > sdb (second
hard disk of the software RAID).
e) Complete steps b and c for the second hard disk as well.
14) Specify the software RAID settings:
a) Select the menu item RAID and click on Add RAID.
b) Select RAID 1 (Mirroring).
c) Select the two partitions sda2 and sdb2 in the Available Devices area on
the left and transfer them with Add to the Selected Devices area on the
right.
d) Click Next.
e) Confirm the default value for the Chunk Size with Next.
f)
In the next window, select the mount point “/” for the first RAID device (/
dev/md0) and click Finish.
g) Then click on Add Raid again.
h) Select RAID 1 (Mirroring).
i)
Select the two partitions sda3 and sdb3 in the Available Devices area on
the left and transfer them with Add to the Selected Devices area on the
right.
j)
Click Next.
k) Confirm the default value for the Chunk Size with Next.
l)
In the next window, select the mount point “/home” for the second RAID
device (/dev/md1) and click Finish.
15) Click Accept. The partitioning data is saved; the actual partitioning of the hard
disk occurs later. You are returned to the Installation Settings window.
16) Specify the Boot Loader settings:
214
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Initial Startup of the Linux Server (LX/HX)
a) Click on Booting and then on Boot Loader Installation.
b) Clear the Boot from Boot Partition check box.
c) Select the Boot from Master Boot Record and Boot from Root
Partition check boxes.
d) Click on Boot-Loader Options.
e) Select the Set active Flag in Partition Table for Boot Partition and
Write generic Boot Code to MBR check boxes.
17) Click OK to confirm your selection. You are returned to the Installation
Settings window.
18) Click OK. The hard disks are now partitioned. After this has occurred, the
Installation Settings window is displayed again.
19) Click Install.
20) Accept the license terms for the Agfa Monotype Corporation Font Software
with I Agree and click on Install. The installation of the Linux operating
system takes about 20 - 30 minutes. A restart is then performed.
21) Select the item Boot from Hard Disk in the Startup window of Linux.
22) After the Linux server is up, enter the password for the system administrator
with the “root” profile. The password should comply with conventional security
policies (i.e., have at least 8 characters, at least one lowercase letter, at least
one uppercase letter, at least one number and at least one special character).
Then click Next.
23) Configure the settings for the host name and domain name:
a) If desired, change the proposed host name under Hostname (to osolx
or osohx, for example).
b) If desired, change the proposed domain name under Domain Name (to
<customer>.com, for example).
c) Clear the Change Hostname via DHCP check box.
d) Clear the Assign HostName to Loopback IP check box.
e) Then click Next.
24) Click in the Network Configuration window on Network Interfaces.
25) Configure the network card:
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
215
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Initial Startup of the Linux Server (LX/HX)
a) Select the desired network card in the Overview window and click on
Edit. The MAC address of the network card selected here is assigned
later in the licensing process to the individual licenses.
b) Enable the radio button Statically assigned IP Address.
c) Under IP Address, enter the assigned IP address of the Linux server
(e.g., 192.168.3.10. The IP address must conform to the IP address
scheme of your internal network and must not have been assigned to any
network client, since this would otherwise result in an IP address conflict.
d) Under Subnet Mask, enter the assigned subnet mask of the Linux server
(e.g., 255.255.255.0. The subnet mask must match the IP address
scheme of your internal network.
e) Then click Next.
26) Specify the DNS server and the default gateway.
a) In the Network Settings window, click on the Host name/DNS tab.
b) Enter the IP address of the DNS server under Name Server 1. If no DNS
server is available in the internal network, enter the IP address of the
Internet router (e.g., 192.168.3.1).
c) In the Network Settings window, click on the Routing tab.
d) Under Default Gateway, enter the IP address of the Internet router (for
example:. 192.168.3.1).
e) Click OK.
27) Click in the Network Configuration window on Next.
28) Activate the radio button Yes, Test Connection to the Internet via in the
Test Internet Connection window and select the network card via which the
Internet connection is to be set up.
29) Click Next.
30) After the test succeeds, click Next.
31) Register with Novell for patches and software updates:
a) In the Novell Customer Center Configuration window, enable the
option Configure now (Recommended) and click Next. You will be
redirected to the Novell web page.
b) Enter your e-mail address and activation code there. After a successful
registration, the update window appears.
c) Click on Run Update.
d) Select what you want to install from the list of patches (exception: Service
Packs may not be installed) and click Accept. The updates are
downloaded and installed.
32) Then click Next.
33) Click in the Network Services Configuration window on Next., since no
changes are required at the CA Management and the OpenLDAP server.
216
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Initial Startup of the Linux Server (LX/HX)
34) Activate the radio button Local (/etc/passwd) in the User Authentication
Method window and click Next.
35) Create a new user with restricted privileges. This is required so that you are
not logged in as “root” with all administrator privileges during normal
operation.
a) Enter the full name of the user under User’s Full Name, e.g., John Doe.
b) Enter a freely selectable name under Username, e.g., john2000.
c) Enter a password for the user under Password and Confirm Password.
The password should comply with conventional security policies (i.e.,
have at least 8 characters, at least one lowercase letter, at least one
uppercase letter, at least one number and at least one special character).
d) Make sure that the Receive System Mail and Automatic Login check
boxes are cleared.
e) Click Next.
36) Click in the Release Notes window on Next.
37) Confirm the test of the graphics card with OK.
38) Verify the hardware configuration in the Hardware configuration window. As
a rule, the hardware is automatically recognized correctly, and nothing needs
to be configured here. If you want to change some settings, this can be done
via the change button.
39) Click Next.
40) If you leave the check box Clone This System for AutoYAST enabled in the
Installation Competed window, all the configuration settings made here will
be saved to a file (requires approx. 1-2 minutes). This enables further Linux
servers to be quickly and conveniently installed with the same configuration
settings.
41) Click Finish.
42) To enable the PC to start from both hard disks, the following adaptations are
needed (based on this example of a software RAID with the hard disks sda
and sdb):
a) Log in as the “root” user.
b) Open a root shell and run the following commands there:
grub --device-map=/boot/grub/device.map
root (hd0,1)
setup (hd0)
root (hd1,1)
setup (hd1)
quit
43) The Linux installation is complete. Remove the DVD from the DVD drive.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
217
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Initial Startup of the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Next steps
Configure an NTP server (for a uniform time base).
Related Topics
6.5.3 Configuring a Uniform Time Base (LX/HX)
The communication system and IP stations (IP phones, client PCs) should have
a uniform time base (date and time). This time base is provided by an SNTP
server.
INFO: If Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office is run as a guest
operating system in a virtualized environment, the NTP settings in
the file ./etc/ntp.conf must be adapted (see How to
Configure Time Synchronization for the Guest Operating System
Linux ).
The following variants are possible as a time base:
•
SNTP server on the internal network (recommended)
If possible, an existing SNTP server on the internal network should be used.
If this is the case, the IP address, URL or DNS name of the SNTP server is
required.
•
SNTP Server on the Internet
If Internet access is available and set up, an SNTP server from the Internet
can also be used. In this case, the URL or DNS name of the SNTP server is
required.
•
HG 1500 as SNTP server (only for OpenScape Office HX)
With OpenScape Office HX, the LAN board HG 1500 from HiPath 3000 may
alternatively also used as an SNTP server. This requires the HiPath 3000 to
be connected to the Central Office via ISDN lines and the system time to be
obtained from the CO. In this case, the HG 1500 must be first set up for use
as an SNTP server (see the HG 1500 Administrator documentation), and the
IP address of the HG 1500 must then be entered as an SNTP server within
Linux.
The IP phones automatically receive the date and time from OpenScape Office
(with OpenScape Office LX) or from HiPath 3000 (with OpenScape Office HX).
The client PCs that use the OpenScape Office clients must be set so that they are
synchronized with OpenScape Office LX or HiPath 3000 (see the operating
system instructions for the client PCs).
Related Topics
6.5.3.1 How to Configure an SNTP Server
Step by Step
1) Click on Computer in the task bar.
2) Click in the menu tree on System > YaST.
218
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Updates (LX/HX)
3) Enter the password for the root user and click Continue. The YaST2 Control
Center is opened.
4) Click System in the menu tree.
5) In the System area, click on Date and Time.
6) Click Change.
7) Activate the Synchronize with NTP Server option.
8) Specify an NTP server:
•
SNTP server on the internal network (recommended)
Enter the IP address, URL or DNS name of the SNTP server directly into
the list box.
•
SNTP Server on the Internet
Select the desired SNTP server from the NTP Server Address list or
enter the URL or DNS name of the SNTP server directly into the list box.
•
HG 1500 as SNTP server (only for OpenScape Office HX)
Enter the IP address of the HG 1500 directly into the list box.
9) Select the Save NTP configuration check box.
10) Click Configure.
11) Activate the Now and On Boot option.
12) Click OK followed by Accept.
13) Close the window with OK.
14) Close the YaST2Control Center.
Related Topics
6.6 Updates (LX/HX)
In order to receive updates, it is necessary to register by using the activation code.
If the Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office is used, registration occurs at the
Linux Update Server (Central Update Server); with SLES 11 SP1 32 Bit, directly
at Novell.
Updates for Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office
You must register at the Linux Update Server by using the activation code. The
activation code can be downloaded at the CLS (Central License Servers).
The support with updates begins from the date of registration and is valid for 3
years. After 3 years, a further 3 years of support can be procured. Within the Linux
Appliance for OpenScape Office, it is not possible to upgrade to a new service
pack or a new SLES version. In this case, a new Linux Appliance for OpenScape
Office version is needed.
In order to obtain the updates, Internet access and the setting to enable updates
to be automatically downloaded and installed (see How to Enable Automatic
Online Updates ) are required.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
219
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Updates (LX/HX)
Updates that require no user intervention are installed automatically. Updates that
require user interaction cannot be performed automatically. Consequently, an
update of the operating system should also be initiated manually from time to time
to ensure that updates which need an interaction are also installed.
Updates for SLES 11 SP1 32 Bit
The installation and operation of the commercial SLES 11 SP1 32 Bit version is
possible without registration. However, it is still important to register with Novell in
order to obtain security patches and software updates. A customer account with
Novell is required for this purpose. It is recommended that the customer account
be set up before the Linux installation.
The following update variants are possible: Registering with Novell is a prerequisite.
•
Update during the Linux installation (recommended)
During the Linux installation, updates and patches can be downloaded online
from the Novell Download Server.
Exception: Service Packs may not be installed.
•
Update after the Linux installation and before the installation of
OpenScape Office
After the Linux installation, updates and patches can be downloaded online
from the Novell Download Server using YaST (Software - Online Updates).
Exception: Service Packs may not be installed.
•
Update after the installation of OpenScape Office
After the installation of OpenScape Office, only the “security patches” that are
installed automatically online without any prompts may be installed.
The corresponding settings are made using YaST (Software - Online
Updates).
Deviations from the previously mentioned variants are possible and are described
in the Release Notes of OpenScape Office HX and OpenScape Office LX.
Related Topics
6.6.1 How to Register at the Linux Update Server (only for Linux Appliance
for OpenScape Office)
Prerequisites
•
You have the Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office installed.
•
You are logged in as a system administrator with the “root” profile.
•
The activation code is available.
Step by Step
1) Double-click on the root’s home icon on the desktop.
2) Double-click on the Registration icon.
220
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Updates (LX/HX)
3) Enter the activation code and click on Register. A connection to the Linux
Update Server is set up In the background
https://www.central-update-server.com
and the entered activation code is checked.
4) Confirm the successful registration with Close.
Next steps
Enabling automatic online updates
Related Topics
6.6.2 How to Enable Automatic Online Updates
Step by Step
1) Click on Computer in the task bar.
2) Click in the menu tree on System > YaST.
3) Enter the password for the root user and click Continue. The YaST2 Control
Center is opened.
4) Click on Software in the menu tree.
5) Click on Online Update Configuration.
6) Enable the Automatic Online Update check box and then select daily,
weekly or monthly as the interval.
7) Select the Skip Interactive Patches check box.
8) Click Finish.
9) Close the YaST2Control Center.
Related Topics
6.6.3 How to Enable Online Updates Manually
Step by Step
1) Click on Computer in the task bar.
2) Click in the menu tree on System > YaST.
3) Enter the password for the root user and click Continue. The YaST2 Control
Center is opened.
4) Click on Software in the menu tree.
5) Click on Online Update You will see a list of the available patches (Needed
Patches) that are required. If you already have all the latest patches installed,
this list will be empty.
6) Click on Accept to start the manual online update. The window will close
automatically after the update.
7) Close the YaST2Control Center.
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
221
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Backup & Restore (LX/HX)
6.7 Backup & Restore (LX/HX)
It is essential to back up the Linux operating system so it can be restored in an
emergency.
After the initial startup and before each manual update, it is strongly recommended that an appropriate tool be used to create a full backup of the server PC
and the affected partitions. If a fatal error occurs after an update, for example, the
server PC would to be completely restored.
In a virtual environment, the entire virtual machine to be copied.
If the entire server PC is backed up, the data of OpenScape Office will be included
in this backup. If only the operating system is backed up, the data of OpenScape
Office will also need to be backed up cyclically.
Linux Update Servers for the Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office Version
For non-critical errors, it may, under some circumstances, be advisable to wait
until the next patch for the Linux Appliance for OpenScape Office version or for
the OpenScape Office software is released.
For critical errors, the server PC will need to be restored.
Please inform the Service of the Linux Update Server in both cases.
Related Topics
6.8 Used Ports (LX/HX)
The system components of OpenScape Office LX and OpenScape Office HX use
different ports. These ports must be enabled for proper operation of the firewall.
The following ports are used by OpenScape Office LX and OpenScape Office HX.
Port number
Description
TCP
UDP
X
HX
21
FTP
161
SNMP
389
LDAP
X
X
X
443
HTTPS
X
X
X
1300
Secure H225
X
X
1720
H225
X
X
3011
SSDP
X
X
3517
WLAN Access
Point Discovery
4060
CorNet-TC
X
X
4061
Secure CorNet-TC X
X
5060
SIP
X
5061
Secure SIP
X
222
X
LX
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing the Linux Server (LX/HX)
Used Ports (LX/HX)
Port number
Description
TCP
UDP
LX
HX
5262
XMPP
X
X
X
5269
XMPP
X
X
X
5432
SQL
X
X
X
8101
OSO myReports
X
X
X
8770
OSO Upload
X
X
X
8778
OSO Multisite
X
X
X
8779
OSO User Portal
X
X
X
X
8000-8007
Gate View
X
X
X
X
8008-8010
Gate View
X
X
X
8084
DLSC
X
X
8800
CSP
X
X
X
8801
Mobile Browser Cli- X
ents (HTTP)
X
X
8802
Mobile Browser Cli- X
ents (HTTPS)
X
X
8808
System Status
Server
X
X
X
9091
XMPP
X
X
X
10023
Online Endpoint
X
X
12061
CAR Register
X
X
12063
CAR Update
X
X
18443
DLI
X
X
21965
Diagnostic
X
X
23232
Licensing
61740
Licensing
40000-40040
FTP
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
223
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Installation Example for OpenScape Office LX
7 Installing OpenScape Office LX
The initial installation of OpenScape Office LX with OpenScape Office Assistant
is described here with the aid of a selected installation example.
Related Topics
7.1 Installation Example for OpenScape Office LX
The installation example for OpenScape Office LX covers the following content:
setting up the trunk connection of the communication system via an Internet
Telephony Service Provider, setting up Internet access via an existing Internet
router (e.g., DSL) and setting up the IP stations (OpenStage). The detailed
administration of the various features of OpenScape Office LX can be found in
later sections.
Internet Telephony
In order to use Internet telephony, you will need Internet access. You also need
an Internet Telephony Service Provider (ITSP, SIP Provider) that provides a pointto-point connection or a station connection with the appropriate phone numbers.
OpenScape Office LX can be used to set up a preconfigured ITSP or to add a new
ITSP. The following two variants exist for an ITSP:
•
ITSP for the Internet Telephony Station Connection
•
ITSP for the Internet Telephony Point-to-Point Connection
The installation example describes the setup of a new ITSP for an Internet
telephony point-to-point connection. A preconfigured ITSP is essentially set up in
the same way, except for the fact that some of the data is already prefilled. For
more information, see IP Telephony (Voice over IP, VoIP) .
Other Scenarios
Other possible scenarios:
•
OpenScape Office LX networked with OpenScape Office MX as a gateway
for the ISDN outside line (see Scenario 3: Networking of
OpenScape Office LX and OpenScape Office MX (Single Gateway) )
Related Topics
7.1.1 Components of OpenScape Office LX
The installation example for OpenScape Office LX includes the components
described below.
In the installation example for OpenScape Office LX, an internal customer
network with an Internet router and a DHCP server is already available. Internet
access is configured in the Internet router. OpenScape Office LX is integrated in
the internal network via the network card of the Linux server. The IP stations (IP
phones, client PCs) are integrated in the LAN via one or more switches and
receive their IP addresses dynamically from the DHCP server of the internal
224
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Installation Example for OpenScape Office LX
network (e.g., from the DHCP server of the Internet router). The DHCP server of
OpenScape Office LX is disabled. To enable the software of the system
telephones to be updated automatically, the IP address of OpenScape Office LX
must be entered as the DLS address at each system telephone.
Internet
PSTN
P
PS
S
SIP Provider
LAN-Port
LAN Infrastructure incl.:
• LAN Switch
• Internet Router
• DHCP Server (DHCP ON)
UC Client
UC Client
OpenScape Office LX
(DHCP OFF)
IP Phone
100
IP Phone
101
Related Topics
7.1.2 IP Address Scheme
An IP address scheme is a definition of how the IP addresses are used in the
internal network. It is, at the same time, also a list of all IP addresses that occur
in the internal network. It lists the IP addresses of PCs, servers, Internet routers,
IP phones, etc.
To provide a better overview of the assignment of IP addresses, an IP address
scheme should be created.
Example of an IP address scheme with the IP address range 192.168.3.x:
IP address range
192.168.3.1 to 192.168.3.49
192.168.3.1
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Clients
Clients with a fixed IP address
Internet router (gateway)
225
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Installation Example for OpenScape Office LX
IP address range
Clients
192.168.3.10
Server PC (OpenScape Office LX)
192.168.3.20
E-mail server
192.168.3.50 to 192.168.3.254
PC clients & IP phones, also the IP address
range of the DHCP server; assignment
occurs automatically
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Prerequisites for OpenScape Office LX
7.1.3 Dial Plan
A dial plan is a list of all phone numbers available in OpenScape Office LX. It
comprises internal phone numbers, DID numbers, and group station numbers.
The dial plan should also contain the names of subscribers that can be assigned
phone numbers.
Default Dial Plan
In OpenScape Office LX, the internal station numbers are preset with default
values. These values can be adapted to suit individual requirements as needed.
Default dial plan of OpenScape Office LX.
Assignment of station numbers
Default phone numbers
Phone numbers for IP stations (max. 499 +1)
100 – 299 (+ 7070)
Station numbers for virtual stations (max. 70)
1025 – 1094
Announcement call numbers (max. 16)
#801 - #816
Station numbers for online users
7070
Call number for voicemail
71
Conference phone numbers (6 preset / max. 20)
7400 – 7404, 7430
Call number for parking
7405
AutoAttendant Phone Numbers (max. 20)
7410 – 7429
Seizure codes (6 preset / max. 64)
Seizure code 1 (external code)
0 = World / 9 = USA
Seizure code 2-6
80 – 84
Access Code for Music on Hold
226
#817
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Installation Example for OpenScape Office LX
Assignment of station numbers
Default phone numbers
Station number for Attendant Console
9 = World / 0 = USA
Substitution for “#” (for service codes)
72
Substitution for “#” (for service codes)
73
Individual Dial Plan
An individual dial plan can be imported in OpenScape Office LX via a CSV file
during the initial startup.
Besides the names and phone numbers of subscribers, the CSV file also includes
additional subscriber data such as the license types and e-mail addresses of the
subscribers.
A sample CSV file with the appropriate explanations can be found in the
OpenScape Office Assistant Administration Program under Service Center >
Download Center > CSV Templates. You can also use the CSV file stored there
as a template for your data.
Structure of a CSV file:
•
Column A contains the call number (possible values: 0-9,*,#)
•
Column B contains the DID number (possible values: 0-9,*,#)
•
Column C contains the name (in the format First Name Last Name or
Last Name, First Name)
The name of a subscriber can consist of up to 16 characters, but must not
include any diacritical characters such as umlauts or special characters.
•
Column D contains the subscriber type (e.g., 1=System Client, 2=SIP User,
3=SIP Fax, 4=RAS User, 5=Analog, 6=Analog Fax, ...)
•
Column E contains the license type (<no entry> or 0=No Licence, 1=Comfort
User, 2=Comfort Plus User)
•
Column F contains the e-mail address
Users of the UC Suite are automatically sent an e-mail with a link to the installation file(s) if their respective e-mail addresses were imported via the CSV
file.
•
Column G contains the mobile number (possible values: 0-9,*,#)
•
Column H contains the private number (possible values: 0-9,*,#)
•
Column I contains the node ID (possible values: 0-999)
This column must be assigned a value; otherwise, no import will occur. If the
system is not networked, 0 must be entered here.
•
Column J contains the IP address of the second gateway
IMPORTANT:
CSV files must be available in ANSI/ASCII format.
CSV files of older OpenScape Office versions are not supported.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
227
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Prerequisites for OpenScape Office LX
Related Topics
Related Topics
• How to Provision the UC Suite for Installation
•
Codes for Activating and Deactivating Features (LX/MX)
•
How to Configure Station Data
7.2 Prerequisites for OpenScape Office LX
Meeting the prerequisites for OpenScape Office LX ensures the proper operation
of OpenScape Office LX.
Hardware for Linux Server
For details on the hardware requirements of the Linux server, see Prerequisites
(LX/HX) .
Software for Linux Servers
For details on installing the Linux operating system on the Linux server, see
Prerequisites (LX/HX) .
The following additional software is required for the installation of OpenScape
Office LX:
•
DVD with OpenScape Office V3
Related Topics
Related Topics
• IP Address Scheme
7.3 Initial Startup of OpenScape Office LX
The initial startup includes installing Linux and OpenScape Office as well as the
standard setup with OpenScape Office Assistant based on the basic scenario
described at the outset.
More detailed information on topics not described in this initial setup can be found
in the Administrator documentation under the relevant topic area.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Remote Access (MX)
228
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office LX
7.3.1 Preparatory Steps for OpenScape Office LX
The preparatory activities include installing the OpenScape Office application on
the Linux server.
Related Topics
7.3.1.1 How to Install OpenScape Office
IMPORTANT: OpenScape Office overwrites any existing configuration files (e.g., for DHCP, FTP, Samba, Postfix, etc.) during the
installation.
Step by Step
1) Insert the OpenScape Office V3 DVD into the DVD drive.
2) Confirm the message with Run. The “Welcome” window appears.
3) Select English as the setup language and click Start.
4) Select OpenScape Office LX as the product and click Select.
5) An analysis of the existing hardware is started. If the hardware requirements
are not met, a warning is issued.
6) A window will appear with the Unify GmbH & Co. KG license agreement
(EULA, End User License Agreement). Read the terms of the license and
accept the license terms with Yes.
7) A check is performed to determine whether additional RPM packages need to
be installed. If yes, confirm this with Confirm. If this occurs, you will need to
switch back to the SLES 11 DVD later.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
229
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office LX
8) In the OpenScape Office LX installation example described here, a DHCP
server is already available (e.g., the DHCP server of the Internet router).
Consequently, cancel the configuration of the Linux DHCP server with No.
INFO: In order to ensure that the software of system telephones
can be updated automatically even when using an external DHCP
server, you have two options:
a) At each system telephone, the IP address of OpenScape
Office LX must be entered as the DLS address (see How to
Configure an IP phone).
b) The vendor-specific data must be entered at the external
DHCP server. Notes on this can be found under /var/log/
OPTI.txt.
INFO: For details on configuring the Linux DHCP server, see
Using the Linux DHCP Server (Optional)
9) After the installation, the Linux operating system needs to be restarted.
Confirm this with Continue.
10) If additional RPM packages need to be installed, you will be prompted to
insert the SLES 11 DVD. Confirm this with Continue. Following the
successful installation of the RPM packages, reinsert the OpenScape Office
DVD and confirm this with Continue.
11) The software of OpenScape Office is installed. The Linux operating system
then restarts.
12) During the restart, remove the OpenScape Office V3 DVD from the DVD
drive.
13) Following the restart, log in as a normal user. It now takes about 10-15
minutes until all components of OpenScape Office are enabled.
Related Topics
7.3.2 Checking Functions of OpenScape Office with OpenScape Office
Observer
The OpenScape Office Observer program can be used to check whether the
OpenScape Office application is operational.
OpenScape Office Observer can be started directly on the Linux server or from a
client PC in the internal network. In order to use the OSO Observer on a client PC,
the program must be copied from the Service Center of OpenScape Office
Assistant to the client PC.
Related Topics
230
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office LX
7.3.2.1 How to Start OpenScape Office Observer from The Linux Server
Step by Step
1) Open a terminal (e.g., a GNOME terminal).
2) Type in the command OsoStatus in the shell interface of the terminal and
confirm this with the Enter key. In the upper right corner of the screen,
OpenScape Office Observer opens and shows you the following:
IP address of the Linux server
Version number of the installed OpenScape Office software
Hard disk usage of the /home partition as a percentage value, e.g.: HD: 40
% LX
3) In the window you will also be informed about the status of OpenScape Office
with an LED display:
Red LED: OpenScape Office is not yet active
Green LED:: OpenScape Office is active
Related Topics
7.3.2.2 How to Copy OpenScape Office Observer to the Client PC
Prerequisites
•
OpenScape Office LX is installed.
Step by Step
1) Open the login page of OpenScape Office Assistant on the client PC by
entering the following address in your web browser:
https://<IP address of the Linux server>, e.g., https://
192.168.3.10.
2) If the web browser prompts you to accept or install a security certificate,
please follow this instruction.
3) If required, use the Language choice list to select in which language the user
interface of OpenScape Office Assistant is to be displayed.
4) In the User Name field, enter the default user name [email protected] for access as an administrator.
INFO: If you press the tab key after entering administrator,
@system will be added automatically.
5) In the Password field, enter the default password administrator for
access as an administrator.
6) Click Login.
7) You are prompted to change the default password.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
231
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office LX
a) Reenter the default password administrator in the Password field.
b) Enter a new password in the New Password and Confirm New
Password fields to protect the system against misuse. Note case usage
and the status of the Num key. The password is displayed as a string of
asterisks (*).
INFO: The password must be at least 8 characters long and
include a digit. Make sure that you remember your new password.
8) Click again on Login.
9) Click Service Center on the navigation bar.
10) Click in the Software area on the item OSO Observer.
11) Save the file OsoObserver.jar on the client PC in a directory of your
choice.
Related Topics
7.3.2.3 How to Start OpenScape Office Observer from the Client PC
Prerequisites
•
The file OsoObserver.jar is stored on the client PC.
Step by Step
1) Navigate on the client PC to the storage path of the OpenScape Office
Observer.
2) Double-click on the file OsoObserver.jar. The OpenScape Office
Observer opens as a small window in the upper right corner of the screen.
3) Enter the IP address of the Linux server on which OpenScape Office LX is
installed (e.g., 192.168.3.10) in the field of the OpenScape Office
Observer.
4) Click on Connect OSO.
5) Another window opens with the following contents:
•
IP address of the Linux server
•
Version number of the installed OpenScape Office LX software
•
Version of the Linux server operating system
•
Utilization of the \home partition and memory of the Linux server
6) In the window you will also be informed about the status of OpenScape Office
LX with an LED display:
•
Red LED: OpenScape Office LX is out of service
•
Green LED: OpenScape Office LX is operational.
Related Topics
232
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office LX
7.3.3 Using the Linux DHCP Server (Optional)
The DHCP server automatically assigns a unique IP address to each IP station
(IP phones, PCs, etc.) and provides the IP stations with network-specific data
such as the IP address of the default gateway, for example.
In order to enable automatic updates to the software of IP phones, a DLS server
is included with OpenScape Office LX. The latest phone software is stored on this
DLS server. If the IP address of DLS server is configured in the DHCP server, it
sends this data to the IP telephone as soon as it logs into the internal network.
This enables the telephone to retrieve the current software from the DLS server.
The DHCP server can be an external DHCP server (e.g., the DHCP server of the
Internet router) or the DHCP Server of the Linux server. In the installation example
described here, the use of an external DHCP server is assumed.
If the DHCP server of the Linux server is to be used instead, the external DHCP
server must be disabled. The configuration of the Linux DHCP server during the
installation of OpenScape Office is described below.
Related Topics
7.3.3.1 How to Enable the Linux DHCP Server
Prerequisites
•
The external DHCP server (e.g., the DHCP server of the Internet router) is
disabled.
•
The installation of OpenScape Office has been started (see How to Install
OpenScape Office ).
Step by Step
1) Run the installation of OpenScape Office up to step 7, as described in How to
Install OpenScape Office .
2) Click on Yes to activate the Linux DHCP server.
3) Enter the following values (preset with default values):
•
Default Route: IP address of the default gateway; as a rule, the IP
address for the Internet router, e.g., 192.168.3.1
•
Domain (optional): the domain specified during the Linux installation,
e.g., <customer>.com
•
DNS-Server (optional): IP address of the DNS server specified during the
Linux installation. If no DNS server is available in the internal network, you
can enter the IP address of the Internet router (e.g., 192.168.3.1) here.
•
SNTP Server: IP address of the internal or external NTP server (see also
Configuring a Uniform Time Base (LX/HX)
•
DLS/DLI Server: IP address of DLS server, i.e., the IP address of the
Linux server (e.g.: 192.168.3.10).
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
233
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office LX
•
Subnet: appropriate subnet for the IP address range, e.g.:
192.168.3.0.
•
Netmask: Subnet mask of the Linux server that was specified during the
Linux installation, e.g.: 255.255.255.0.
•
IP range begin and IP range end: IP address range from which the
DHCP server may assign IP addresses, e.g.: 192.168.3.100 to
192.168.3.254.
4) Click Continue.
5) Now follow the installation steps as of step 9, as described in How to Install
OpenScape Office .
Related Topics
7.3.4 Initial Installation of OpenScape Office LX
The Initial installation wizard of OpenScape Office Assistant is used to make
the basic settings for integration into the existing network.
Related Topics
7.3.4.1 How to Start the Initial Installation
Prerequisites
•
OpenScape Office LX is installed.
Step by Step
1) Open the login page of OpenScape Office Assistant on the Linux server by
entering the following address in your web browser:
https://<IP address of the Linux server>, e.g., https://
192.168.3.10.
2) If the web browser prompts you to accept or install a security certificate,
please follow this instruction.
3) Use the Language choice list to select in which language the user interface
of OpenScape Office Assistant is to be displayed.
4) If OpenScape Office Assistant is being started for the first time:
234
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office LX
a) In the User Name field, enter the default user name [email protected] for access as an administrator.
INFO: If you press the tab key after entering administrator,
@system will be added automatically.
b) In the Password field, enter the default password administrator for
access as an administrator.
c) Click Login.
d) Reenter the default password administrator in the Password field.
e) Enter a new password in the New Password and Confirm New
Password fields to protect the system against misuse. Note case usage
and the status of the Num key. The password is displayed as a string of
asterisks (*).
INFO: The password must be at least 8 characters long and
include a digit. Make sure that you remember your new password.
f)
Click again on Login.
5) If OpenScape Office Assistant has already been started at least once:
a) Enter the User Name and Password for access as an administrator.
b) Click Login.
6) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
7) Click Edit to start the Initial Installation wizard.
INFO: If the size of the browser window cannot display the
workspace in its entirety at low screen resolutions, a horizontal or
vertical scroll bar appears at the sides and can be used to scroll
to the required section.
Next steps
Perform initial installation as described in the following step-by-step instructions.
Fields that are not described here are preset for the default scenario and should
only be changed if they are not appropriate for your network data. For detailed
information, refer to the descriptions provided in the Administrator documentation
for the individual wizards.
Related Topics
7.3.4.2 How to Specify System Settings
In the System Settings window you can define system settings such as the name
of OpenScape Office LX, for example, or the country in which
OpenScape Office LX is operated.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
235
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office LX
Step by Step
1) In the Display Logo field, enter a name of your choice for
OpenScape Office LX (e.g., OpenScape Office or OSO LX). This name is
displayed on system phones.
2) In the System Country Code drop-down list, select the country where
OpenScape Office LX is operated.
3) In the Language for Customer Event Log field, enter the language in which
the customer event log is to be output.
4) Click OK & Next.
5) Click Finish.
Related Topics
7.3.5 Basic Installation of OpenScape Office LX
The Basic Installation wizard of OpenScape Office Assistant can be used to
make the most important settings for the operation of OpenScape Office LX.
Related Topics
7.3.5.1 How to Start the Basic Installation
Prerequisites
•
The Initial installation has been completed.
•
The Linux server and the OpenScape Office application are operational.
Step by Step
1) If the OpenScape Office application was not restarted, skip to step 3.
2) If the OpenScape Office application was restarted, log into
OpenScape Office Assistant again:
a) Open the login page of OpenScape Office Assistant by entering the
following address in your web browser:
https://<IP address of the Linux server>, e.g., https://
192.168.3.10.
b) In the User Name field, enter the default user name [email protected] for access as an administrator.
c) Enter the password you defined at the initial installation in the Password
field.
d) Click Login.
e) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
3) Click Edit to start the Basic Installation wizard.
236
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office LX
Next steps
Perform basic installation as described in the following step-by-step instructions.
Fields that are not described here are preset for the default scenario and should
only be changed if they are not appropriate for your network data. For detailed
information, refer to the descriptions provided in the Administrator documentation
for the individual wizards.
Related Topics
7.3.5.2 How to Configure the Country Code
The entry of the country code is important for Internet telephony and Meet-Me
conferences.
Step by Step
1) In the Country Code field, enter the country code prefix, e.g., 49 or 049 for
Germany. The country code entry is provider-specific.
2) The area code and PABX number need not be entered. For Internet
telephony, the PABX number can also be entered later.
Related Topics
7.3.5.3 How to Configure Network Parameters (Optional)
If OpenScape Office LX is to be integrated in a network (e.g., a network together
with OpenScape Office MX), then a node ID must be assigned to OpenScape
Office LX, and the station data must be configured uniquely across the entire
network.
Prerequisites
•
A CSV file with the station data exists.
Step by Step
1) If OpenScape Office LX is not to be integrated in a network, leave the
Networking Integration check box unselected and click on OK & Next. You
are taken to the Central Functions for Stations window (How to Configure
Station Data ).
2) In order to integrate OpenScape Office LX in a network, you will need to
perform the following steps:
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
237
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office LX
a) Select the Network Integration check box.
b) In the Node ID field for OpenScape Office LX, enter a node ID that is
unique in the internetwork (digits from 0 through 999 are possible).
c) Click OK & Next. You are taken to the Central Functions for Stations
window.
d) Since all station numbers must be unique in a network, the standard
station numbers must be deleted. Enable the Delete all station call
numbers radio button.
e) Enable the check box Delete all station numbers and click OK & Next.
You are taken to the Change preconfigured call and functional
numbers window.
f)
Adapt the preconfigured station numbers to the station numbers in the
network and click OK & Next. You are taken to the Import CSV file with
station data window.
g) Navigate to the storage location of the CSV file and click OK & Next. You
are taken to the Central Functions for Stations window (How to
Configure Station Data ).
Related Topics
7.3.5.4 How to Configure Station Data
If required, you can change the preconfigured call numbers for special functions,
delete all call numbers, or import previously defined station data via the Central
Functions for Stations window.
Step by Step
1) If you want to retain the preconfigured numbers (default dial plan), click Next.
You are taken to the Provider configuration and activation for Internet
Telephony window (How to Add an ITSP for the Internet Telephony Point-toPoint Connection ).
INFO: You can have an overview of all configured station
numbers displayed by enabling the radio button Display station
configuration and then clicking Execute function.
2) If you want to use a customized dial plan, you must delete the preset default
dial plan. To do this, proceed as follows:
238
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office LX
a) Enable the radio button Delete All station call numbers.
b) Enable the check box Delete All Call Addresses.
c) Click Execute function.
d) Some station numbers and function codes may not be deleted. You can,
however, edit the preset values. To do this, enter the required values in
the fields.
e) Click OK. All station numbers and function codes, except for those
displayed, are deleted.
f)
Click Next. You are taken to the Provider configuration and activation
for Internet Telephony window.
3) If you want to edit the predefined station numbers for special functions, e.g.,
the function codes for conferences, proceed as follows:
a) Enable the radio button Change pre-configured call and functional
numbers.
b) Click Execute function.
c) Enter the desired call numbers in the fields and click OK.
INFO: The new call numbers are saved. The call numbers
configured here are not available to subscribers or groups.
d) Click Next. You are taken to the Provider configuration and activation
for Internet Telephony window.
4) If you want to import your station data with the help of a CSV file, delete all
existing station numbers first and then specify the path of your CSV file.
a) Enable the radio button Delete All station call numbers.
b) Enable the check box Delete all station call numbers.
c) Click on Execute function, followed by OK.
d) Enable the radio button Stations configuration by importing CSV file.
e) Click Execute function.
f)
Use Browse to select the created CSV file and click Open.
INFO: For details on the structure of a CSV file, see Dial Plan .
g) Click OK when finished. The station data is imported.
h) Click Next. You are taken to the Provider configuration and activation
for Internet Telephony window.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Dial Plan
•
How to Provision the UC Suite for Installation
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
239
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office LX
7.3.5.5 How to Add an ITSP for the Internet Telephony Point-to-Point Connection
The Provider configuration and activation for Internet telephony window is
used to configure Internet telephony (DSL telephony).
Prerequisites
•
Field
The following ISP-specific Internet access data is available to you:
Description
Value from ITSP
Provider Registrar
IP address/Host name
Host name or IP address of the Registrar
server (e.g., sip-voice.de).
Port
Port number of the Registrar server (e.g.,
5060).
Reregistration interval at Provider (sec)
Interval (in seconds) at which ITSP registration is repeated. The value of the interval must not be 0 and must not be set too
high because on repeating the registration
at the ITSP, a dropped connection can also
be detected, and an alternate route (via
ISDN or an alternate Provider) may be
selected if required. Default value: 120
seconds.
Use Provider Registrar
Predefined by the ITSP and generally
always set.
Field
Description
Value from ITSP
Provider Proxy
IP address/Host name
Host name or IP address of the proxy
server (e.g., sip-voice.de). As a rule, this is
identical with the Provider Registrar entry.
Port
Port number of the proxy server (e.g.,
5060). As a rule, this is identical with the
Provider port number.
Field
Description
Value from ITSP
Provider Outbound Proxy
Use Provider Outbound Proxy
Only set if the ITSP uses an outbound
proxy.
IP address/Host name
Host name or IP address of the outbound
proxy
Port
Port number of the outbound proxy
240
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office LX
Field
Description
Value from ITSP
Provider STUN
Provider STUN IP Address
STUN IP address if the ITSP is using a
STUN server.
Provider STUN Port Number
STUN port number if the ITSP is using a
STUN server.
Step by Step
1) Clear the No call via Internet check box. A country-specific list of the
possible ITSPs is displayed.
2) Click Add in the first row to configure a new ITSP.
3) Assign a name of your choice for the ITSP in the Provider Name field.
4) Activate the check box Enable Provider.
5) Enter the gateway domain name of the ITSP in the Gateway Domain Name
field.
6) Enter the values provided by your ITSP in the remaining areas (see table
immediately after prerequisites).
7) Click OK & Next.
8) Configure the Internet telephony stations with the associated DID phone
numbers. You received this data from your ITSP.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
241
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office LX
a) Click Add.
b) Enter the name of the Internet telephony station in the Internet
Telephony Station field. (This is replaced by the Internet Telephony
Station Number field for some ITSPs such as T-Online, for example).
Enter the Internet telephony phone number here.)
c) Enter the authorization name in the Authorization name field. (This is
replaced by the E-mail Address field for some ITSPs such as T-Online.
Enter the e-mail address of the Internet telephony subscriber here.)
d) Enter the password for the Internet telephony station associated with the
ITSP in the New Password and Confirm Password fields.
e) Select the radio button Internet telephony system phone number in the
Call number type area.
f)
Enter the system phone number, for instance, 722, in the System phone
number (Prefix) field.
g) Enter the DID number range for the Internet telephony station in the ‘from’
and ‘to’ fields after Direct inward dialing band. The range entered by
default is 100 - 147.
INFO: The assignment of direct inward dialing (DID) numbers to
individual subscribers can be performed when configuring the IP
stations (see How to Configure IP Stations ).
9) Click OK & Next.
10) If you want to configure additional Internet telephony stations, click Add and
repeat step 8 .
11) If you do not want to set up further Internet telephony subscribers, click OK &
Next. You will once again see the overview of activated ITSPs.
12) Click OK & Next.
13) Enter the upstream value provided by your ITSP in the Upstream up to
(Kbps) field. The number of simultaneous Internet calls permitted is displayed
in the Number of Simultaneous Internet calls field. This value must not be
changed. It can be reduced if required.
14) Click OK & Next. You are taken to the Special phone numbers window.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• IP Telephony (Voice over IP, VoIP)
7.3.5.6 How to Enter Special Phone Numbers
Special phone numbers (incl. emergency numbers) can be entered via the
Special phone numbers window.
242
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office LX
Step by Step
1) Enter the special numbers you want in the Dialed digits column.
The following station number entries are valid:
0 to 9: allowed digits
-: Field separator
X: Any digit from 0 to 9
N: Any digit from 2 to 9
Z: One or more digits to follow up to the end of dialing
C: Simulated dial tone (can be entered up to three times)
2) Click OK & Next. You are taken to the Select a station - LAN Phones
window.
Related Topics
7.3.5.7 How to Configure IP Stations
The Select a station - LAN Phones window can be used to configure IP stations
(LAN phones and WLAN phones).
Prerequisites
•
A functional wireless LAN network is needed to operate WLAN phones.
Step by Step
1) Assign a DID number to the desired station. You have three alternatives for
this:
•
If you want the internal call number to be automatically assigned to the
station as the direct inward dialing number, activate the radio button Take
DID from changed call number.
•
If you want a different direct inward dialing number for the station than the
call number, enter a DID number for the station under DID in the row of
the desired station.
•
If you want an Internet telephony phone number to be assigned to the
station as the direct inward dialing number, leave the radio button Take
DID from changed call number unselected, and select the Internet
Telephony Service Provider from the list next to the radio button instead.
Then select the Internet Telephony phone number from the DID dropdown list in the row of the desired station.
2) Enter the internal station number for the subscriber under Call No in the
appropriate row of the desired subscriber. You can use the preset phone
number or assign some other free number.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
243
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office LX
3) In the row of the desired station, under Name, enter a name in the format
Last Name, First Name or First Name Last Name.
INFO: The name can consist of up to 16 characters, but must not
include any diacritical characters such as umlauts or special
characters.
4) Select the type of IP station (e.g., “System Client“, “SIP Client “ or “RAS
User“) from the Type drop-down list in the row of the desired station.
5) From the License Type drop-down list in the row of the desired station, select
whether the IP station is to be operated as a Comfort User or a Comfort Plus
User. The IP station will only be operational if one of the two license types has
been selected. For details on the different functional scopes offered by the
two license types, see Licenses .
INFO: You can use this procedure to configure as many Comfort
User and Comfort Plus User stations as the number of licenses
purchased. In the Licensed column you will see if the subscriber
is successfully licensed.
6) If you want to set up a fax box for the subscriber (which can be used with the
UC clients myPortal for Desktop or myPortal for Outlook, for example, but
is only possible as Comfort Plus Users), proceed as follows:
a) In the row of the desired station, in the Fax No. field, enter the desired
internal fax number at which the user can receive internal fax messages.
b) If you want to configure a DID number for the fax box, enter the desired
external fax number under which the subscriber can receive external fax
messages in the Fax DID field in the row of the desired subscriber.
7) Choose the desired Class of Service group in the row of the desired
subscriber from the Class of Service drop-down list.
8) To add the subscriber to a call pickup group, select a call pickup group from
the Call pickup group drop-down list in the row of the desired subscriber.
9) Make the settings described under this step only if needed:
a) Click in the row of the desired IP station on the pencil icon Edit.
b) Assign one DID number each for Internet telephony to the station and, if
desired, to its fax box in the Direct inward dialing for Internet
Telephony area. To do this, select the DID numbers from the drop-down
244
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office LX
lists of the desired ITSPs. For every active ITSP, you will be presented
with one drop-down list for the station and one drop-down list for its fax
box.
c) In the Clip/Lin field, enter a phone number (DID number or MSN) to be
displayed at the called party’s extension instead of the own phone number
in the case of an external call.
INFO: This feature must be released by the network provider.
d) Select the language for the menu controls on the phone from the
Language drop-down list.
e) From the Call signaling internal drop-down list, select and assign one of
a total of eight possible acoustic call signals for internal calls. The station
then will then send the modified ringing tone to other internal stations,
thus enabling its calls to be distinguished from other internal stations
(default: Ring type 1).
f)
From the Call signaling external drop-down list, select and assign one
of a total of three possible acoustic call signals for external calls (default:
Ring type 1).
g) Click OK & Next.
10) If you want to configure another IP station, repeat steps 2 through 9.
11) Click OK & Next. A list of all configured stations appears. This list is effectively a dial plan.
In addition, you will see how many user Comfort User or Comfort Plus User
licenses are available and how many of those are already being used. The
number of configured license types includes all the configured stations for the
license type. Consequently, there could be more stations configured as
Comfort Plus Users, for example, than the number of licenses available for it.
12) Click Print to print out the data of the configured stations.
13) Then click OK & Next. You are taken to the Edit Meet-Me Conference
Settings window.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Licenses
7.3.5.8 How to Configure a Dial-in Number for Conferencing (Optional)
The Edit Meet-Me Conference Settings window can be used to define the call
numbers and the conference dial-in numbers for conferences.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
245
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office LX
Step by Step
1) If required, change the predefined number for the conference in the Call
number field.
2) Enter the dial-in number (conference DID) for the conference with which
subscribers can dial into the existing conference in the Direct inward dialing
field. The dial-in number may only include the digits 0-9.
3) Click OK & Next. You are taken to the Edit E-Mail Forwarding window.
INFO: For more information, see Scheduled Conference (LX/
MX) ..
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Scheduled Conference (LX/MX)
7.3.5.9 How to Configure the Sending of E-mails (Optional)
The Edit E-Mail Forwarding window can be used to define the E-mail server via
which OpenScape Office MX should forward the e-mails. Voicemails, fax
messages and internal system messages can then be sent via this E-mail server
to one or several different configurable e-mail addresses.
Prerequisites
•
An e-mail account with a password exists with an e-mail provider, and you
know the access data for this account.
Step by Step
1) Enter the Outgoing mail server (SMTP) for the e-mail server to be used for
sending e-mails, e.g., smtp.web.de. Ask your e-mail provider for the
outgoing mail server if required.
INFO: In some cases, the sending of e-mails does not work
because the name of the outgoing mail server cannot be resolved.
To fix this problem, you must start the e-mail forwarding function
via Service Center > E-mail Forwarding and then enter the IP
address of the outgoing mail server instead of its name.
2) If a secure connection is required, enable the corresponding check box. If
required, check with your e-mail provider whether this option needs to be
enabled.
3) Enter the User Name of the e-mail account, e.g.,: john.doe.
246
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office LX
4) Enter the Password for the e-mail account and repeat it in the Confirm
Password field.
INFO: Entering the e-mail server is important if an e-mail with a
link to the installation file(s) is to be automatically sent to the users
of the UC Suite (see How to Provision the UC Suite for
Installation ).
5) Enter the E-mail Address, for example: [email protected]
6) If you want to test the entered e-mail settings immediately, proceed as follows:
a) Click Test Connection.
b) Under Send to e-mail address, enter the e-mail address of any e-mail
box that you can access. The test e-mail will be sent to that e-mail
address.
c) Under Subject in the e-mail, enter a descriptive text so that you can
identify the e-mail in your e-mail inbox.
d) Click Send Test E-mail. The e-mail settings are verified, and the e-mail
is sent to the specified e-mail address.
e) Check whether the e-mail has arrived in your e-mail inbox.
f)
If the e-mail was sent correctly, proceed to the next step.
g) If the e-mail delivery failed, click Back and correct your e-mail settings
(starting with step 1).
7) Click OK & Next followed by Finish. The basic installation is finished. Before
you perform the backup mentioned in the wizard, you should activate the
licenses.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• How to Provision the UC Suite for Installation
•
How to Provision the UC Suite for Installation
7.3.6 Closing Activities for OpenScape Office LX
After the initial installation and the basic installation with
OpenScape Office Assistant have been completed, some important settings
must still be made for the operation of OpenScape Office LX.
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
247
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office LX
7.3.6.1 How to Enable Remote Access
The Remote Access wizard can be used to provide authorized service technicians with access to the communication system via the Internet connection. This
ensures that support is available when solving administration tasks or performing
troubleshooting.
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
•
You have a port number which can be used for Internet access to the communication system by the service technician. This port number must not be
blocked by a firewall.
Step by Step
1) Click Service Center on the navigation bar.
2) Click on Remote Access in the navigation tree.
3) Click on Remote Access to start the Remote Access wizard.
4) Activate the radio button Remote access: on to enable remote access.
5) Enable the radio button Remote Access via: Internet to enable remote
access via the Internet.
6) Enter the port number you want to use for remote access in the Port Number
field.
7) Click OK & Next followed by Finish.
Related Topics
7.3.6.2 How to Activate Licenses
The basic license supplied with OpenScape Office LX and all additional licenses
procured must be activated within a period of 30 days. The time period begins
with the first activation of OpenScape Office LX. After this time period expires,
OpenScape Office LX will only operate in restricted mode. You can also complete
the licensing at some later time within this time period.
Prerequisites
•
You are logged into OpenScape Office Assistant, and the wizard for the basic
installation has been completed. You know the LAC (License Authorization
Code) for releasing the license and have a user ID and password for
accessing the license server. You need Internet access to connect to the
license server.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Basic Installation.
248
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office LX
3) Click Edit to start the Licensing wizard.
4) Enter the appropriate LAC in the License Authorization Code (LAC) field.
5) Select the check box to access the license server and enter the user name
and password in the User Name and Password fields.
6) Click OK & Next. The connection to the license server is established and the
license is released.
Related Topics
7.3.6.3 How to Provision the UC Suite for Installation
The UC Suite consists of the UC clients myPortal for Desktop,
myPortal for Outlook, myPortal for Zimbra, myAttendant and Fax Printer
and the Contact Center clients myAgent and myReports. The installation files
for the clients are stored on the hard disk of OpenScape Office and can be made
available to the IP stations automatically or manually.
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant.
INFO: In order to use myPortal for Outlook, myPortal for
Zimbra, myAttendant, myAgent and myReports, additional
licenses are required.
Step by Step
1) To enable the installation files to be provided automatically to an IP station,
make sure that the following steps have been performed:
a) The e-mail addresses of the IP stations and the associated subscriber
data must have either been already imported via a CSV file (see How to
Configure Station Data ) or entered later under Expert mode > Applications > UC Suite > User Directory.
b) An e-mail server must be entered (see How to Configure the Sending of
E-mails (Optional) ).
INFO: You can also enter an E-mail server later under Service
Center > E-mail Forwarding.
All IP subscribers whose e-mail addresses are known receive an e-mail with
a link to the installation directory of the clients and Getting Started Instructions. The installation folder also includes a Readme file with information on
installing the software on client PCs.
2) If the required steps for automatic notification are not fulfilled, you can also
make the installation files available manually. To do this, proceed as follows:
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
249
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office LX
a) Click Service Center on the navigation bar.
b) In the navigation tree, click Download Center.
c) Click on the desired client and save the zipped installation files on a
shared network drive.
d) Click on the documentation of the desired client and save the documentation file on a shared network drive.
e) Send the zipped installation files and the documentation file to the users
of the UC Suite by e-mail or inform the users about the storage location
of these files.
f)
The zip file with the installation files also includes a Readme file. Notify
the users that the installation of the clients must be performed in accordance with the installation notes in the Readme file.
g) Only for myPortal for Zimbra: Download the ZIP file of the zimlet for
myPortal for Zimbra and then upload the zimlet to the Zimbra server
(https://<IP-address of the Zimbra server>) with the option
Flush Zimlet cache.
INFO: The Zimbra server must be able to reach the communication system via port 8801.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Dial Plan
•
How to Configure the Sending of E-mails (Optional)
•
How to Configure Station Data
•
How to Configure the Sending of E-mails (Optional)
7.3.6.4 How to Perform a Data Backup
All previous changes to OpenScape Office LX must be backed up. The backup
can be saved as a backup set on the hard disk of the Linux server, in the internal
network or on a USB medium.
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant.
•
For a backup to a USB storage device (USB stick or USB hard disk), the USB
device must be connected to the USB port of the Linux server.
INFO: For details on backing up to an FTP server, see Backup
and Restore .
250
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office LX
Step by Step
1) Click Data Backup on the navigation bar.
2) In the navigation tree, click Backup - Immediate.
3) Enter a comment for the backup set in the Comment field in the Name area
so that the backup set can be easily identified if needed later for a restore.
Avoid the use of diacritical characters such as umlauts and special characters
in your input.
4) Activate the target drive on which the backup set is to be saved in the Devices
area.
5) Click OK & Next. The progress of the backup process is displayed in a
separate window.
6) The backup was successful if the message Backup completed successfully! appears. Click Finish.
7) If you are using a USB stick as the backup medium, wait until the LED of the
USB stick stops blinking. This ensures that the backup has been successfully
saved on the USB stick. You can then safely remove the USB stick.
8) This completes the initial setup with OpenScape Office Assistant. Exit
OpenScape Office Assistant by clicking on the Logout link on the top right of
the screen and the close the window.
INFO: If a new software version of OpenScape Office LX is
available, you will be notified about this on the home page of
OpenScape Office Assistant, provided the Internet connection
was set up correctly. If a new software version is available,
perform a full update (see Updating OpenScape Office ).
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Backup and Restore
•
Updating OpenScape Office
7.3.6.5 How to Configure an IP phone
To enable an IP phone to register at OpenScape Office LX, the defined call
number and IP address of the Linux PC must be entered at the phone, and the
settings for the Deployment Service may need to be changed.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
251
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office LX
Prerequisites
•
The IP phone is connected to the internal network and operational.
INFO: The configuration described here uses an OpenStage 40/
60/80 system telephone as an example. The same settings must
also be made for an SIP phone. For more information, refer to the
manual supplied with your SIP phone.
Step by Step
1) To reach the administration mode of the system telephone, press the appropriate key for the Settings/Applications menu on the phone.
2) Scroll through the Settings options until Admin and confirm this with the
OK key.
3) Enter the administration password (123456 by default) and confirm your
selection with the OK key.
4) Scroll to Network and confirm your selection with the OK key.
5) Enter the IP address of the Deployment Server (DLS) so that the software of
the system telephone can be updated automatically. This applies only to
system telephones. Proceed as follows:
a) Scroll to Update service (DLS) and confirm your selection with the
OK key.
b) Scroll to DLS address and confirm your selection with the OK key.
c) Specify the IP address of the Linux PC as the Deployment Server and
confirm your entry with the OK key.
d) Scroll to Save & Exit and confirm your selection with the OK key.
6) Scroll to IP configuration and confirm your selection with the OK key.
7) Scroll to Route (default) and confirm your selection with the OK key.
8) Specify the IP address of the Linux PC and confirm your entry with the OK
key.
9) Scroll to Save & Exit and confirm your selection with the OK key.
10) Navigate one menu level back with the Back key.
11) Scroll to System and confirm your selection with the OK key.
12) Scroll to Identity and confirm your selection with the OK key.
13) Scroll to Terminal number and confirm your selection with the OK key.
14) Enter the phone number set and confirm your selection with the OK key.
15) Scroll to Save & Exit and confirm your selection with the OK key.
16) Navigate one menu level back with the Back key.
252
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office LX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office LX
17) If the system telephone needs to be restarted due to the changes made, the
menu item Restart will appear in the Admin menu. Confirm the Restart
with the OK key and then also confirm Yes with the OK key. The system
telephone performs a reboot and logs in to OpenScape Office LX.
Related Topics
7.3.7 Uninstallation of OpenScape Office
OpenScape Office can be uninstalled via a text console.
Related Topics
7.3.7.1 How to Uninstall OpenScape Office
Step by Step
1) Open a terminal (e.g., a GNOME terminal).
2) Enter the command su (for superuser = root) in the shell interface and confirm
it by pressing the Enter key.
3) Enter the password for the “root” user in the shell interface and confirm it by
pressing the Enter key.
4) Enter the command oso_deinstall.sh in the shell interface and confirm it
by pressing the Enter key. Follow the instructions of the uninstallation
program.
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
253
Installing OpenScape Office HX
Installation Example for OpenScape Office HX
8 Installing OpenScape Office HX
The initial installation of OpenScape Office Assistant is described here with the
aid of a selected basic scenario.
Related Topics
8.1 Installation Example for OpenScape Office HX
The contents of the installation example for OpenScape Office HX include setting
up the ISDN trunk connection to the public network (PSTN) via HiPath 3000,
enabling Internet access via an existing Internet router (e.g., DSL) and configuring IP stations (system telephones, e.g., OpenStage). The detailed administration of the various features of OpenScape Office HX can be found in later
chapters.
Related Topics
8.1.1 Components of OpenScape Office HX
The installation example for OpenScape Office HX includes the components
described below.
In the installation example for OpenScape Office HX, an internal customer
network with an Internet router and a DHCP server is already available. Internet
access is configured in the Internet router. OpenScape Office HX is integrated in
the internal network via the network card of the Linux server. The IP stations (IP
phones, client PCs) are integrated in the LAN via one or more switches and
receive their IP addresses dynamically from the DHCP server of the internal
network (e.g., from the DHCP server of the Internet router). To enable the
software of the phone system to be updated automatically, the IP address of
OpenScape Office HX must be entered as the DLS address at each system
telephone.
254
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office HX
Prerequisites for OpenScape Office HX
PSTN
PS
S
Internet P
PSTN/ISDN
HG 1500
00
LAN Infrastructure incl.:
• LAN Switch
• Internet Router
• DHCP Server (DHCP ON)
UC Client
UC Client
IP Phone
100
S0
HiPath 3000
OpenScape Office HX
(DHCP OFF)
IP Phone
101
Related Topics
8.2 Prerequisites for OpenScape Office HX
The fulfillment of the prerequisites for OpenScape Office HX ensures the proper
configuration of HiPath 3000 with the admin PC and the operation of OpenScape
Office HX.
Hardware for Linux Server
For details on the hardware requirements of the Linux server, see Prerequisites
(LX/HX) .
Software for Linux Servers
For details on installing the Linux operating system on the Linux server, see
Prerequisites (LX/HX) .
The following additional software is required for the installation of OpenScape
Office HX:
•
DVD with OpenScape Office V3
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
255
Installing OpenScape Office HX
Prerequisites for OpenScape Office HX
Hardware for the HiPath 3000 Admin PC
•
1 GHz CPU
•
512 MB RAM for Microsoft Windows XP SP3 (32 bit)
•
1 GB RAM for Microsoft Windows Vista SP2 (32 bit) and Microsoft Windows
Server 2003 SP2 (32 bit)
•
100 Mbps LAN
•
1024x768 screen resolution
Software for the HiPath 3000 Admin PC
•
HiPath 3000 Manager E as of V9 R1.x.x
•
CLA (Customer Licence Agent) as of V1 (V1 R16.0.0 Windows)
•
Supported Web browsers:
•
–
Microsoft Internet Explorer Version 6 and later
–
Mozilla Firefox Version 3 and later
Java Edition 6 (1.6.0)
HiPath 3000 System Resource Requirements
The following resources of the HiPath 3000 communication system are required
by OpenScape Office HX and the UC clients:
256
•
In order to ensure that agents can be reached in the Contact Center at any
time, a B channel on an HG 1500 or STMI2 board is required for each agent
who is using an IP phone.
•
For each waiting call, an additional B channel is required.
•
A further B channel is needed to play Music on Hold for IP phones.
•
The additionally required number of B channels for announcements and the
voicemail box primarily depends on the phone traffic at the customer’s site
and the size of the Contact Center.
•
B channels are required for non-Contact Center applications as well. The
number of B channels for the remaining office phones must be determined
separately. This also applies to the required B channels for the office
voicemail box and the office fax.
•
Faxes to the Contact Center only work via T.38. An HG 1500 board supports
only two parallel faxes via T.38. An STMI2 board, by contrast, supports three
parallel faxes via T.38.
•
If Signaling & Payload Encryption (SPE) is enabled, 20% of the B channels
are used for SPE. MEB does not support SPE.
•
The system time of HiPath 3000, the Linux server and client PCs must be
synchronized with one another. If this does not occur, the agent status may
be incorrectly displayed. Otherwise, an NTP server with which all components
are synchronized must be installed on the Linux server of OpenScape Office
HX.
•
For performance reasons, the OpenScape Office Contact Center has
currently been released only for the HiPath 3800 communication system with
up to 64 agents. To determine the exact amount of system resources
available, the projection tool must be used (see also HiPath 3000/5000 V6.0,
Projection Tool, Description).
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office HX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office HX
•
The OpenScape Office Contact Center is currently not released on SIP
provider trunks.
Related Topics
8.3 Initial Startup of OpenScape Office HX
The initial startup includes the initial installation of OpenScape Office, the configuration steps required for OpenScape Office at the HiPath 3000 and starting the
OpenScape Office Assistant administration program.
More detailed information on topics not described in this initial setup can be found
in the Administrator documentation under the relevant topic area.
Related Topics
8.3.1 Preparatory Steps for OpenScape Office HX
The preparatory activities include installing the OpenScape Office application on
the Linux server.
OpenScape Office can be basically installed by two methods: through the
graphical user interface or in the text console mode. Installation in the text console
mode makes sense if another graphical user interface is present.
INFO: If problems occur during the installation of OpenScape
Office, the log file /var/log/oso_install should be checked.
Related Topics
8.3.1.1 How to Install OpenScape Office in the Graphical Interface
IMPORTANT: OpenScape Office overwrites any existing configuration files (e.g., for DHCP, FTP, Samba, Postfix, etc.) during the
installation.
Step by Step
1) Insert the OpenScape Office V3 DVD into the DVD drive.
2) Confirm the message with Run. The “Welcome” window appears.
3) Select English as the setup language and click Start.
4) Select OpenScape Office HX as the product and click Select.
5) An analysis of the existing hardware is started. If the hardware requirements
are not met, a warning is issued.
6) A window will appear with the Unify GmbH & Co. KG license agreement
(EULA, End User License Agreement). Read the terms of the license and
accept the license terms with Yes.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
257
Installing OpenScape Office HX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office HX
7) A check is performed to determine whether additional RPM packages need to
be installed. If yes, confirm this with Confirm. If this occurs, you will need to
switch back to the SLES 11 DVD later.
8) In the OpenScape Office HX installation example described here, a DHCP
server is already available (e.g., the DHCP server of the Internet router).
Consequently, cancel the configuration of the Linux DHCP server with No.
INFO: In order to ensure that the software of system telephones
can be updated automatically even when using an external DHCP
server, you have two options:
a) At each system telephone, the IP address of OpenScape
Office HX must be entered as the DLS address (How to Configure
an IP phone ).
b) The vendor-specific data must be entered at the external DHCP
server. Notes on this can be found under /var/log/OPTI.txt.
INFO: For details on configuring the Linux DHCP server, see
Using the Linux DHCP Server (Optional) .
9) After the installation, the Linux operating system needs to be restarted.
Confirm this with Continue.
10) If additional RPM packages need to be installed, you will be prompted to
insert the SLES 11 DVD. Confirm this with Continue. Following the
successful installation of the RPM packages, reinsert the OpenScape Office
DVD and confirm this with Continue.
11) The software of OpenScape Office is installed. The Linux operating system
then restarts.
12) During the restart, remove the OpenScape Office V3 DVD from the DVD
drive.
13) Following the restart, log in as a normal user. It now takes about 10-15
minutes until all components of OpenScape Office are enabled.
Related Topics
8.3.1.2 How to Install OpenScape Office in Text Console Mode (Alternative)
Prerequisites
•
This installation variant is possible if the graphical user interface is not
available.
Start the installation of OpenScape Office as follows:
258
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office HX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office HX
Step by Step
1) Start the Linux computer and turn off the graphical user interface if required.
The computer is started in text console mode. A screen with startup
messages and the following command line appears: <computer name>
login: _, e.g.,: linux-suse login: _
INFO: As an alternative to the Text Console mode, you can also
log in as an administrator (root) under the respective user
interface, call up the terminal program (e.g., console, xterm) and
begin with step 3.
2) Log in as the “root” user:
After several (system-dependent) messages have appeared, the following
command prompt is displayed:<computer-name>:~ # _, e.g., linuxsuse:~ # _
3) Insert the DVD with the OpenScape Office software into the DVD drive.
4) Enter the following command to mount the DVD drive in Linux: mount /dev/
cdrom /media/
The drive is mounted, and the following message appears: mount: block
device /dev/<drive-name> is write-protected, mounting
read-only, e.g., mount: block device /dev/sr0 is writeprotected, mounting read-only
5) Start the installation:
a) Enter the following command to switch to the directory with the installation
file: cd /media/ and press the Return (Enter) key.
b) Enter the following command to start the installation: ./<installation
file>, e.g., ./oso_install.sh, and press the Return (Enter) key.
The installation is started. After a few minutes, the following message
appears: OSO INSTALLATION as well as an input prompt to select the
language for the installation.
6) Enter1 for German or 2 for English and press the Return key.
Related Topics
8.3.1.3 Service Scripts of OpenScape Office
The following service scripts are installed together with the OpenScape Office
component:
•
oso_install.sh on the DVD:
This script is used to install OpenScape Office and is started from the
Autostart file on the DVD during the installation in the KDE User Interface.
•
/sbin/oso_basis.sh (with the start and stop parameters):
This script is used to manually start and stop OpenScape Office.
–
To start: /sbin/oso_basis.sh start
–
To stop: /sbin/oso_basis.sh stop
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
259
Installing OpenScape Office HX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office HX
•
/sbin/oso_deinstall.sh :
This script is used to uninstall the OpenScape Office.
•
/sbin/oso_status.sh:
This script is used to check the statuses of OpenScape Office.
Related Topics
8.3.2 Checking Functions of OpenScape Office HX with OpenScape Office
Observer
The OpenScape Office Observer program can be used to check whether
OpenScape Office HX is operational.
OpenScape Office Observer can be started directly on the Linux server or from a
client PC in the internal network. In order to use the OSO Observer on a client PC,
the program must be copied from the Service Center of OpenScape Office
Assistant to the client PC.
Related Topics
8.3.2.1 How to Start OpenScape Office Observer from The Linux Server
Step by Step
1) Open a terminal (e.g., a GNOME terminal).
2) Type in the command OsoStatus in the shell interface of the terminal and
confirm this with the Enter key. In the upper right corner of the screen,
OpenScape Office Observer opens and shows you the following:
IP address of the Linux server
Version number of the installed OpenScape Office HX software
Hard disk usage of the /home partition of the LKinux server as a percentage
value, e.g.: HD: 40 % LX
3) In the window you will also be informed about the status of OpenScape Office
HX with an LED display:
Red LED: OpenScape Office HX is out of service
Green LED: OpenScape Office HX is operational.
Related Topics
8.3.2.2 How to Copy OpenScape Office Observer to the Client PC
Prerequisites
260
•
OpenScape Office is installed.
•
The client PC and OpenScape Office HX can communicate with one another
over the LAN.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office HX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office HX
Step by Step
1) Open the login page of OpenScape Office Assistant on the client PC by
entering the following address in your web browser:
https://<IP address of the Linux server>, e.g., https://
192.168.3.10.
INFO: If OpenScape Office Assistant cannot be started, check
the LAN connection and repeat the call. If it still cannot be started,
check whether the IP address has been blocked by your firewall.
More detailed information can be found in the documentation of
your firewall
2) If the web browser prompts you to accept or install a security certificate,
please follow this instruction.
3) If required, use the Language choice list to select in which language the user
interface of OpenScape Office Assistant is to be displayed.
4) In the User Name field, enter the default user name [email protected] for access as an administrator.
INFO: If you press the tab key after entering administrator,
@system will be added automatically.
5) In the Password field, enter the default password administrator for
access as an administrator.
6) Click Login.
7) You are prompted to change the default password.
a) Reenter the default password administrator in the Password field.
b) Enter a new password in the New Password and Confirm New
Password fields to protect the system against misuse. Note case usage
and the status of the Num key. The password is displayed as a string of
asterisks (*).
INFO: The password must be at least 8 characters long and
include a digit. Make sure that you remember your new password.
8) Click again on Login.
9) Click Service Center on the navigation bar.
10) Click in the Software area on the item OSO Observer.
11) Save the file OsoObserver.jar on the client PC in a directory of your
choice.
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
261
Installing OpenScape Office HX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office HX
8.3.2.3 How to Start OpenScape Office Observer from the Client PC
Prerequisites
•
The file OsoObserver.jar is stored on the client PC.
Step by Step
1) Navigate on the client PC to the storage path of the OpenScape Office
Observer.
2) Double-click on the file OsoObserver.jar. The OpenScape Office
Observer opens as a small window in the upper right corner of the screen.
3) Enter the IP address of the Linux server on which OpenScape Office HX is
installed (e.g., 192.168.3.10) in the field of the OpenScape Office
Observer.
4) Click on Connect OSO.
5) Another window opens with the following contents:
•
IP address of the Linux server
•
Version number of the installed OpenScape Office HX software
•
Version of the Linux server operating system
•
Utilization of the \home partition and memory of the Linux server
6) In the window you will also be informed about the status of OpenScape Office
HX with an LED display:
•
Red LED: OpenScape Office HX is out of service
•
Green LED: OpenScape Office HX is operational.
Related Topics
8.3.3 Using the Linux DHCP Server (Optional)
The DHCP server automatically assigns a unique IP address to each IP station
(IP phones, PCs, etc.) and provides the IP stations with network-specific data
such as the IP address of the default gateway, for example.
In order to enable automatic updates to the software of IP phones, a DLS server
is included with OpenScape Office HX. The latest phone software is stored on this
DLS server. If the IP address of DLS server is configured in the DHCP server, it
sends this data to the IP telephone as soon as it logs into the internal network.
This enables the telephone to retrieve the current software from the DLS server.
The DHCP server can be an external DHCP server (e.g., the DHCP server of the
Internet router) or the DHCP Server of the Linux server. In the installation example
described here, the use of an external DHCP server is assumed.
If the DHCP server of the Linux server is to be used instead, the external DHCP
server must be disabled. The configuration of the Linux DHCP server during the
installation of OpenScape Office is described below.
Related Topics
262
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office HX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office HX
8.3.3.1 How to Enable the Linux DHCP Server
Prerequisites
•
The external DHCP server (e.g., the DHCP server of the Internet router) is
disabled.
•
The installation of OpenScape Office has been started (see How to Install
OpenScape Office in the Graphical Interface ).
Step by Step
1) Run the installation of OpenScape Office up to step 7, as described in How to
Install OpenScape Office in the Graphical Interface .
2) Click on Yes to activate the Linux DHCP server.
3) Enter the following values (preset with default values):
•
Default Route: IP address of the default gateway; as a rule, the IP
address for the Internet router, e.g., 192.168.3.1
•
Domain (optional): the domain specified during the Linux installation,
e.g., <customer>.com
•
DNS-Server (optional): IP address of the DNS server specified during the
Linux installation. If no DNS server is available in the internal network, you
can enter the IP address of the Internet router (e.g., 192.168.3.1) here.
•
SNTP Server: IP address of the internal or external NTP server (see also
Configuring a Uniform Time Base (LX/HX)
•
DLS/DLI Server: IP address of DLS server, i.e., the IP address of the
Linux server (e.g.: 192.168.3.10).
•
Subnet: appropriate subnet for the IP address range, e.g.:
192.168.3.0.
•
Netmask: Subnet mask of the Linux server that was specified during the
Linux installation, e.g.: 255.255.255.0.
•
IP range begin and IP range end: IP address range from which the
DHCP server may assign IP addresses, e.g.: 192.168.3.100 to
192.168.3.254.
4) Click Continue.
5) Now follow the installation steps as of step 9, as described in How to Install
OpenScape Office in the Graphical Interface .
Related Topics
8.3.4 Configuring HiPath 3000 for OpenScape Office HX
In order to set up HiPath 3000 for OpenScape Office HX, you will need to make
different settings in HiPath 3000 Manager E and transfer them to the HiPath 3000.
In addition, further settings must be made in the HG 1500 WBM.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
263
Installing OpenScape Office HX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office HX
Prerequisites
•
HiPath 3000 is operational. The stations and trunks have been set up in
accordance with customer requirements. A dial plan exists.
•
HiPath 3000 Manager E is installed in the required version on the admin PC,
and the admin PC and is connected to the HiPath 3000.
Interfaces
The following interfaces are used by OpenScape Office HX:
•
CSTA: for connection control
•
CorNet-NQ over IP: for AutoAttendant, announcements, voicemail and faxes
(T.38)
Optional OpenScape Office Functions
The following optional OpenScape Office functions require additional configurations to be performed in the HiPath 3000. Pilot numbers (dial-in numbers) must
be set up as virtual stations for the “Park”, “AutoAttendant”, “Fax”, “Fax Group”
and “Contact Center Fax” functions.
•
Voicemail group: a single voicemail box can be assigned to a group of
subscribers. If a call cannot be placed through to any member of the voicemail
group, e.g., because all are busy, then the call is redirected to the voicemail
box of this group.
•
Parking: An ongoing call is parked by dialing the station number of the virtual
station. This station number must be specified to enable the call to be picked
up at another phone. A parked call is visible in myAttendant only if a virtual
station has been created for it.
•
AutoAttendant: when a caller is switched through to the AutoAttendant, e.g.,
because the call was made outside normal business hours, the caller can be
automatically switched from there.
•
Fax: A virtual station must be created and set up as the fax destination. A fax
is handled as a fax only if it comes from a virtual Fax device (virtual station).
•
Fax Group: An incoming fax is to be distributed to multiple stations. To
achieve this, a fax group must be set up as a virtual station.
•
Contact Center Fax: A virtual station must be created and set up as the
Contact Center fax destination.
In addition, call destination lists must be created for the AutoAttendant and Fax
functionality so that the virtual stations configured there can be permanently
redirected to a voicemail box.
Related Topics
8.3.4.1 How to Load the CDB from HiPath 3000
The settings at the HiPath 3000 must be made in the CDB (customer database)
of PiPath 3000 using HiPath 3000 Manager E.
264
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office HX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office HX
Step by Step
1) Log into HiPath 3000 Manager E at the admin PC.
2) Click on File | Transmit in the menu bar.
3) Select the Communication tab.
4) In the Access area, enable the appropriate radio button, depending on the
type of connection from the admin PC to the communication system.
5) Enable the radio button Read/write CDB and click on System -> PC.
6) Click OK. The CDB will be transferred from HiPath 3000 to HiPath 3000
Manager E.
7) After the successful transfer, click OK and then on Close.
Related Topics
8.3.4.2 How to Enter the IP Address for the Linux Server of OpenScape Office HX
Step by Step
1) Click in HiPath 3000 Manager E in the menu tree of the system view on
Settings | Network | Basic Settings.
2) Enter the IP address of the Linux server of OpenScape Office HX, e.g.,
“192.168.3.1”, in the OSO IP Address field.
3) Click Apply.
Related Topics
8.3.4.3 How to Configure a Connection to an External SIP Registrar
Step by Step
1) Click in the system view in the menu tree on Settings | Network | Ext. SIP.
2) Select the check box Operate with external SIP-Registrar
3) Select the item HP4000 in the Environment drop-down list.
4) Enter IP address of the Linux server of OpenScape Office HX, e.g.,
“192.168.3.1”, under IP Address.
5) Click Apply.
Related Topics
8.3.4.4 How to Add IP Trunks for OpenScape Office HX
Step by Step
1) Click in the menu tree of the system view on Settings | Trunks/Routing | IP
Trunks.
2) Enter the number of IP trunks to OpenScape Office HX, e.g., “30”, in the input
field in the Number area.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
265
Installing OpenScape Office HX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office HX
3) Select the item Ext. SIP from the list box in the Number area.
4) Click Add. The new IP trunks with the type Ext. SIP are inserted into the
Trunks table.
INFO: Note the trunk numbers of the newly configured IP trunks
for further processing (e.g., “Trk. 17” to “Trk. 46”).
5) Click Apply.
Related Topics
8.3.4.5 How to Configure Route 8 for OpenScape Office HX
Prerequisites
•
Route 8 must not have been assigned to any trunk.
Step by Step
1) Click in the system view in the menu tree on Settings | Trunks/Routing |
Routes.
2) Select the route Trk Grp. 8 in the Routes area.
3) Enter the name of the route, e.g., “OSO HX”, in the Route Name area.
4) Delete the entry in the Route prefix area.
5) Leave all other settings unchanged and click Apply.
6) Click in the system view in the menu tree on Settings | Trunks/Routing |
Trunks.
7) Select the trunks added earlier and assign the previously defined route, e.g.,
“OSO HX”, to them in Routes column.
8) Click Check.
9) Click Apply.
10) Click in the system view in the menu tree on Settings | Trunks/Routing |
Routing Parameters.
11) Select route 8 (Trk. Grp. 8 or OSO HX) in the Routes list.
12) In the Route type area, enable the radio button PABX.
13) In the No. and type, outgoing area, enable the radio button Internal.
14) In the Call number type area, enable the radio button Internal / DID.
15) Leave all other settings unchanged and click Apply.
Related Topics
266
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office HX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office HX
8.3.4.6 How to Activate LCR (Least Cost Routing)
Step by Step
1) Click in the system view in the menu tree on Settings | Least Cost Routing
(LCR)| Flags and COS.
2) In the LCR Flags area, enable the check box Activate LCR.
3) Click Apply.
Related Topics
8.3.4.7 How to Configure an Outside Line
Prerequisites
•
One route is configured as the trunk access, i.e., the outside line.
Step by Step
1) Click in the system view in the menu tree on Settings | Routes.
2) In the Routes table, select the route for which the outside line is configured,
e.g., Trk Grp.1 or ISDN or CO.
3) Verify that the following values are correctly entered for Incoming PABX
number:
•
Country code: e.g., 49 for Germany
•
Local area code: e.g., 89 for Munich
•
PABX number: e.g., 667
4) Check whether the Location number check box is selected.
5) Click Apply.
6) Click in the system view in the menu tree on Settings | Least Cost Routing
(LCR)| Dial Plan.
7) Enter the following values in any row of the above table:
•
Name column: e.g., CO
•
Dialed digits column: OCZ
8) Select the entry 1 in the Routing Table column.
9) In the Routing table field between the two tables, select the entry 1.
10) Select the following entries in any row of the table below:
•
Route column: route with outside line, e.g., Trk. Grp 1 or CO
•
Dial Rule column: Dial Rule 1
•
min. COS choice list: 1 (to send faxes, for example)
11) Click Dial Rule-Wizard.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
267
Installing OpenScape Office HX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office HX
12) Select the item Dial Rule 1 in the Edited dial rule drop-down list.
13) Select the item Main network supplier in the Network provider’s method
of access drop-down list.
14) Enter the value A in the Dial rule format field.
15) Click OK.
16) Click Apply.
Related Topics
8.3.4.8 How to Set up the Dial Plan
Step by Step
1) Click in the system view in the menu tree on Settings | Least Cost Routing
(LCR)| Dial Plan.
2) Enter the following values in any row of the above table:
•
Name column: “OSO HX”
•
Dialed Digits column: e.g.,”-71” for accessing the OpenScape Office
voicemail box
3) Select the entry “2” in the Routing table column.
INFO: The number of the routing table, which is “2” in this case,
is automatically entered in the Routing table field.
4) Select the following entries in any row of the table below:
•
Route column: “OSO HX”
•
Column Dial Rule: “Dial Rule 2”
5) Click Dial Rule-Wizard.
6) Select the item Dial Rule 2 in the Edited dial rule drop-down list.
7) Select the item Corporate Network in the Network provider’s method of
access drop-down list.
8) Enter the value E1A in the Dial rule format field.
9) Click OK.
10) Click Apply.
Related Topics
268
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office HX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office HX
8.3.4.9 How to Define the Call Number for Accessing OpenScape Office
Step by Step
1) Click in the system view in the menu tree on Settings | System Parameters
| System Settings.
2) Click on Set OSO Access.
3) Select the item OSO HX in the Route drop-down list.
4) Enter the call number for the Open Scape Office voicemail box, e.g., “71”, in
the Call no.field.
5) Click OK.
6) Click Apply.
Related Topics
8.3.4.10 How to Enable E.164 Numbering
When E.164 numbering is enabled, a phone number that is stored in canonical
format can be dialed directly from the directories, the Favorites list and the Journal
of the communications clients myPortal for Desktop, myPortal for Outlook, etc.
Step by Step
1) Click in the system view in the menu tree on Settings | System Parameters
| Flags.
2) Select the E.164 numbering scheme check box.
3) Click Apply.
Related Topics
8.3.4.11 How to Set the Plus Product Flags
Step by Step
1) Click in the system view in the menu tree on Settings | System Parameters
| Plus Product Flags / MW.
2) Enable the following check boxes:
•
CSTA application active
•
Direction prefix send via CSTA
•
Enhanced CSTA-CAUSE handling activated
•
CSTA with CSP
•
Blind Transfer
•
MULAP Monitoring
•
Networked CTI domain
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
269
Installing OpenScape Office HX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office HX
3) Click Apply.
Related Topics
8.3.4.12 How to Configure the Settings of the Voicemail Box
Step by Step
1) Click in the menu tree of the system view on Settings | Auxiliary Equipment
| PhoneMail.
2) Enter the station number for the OpenScape Office voicemail box, e.g., “71”,
in the Station number field.
3) Enter a name for the OpenScape Office voicemail box, e.g., “voicemail”, in the
Name field.
4) Click Apply.
Related Topics
8.3.4.13 How to Configure Voicemail Groups
Step by Step
1) Click in the system view in the menu tree on Incoming Calls | Groups/Hunt
groups.
2) Select a group call number from the Group table (e.g., Index 1, 350) and
make the following settings:
a) Enter a name for the voicemail group in the Name column.
b) Select the item Voicemail in the Type column.
3) Select the desired subscriber in the Selection table and add that subscriber
to the Members table.
4) If you want to configure further voicemail groups, repeat steps 2 through 3.
5) Click Apply.
Related Topics
8.3.4.14 How to Configure Virtual Stations for OpenScape Office
Step by Step
1) Click in the menu tree of the System View on Set up Station | Stations.
2) Select a free station and enter the desired call number (pilot number) for the
virtual station in the Call No. field.
3) Click on Check to ensure that the desired call number is still free.
4) Enter the MSN of the virtual station in the DID field.
270
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office HX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office HX
5) Enter the name of the virtual station in the Name field.
The name should uniquely identify for which OpenScapeOffice function (Park,
AutoAttendant, Fax, Fax Group or Contact Center Fax) this station is
intended.
6) If you want to configure further virtual stations, repeat steps 2 through 5 .
7) Click Apply.
8) Select a newly created virtual station in the Station view in the Station
Selection table.
9) Enable the Virtual Station check box for this station.
10) Repeat the two preceding steps for all of the newly created virtual stations.
11) Click Apply.
Related Topics
8.3.4.15 How to Configure the OpenScape Office Type for Virtual Stations
Step by Step
1) Click in the system view in the menu tree on Set up Station | OSO Ports.
2) Select the virtual station to be configured in the OSO Ports Configuration
table.
3) Assign the desired OpenScape Office type to the virtual station in the Type
column.
•
AutoAttendant
•
Parking
•
Fax
•
Fax Group
•
Contact Center Fax
4) If required, assign the desired call number to the virtual station in the Call No.
column.
5) Repeat the last three steps for all virtual stations.
6) Click Apply.
Related Topics
8.3.4.16 How to Configure Call Destination Lists for Virtual Stations
Required for the OpenScape Office types Fax, Fax Group, Contact Center Fax
and AutoAttendant. In OpenScape Office, all incoming faxes and all incoming
calls at the AutoAttendant must be sent via virtual stations that are permanently
forwarded to the voicemail box. This is achieved through a call destination list in
which the voicemail box is defined as the first destination.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
271
Installing OpenScape Office HX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office HX
Step by Step
1) Click in the menu tree of the System View on Incoming calls | Call
forwarding.
2) Select a call destination list (e.g., 10) for the first OpenScape Office type (e.g.,
AutoAttendant) in the Call dest. list - Definition table and enter the call
number of the voicemail box (e.g., 71) in the Target 1 column.
3) Assign the virtual stations to the configured call destination list in the Call
dest. list - Station assignment area as follows:
a) Go to the row of the first virtual station of the first OpenScape Office type,
e.g., to call number 500.
b) In the Day, Night and Internal columns, select the same call destination
list that was set up in step 2 for this virtual station, e.g., 10.
c) Repeat steps a and b for the remaining virtual stations of the first
OpenScape Office type.
4) If you have created further OpenScape Office types, (e.g., Fax and Contact
Center Fax), configure the associated call destination lists for these
OpenScape Office types. To do this, repeat step 2 and 3.
5) Click Apply.
Related Topics
8.3.4.17 How to Transfer Settings to HiPath 3000
The settings are transferred to HiPath 3000 using HiPath 3000 Manager E:
Step by Step
1) Click on File | Transmit in the menu bar.
2) Select the Communication tab.
3) In the Access area, enable the appropriate radio button, depending on the
type of connection from the PC to the communication system.
4) Enable the radio button Read/write CDB.
5) Click PC > System followed by OK. The settings are transferred to HiPath
3000.
6) Then click OK and Close.
Related Topics
8.3.5 Connecting the Linux Server of OpenScape Office HX to HiPath 3000
After HiPath 3000 has been configured, the communication system must be
connected to the Linux Server of OpenScape Office HX over a LAN. The settings
of the HiPath 3000 are then transferred to the SQL database on the Linux Server
of OpenScape Office HX.
272
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office HX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office HX
Transfer the settings
Following the initial transfer of the settings via the CDB from HiPath 3000
Manager E to HiPath 3000, it will take some time until the data of HiPath 3000 has
been written to the SQL database on Linux Server of OpenScape Office HX, since
the database is fully recreated. For HiPath 3800, the transmission takes about 20
minutes, and for HiPath 3500, about 60 minutes. All other changes to the settings
are written to the SQL database faster.
Related Topics
8.3.5.1 How to Connect the Linux Server of OpenScape Office HX to HiPath 3000
In order to use the functions of OpenScape Office HX, the HiPath 3000 V8 and
the Linux Server of OpenScape Office HX must be able to exchange data in the
internal network.
Step by Step
›
Make sure that the subnet mask and the IP router settings of the Linux Server
of OpenScape Office HX are correct and add the Linux Server of OpenScape
Office HX to the internal network in which the HiPath 3000 V8 is located.
Related Topics
8.3.5.2 How to Check the Data Transfer with HiPath 3000 Manager E
When HiPath 3000 V9 and the Linux server of OpenScape Office HX are
connected to one another, the changed HiPath 3000 settings are automatically
transferred to the SQL database of the Linux server of OpenScape Office HX.
Depending on the communication system, the initial transmission may take some
time, since the SQL database needs to be recreated (for HiPath 3800, about 20
minutes and for HiPath 3500 up to 60 minutes). HiPath 3000 Manager E can be
used to check when the transmission has completed. However, a more convenient method to do this is available via the OpenScape Office Assistant administration program (see How to Check the Data Transfer with OpenScape Office
Assistant ).
Related Topics
8.3.6 Configuring OpenScape Office
In order to use of the features available in OpenScape Office optimally, you will
first need to configure OpenScape Office. This can be done by using the
OpenScape Office Assistant administration program.
Calling the OpenScape Office Assistant
After the installation of Linux, the OpenScape Office Assistant can be called via
the web browser of the Linux system and also from any other computer on the
LAN via its respective web browser with the following link:
https://<IP address of the Linux server>
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
273
Installing OpenScape Office HX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office HX
The Administration Concept section presents the OpenScape Office Assistant
administration program and shows you how to log into the OpenScape Office
Assistant (see How to Log Into OpenScape Office Assistant ). The individual
features of OpenScape Office and their configuration are described in the
sections that follow.
Related Topics
8.3.6.1 How to Check the Data Transfer with OpenScape Office Assistant
The OpenScape Office Assistant administration program can be used to check
when HiPath 3000 has completed he transmission of the HiPath 3000 data to the
SQL database on the Linux Server of OpenScape Office HX.
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant.
›
Information on the status of the transmission is provided on the start page
above the navigation bar by the following symbols:
Step by Step
Symbol
Meaning
HiPath 3000 has no connection to the Linux
server.
SQL data available since:
dd.mm.yyyy hh:mm
Current data has not yet been transferred from
HiPath 3000 to the Linux server. This is the case
after updating OpenScape Office HX, for example.
However, the functionality is not affected. OpenScape Office HX continues to work with the existing data. The updating of data via the HiPath 3000
takes place only after a manual update or after the
daily automatic update.
HiPath 3000 is connected to the Linux server, with
updated data.
HiPath 3000 is connected to the Linux server, with
ongoing data transmission from HiPath 3000 to
the Linux server.
HiPath 3000 is connected to the Linux server, but
the data transmission from HiPath 3000 to the
Linux server was aborted.
The display is updated every 10 seconds.
Related Topics
8.3.7 Installing the UC Clients
The installation files of the UC clients are stored in the download area in the
Service Center of OpenScape Office Assistant. These installation files must be
saved on the required client PCs and started there.
274
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Installing OpenScape Office HX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office HX
Related Topics
8.3.8 Networking Multiple HiPath 3000 Systems with OpenScape Office HX
This section discusses the specifics of integrating OpenScape Office HX in a
HiPath 3000 internetwork.
Scenario
Multiple HiPath 3000 V8 communication systems with a local OpenScape Office
HX connected to each of them are to be networked with one another. The
networking of HiPath 3000 as well as the connection of OpenScape Office HX
occur via the H.323-Q protocol (CorNet-NQ tunneled in the H.323 protocol).
OpenScape Office HX provides not only local features for the respective HiPath
3000 node (e.g., AutoAttendant, announcements, and fax), but also network-wide
functions (such as call forwarding, call transfer or conferencing). Features such
as voicemail or the Multimedia Contact Center are, however, always provided by
the OpenScape Office HX connected to the respective HiPath 3000 node.
Restrictions
The following restrictions apply for an internetwork with OpenScape Office HX:
•
Open numbering cannot be used. Only closed numbering is supported.
•
It is not possible to cross-link the OpenScape Office applications between the
local OpenScape Office HX systems. Consequently, the presence statuses of
users of other OpenScape Office HX nodes are not visible, for example.
•
A linked, multi-node call diversion or forwarding to OpenScape Office HX in a
foreign HiPath 3000 node will not be followed.
•
OpenScape Office HX is connected to the HiPath 3000 as an external H.323
gateway. Therefore, in this scenario, no additional networking with HiPath
4000 is possible via H.323-Q.
•
Only route 8 of the HiPath 3000 may be used for the connection of the
OpenScape Office HX.
•
Due to the licensing model, the HiPath 3000 internetwork with the integrated
OpenScape Office HX cannot be administered with the HiPath 5000 RSM.
Prerequisites
The following preconditions should be checked before the setup:
•
•
The components involved have the following states:
–
HiPath 3000 V9 R1.x.x or later
–
OpenScape Office HX V3R2.x.x or later
HiPath 3000 V9 and the networking of HiPath 3000 V9 and OpenScape Office
HX have already been configured (see previous sections).
Procedure
The steps described below must be performed on all HiPath 3000 nodes in the
internetwork where an OpenScape Office HX is locally connected.
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
275
Installing OpenScape Office HX
Initial Startup of OpenScape Office HX
8.3.8.1 How to Set the “Networked CTI Domain” System Flag
Activating the system flag “Networked CTI domain” enables CSTA monitoring for
IP trunks. The only exceptions are trunks to which route 8 was assigned.
Prerequisites
•
The admin PC is connected to the HiPath 3000 to be set up.
•
HiPath 3000 Manager E is open, and the CDB from the HiPath 3000 is loaded
(see How to Load the CDB from HiPath 3000 ).
•
Make sure that the IP address of the Linux server of OpenScape Office HX is
entered as an external H.323 destination (see How to Configure a Connection
to an External SIP Registrar ).
•
Verify that the IP trunks and route 8 are configured appropriately (see How to
Add IP Trunks for OpenScape Office HX and How to Configure Route 8 for
OpenScape Office HX ).
Step by Step
1) Click in the system view in the menu tree on Settings | System Parameters
| Plus Product Flags / MW.
2) Select the check box Networked CTI-Domain in the Plus Products Flags
area.
3) Leave all other settings unchanged and click Apply.
Next steps
Transfer the CDB back to the HiPath 3000 (see How to Transfer Settings to
HiPath 3000 ).
Related Topics
276
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Internet Access (MX)
9 Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
The communication system supports different connections to service providers
for Internet access and Internet telephony via an Internet Telephony Service
Provider (ITSP, SIP Provider). OpenScape Office MX also provides access to
outside lines via ISDN or analog connections through optional gateway modules.
Access to the Internet occurs via either an Internet modem or an Internet router.
In order to connect OpenScape Office MX to the Internet, the communication
system must be configured as described below. In the case of
OpenScape Office LX, access to the Internet is configured in the Linux operating
system and is therefore not a part of this documentation.
Access to an outside line occurs via additionally available gateway modules in
OpenScape Office LX and is described in the following. For OpenScape Office
LX, an external gateway is needed to access an outside line. The configuration of
the outside line is described in the instructions for the gateway.
Related Topics
9.1 Internet Access (MX)
A broadband connection (DSL or connection) is required for access to the
Internet. This provides for fast data transmissions over the Internet and enables
Internet (or DSL) telephony.
Internet Access via a DSL Connection
Conventional telephone lines are used for broadband Internet access via DSL
(digital subscriber line). The Internet access can be used at the same time as the
normal phone. Fax, analog phone or ISDN are also available during the DSL
connection. This makes it possible to implement Internet access that is permanently available as in the case of a dedicated line (flat rate).
For Internet access via DSL, you need a modular jack (analog or ISDN) and an
Internet Service Provider (ISP). The ISP provides a splitter and an Internet
modem (DSL modem) or an Internet router with a built-in Internet modem. The
splitter divides the signal into DSL and telephony parts and forwards the DSL
signals to the Internet modem.
The communication system can be connected directly to the Internet modem or
to the Internet router with an integrated Internet modem. In the first case, the
access data of the ISP must be entered in the communication system; in the
second, the Internet router must be made known to the communication system.
The access data of the ISP is saved in the Internet router.
To use Internet telephony, you will also need an Internet Telephony Service
Provider (ITSP, SIP provider).
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
277
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Internet Access (MX)
Internet Access via a Cable Connection
The broadband connection to the Internet is implemented via the TV cable. In
addition to transmitting TV signals, the TV cable connection can be used for
accessing the Internet and making calls. This means you do not need a telephone
line to surf and for telephony.
For Internet access via cable, you need a cable provider that offers this feature.
The cable provider is also your Internet Service Provider (ISP). This cable
provider supplies you with a cable port with a back channel and a cable modem
that transmits the data over the TV cable network. The cable port and the communication system are connected to the cable modem over Ethernet. Internet data
filtration takes place directly in the cable modem.
The communication system can be connected directly to the cable modem or to
an Internet router that is connected to the cable modem. In both cases, the cable
modem or the Internet router must be made known to the communication system.
To use Internet telephony, you will also need an Internet Telephony Service
Provider (ITSP, SIP provider).
Configuring Internet Access
Internet access is configured with OpenScape Office Assistant. You have the
following options:
•
Internet access via an external Internet router
You want to operate the communication system at an external Internet router.
The communication system and the Internet router are either in the same LAN
segment or in different LAN segments. This variant also applies if you want to
access the Internet with a cable modem.
•
Internet access via an Internet modem
You want to operate the communication system directly at an Internet
modem. Use the WAN port for this.
•
Deactivate Internet access (default setting)
You do not want to use the Internet. Then leave the WAN port disabled.
Related Topics
9.1.1 Internet Access via an External Internet Router (MX)
The Network Configuration wizard helps you configure your Internet access via
an additional Internet router.
To set up Internet access, you have the following options:
•
The communication system and the Internet router are in the same LAN
segment. In this case, you must enter the IP address of the Internet router and
that of the DNS server and connect the Internet router with the LAN port of the
communication system.
•
The communication system and the Internet router are to be located in
different LAN segments. You will need to configure your WAN port as a LAN
port for this. This scenario requires a network specialist and is not covered in
this documentation.
Related Topics
278
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Internet Access (MX)
9.1.1.1 How to Connect to the Internet Router
The Internet Configuration wizard helps you configure the Internet access if
OpenScape Office MX is operated downstream of an additional Internet router.
OpenScape Office MX and the Internet router are in the same LAN segment. You
must enter the IP address of the Internet router and the DNS server for this.
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
•
OpenScape Office MX is connected to the internal network via the UPLINK
LAN port. The connection must not use the WAN port, since this is disabled.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Network / Internet.
3) Click Edit to start the Internet Configuration wizard.
4) Activate the radio button TCP/IP at LAN Port 4 (UPLINK) via an external
router and click OK & Next.
5) Enter the IP address of the local DNS server (e.g., the Internet router) or the
Internet DNS server (for Internet telephony, for example) in the IP Address
of DNS Server field.
6) Enter the IP address of the external Internet router in the IP Address of
Default Router field.
7) Click OK & Next followed by Finish.
Related Topics
9.1.2 Internet Access via an Internet Modem (MX)
The Internet Configuration wizard helps you configure your Internet access via
an Internet modem. An Internet modem is directly connected for this to the WAN
port on your communication system. You can use an ISP that was preconfigured
in the communication system or a standard ISP type (consult ISP for type).
To set up Internet access, you have the following options:
•
Setting up Internet Access via a Preconfigured ISP
You are using an ISP preconfigured in the communication system. You can
then select your preconfigured ISP from a list.
•
Setting up Internet Access via the Standard ISP PPPoE
You are using the standard ISP type Provider PPPoE. Obtain the required
settings from your ISP.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
279
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Internet Access (MX)
•
Setting up Internet Access via the Standard ISP PPTP
You are using the standard ISP type Provider PPTP. Obtain the required
settings from your ISP.
INFO: You can also use the WAN port to operate
OpenScape Office MX as a router between two internal networks.
OpenScape Office MX uses the integrated router function to
enable communication between two different internal networks.
More Information can be found in the Administrator documentation in the topic Network under Configuring the WAN
Connection as a LAN Connection.
Connection Clear-down Depending on the Tariff Model
Depending on the tariff model, you can define whether or not the connection to
the ISP should be maintained in the event of inactivity.
•
With the flat-rate tariff model, the Internet connection does not have to time
out on inactivity. Many ISPs require forced timeout every 24 hours. You can
enter the time when the connection should time out.
•
With the time-based tariff model, the Internet connection should time out on
inactivity. You can specify the inactivity timeout for connection clear-down (for
instance, 60 seconds). The connection is automatically reestablished the next
time an Internet request is made. If VPN is configured, the connection should
not be cleared due to inactivity; the flat rate tariff model should hence be
selected here.
INFO: Network-based programs or services can automatically
set up an Internet connection and thereby incur additional
connection charges for you if your tariff is time-based.
Bandwidth
Different bandwidths for downloading and uploading are usually provided by the
ISP. The bandwidth is specified in Kbps. If Internet telephony is also used, the
bandwidth is shared by voice and data transmission. We therefore recommend
reserving sufficient bandwidth to guarantee good voice quality during voice transmission. However, this can lead to data transfer bottlenecks (for example, slower
downloads) during periods with a high volume of voice transmissions.
You can choose whether bandwidth control for voice connections should be
enabled only for uploading for both uploading and downloading. If the download
bandwidth is high and the upload bandwidth is low, bandwidth control should be
enabled only for uploading to prevent an unnecessarily high amount of download
bandwidth from being reserved for voice transmissions.
INFO: About 128 Kbps of bandwidth is reserved for an Internet
call.
Related Topics
280
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Internet Access (MX)
9.1.2.1 How to Configure Internet Access via a Preconfigured ISP
You can use the Internet Configuration wizard to set up your Internet access via
a preconfigured Internet Service Provider (ISP) in the communication system.
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
•
Your ISP’s Internet access data is available (for example, user account,
password, etc.).
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Network / Internet.
3) Click Edit to start the Internet Configuration wizard.
4) Activate the radio button DSL at WAN Port directly and click OK & Next.
5) Select your ISP from the Internet Service Provider Selection drop-down
list.
6) Enter the access data that you received from your ISP in the Internet Access
Data for... area. The fields in this area ate provider-specific. When entering
your data, bear in mind that the input is case-sensitive!
7) Depending on your tariff model, select one of the following two options under
Full-Time Circuit in the Router Settings area:
•
If you have a flat rate tariff model, enable the radio button On. In the
Forced Disconnect at (hour:min) field, enter the time at which the
Internet connection is to be deactivated (e.g., 04:59).
•
If you have a time-based tariff model, enable the radio button Off. In the
Disconnect automatically after (seconds) field, enter the duration of
inactivity after which the connection is to be dropped (e.g., 60 seconds).
8) Set the following values in the QoS Parameters area:
a) In the Bandwidth for Downloads and Bandwidth for Uploads fields,
enter the bandwidth in Kbps for downloads and uploads, respectively, as
provided by your ISP.
b) If you want to use Internet Telephony as well, open the drop-down list
Bandwidth Control for Voice Connections and select the item Upload
only or Upload and Download, as required. In the field Bandwidth
Used for Voice/Fax (%), enter how much bandwidth is to be reserved for
voice and fax connections as a percentage value (default value: 80%).
9) Click OK & Next. You are taken to the Configure DynDNS-Account
window.
10) If you want to use a VPN or remote access, you will need to have already
applied for and set up a DynDNS account (at dyndns.org, for example).
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
281
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Internet Access (MX)
a) Enter the data of your DynDNS account.
b) Test the DynDNS account with Connection test.
c) After the test succeeds, click OK.
d) Click OK & Next.
11) If you want to use neither a VPN nor remote access, click No DynDNS.
12) Click Finish. OpenScape Office MX performs a reboot.
Related Topics
9.1.2.2 How to Configure Internet Access via the Standard ISP PPPoE
You can use the Internet Configuration wizard to set up your Internet access via
the standard Internet Service Provider PPPoE.
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
•
The following ISP-specific Internet access data is available to you:
Field
Description
Value from ISP
IP Parameters (only for a fixed IP address)
Remote IP Address of the PPP
Connection
IP address of your ISP’s server.
Local IP Address of the PPP Connection
IP address that was assigned to you by your
ISP for Internet access.
Maximum Data Packet Size (Bytes) Maximum packet length in bytes applicable
for the IP protocol. Values between 576 and
1500 are permitted.
Authentication (via PAP or CHAP). PAP is seldom used, since the authentication is unencrypted.
PPP User Name
User name that was assigned to you by
your ISP for the PPP connection.
PAP Authentication Mode
Authentication mode for the PPP connection over PAP: PAP Client, PAP Host or
Not used.
PAP Password
Password assigned to you by the ISP for
PAP authentication
CHAP Authentication Mode
Authentication mode for PPP connection via
CHAP: CHAP Client, CHAP Host, CHAP
Client and Host or Not used.
CHAP Password
Password assigned to you by the ISP for
CHAP authentication
282
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Internet Access (MX)
Field
Description
Value from ISP
QoS Parameters of Interface
Bandwidth for Downloads
Value of the full download bandwidth in
Kbps provided by the ISP.
Bandwidth for Uploads
Value of the full upload bandwidth in Kbps
provided by the ISP.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Network / Internet.
3) Click Edit to start the Internet Configuration wizard.
4) Activate the radio button DSL at WAN Port directly and click OK & Next.
5) From the Internet Service Provider Selection drop-down list, select the
standard ISP Type Provider PPPoE.
6) The settings in the IP Parameters area depend on whether or not you obtain
a dynamic or fixed IP address from your ISP.
•
Dynamic IP address: Make sure that the IP Parameters check box is
disabled.
•
Fixed IP address: Enable the IP Parameters check box. In the Remote
IP Address of the PPP Connection, Local IP Address of the PPP
Connection and Max. Data Packet Size (bytes) fields, enter the values
that you have received from your ISP. From the IP Address Negotiation
drop-down list, select the item Use configured IP address.
7) Depending on your tariff model, select one of the following two options under
Full-Time Circuit in the Router Settings area:
•
If you have a flat rate tariff model, enable the radio button On. In the
Forced Disconnect at (hour:min) field, enter the time at which the
Internet connection is to be deactivated (e.g., 04:59).
•
If you have a time-based tariff model, enable the radio button Off. In the
Disconnect automatically after (seconds) field, enter the duration of
inactivity after which the connection is to be dropped (e.g., 60 seconds).
8) The settings in the Authentication area depend on whether or not the ISP
requires authentication via PPP.
•
Authentication required by ISP: Make sure that the check box PPP
Authentication is enabled. Enter the Internet access name of the ISP as
the PPP user name. The customary standard is the CHAP Client authentication mode.
•
Authentication not required by ISP: Make sure that the check box PPP
Authentication is disabled.
9) If you want to use NAT, enable the NAT check box (enabled by default) in the
Address Translation area.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
283
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Internet Access (MX)
10) If you want to use IP mapping, enable the Address Mapping check box
(disabled by default) in the Address Translation area.
11) Set the following values in the QoS Parameters of Interface area:
a) In the Bandwidth for Downloads and Bandwidth for Uploads fields,
enter the bandwidth in Kbps for downloads and uploads, respectively, as
provided by your ISP.
b) If you want to use Internet Telephony as well, open the drop-down list
Bandwidth Control for Voice Connections and select the item Upload
only or Upload and Download, as required. In the field Bandwidth
Used for Voice/Fax (%), enter how much bandwidth is to be reserved for
voice and fax connections as a percentage value (default value: 80%).
12) Click OK & Next. You are taken to the Configure DynDNS-Account
window.
13) If you want to use a VPN or remote access, you will need to have already
applied for and set up a DynDNS account (at dyndns.org, for example).
a) Enter the data of your DynDNS account.
b) Test the DynDNS account with Connection test.
c) After the test succeeds, click OK.
d) Click OK & Next.
14) If you want to use neither a VPN nor remote access, click No DynDNS.
15) Click Finish. OpenScape Office MX performs a reboot.
Related Topics
9.1.2.3 How to Configure Internet Access via the Standard ISP PPTP
You can use the Internet Configuration wizard to set up your Internet access via
the standard Internet Service Provider PPTP.
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
•
The following ISP-specific Internet access data is available to you:
Field
Description
Value from ISP
IP Parameters (only for a fixed IP address)
Remote IP Address of the PPP
Connection
IP address of your ISP’s server.
Local IP Address of the PPP Connection
IP address that was assigned to you by
your ISP for Internet access.
Maximum Data Packet Size (Bytes) Maximum packet length in bytes applicable for the IP protocol. Values between 576
and 1500 are permitted.
PPTP Parameter
284
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Internet Access (MX)
Field
Description
Local IP Address of the Control
Connection
IP address that was assigned to you by
your ISP for the PPTP connection. The
default value is 10.0.0.140.
Remote IP Address of the Control
Connection
IP address of your ISP’s server for the
PPTP connection. The default value is
10.0.0.138.
Remote Netmask for the Control
Connection
Subnet mask that was assigned to you by
your ISP for the PPTP connection. The
default value is 255.255.255.248.
Value from ISP
Authentication (via PAP or CHAP). PAP is seldom used, since the authentication is unencrypted.
PPP User Name
User name that was assigned to you by
your ISP for the PPP connection.
PAP Authentication Mode
Authentication mode for the PPP connection over PAP: PAP Client, PAP Host or
Not used.
PAP Password
Password assigned to you by the ISP for
PAP authentication
CHAP Authentication Mode
Authentication mode for PPP connection
via CHAP: CHAP Client, CHAP Host,
CHAP Client and Host or Not used.
CHAP Password
Password assigned to you by the ISP for
CHAP authentication
QoS Parameters of Interface
Bandwidth for Downloads
Value of the full download bandwidth in
Kbps provided by the ISP.
Bandwidth for Uploads
Value of the full upload bandwidth in Kbps
provided by the ISP.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Network / Internet.
3) Click Edit to start the Internet Configuration wizard.
4) Activate the radio button DSL at WAN Port directly and click OK & Next.
5) From the Internet Service Provider Selection drop-down list, select the
standard ISP Type Provider PPTP.
6) The settings in the IP Parameters area depend on whether or not you obtain
a dynamic or fixed IP address from your ISP.
•
Dynamic IP address: Make sure that the IP Parameters check box is
disabled.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
285
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Internet Access (MX)
•
Fixed IP address: Enable the IP Parameters check box. In the Remote
IP Address of the PPP Connection, Local IP Address of the PPP
Connection and Max. Data Packet Size (bytes) fields, enter the values
that you have received from your ISP. From the IP Address Negotiation
drop-down list, select the item Use configured IP address.
7) Enter the values that you received from your ISP in the PPTP Parameter
area.
8) If you have a time-based tariff model, select the Short Hold check box. In the
Short Hold Time (sec) field, enter the duration of inactivity after which the
connection is to be dropped (e.g., 60 seconds).
9) The settings in the Authentication area depend on whether or not the ISP
requires authentication via PPP.
•
Authentication required by ISP: Make sure that the check box PPP
Authentication is enabled. Enter the Internet access name of the ISP as
the PPP user name. Make the PAP and CHAP settings, as assigned to
you by your ISP.
•
Authentication not required by ISP: Make sure that the check box PPP
Authentication is disabled.
10) If you want to use NAT, enable the NAT check box (enabled by default) in the
Address Translation area.
11) If you want to use IP mapping, enable the Address Mapping check box
(disabled by default) in the Address Translation area.
12) Set the following values in the QoS Parameters of Interface area:
a) In the Bandwidth for Downloads and Bandwidth for Uploads fields,
enter the bandwidth in Kbps for downloads and uploads, respectively, as
provided by your ISP.
b) If you want to use Internet Telephony as well, open the drop-down list
Bandwidth Control for Voice Connections and select the item Upload
only or Upload and Download, as required. In the field Bandwidth
Used for Voice/Fax (%), enter how much bandwidth is to be reserved for
voice and fax connections as a percentage value (default value: 80%).
13) Click OK & Next. You are taken to the Configure DynDNS-Account
window.
14) If you want to use a VPN or remote access, you will need to have already
applied for and set up a DynDNS account (at dyndns.org, for example).
a) Enter the data of your DynDNS account.
b) Test the DynDNS account with Connection test.
c) After the test succeeds, click OK.
d) Click OK & Next.
15) If you want to use neither a VPN nor remote access, click No DynDNS.
16) Click Finish. OpenScape Office MX performs a reboot.
Related Topics
286
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Internet Access (MX)
9.1.3 WAN Port (MX)
WANs (Wide Area Network) are used to network different LANs (Local Area
Network) as well as individual computers with one another. An Internet modem
for access to the Internet can be connected to the WAN port.
The WAN port must not be used for the networking of network nodes and for
connecting IP stations or IP clients.
Related Topics
9.1.4 NAT (MX)
NAT (network address translation) is a procedure for replacing one IP address in
a data packet with another. The clients in an internal network use private IP
addresses. As private IP addresses are not forwarded in a public network, you
can use NAT to map the private IP addresses to a public IP address. This gives
internal clients access to the public network while masking the structure of the
internal network with its private IP addresses and keeping it separate from the
public network (for example, the Internet).
Address translation is performed at the gateway between an internal and a public
network. NAT can run on an Internet router, a server or another specialized
device. An Internet router can use NAT, for instance, to connect the internal
network to the Internet.
The internal network appears on the Internet with only a single public IP address,
which is assigned to the Internet router by the Internet Service Provider (ISP). All
access attempts made from the internal network are routed via this official IP
address with different port numbers. The Internet router replaces the private IP
addresses with the official IP address assigned by the ISP. In the case of incoming
data packets, the official IP address is replaced by the private IP addresses. The
relevant port numbers are important for allocation. Only specially enabled private
IP addresses can be reached directly from the Internet.
NAT rules
You can use NAT rules to define if private (local) IP addresses should be reached
directly from the Internet. Individual NAT rules can be defined for this or the
default NAT rules already set can be used for the services FTP Server, HTTP
Server, etc. A total of 20 NAT rules can be defined. In order to use the NAT rules,
the local address data of the client PC that will provide these services for the
Internet must be entered, and the NAT rule must be activated. Multiple NAT rules
can be configured together with the help of a NAT table editor. You can delete
NAT rules that are no longer needed.
Related Topics
9.1.4.1 How to Configure a NAT Rule
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
287
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Internet Access (MX)
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Routing.
3) Configure the NAT rule:
•
If you want to define a new NAT rule, click on NAT in the menu tree and
then on the Add NAT tab.
•
If you want to edit an existing NAT rule, navigate in the NAT menu tree
down to the desired NAT rule.
4) Enter a name for the NAT rule in the Description field. In the case of a
standard NAT rule, this name cannot be changed.
5) Enter the IP address you want to enable for the client in the internal network
in the Local IP Address field.
6) Enter the port number used by the internal client’s application in the Local
Port field.
7) Enter the port number used by the external communication partner’s application in the Global Port field.
8) In the Protocol drop-down list, select the transport protocol (TCP or UDP)
used by the application. The protocol cannot be changed in the case of a
standard NAT rule.
9) Select the radio button NAT Rule Active if you want to apply the NAT rule.
10) Click Apply followed by OK. The activated NAT rule is identified under the
menu item NAT with a green symbol.
Related Topics
9.1.4.2 How to Configure NAT Rules with the NAT Table Editor
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation bar, click on Telephony > Routing.
3) In the menu tree, click on Routing.
4) Click in the NAT menu tree and then on the NAT Table Editor tab.
5) Configure the NAT rule:
288
•
If you want to define a new NAT rule, fill in the fields of the first row as
described below.
•
If you want to edit an existing NAT rule, click in the desired field of the NAT
rule and fill them in as described below.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Internet Access (MX)
6) Enter the IP address you want to enable for the client in the internal network
in the Local IP Address column.
7) Enter the port number used by the internal client’s application in the Local
Port column.
8) Enter the port number used by the external communication partner’s application in the Global Port column.
9) In the Protocol drop-down list, select the transport protocol (TCP or UDP)
used by the application. The protocol cannot be changed in the case of a
standard NAT rule.
10) To apply the NAT rule, enable the Active column with a check mark.
11) Enter a name for the NAT rule in the Description column. In the case of a
standard NAT rule, this name cannot be changed.
12) Saving the NAT rule:
•
If you have configured a new NAT rule, click Add and then OK. The new
NAT rule is inserted at the end of the table.
•
If you have edited an existing NAT rule, go to step 13 .
13) Click Apply. An activated NAT rule is identified under the menu item NAT with
a green symbol.
Related Topics
9.1.4.3 How to Delete a NAT Rule
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click on Telephony > Routing.
2) In the navigation tree, click Routing.
3) Click on NAT in the menu tree.
4) Click on the NAT rule to be deleted in the menu tree and click the Delete NAT
tab. You cannot delete predefined default NAT rules.
5) Confirm the warning with Delete and then click OK. The NAT rule is deleted
from the list of NAT rules under the NAT menu item.
Related Topics
9.1.5 DNS, Domain Name Service (MX)
The communication system offers you the same functions as a DNS server
(gateway DNS functionality). DNS servers include data about a particular section
of the DNS domain tree structure and process name resolution requests received
from DNS clients.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
289
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Internet Access (MX)
On receiving a request, DNS servers provide the required information, return a
reference to some other server that can help resolve the request, or return an
acknowledgment to indicate that the information is not available or does not exist.
The main task of the Domain Name Service (DNS) is to translate “names” such
as www.wikipedia.com to their associated IP addresses. The DNS client
requests the IP address of a DNS name from the DNS server. Example: for
www.wikipedia.com, the DNS server returns the IP address 91.198.174.2.
The DNS is a hierarchical database that manages the Internet name space and
is distributed over a collection of servers worldwide. This name space is divided
into so-called zones. Separate Internet-independent DNS servers are usually
operated for local requirements – for example, within a corporate network.
System-Specific Information
OpenScape Office MX can serve as a DNS client and send requests to an
external DNS server, support gateway DNS functionality for other DNS clients
and also be used as a DNS server for the administration of DNS zones.
Primary/Secondary DNS Servers
A request is first forwarded to the primary DNS server. If this request can be
satisfied, it returns a response. If not, the request is forwarded to a second DNS
Server (if configured).
Related Topics
9.1.5.1 How to Define External DNS Servers
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Routing.
3) Navigate in the menu tree to IP Routing > DNS Server. The Edit DNS
Settings window appears.
4) Enter the IP address of the primary external DNS server in the IP Address of
primary DNS Server field.
5) If required for a fallback configuration: Enter the IP address of the secondary
external DNS server in the IP Address of secondary DNS Server field.
6) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
9.1.6 DynDNS (MX)
DynDNS (Dynamic Domain Name Service) is an Internet service that assigns a
fixed DNS name to an IP address that changes dynamically.
290
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Internet Access (MX)
DNS Name
With DynDNS, a client who is connected to the Internet with a dynamic IP address
can always be addressed with the same name, the DNS name. A DynDNS
account with a DynDNS provider (such as www.dyndns.org) is needed for this. If
the communication system is assigned a new IP address (for example, by the
Internet Service Provider), this IP address is automatically sent to the DynDNS
provider and saved in the DynDNS account. The refresh interval is adjustable. If
a DNS name is addressed, a request is sent to the DynDNS provider to translate
the name into the IP address currently valid. The entire DNS name (also known
as the domain name) is composed of a host name of your choice (myhost, for
instance) and the selected DynDNS provider (dyndns.org, for instance),
producing, in this instance, myhost.dyndns.org. More information on this can, for
example, be found at the Internet address:
http://www.dyndns.org/services/dyndns
DynDNS also lets you set up a virtual private network (VPN) over an Internet
Service Provider that supplies dynamic IP addresses. This enables teleworkers,
for example, to access the internal network via the Internet. More Information can
be found under VPN (Virtual Private Network) (MX) .
Mail Exchanger
The Mail Exchange entry (MX record) in the Domain Name Service (DNS)
specifies the IP address to which e-mails should be sent for the domain name
configured (myhost.dyndns.org, for instance). The mail server (Mail Exchanger)
must be located at the IP address specified. An e-mail address for this domain
name could be as follows: [email protected]
The Backup MX function buffers e-mails that could not be delivered to the Mail
Exchanger specified above (because of temporary unavailability, for instance)
and delivers them as soon as Mail Exchanger availability is restored.
Related Topics
9.1.6.1 How to Configure the DynDNS Service
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) Click Telephony > Basic Settings in the navigation tree.
3) Click on DynDNS in the menu tree.
4) Click Update Timer for DNS Names.
5) Activate the radio button Update DNS Names.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
291
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Internet Access (MX)
6) Enter the interval (in seconds) after which the current IP address is synchronized with the DynDNS provider in the Update Timer value for DNS names
(sec) field. The default value for this field is 180, which corresponds to an
update interval of 3 minutes.
7) In the menu tree, click on DynDNS Service.
8) Click the Edit DynDNS Configuration tab.
9) Enter the user name for your DynDNS account with the DynDNS provider in
the Login Name field.
10) Enter the password of your DynDNS account with the DynDNS provider in the
Password and Retype Password fields.
11) Enter the host name assigned to you by the DynDNS provider, omitting the
domain name, for instance, myhost, in the Hostname field.
12) From the Domain name drop-down list, select your DynDNS provider, e.g.,
dyndns.org. Your complete domain name then is myhost.dyndns.org.
13) Activate the radio button Enable Wildcard if you want queries to a subordinate domain name such as any.myhost.dyndns.org to also be accepted.
14) Activate the radio button Use HTTPS for Update if you want to use a secure
connection to the DynDNS provider to update the IP address.
15) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
9.1.6.2 How to Define the Mail Exchanger
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) Click Telephony > Basic Settings in the navigation tree.
3) Click on DynDNS in the menu tree.
4) Click DynDNS Service.
5) Click the Edit DynDNS Configuration tab.
6) Enter the IP address of the mail server (Mail Exchange entry or MX record) in
the Mail Exchanger field.
7) If necessary, activate the Backup MX radio button.
8) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
9.1.7 IP Routing (MX)
In data technology, routing describes the definition of paths (routes) for data
streams.
292
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Internet Access (MX)
Default Router
A network address is configured as a default router where clients send their data
if the destination address is outside their own network and they are unfamiliar with
the path to the destination client. The default router will then redirect the data to
the parent network.
Static Routes
Static routes are used to establish the path along which data will travel to a
network that cannot be reached via the default router.
ARP (Address Resolution Protocol)
The Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) is a network protocol that facilitates the
assignment of network addresses to hardware addresses. Although it is not
restricted to Ethernet and IP protocols, it is almost exclusively used in conjunction
with IP addressing in Ethernet networks.
Node A wants to communicate with node B in a network. Node A needs the MAC
address of node B for this. Node A queries the MAC address by sending an ARP
request with the IP address of the node it wants to find (node B) to all nodes in
the network. Node B sends the ARP reply and shares its MAC address with node
A. The prerequisites for communication are therefore satisfied. Node A saves the
association of the MAC address to the IP address of Node B in its ARP cache.
This speeds up communication connections in the network in future.
Related Topics
9.1.7.1 How to Configure Default Routers
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Routing.
3) Navigate in the menu tree to IP Routing > Default Router. The Edit Default
Router window appears.
4) Under Default Routing via, enter how the default routing is to occur (usually
via the LAN).
5) Enter the appropriate IP address under IP Address of Default Router.
6) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
293
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Internet Access (MX)
9.1.7.2 How to Add a Static Route
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Routing.
3) Navigate in the menu tree to IP Routing > Static Route. The Static Routes
window is displayed.
4) Click the Add Static Route tab. The Route Index shows which route is
added.
5) Enter the required name for this route in the Route Name field.
6) Enter the IP address of the Destination Network/Host.
7) Enter the IP address of the Destination Subnet Mask (subnet mask).
8) Enter the IP address of the router you want to use to reach the destination
network in the Route Gateway field.
9) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
9.1.7.3 How to Delete Static Routes
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Routing.
3) Navigate in the menu tree to IP Routing > Static Routes.
4) Mark the route you want to delete.
5) Click the Delete Static Route tab.
6) Click Delete.
7) Confirm the advisory message and then click OK.
Related Topics
9.1.7.4 How to Display the Address Resolution Protocol
Prerequisites
•
294
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Internet Access (MX)
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Routing.
3) Navigate in the menu tree to IP Routing > Address Resolution Protocol.
The current ARP table is displayed.
Related Topics
9.1.8 IP Mapping (MX)
IP mapping translates public IP addresses into internal IP addresses. The internal
clients can therefore be reached at an external IP address.
Related Topics
9.1.8.1 How to Edit the IP Mapping Netmask
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Routing.
3) Navigate in the menu tree down to IP Mapping. The IP Mapping window
appears.
4) To edit the subnet mask, enter the new subnet mask in the IP Mapping
Netmask field on the Edit IP Mapping Netmask tab.
5) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
9.1.8.2 How to Add an IP Map
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Routing.
3) Navigate in the menu tree down to IP Mapping. The IP Mapping window is
displayed.
4) Click the Add IP Map tab.
5) Enter the external IP address under Global Address.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
295
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
IP Telephony (Voice over IP, VoIP)
6) Under Local IP Address, enter the local IP address to which the global IP
address is to be mapped.
7) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
9.1.8.3 How to Edit/Delete an IP Map
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Routing.
3) Navigate in the menu tree down to IP Mapping.
4) Click the entry to be deleted.
5) Click the Delete IP Map tab.
6) Click Delete followed by OK.
Related Topics
9.2 IP Telephony (Voice over IP, VoIP)
IP Telephony describes telephony within IP networks. The signals required for the
call are transmitted using IP Protocols over IP networks that can be used for data
transmission. This type of telephony is also called Voice over IP (VoIP). IP
telephony is implemented on the one hand for calls within an internal network
(LAN or WAN in coupled corporate networks) and, on the other hand, for calls
over the Internet between two IP stations or for calls over the Internet to conventional telephone networks. If the IP telephony occurs over the Internet, this is also
referred to as Internet telephony. Both PCs as well as IP telephones suitable for
IP telephony may be used as IP stations. To guarantee loss-free transmission
and good voice quality, voice signals are compressed using audio codecs and
marked using special procedures (Quality of Service) so that voice transmission
has priority over data.
IP Telephony in the Internal Network (LAN Telephony)
IP stations can telephone each other over the internal network (LAN, local area
network) using the Internet protocol. IP telephony is also possible if two internal
networks, for example, two branches in different locations, are connected via a
WAN (wide area network). The communication system must support VoIP for this.
All of the communication system’s telephony features can be used within the
internal network with the corresponding protocol.
296
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
IP Telephony (Voice over IP, VoIP)
IP Telephony via the Internet (Internet Telephony)
Internet telephony means that IP stations can communicate directly with other IP
stations over the Internet or with stations from the conventional telephone
network.
To use Internet telephony, you will need access to an Internet Telephony Service
Provider (ITSP).
Calls are set up and cleared down via the Session Initiation Protocol (SIP). The
voice data is combined in IP packets and transferred over the Realtime Transport
Protocol (RTP). Call stations such as IP phones, PCs, and conventional phones
connected via special adapters can set up the connection to the Internet.
Connecting to the Internet (to the ITSP)
The communication system can be connected to the Internet either directly or via
an additional Internet router.
•
Communication system with direct Internet access
•
Communication system with Internet access via existing Internet router:
The internal network is connected to the Internet over an existing Internet
router. NAT is typically used in this environment so that the IP addresses used
in the internal network are not visible in the Internet. To be able to receive
incoming calls over the Internet, the relevant IP station must be able to
determine its IP address used in the Internet and forward this information to
the communication partner. To do this, a STUN server operated by the ITSP
is required.
Call Flow
A connection between two IP station is set up via the SIP server. The SIP server
is no longer needed for the actual telephone call because the call data is sent
directly by the IP station. Connections are again set up via the SIP server.
Related Topics
9.2.1 ITSP Requirements (LX/MX)
An Internet Telephony Service Provider (ITSP, SIP Provider) lets you conduct
calls over the Internet. To do this, an Internet telephony connection must be
applied for from the ITSP, and a user account must be set up for the IP station.
Internet Telephony Service Providers do not always offer the same range of SIP
features. It is therefore important that the ITSP is certified for OpenScape Office.
A list of certified ITSPs can be found at the following link:
http://wiki.unify.com/wiki/
Collaboration_with_VoIP_Providers
Types of Internet Telephony Connections
•
The Internet telephony user connection is a connection with the registration
of individual call numbers. With this connection type, a registration and
authentication from the ITSP is required for every individual station
connection call number.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
297
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
IP Telephony (Voice over IP, VoIP)
•
The Internet telephony point-to-point connection is a connection with the
registration of a call number range. With this connection type, only a single
registration and authentication from the ITSP is required for the entire call
number range.
ITSP user account
The ITSP user account (SIP User Account) must be applied for from the ITSP.
The ITSP provides an SIP Registrar server at which the IP station must first log
in (provider-specific) for this purpose.
INFO: Special numbers and emergency numbers that cannot be
supported by the ITSP are routed over fixed network connections.
INFO: In the event of ITSP failure, the connection is guaranteed
over fixed network connections via least cost routing (LCR).
Related Topics
9.2.2 Internet Telephony via a Station Connection (LX/MX)
An Internet telephony station connection is a connection with the registration of
individual call numbers. With this connection type, a registration and authentication from the ITSP is required for every individual station connection call
number.
Related Topics
9.2.2.1 How to Configure a Predefined ITSP for the Internet Telephony User Connection
The Internet Telephony wizard can be used to activate a predefined Internet
Telephony Service Provider (ITSP) for the Internet telephony user connection.
You can configure Internet telephony stations for every ITSP.
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
•
The Internet connection is operational.
•
Your ITSP’s Internet telephony access data is available (for example, user
account, password and Internet telephony phone number).
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Central Telephony.
3) Click Edit to start the Internet Telephony wizard.
298
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
IP Telephony (Voice over IP, VoIP)
4) Clear the No call via Internet check box. A country-specific list of the
possible ITSPs is displayed. The list contains the predefined ITSPs for the
selected country and the newly added ITSPs.
5) If you want to change the preset country, select the desired country from the
Country specific view drop-down list to display the ITSPs that are available
for this country.
6) If required, click Display Status to check which ITSPs have already been
activated and which Internet telephony subscribers have already been
configured under each ITSP. You can activate a maximum of four ITSPs. Click
OK when finished.
7) To activate a preconfigured ITSP and configure Internet telephony stations,
click Edit in the line associated with the relevant ITSP.
8) Activate the check box Enable Provider.
9) Click OK & Next.
10) Configure the Internet telephony stations with the associated Internet
telephony phone numbers. You received this data from your ITSP.
The fields that will then be displayed are provider-specific.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
299
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
IP Telephony (Voice over IP, VoIP)
a) Click Add.
b) Enter the Internet Telephony Station. You received this data from your
ITSP. Depending on the ITSP, different designations are used for this, for
example: SIP User, SIP ID, etc. You may also need to enter the ITSP
customer number here.
For some ITSPs such as T-Online, for example, this is replaced by the
Internet Telephony Station Number field. Enter the Internet telephony
phone number here.
c) Enter the authorization name in the Authorization name field. You
received this data from your ITSP. You may need to enter the Internet
Telephony Station or the ITSP customer number again here.
For some ITSPs such as T-Online, for example, this is replaced by the Email Address field. Enter the e-mail address of the Internet telephony
subscriber here.
d) Enter the password you received from the ITSP in the New Password
and Confirm Password fields. Depending on the ITSP, different designations are used for this, for example: Password, SIP Password, etc).
e) Select the radio button Internet telephony phone number in the Call
number type area.
f)
In the Internet Telephony Phone Numbers area, enter one of the
Internet telephony phone numbers provided by the ITSP in the field next
to the Add button and then click Add.
The Internet Telephony Phone Numbers area is not available for TOnline because Internet telephony stations and Internet telephony phone
numbers are identical. Instead of an Internet telephony station, you
configure an Internet telephony phone number here.
g) To assign further Internet telephony phone numbers to the Internet
telephony station, repeat step f).
INFO: For details on how to assign the Internet telephony phone
numbers to the individual stations, see Configuring Stations Using
Wizards (LX/MX) .
11) Click OK & Next.
12) If you want to configure another Internet telephony station with the associated
Internet telephony phone numbers, repeat steps 10 and 11.
13) Click OK & Next. You will see an overview of which Internet telephony phone
numbers are assigned to which Internet telephony stations.
14) Assign one internal call number each to all Internet telephony phone
numbers.
300
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
IP Telephony (Voice over IP, VoIP)
a) To do this, select an internal number in the appropriate line from the
Internal Call Number drop-down list.
b) If an IP subscriber without an Internet telephony phone number or the
members of a call group want to make external calls via the Internet, the
radio button Use as PABX number for outgoing calls must be activated
at one Internet telephony station. The radio button should be activated for
only one single Internet telephony phone number.
15) Click OK & Next. You will again see an overview of the possible ITSPs here.
The enabled ITSPs are identified with a check mark in the Enable Provider
column.
16) Click OK & Next.
17) Enter the upload speed of your Internet connection in the Upstream up to
(Kbps) field. Please do not confuse this with the download speed!
INFO: The number of simultaneous Internet calls permitted is
displayed in the Number of Simultaneous Internet calls field. If
the voice quality deteriorates due to the network load, you will
need to reduce the number.
18) Click OK & Next.
19) If you did not activate the full-time circuit when setting up your Internet access,
you can now do this here. Without a permanent connection (full-time circuit),
you cannot receive calls over the Internet. If the full-time circuit has already
been set up, the fields described under a) to c) will not appear.
a) Enable the radio button On under Full-Time Circuit.
b) In the Forced Disconnect at (hour:min) field, enter the time at which the
Internet connection is to be deactivated (e.g., 04:59).
c) Click OK & Next.
20) Enter the special numbers you want in the Dialed digits column.
The following station number entries are valid:
0 to 9: allowed digits
-: Field separator
X: Any digit from 0 to 9
N: Any digit from 2 to 9
Z: One or more digits to follow up to the end of dialing
C: Simulated dial tone (can be entered up to three times)
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
301
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
IP Telephony (Voice over IP, VoIP)
21) Use the Dial over Provider column to specify whether the special number
should be dialed via ISDN or an ITSP. Only the active ITSP is displayed.
INFO: Ensure that emergency numbers can always be dialed. If
you want to dial emergency numbers via an Internet Telephony
Service Provider, you must make sure that the ITSP supports this
feature.
22) Click OK & Next. The status of your ITSP will be displayed.
23) Click Next followed by Finish. Following this step, please run the CO Trunk
ISDN / Analog wizard to set the prioritization for the exchange line seizure
(for example: Exchange Line Seizure First over ITSP and Next over ISDN).
Related Topics
9.2.2.2 How to Add an ITSP for the Internet Telephony User Connection
The Internet Telephony wizard can be used to not only activate a predefined
Internet Telephony Service Provider (ITSP) for den Internet telephony user
connection, but also to add new ITSPs. You can configure Internet telephony
stations for every ITSP.
Prerequisites
Field
Gateway Domain Name
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
•
The Internet connection is operational.
•
The following ITSP-specific Internet access data is available:
Description
Value from ISP
Gateway Domain Name of the ITSP Usually
identical to the host name (e.g., sip-voice.de)
Provider Registrar
Use Provider Registrar
Predefined by the ITSP and generally always
set.
IP address/Host name
Host name or IP address of the Registrar
server (e.g., sip-voice.de).
Port
Port number of the Registrar server (e.g.,
5060).
Reregistration interval at Provider (sec)
Interval (in seconds) at which ITSP registration
is repeated. The value of the interval must not
be 0 and must not be set too high because on
repeating the registration at the ITSP, a
dropped connection can also be detected, and
an alternate route (via ISDN or an alternate
Provider) may be selected if required. Default
value: 120 seconds.
Provider Proxy
302
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
IP Telephony (Voice over IP, VoIP)
Field
Description
IP address/Host name
Host name or IP address of the proxy server
(e.g., sip-voice.de). As a rule, this is identical
with the Provider Registrar entry.
Port
Port number of the proxy server (e.g., 5060).
As a rule, this is identical with the Provider port
number.
Value from ISP
Provider Outbound Proxy
Use Provider Outbound Proxy
Only set if the ITSP uses an outbound proxy.
IP address/Host name
Host name or IP address of the outbound proxy
Port
Port number of the outbound proxy
Provider STUN
Provider STUN IP Address
STUN IP address if the ITSP is using a STUN
server.
Provider STUN Port Number
STUN port number if the ITSP is using a STUN
server.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Central Telephony.
3) Click Edit to start the Internet Telephony wizard.
4) Clear the No call via Internet check box. A country-specific list of the
possible ITSPs is displayed. The list contains the predefined ITSPs for the
selected country and the newly added ITSPs.
5) If required, click Display Status to check which ITSPs have already been
activated and which Internet telephony subscribers have already been
configured under each ITSP. You can activate a maximum of four ITSPs. Click
OK when finished.
6) Click Add to configure a new ITSP and Internet Telephony station.
7) Assign a name of your choice for the ITSP in the Provider Name field.
8) Activate the check box Enable Provider.
9) Enter the values provided by your ITSP in the remaining areas (see table
immediately after prerequisites).
10) Click OK & Next.
11) Configure the Internet telephony stations with the associated Internet
telephony phone numbers. You received this data from your ITSP.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
303
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
IP Telephony (Voice over IP, VoIP)
a) Click Add.
b) Enter the Internet Telephony Station. You received this data from your
ITSP. Depending on the ITSP, different designations are used for this, for
example: SIP User, SIP ID, etc. You may also need to enter the ITSP
customer number here.
For some ITSPs such as T-Online, for example, this is replaced by the
Internet Telephony Station Number field. Enter the Internet telephony
phone number here.
c) Enter the authorization name in the Authorization name field. You
received this data from your ITSP. You may need to enter the Internet
Telephony Station or the ITSP customer number again here.
For some ITSPs such as T-Online, for example, this is replaced by the Email Address field. Enter the e-mail address of the Internet telephony
subscriber here.
d) Enter the password you received from the ITSP in the New Password
and Confirm Password fields. Depending on the ITSP, different designations are used for this, for example: Password, SIP Password, etc).
e) Select the radio button Internet telephony phone number in the Call
number type area.
f)
In the Internet Telephony Phone Numbers area, enter one of the
Internet telephony phone numbers provided by the ITSP in the field next
to the Add button and then click Add.
g) To assign further Internet telephony phone numbers to the Internet
telephony station, repeat step f).
INFO: For details on how to assign the Internet telephony phone
numbers to the individual stations, see Configuring Stations Using
Wizards (LX/MX)
12) Click OK & Next.
13) If you want to configure another Internet telephony station with the associated
Internet telephony phone numbers, repeat steps 11 and 12.
14) Click OK & Next. You will see an overview of which Internet telephony phone
numbers are assigned to which Internet telephony stations.
15) Assign one internal call number each to all Internet telephony phone
numbers.
a) To do this, select an internal number in the appropriate line from the
Internal Call Number drop-down list.
b) If an IP subscriber without an Internet telephony phone number or the
members of a call group want to make external calls via the Internet, the
radio button Use as PABX number for outgoing calls must be activated
at one Internet telephony station. The radio button should be activated for
only one single Internet telephony phone number.
304
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
IP Telephony (Voice over IP, VoIP)
16) Click OK & Next. You will again see an overview of the possible ITSPs here.
The enabled ITSPs are identified with a check mark in the Enable Provider
column.
17) Click OK & Next.
18) Enter the upload speed of your Internet connection in the Upstream up to
(Kbps) field. Please do not confuse this with the download speed!
INFO: The number of simultaneous Internet calls permitted is
displayed in the Number of Simultaneous Internet calls field. If
the voice quality deteriorates due to the network load, you will
need to reduce the number.
19) Click OK & Next.
20) If you did not activate the full-time circuit when setting up your Internet access,
you can now do this here. Without a permanent connection (full-time circuit),
you cannot receive calls over the Internet. If the full-time circuit has already
been set up, the fields described under a) to c) will not appear.
a) Enable the radio button On under Full-Time Circuit.
b) In the Forced Disconnect at (hour:min) field, enter the time at which the
Internet connection is to be deactivated (e.g., 04:59).
c) Click OK & Next.
21) Enter the special numbers you want in the Dialed digits column.
The following station number entries are valid:
0 to 9: allowed digits
-: Field separator
X: Any digit from 0 to 9
N: Any digit from 2 to 9
Z: One or more digits to follow up to the end of dialing
C: Simulated dial tone (can be entered up to three times)
22) Use the Dial over Provider column to specify whether the special number
should be dialed via ISDN or an ITSP. Only the active ITSP is displayed.
INFO: Ensure that emergency numbers can always be dialed. If
you want to dial emergency numbers via an Internet Telephony
Service Provider, you must make sure that the ITSP supports this
feature.
23) Click OK & Next. The status of your ITSP will be displayed.
24) Click Next followed by Finish. Following this step, please run the CO Trunk
ISDN / Analog wizard to set the prioritization for the exchange line seizure
(for example: Exchange Line Seizure First over ITSP and Next over ISDN).
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
305
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
IP Telephony (Voice over IP, VoIP)
9.2.3 Internet Telephony via a Point-to-Point Connection (LX/MX)
An Internet telephony point-to-point connection is a connection with the registration of a call number range. With this connection type, only a single registration
and authentication from the ITSP is required for the entire call number range.
Related Topics
9.2.3.1 How to Configure a Predefined ITSP for the Internet Telephony System
Connection
The Internet Telephony wizard can be used to activate a predefined Internet
Telephony Service Provider (ITSP) for the Internet telephony system connection.
You can configure Internet telephony stations for every ITSP.
Prerequisites
•
The Internet connection is operational.
•
Your ITSP’s Internet telephony access data is available (for example, user
account, password and Internet telephony phone number).
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Central Telephony.
3) Click Edit to start the Internet Telephony wizard.
4) Clear the No call via Internet check box. A country-specific list of the
possible ITSPs is displayed. The list contains the predefined ITSPs for the
selected country and the newly added ITSPs.
5) If you want to change the preset country, select the desired country from the
Country specific view drop-down list to display the ITSPs that are available
for this country.
6) If required, click Display Status to check which ITSPs have already been
activated and which Internet telephony subscribers have already been
configured under each ITSP. You can activate a maximum of four ITSPs. Click
OK when finished.
7) To activate a predefined ITSP and configure Internet telephony stations, click
Edit in the line associated with the relevant ITSP.
8) Activate the check box Enable Provider.
9) Click OK & Next.
10) Configure the Internet telephony stations with the associated DID phone
numbers. You received this data from your ITSP.
The fields that will then be displayed are provider-specific.
306
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
IP Telephony (Voice over IP, VoIP)
a) Click Add.
b) Enter the Internet Telephony Station. You received this data from your
ITSP. Depending on the ITSP, different designations are used for this, for
example: SIP User, SIP ID, etc. You may also need to enter the ITSP
customer number here.
For some ITSPs such as T-Online, for example, this is replaced by the
Internet Telephony Station Number field. Enter the Internet telephony
phone number here.
c) Enter the authorization name in the Authorization name field. You
received this data from your ITSP. You may need to enter the Internet
Telephony Station or the ITSP customer number again here.
For some ITSPs such as T-Online, for example, this is replaced by the Email Address field. Enter the e-mail address of the Internet telephony
subscriber here.
d) Enter the password you received from the ITSP in the New Password
and Confirm Password fields. Depending on the ITSP, different designations are used for this, for example: Password, SIP Password, etc).
e) Select the radio button Internet telephony system phone number in the
Call number type area.
f)
Enter the system phone number, for instance, 722, under System phone
number (prefix).
g) Enter the desired DID number range for the Internet telephony station in
the ‘from’ and ‘to ‘ fields after Direct inward dialing band. The range
entered by default is 100 - 147.
INFO: For details on how to edit the assignments of DID numbers
to the individual stations, see Configuring Stations Using Wizards
(LX/MX) .
11) Click OK & Next.
12) If you want to configure another Internet telephony station, repeat steps 10
and 11.
13) Click OK & Next. You will see an overview of which Internet telephony phone
numbers are assigned to which Internet telephony stations.
14) Click OK & Next. You will again see an overview of the possible ITSPs here.
The enabled ITSPs are identified with a check mark in the Enable Provider
column.
15) Click OK & Next.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
307
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
IP Telephony (Voice over IP, VoIP)
16) Enter the upload speed of your Internet connection in the Upstream up to
(Kbps) field. Please do not confuse this with the download speed!
INFO: The number of simultaneous Internet calls permitted is
displayed in the Number of Simultaneous Internet calls field. If
the voice quality deteriorates due to the network load, you will
need to reduce the number.
17) Click OK & Next.
18) If you did not activate the full-time circuit when setting up your Internet access,
you can now do this here. Without a permanent connection (full-time circuit),
you cannot receive calls over the Internet. If the full-time circuit has already
been set up, the fields described under a) to c) will not appear.
a) Enable the radio button On under Full-Time Circuit.
b) In the Forced Disconnect at (hour:min) field, enter the time at which the
Internet connection is to be deactivated (e.g., 04:59).
c) Click OK & Next.
19) Enter the special numbers you want in the Dialed digits column.
The following station number entries are valid:
0 to 9: allowed digits
-: Field separator
X: Any digit from 0 to 9
N: Any digit from 2 to 9
Z: One or more digits to follow up to the end of dialing
C: Simulated dial tone (can be entered up to three times)
20) Use the Dial over Provider column to specify whether the special number
should be dialed via ISDN or an ITSP. Only the active ITSP is displayed.
INFO: Ensure that emergency numbers can always be dialed. If
you want to dial emergency numbers via an Internet Telephony
Service Provider, you must make sure that the ITSP supports this
feature.
21) Click OK & Next. The status of your ITSP will be displayed.
22) Click Next followed by Finish. Following this step, please run the CO Trunk
ISDN / Analog wizard to set the prioritization for the exchange line seizure
(for example: Exchange Line Seizure First over ITSP and Next over ISDN).
Related Topics
308
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
IP Telephony (Voice over IP, VoIP)
9.2.3.2 How to Add a New ITSP for the Internet Telephony System Connection
The Internet Telephony wizard can be used to not only activate a predefined
Internet Telephony Service Provider (ITSP) for the Internet telephony system
connection, but also to add new ITSPs. You can configure Internet telephony
stations for every ITSP.
Prerequisites
Field
Gateway Domain Name
•
The Internet connection is operational.
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
•
The following ISP-specific Internet access data is available to you:
Description
Value from ISP
Gateway Domain Name of the ITSP Usually identical to the host name (e.g., sipvoice.de)
Provider Registrar
Use Provider Registrar
Predefined by the ITSP and generally
always set.
IP address/Host name
Host name or IP address of the Registrar
server (e.g., sip-voice.de).
Port
Port number of the Registrar server (e.g.,
5060).
Reregistration interval at Provider (sec)
Interval (in seconds) at which ITSP registration is repeated. The value of the interval must not be 0 and must not be set too
high because on repeating the registration
at the ITSP, a dropped connection can also
be detected, and an alternate route (via
ISDN or an alternate Provider) may be
selected if required. Default value: 120
seconds.
Provider Proxy
IP address/Host name
Host name or IP address of the proxy
server (e.g., sip-voice.de). As a rule, this is
identical with the Provider Registrar entry.
Port
Port number of the proxy server (e.g.,
5060). As a rule, this is identical with the
Provider port number.
Provider Outbound Proxy
Use Provider Outbound Proxy
Only set if the ITSP uses an outbound
proxy.
IP address/Host name
Host name or IP address of the outbound
proxy
Port
Port number of the outbound proxy
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
309
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
IP Telephony (Voice over IP, VoIP)
Field
Description
Value from ISP
Provider STUN
Provider STUN IP Address
STUN IP address if the ITSP is using a
STUN server.
Provider STUN Port Number
STUN port number if the ITSP is using a
STUN server.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Central Telephony.
3) Click Edit to start the Internet Telephony wizard.
4) Clear the No call via Internet check box. A country-specific list of the
possible ITSPs is displayed. The list contains the predefined ITSPs for the
selected country and the newly added ITSPs.
5) If required, click Display Status to check which ITSPs have already been
activated and which Internet telephony subscribers have already been
configured under each ITSP. You can activate a maximum of four ITSPs. Click
OK when finished.
6) Click Add to set up a new ITSP. A configuration window for the new ITSP
appears.
7) Assign a name of your choice for the ITSP in the Provider Name field.
8) Activate the check box Enable Provider.
9) Enter the values provided by your ITSP in the remaining areas (see table
immediately after prerequisites).
10) Click OK & Next.
11) Configure the Internet telephony stations with the associated DID phone
numbers. You received this data from your ITSP.
310
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
IP Telephony (Voice over IP, VoIP)
a) Click Add.
b) Enter the Internet Telephony Station. You received this data from your
ITSP. Depending on the ITSP, different designations are used for this, for
example: SIP User, SIP ID, etc. You may also need to enter the ITSP
customer number here.
For some ITSPs such as T-Online, for example, this is replaced by the
Internet Telephony Station Number field. Enter the Internet telephony
phone number here.
c) Enter the authorization name in the Authorization name field. You
received this data from your ITSP. You may need to enter the Internet
Telephony Station or the ITSP customer number again here.
For some ITSPs such as T-Online, for example, this is replaced by the Email Address field. Enter the e-mail address of the Internet telephony
subscriber here.
d) Enter the password you received from the ITSP in the New Password
and Confirm Password fields. Depending on the ITSP, different designations are used for this, for example: Password, SIP Password, etc).
e) Select the radio button Internet telephony system phone number in the
Call number type area.
f)
Enter the system phone number, for instance, 722, in the System phone
number (Prefix) field.
g) Enter the desired DID number range for the Internet telephony station in
the ‘from’ and ‘to ‘ fields after Direct inward dialing band. The range
entered by default is 100 - 147.
INFO: For details on how to edit the assignments of DID numbers
to the individual stations, see Configuring Stations Using Wizards
(LX/MX) .
12) Click OK & Next.
13) If you want to configure another Internet telephony station, repeat steps 11
and 12.
14) Click OK & Next. You will see an overview of which Internet telephony phone
numbers are assigned to which Internet telephony stations.
15) Click OK & Next. You will again see an overview of the possible ITSPs here.
The enabled ITSPs are identified with a check mark in the Enable Provider
column.
16) Click OK & Next.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
311
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
IP Telephony (Voice over IP, VoIP)
17) Enter the upload speed of your Internet connection in the Upstream up to
(Kbps) field. Please do not confuse this with the download speed!
INFO: The number of simultaneous Internet calls permitted is
displayed in the Number of Simultaneous Internet calls field. If
the voice quality deteriorates due to the network load, you will
need to reduce the number.
18) Click OK & Next.
19) If you did not activate the full-time circuit when setting up your Internet access,
you can now do this here. Without a permanent connection (full-time circuit),
you cannot receive calls over the Internet. If the full-time circuit has already
been set up, the fields described under a) to c) will not appear.
a) Enable the radio button On under Full-Time Circuit.
b) In the Forced Disconnect at (hour:min) field, enter the time at which the
Internet connection is to be deactivated (e.g., 04:59).
c) Click OK & Next.
20) Enter the special numbers you want in the Dialed digits column.
The following station number entries are valid:
0 to 9: allowed digits
-: Field separator
X: Any digit from 0 to 9
N: Any digit from 2 to 9
Z: One or more digits to follow up to the end of dialing
C: Simulated dial tone (can be entered up to three times)
21) Use the Dial over Provider column to specify whether the special number
should be dialed via ISDN or an ITSP. Only the active ITSP is displayed.
INFO: Ensure that emergency numbers can always be dialed. If
you want to dial emergency numbers via an Internet Telephony
Service Provider, you must make sure that the ITSP supports this
feature.
22) Click OK & Next. The status of your ITSP will be displayed.
23) Click Next followed by Finish. Following this step, please run the CO Trunk
ISDN / Analog wizard to set the prioritization for the exchange line seizure
(for example: Exchange Line Seizure First over ITSP and Next over ISDN).
Related Topics
312
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Outside Line (MX)
9.2.4 STUN (Simple Traversal of UDP through NAT (LX/MX)
When operating the communication system behind a NAT router, STUN enables
determination of the own IP address/port, which is required for Internet telephony
via SIP The functionality is made available on the Internet on STUN servers,
whose addresses must be stored in the configuration of the communication
system.
The following function can be implemented in the communication system with
STUN:
•
Detecting the NAT type
The communication system determines independently whether STUM must
and can be used. No STUN requests occur if no NAT router exists or if a NAT
type not supported by STUN is detected. For routers with symmetric NAT, for
example, STUN cannot determine any valid public address, so VoIP is
possible in this case.
INFO: Some ITSPs use session border controllers (SBC), which
obtain knowledge of where they should send their own RTP data
stream from the incoming RTP data stream instead of the SIP
signaling. In this case, Internet telephony is also possible with
symmetric NAT.
•
Monitoring the Public IP address
The IP address under which the communication system is seen on the
Internet is determined cyclically. This is done by sending a request to the
STUN server, which indicates in its response with which public IP address it
had seen the IP packet If the IP address changes, STUN notifies the required
components of the communication system.
•
Determining the RTP/RTCP Address per Call
If STUN is active, the public RTP and RTCP ports are determined for each
call. To do this, a request is sent to the STUN server via each of the respective
ports that will also be later used for the voice packets. In its response the
STUN server indicates with which public IP address / port the IP packet
arrived. This information is used in the SIP signaling to transmit to the communication partner to which IP address and port it should send its voice packets.
•
Opening the NAT Bindings for Early Payload per Call
STUN open the NAT Binding in the NAT router for Early Payload by sending
an empty UDP packet. This makes it possible to hear announcements before
“Connect” in the case of outgoing calls, for example.
Related Topics
9.3 Outside Line (MX)
The outside line connects the communication system to the public network
(PSTN) via ISDN or analog connections.
Wizards are available to facilitate the configuration of an ISDN outside line or
analog outside line.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
313
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Outside Line (MX)
Related Topics
9.3.1 Trunks (MX)
Trunks connect the communication system with the public network (PSTN). Every
trunk is assigned a route through which different properties can be assigned to
the trunk.
By default, all trunks are assigned a seizure code and a route. These assignments
can be changed by the administrator.
In the case of an ISDN trunk connection, the trunks are also referred to as Bchannels.
Trunk code
Using the trunk code, the communication system seizes the specific trunk
assigned to that trunk code. The trunk code is also used to program a trunk key
or to test a trunk.
MSN Allocation
An MSN can be assigned directly to an ISDN trunk for external call forwarding in
the case of multiple PMP trunks (PMP=point-to-multipoint), for example.
ISDN Protocol
The used ISDN protocol is determined by the country initialization. It should only
be changed if the PSTN connection explicitly requires some other deviant
protocol. Several protocol templates, which can be adapted to individual requirements, are available. The requisite information for this can be obtained from your
Service Provider.
B Channel Seizure Mode
Individual B channels of an ISDN trunk can be blocked for outgoing and/or
incoming traffic.
The following B channel seizure modes are possible:
•
outgoing only
•
incoming only
•
outgoing and incoming (default)
The B channel seizure mode is only evaluated when the communication system
must offer a B-channel. The applies in the following situations:
S2 outgoing: The communication system must offer a B-channel.
314
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Outside Line (MX)
S2 incoming: The remote station must offer a B-channel. This B-channel is accepted by
the communication system without checking the setting. It is thus of no
direct significance.
S0 outgoing: Since the communication system does not pre-assign a B-channel (any
channel), this setting is of no direct significance.
S0 incoming: When the remote station sets up a call without specifying a B-channel, the
communication system offers a B-channel, while taking the set B channel
seizure mode into account.
Dialing Method for Analog CO Trunks (MSI)
The dialing method is automatically detected by the communication system
whenever the line is seized. For special cases, the dialing method can also be set
directly to Dual Tone Multifrequency (DTMF) or Dial Pulsing (DP).
Related Topics
9.3.1.1 How to Configure an ISDN Outside Line
Use the CO Trunk ISDN / Analog wizard to configure the ISDN outside line.
Depending on which ports are present for CO trunks in the communication
system (ISDN or analog), the wizard goes through different steps.
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
•
The communication system is connected to an ISDN trunk.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Central Telephony.
3) Click on Edit to start the CO Trunk ISDN / Analog / ITSP wizard. The wizard
displays an overview of the box(es), slot(s) and S0 ports.
4) Enter the Country code.
5) If a point-to-point connection is involved, enter the Local area code and
PABX number.
6) Click OK & Next.
7) Select one of the following connection types for the relevant connection (box,
slot and S0 port):
•
If you want to configure a point-to-point connection, select the Point-topoint connection radio button.
•
If you want to configure a point-to-multipoint connection, select the Pointto-multipoint connection radio button.
8) Click OK & Next.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
315
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Outside Line (MX)
9) If a point-to-multipoint connection is involved, enter the MSN for the relevant
connection (box, slot and S0 port) and click OK & Next.
10) Leave the setting of the No call via Internet check box unchanged and click
Skip.
11) Select the preferred trunk (CO) access in the First over drop-down list and
then click OK & Next.
12) Click OK & Next followed by Finish.
Related Topics
9.3.1.2 How to Configure an Analog Outside Line
Use the CO Trunk ISDN / Analog wizard to configure the analog outside line.
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
•
Your communication system is connected to an analog trunk.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Central Telephony.
3) Click on Edit to start the CO Trunk ISDN / Analog / ITSP wizard. The wizard
displays an overview of the box(es), slot(s) and analog ports.
4) Enter the Country code.
5) If a point-to-point connection is involved, enter the Local area code and
PABX number.
6) Click OK & Next.
7) Click Skip ISDN.
8) Leave the setting of the No call via Internet check box unchanged and click
Skip.
9) Select one of the following options in the Protocol drop-down list:
•
If you want to use Frequency Shift Keying for CLIP, select FSK.
•
If you want to use Dual Tone Multifrequency (DTMF) for CLIP, select
DTMF.
•
If you do not want to use CLIP, select None.
10) Click OK & Next.
11) Click Edit to configure the properties of the relevant trunk. If required, edit the
values for the Dialing method, CO call identification, Flash, Line Length
and Flags and then click OK.
12) Click OK & Next.
13) Click Skip and then, if necessary, on OK & Next.
316
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Outside Line (MX)
14) Select the preferred trunk (CO) access in the First over drop-down list and
then click OK & Next.
15) Click OK & Next followed by Finish.
Related Topics
9.3.1.3 How to Display All Trunks
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Telephony > Trunks/Routing.
3) Click on Trunks/Routing > Trunks in the menu tree. Depending on the
configuration of the communication system, all possible trunks, including the
trunk code and route, will be displayed.
Related Topics
9.3.1.4 How to Display Individual Trunks
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Telephony > Trunks/Routing.
3) Navigate in the menu tree under Trunks/Routing > Trunks > ... to the
desired line. The trunk connected to the communication system, including the
trunk code and route, will be displayed.
4) Click OK.
Related Topics
9.3.1.5 How to Change the Trunk Code
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Telephony > Trunks/Routing.
3) Navigate in the menu tree under Trunks/Routing > Trunks > ... to the
desired line.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
317
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Outside Line (MX)
4) Click the Change Line tab.
5) Enter the desired value in the Code field.
INFO: If no value is entered as the code, this trunk has no trunk
code.
6) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
9.3.1.6 How to Assign an MSN to a Trunk
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Trunks / Routing.
3) Click Trunks/Routing > MSN assign in the menu tree.
4) Click on the entry that you want to edit under MSN assign in the menu tree.
5) Enter the MSN.
6) Select the route that you want to assign from the Trunk drop-down list.
7) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
9.3.1.7 How to Change the ISDN Protocol
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Trunks / Routing.
3) Navigate in the menu tree under Trunks/Routing > Trunks > ... to the
desired port.
4) Click the Change ISDN Flags tab.
5) Select the desired protocol from the drop-down list in the Protocol:
Description area.
6) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
318
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Outside Line (MX)
9.3.1.8 How to Change the B Channel Seizure Mode
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Trunks / Routing.
3) Navigate in the menu tree under Trunks/Routing > Trunks > ... to the
desired port.
4) Click the Change B-Channel tab.
5) Clear the check boxes for each channel in the outgoing and incoming
columns as desired.
6) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
9.3.1.9 How to Change the Dialing Method
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Trunks / Routing.
3) Navigate in the menu tree under Trunks/Routing > Trunks > ... to the
desired port.
4) Click the Edit MSI Flags tab.
5) Set the dialing method to Dual Tone Multifrequency (DTMF) or Dial Pulsing
(DP).
6) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
9.3.2 Routes (MX)
Routes enable trunks (B channels) to be grouped. Separate parameters can be
configured for each trunk group.
Each trunk can be assigned to exactly one route. By default, all trunks are
assigned to route 1.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
319
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Outside Line (MX)
For each route, a name and a seizure code can be assigned.
INFO: Seizure codes only work if LCR has not been activated.
B Channel Allocation
The allocation of B channels to different trunk groups is also called the B-channel
allocation. Typical use cases include ISDN trunk connections with multiple Bchannels such as S2M trunk connections, for example.
For outgoing calls, only B-channels that are included in the trunk group can be
selected (e.g., trunk group selected via the seizure code, overflow trunk group or
trunk group selected using LCR)
Incoming calls are always accepted, regardless of the trunk group. As a rule, the
B-channel offered by the peer is seized. If the peer system or the public network
does not support B-channel allocation, the correct allocation of the call to the
correct trunk group cannot be guaranteed.
Trunk group key
A subscriber can assign a route to a trunk group key on the telephone. One trunk
group key is reserved for outbound calls. Calls placed via trunk group keys are
subject to COS toll restriction levels and rules.
When a subscriber presses a trunk group key (or dials a seizure code), the
communication system seizes a free trunk that is assigned to the appropriate
route. The telephone shows the trunk number in the display. If all trunks of the
route are seized, the corresponding LED lights up, even in the case of a
successful overflow.
Overflow route
For each route, the administrator can also define an overflow route. If all the
trunks of a route are busy during a seizure attempt, the search for trunks
continues among all trunks in the overflow route. If all the trunks in the overflow
route are busy as well, no further overflow occurs.
Type of seizure
For an outgoing route seizure, the administrator can specify the criteria to be used
by the communication system when searching for a free trunk in the required
direction. This is done by defining the type of seizure as follows:
320
•
cyclic:
after the last outbound seized trunk - search begins at the next higher trunk
number, as of the last outgoing trunk reserved for that direction. Consequently, all trunks are used with the same frequency.
•
linear:
always the first free trunk - search begins at the lowest trunk number assigned
to that route.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Outside Line (MX)
Entering a PABX Number, Incoming and Outgoing
To implement the CLI no screening feature, the administrator can define the
PABX number for incoming and outgoing calls separately. If no “PABX number
outgoing” has been configured, the communication system will always use the
data of the “PABX number incoming” setting. In the case of an incoming seizure
on an ISDN line, the communication system truncates the PABX number (leftaligned) from the received phone number and interprets remaining portion as the
Direct Inward Dialing number. For call number information to the PSTN, the
communication system automatically inserts the PABX number as the leading
portion of the call number. This does not apply to dialing information (destination
address). In Germany, the PABX number must omit the area code and the
attendant code.
Station Number Transmission
The station number that is sent to the PSTN and to the receiver can be composed
as follows:
Type
Station number transmitted to the PSTN
Unknown
only DID number (default setting)
PABX number
PABX number + DID number
Local area code
+ Local area code + PABX number + DID number
Country code
Country code + Local area code + PABX number + DID number
Internal
Only for networked system: number prefixes may not be added for
closed numbering plans. Call number prefixes are suppressed here.
In addition, you can specify which call number information is to be transmitted
from the dialing station to the destination station.
Type
Station number transmitted to the PSTN
Internal
In this case, only the internal call number is transmitted. If the destination is an external station, either no number is transmitted or only
that of the attendant. The internal call number can be displayed
when the destination is an internal station.
Direct inward dialing
In this case, only the DID number is transmitted. The internal call
number is not provided for display at internal destinations in other
nodes. The call number information is sufficient for external destinations.
Internal / DID
This setting is useful for networking purposes. Both the internal call
number and the DID call number are transmitted to the destination
station. If an internal station is called within the network, the internal
call number of the caller can be displayed for this station. If the
internal destination station has activated call forwarding to an external destination, for example, a DID number can also be transmitted
in this case.
In addition, the communication system can extend the call number for outgoing
and incoming connections by adding the seizure code (direction prefix).
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
321
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Outside Line (MX)
Second CO Code
A second trunk code is defined only if the communication system is a subsystem
of another communication system or is networked with several other communication systems. In this case, the second trunk code is the seizure code for the
main system. With this code, the subsystem can access the CO trunks of the main
system.
Related Topics
9.3.2.1 How to Change a Route Assignment
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Telephony > Trunks/Routing.
3) Navigate in the menu tree under Trunks/Routing > Trunks > ... to the
desired line.
4) Click the Change Line tab.
5) Select the route that you want to assign to the trunk from the Routes dropdown list.
6) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
9.3.2.2 How to Change the Route Name
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Telephony > Trunks/Routing.
3) Click Trunks/Routing > Route in the menu tree.
4) Click on the entry that you want to edit under Route in the menu tree.
5) Enter the desired value in the Route Name field.
6) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
322
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Outside Line (MX)
9.3.2.3 How to Change the Seizure Code
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
INFO: Seizure codes only work if LCR has not been activated.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Telephony > Trunks/Routing.
3) Click Trunks/Routing > Route in the menu tree.
4) Click on the entry that you want to edit under Route in the menu tree.
5) Enter the desired value in the Seizure code field.
6) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
9.3.2.4 How to Enter an Overflow Route
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Trunks / Routing.
3) Click Trunks / Routing > Route in the menu tree.
4) Click on the entry that you want to edit under Route in the menu tree.
5) Select the desired item from the Overflow route drop-down list.
6) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
9.3.2.5 How to Configure the Type of Seizure
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Telephony > Trunks/Routing.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
323
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Outside Line (MX)
3) Click Trunks/Routing > Route in the menu tree.
4) Click on the route that you want to edit under Route in the menu tree.
5) Click the Change Routing Parameters tab.
6) In the Type of seizure drop-down list, select either cyclic or linear.
7) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
9.3.2.6 How to Enter a PABX Number Incoming and Outgoing
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Trunks / Routing.
3) Click Trunks / Routing > Route in the menu tree.
4) Click on the entry that you want to edit under Route in the menu tree.
5) In the PABX number incoming area, enter the appropriate values without
leading zeros in the fields Country Code, Local area code and PABX
number.
6) In the PABX number Outgoing area, enter the appropriate values without
leading zeros in the fields Country Code, Local area code and PABX
number.
7) Select one of the following options:
•
If you want to suppress the station number, enable the Suppress station
number check box.
•
If you do not want to suppress the station number, leave the Suppress
station number disabled.
8) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
9.3.2.7 How to Configure Station Number Transmission
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Telephony > Trunks/Routing.
3) Click Trunks/Routing > Route in the menu tree.
324
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Outside Line (MX)
4) Click on the route that you want to edit under Route in the menu tree.
5) Click the Change Routing Parameters tab.
6) Select the type of station number transmission in the No. and type, outgoing
drop-down list:
7) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
9.3.2.8 How to Configure Call Number Information
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Telephony > Trunks/Routing.
3) Click Trunks/Routing > Route in the menu tree.
4) Click on the route that you want to edit under Route in the menu tree.
5) Click the Change Routing Parameters tab.
6) In the Call number type drop-down list, select the item Internal, Direct
inward dialing or Internal/DID.
7) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
9.3.2.9 How to Configure the Direction Prefix
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Telephony > Trunks/Routing.
3) Click Trunks/Routing > Route in the menu tree.
4) Click on the route that you want to edit under Route in the menu tree.
5) Click the Change Routing Parameters tab.
6) Select one of the following options:
•
If you want the seizure code to be added to the Calling Line ID for inbound
calls, select the check box Add direction prefix incoming in the
Routing flags area.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
325
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Outside Line (MX)
•
If you do not want the seizure code to be added to the Calling Line ID for
inbound calls, clear the check box Add direction prefix incoming in the
Routing flags area.
•
If you want the seizure code to be added to the Calling Line ID for
outbound calls, select the check box Add direction prefix outgoing in
the Routing flags area.
•
If you do not want the seizure code to be added to the Calling Line ID for
outbound calls, clear the check box Add direction prefix outgoing in the
Routing flags area.
7) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
9.3.2.10 How to Enter a Second CO Code
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Telephony > Trunks/Routing.
3) Click Trunks/Routing > Route in the menu tree.
4) Click on the entry that you want to edit under Route in the menu tree.
5) Enter the desired value in the field CO code (2nd trunk code).
6) Click the Change Routing Parameters tab.
7) Select the item PABX in the Route type drop-down list.
8) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
9.3.3 Prioritization for Exchange Line Seizure (LX/MX)
The prioritization for exchange line seizure defines in what order different network
providers (ISDN/analog or ITSPs) are selected.
The exchange line seizure normally occurs by dialing the prefix “0”. Within this
code, different providers are prioritized (depending on what is preset). For
example, an outbound call may be first routed via an ITSP and, if the exchange
line seizure fails, be then sent via ISDN.
Related Topics
9.3.3.1 How to Prioritize the Seizure of Exchange Lines
The CO Trunk ISDN / Analog wizard can be used to configure the order in which
exchanges lines are seized over ISDN/analog Providers and ITSPs.
326
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Outside Line (MX)
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Different ITSPs have been set up.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Central Telephony.
3) Click on Edit to start the CO Trunk ISDN / Analog / ITSP wizard. The wizard
displays an overview of the box(es), slot(s) and analog ports.
4) Click OK & Next.
5) Continue clicking on OK & Next as often as needed until you reach the Prioritization for Exchange Line Seizure window.
6) In the Try to get ‘Outside line Seizure’ area, select the preferred network
provider over which the communication system should first try to obtain a free
CO trunk (i.e., an exchange line) from the First over drop-down list.
7) Then select a second network provider over which the next attempt to seize
an exchange line should be made from the Next over drop-down list.
8) Finally, select a third network provider over which an attempt to seize an
exchange line should be made from the following Next over drop-down list.
9) Click OK & Next followed by Finish.
Related Topics
9.3.4 Dial Tone Monitoring
When setting up a connection over an analog trunk line, the dialed digits can be
sent to the Central Office only when a dial tone (audible signal) has been
detected. Since the time until the arrival of the dial tone varies depending on the
network provider and network state, the arrival of the dial tone can be monitored.
Delay Period for Dial Tone Monitoring
The monitoring of the dial tone can be done immediately or only after a pause. In
some cases, additional tones may need to be played back to the subscriber after
the line is seized, for example, to inform him or her that call forwarding has been
enabled at the Central office. For such cases, a delay period for the dial tone
monitoring (Analog trunk seizure, 1-9 seconds) can be programmed. The dialed
digits will then be sent to the CO only after this pause.
INFO: Notes for Brazil:
If the DTMF dialing method is used from analog phone devices in
conjunction with analog trunks (TLAx and TML8W) and pulse
dialing after the dial tone monitoring, problems may arise with toll
restriction when the country code is set to Brazil. In this case, the
DTMF signals from the analog devices go directly to the analog
trunk lines. All DTMF signals that were dialed before receiving the
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
327
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Outside Line (MX)
dial tone are lost. Consequently, for such cases, least cost routing
(LCR) must be enabled for the dialing method and toll restriction
to operate properly at the device.
Analysis of the Second Dial Tone
The communication system can recognize an additional dial tone (2nd dial tone).
This is relevant for public network providers who transmit at a second dial tone for
international calls, e.g., for Belgium after 00 and for France after 16 or 19. For
Germany, this feature is not relevant.
Related Topics
9.3.4.1 How to Configure a Delay Period for Dial Tone Monitoring
Prerequisites
•
An analog port with the analog outside line is available.
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Telephony > Trunks/Routing.
3) Click Trunks/Routing > Route in the menu tree.
4) Click on the analog route that you want to edit under Route in the menu tree.
5) Click the Change Routing Parameters tab.
6) If the dial tone monitoring is to take place immediately, enable the radio button
no pause in the Analog trunk seizure area.
7) If the dial tone monitoring is to take place only after a delay period, select the
delay period in seconds in the Analog trunk seizure area.
8) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
9.3.4.2 How to Enable or Disable the Analysis of the Second Dial Tone
Prerequisites
•
An analog port with the analog outside line is available.
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Telephony > Trunks/Routing.
3) Click Trunks/Routing > Route in the menu tree.
328
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Connection to Service Provider (LX/MX)
Outside Line (MX)
4) Click on the analog route that you want to edit under Route in the menu tree.
5) Click the Change Routing Parameters tab.
6) If you want to enable the analysis of the second dial tone, select the Analysis
of second dial tone check box in the Routing flags area.
7) If you want to disable the analysis of the second dial tone, clear the Analysis
of second dial tone check box in the Routing flags area.
8) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
329
Stations
Dial Plan
10 Stations
A subscriber or station is a communication partner connected to the communication system. In general, every station (apart from virtual stations) is assigned a
terminal. A terminal is, for example, a telephone, a PC or fax device. The
subscribers can also be users of the OpenScape Office clients (e.g., users of
myPortal for Outlook). A default dial plan facilitates the administration.
The following types of stations exist:
•
IP stations (also known as IP clients)
•
ISDN stations
•
Analog stations
•
Mobile stations (Mobility Clients)
•
Virtual stations for call forwarding
The data of subscribers (name, station number, DID number, e-mail address, etc.)
can be imported (see Individual Dial Plan for OpenScape Office LX/MX ) and
exported (see Exporting Subscriber Data ) as a CSV file.
Related Topics
10.1 Dial Plan
A dial plan, which is also called a numbering plan, is a list of all phone numbers
and codes available in the communication system. It includes, among other
things, the internal call numbers, DID numbers and group call numbers. Most of
the call numbers are preassigned default values, but these can be changed as
required.
The dial plan with the currently configured phone numbers and codes can be
displayed via the OpenScape Office Assistant Service Center. If names have
been assigned to the call numbers, these are shown.
All types of call numbers and codes are summarized in the following table, using
OpenScape Office MX as an example.
A sample dial plan of OpenScape Office LX can be found under Dial Plan .
330
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
Dial Plan
Type of call numbers
Preset value
Action
Station numbers for IP stations (max. 297 + 3)
100 – 249 (+ 7070, 7080 and 7090)
deletable
Phone numbers for analog stations (25 preset / max. 96)
250 – 274
deletable
Phone Numbers for ISDN stations (25 preset / max. 48)
275 – 299
deletable
Station numbers for virtual stations (max. 70)
1025 – 1094
deletable
DID numbers of the stations
not preset
deletable
Internal group station numbers & direct inward dialing
not preset
deletable
Trunk numbers (max. 250)
not preset
deletable
Announcement call numbers (max. 16)
#801 - #816
only editable
Station numbers for online users
7070
only editable
Call number for remote access
7080
only editable
Call number for automatic licensing
7090
only editable
Call number for voicemail
71
only editable
Conference phone numbers (5 preset / max. 20)
7400 – 7404, 7430
only editable
Call number for parking
7405
only editable
AutoAttendant Phone Numbers (max. 20)
7410 – 7429
only editable
Seizure code 1 (external code)
0 = World / 9 = USA
only editable
Seizure code 2-6
80 – 84
only editable
Access Code for Music on Hold
#817
only editable
Station number for Attendant Console
9 = World / 0 = USA
only editable
Substitution for “#” (for service codes)
72
deletable
Substitution for “#” (for service codes)
73
deletable
Service Codes
Service Codes Table (see Codes for Acti- not editable
vating and Deactivating Features (LX/
MX) )
Seizure codes (6 preset / max. 64)
INFO: When setting up call numbers or codes, error messages
ay be produced if the desired number is already being used. The
dial plan can be used to check which call numbers can still be
assigned.
INFO: If an internetwork with multiple communication systems is
involved, it must be noted that only a closed numbering system for
the station numbers may be used (see Dial Plan in the Network ).
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
331
Stations
Dial Plan
10.1.1 Default Dial Plan for OpenScape Office LX/MX
Most of the call numbers in the default dial plan for OpenScape Office LX/MX are
predefined with default values.
Related Topics
10.1.1.1 How to Display the Dial Plan
You can view all the station numbers and codes configured in
OpenScape Office MX by displaying the dial plan.
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) Click Service Center on the navigation bar.
2) Click Diagnostics > Status in the navigation tree.
3) Click the Dialplan tab. All currently configured call numbers and codes are
displayed.
Related Topics
10.1.2 Individual Dial Plan for OpenScape Office LX/MX
OpenScape Office LX/MX allows you to set up an individual dial plan by editing
the predefined call numbers.
The following actions are useful for this purpose:
•
Delete defaults: apart from some exceptions (special default numbers),
default call numbers can be deleted. These call numbers are identified as
“deletable” in the “Action” column.
•
Edit special defaults: these call numbers must not be deleted. However, their
values may be edited. These call numbers are identified as “only editable” in
the “Action” column.
•
Import call numbers and station data: station data can be imported via a CSV
file. The call numbers and DID numbers of the stations are imported as well.
Importing Station Data via a CSV File
An individual dial plan can be imported into OpenScape Office. The data must be
available as a CSV file.
A sample CSV file with the appropriate explanations can be found in the
OpenScape Office Assistant Administration Program under Service Center >
Download Center > CSV Templates. You can also use the CSV file stored there
as a template for your data.
Structure of a CSV file:
•
332
Column A contains the call number (possible values: 0-9,*,#)
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
Dial Plan
•
Column B contains the DID number (possible values: 0-9,*,#)
•
Column C contains the name (in the format First Name Last Name or
Last Name, First Name)
The name of a subscriber can consist of up to 16 characters, but must not
include any diacritical characters such as umlauts or special characters.
•
Column D contains the subscriber type (e.g., 1=System Client, 2=SIP User,
3=SIP Fax, 4=RAS User, 5=Analog, 6=Analog Fax, ...)
•
Column E contains the license type (<no entry> or 0=No Licence, 1=Comfort
User, 2=Comfort Plus User)
•
Column F contains the e-mail address
Users of the UC Suite are automatically sent an e-mail with a link to the installation file(s) if their respective e-mail addresses were imported via the CSV
file.
•
Column G contains the mobile number (possible values: 0-9,*,#)
•
Column H contains the private number (possible values: 0-9,*,#)
•
Column I contains the node ID (possible values: 0-999)
This column must be assigned a value; otherwise, no import will occur. If the
system is not networked, 0 must be entered here.
•
Column J contains the IP address of the second gateway
IMPORTANT:
CSV files must be available in ANSI/ASCII format.
CSV files of older OpenScape Office versions are not supported.
Related Topics
10.1.2.1 How to Delete or Edit Default Phone Numbers
You can delete some of the default call numbers and then redefine them via the
wizards. For special default call numbers, you can edit and change the default
values.
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) Click Edit to start the Basic Installation wizard.
3) Click Next.
INFO: You can have an overview of all configured station
numbers displayed by enabling the radio button Display station
configuration and then clicking Execute function.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
333
Stations
Dial Plan
4) Enable the radio button Delete All station call numbers.
5) Enable the check box Delete all station call numbers in the confirmation
prompt.
6) Click Execute function.
7) Edit the default values in the fields of the special default call numbers (and
codes) if required.
8) Click OK. The call numbers are deleted, and any other changes made to the
special default call numbers are applied.
9) Click Cancel to end the Basic Installation wizard.
Related Topics
10.1.2.2 How to Edit Special Default Call Numbers
You can dit the predefined station numbers for special functions, e.g., the function
codes for conferences.
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) Click Edit to start the Basic Installation wizard.
3) Click Next.
INFO: You can have an overview of all configured station
numbers displayed by enabling the radio button Display station
configuration and then clicking Execute function.
4) Enable the radio button Change pre-configured call and functional
numbers.
5) Click Execute function.
6) Enter the desired call numbers and codes in the fields and click OK. The new
call numbers and codes are saved.
INFO: Note that the call numbers configured here cannot be
assigned as station numbers, DID numbers or group call
numbers.
7) Click Cancel to end the Basic Installation wizard.
Related Topics
334
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
IP Stations and LAN Telephony (LX/MX)
10.1.2.3 How to Import Call Numbers and Station Data
You can import predefined station data via a CSV file you created earlier.
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) Click Edit to start the Basic Installation wizard.
3) Click Next.
INFO: You can have an overview of all configured station
numbers displayed by enabling the radio button Display station
configuration and then clicking Execute function.
4) Enable the radio button Stations configuration by importing CSV file.
5) Click Execute function.
6) Use Browse to select the created CSV file and click Open.
7) Click OK when finished. The station data is imported.
8) Click Cancel to end the Basic Installation wizard.
Related Topics
10.2 IP Stations and LAN Telephony (LX/MX)
The term LAN telephony refers to making and receiving calls in the internal
network (LAN). To enable this, the communication system and IP stations must
be integrated in the LAN infrastructure during the initial startup.
The communication partners (IP stations) can be PCs as well as any phones
suitable for LAN telephony (e.g., system telephones or even SIP phones).
In order to enable the system telephones to log into the communication system
automatically during the initial startup and obtain the latest software updates, a
DHCP server is required in the internal network.
To guarantee loss-free transmission and good voice quality, voice signals are
compressed using audio codecs and marked using special procedures (Quality
of Service) so that voice transmission has priority over data.
Related Topics
10.2.1 IP User
An IP station uses a LAN line to transmit digital signals. The communication
system connects the IP station via the LAN ports. An IP station is generally a LAN
or WLAN phone.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
335
Stations
IP Stations and LAN Telephony (LX/MX)
The following types of IP stations exist:
•
System Client: A system client is an IP station that can use all the features
of the communication system for communication in the internal network. This
can be a system telephone such as an OpenStage 60 HFA, for instance, or a
PC with CTI software such as OpenScape Personal Edition.
•
SIP client: A SIP client is an IP station that uses the SIP protocol. It can
access only limited functionality of the communication system via the SIP
protocol. A SIP client is a SIP phone such as the OpenStage 15 S, for
example.
•
RAS User: A RAS user (Remote Access Service user) is granted Internet
access to the IP network via the ISDN connection. This allows the communication system to be maintained remotely.
Three IP stations are reserved for the Online User (call number 7070), for remote
access via ISDN (call number 7080) and licensing via ISDN (call number 7090).
The remaining IP stations are assigned internal call numbers, e.g., 100 through
297, depending on the communication system. If the three reserved stations are
not required, these stations can be converted to IP stations in Expert mode.
For each connected IP station, a license is required.
Configuring IP Stations
The following configurations can be performed for an IP station:
•
Configuration of standard parameters with the IP Telephones wizard (see
How to Configure IP Stations ).
•
Configuration of all parameters (standard and advanced parameters) in
Expert mode (see Configuring Stations in Expert Mode (LX/MX) ).
Related Topics
10.2.2 LAN Telephony Requirements (LX/MX)
To ensure the quality of the voice transmission in LAN telephony, the IP networks
being used and the communication system must meet certain requirements. The
voice quality and voice communication reliability always depend on the network
technology in use.
Requirements
336
•
LAN with 100 Mbps or higher
•
Every component in the IP network must be connected to a separate port on
a switch or to a router; a hub should not be used.
•
Not more than 50 msec delay in one direction (One Way Delay); not more
than 150 msec total delay
•
Max. 3% packet loss; if a fax/modem via G.711 is used, the packet loss must
not exceed 0.05%.
•
Not more than 20 msec jitter
•
Support for Quality of Service (QoS): IEEE 802.p, DiffServ (RFC 2474) or ToS
(RFC 791)
•
Maximum 40% network load
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
IP Stations and LAN Telephony (LX/MX)
Related Topics
10.2.3 IP Addresses (LX/MX)
In order to integrate the communication system in the LAN infrastructure, the IP
address and internal IP address range of the communication system must be
adapted to the IP address scheme of the internal network.
The IP address and subnet mask of the communication system are defined during
the initial startup. The IP address and subnet mask can also be changed later if
required.
By default, the communication system uses the IP address range 192.168.2.xxx
for the internal communication of its modules. If this IP address range is already
being used by other clients in the internal network, the communication system
automatically switches to another predefined IP address range. Overall, the
communication system can switch the IP address range automatically up to four
times.
The internal IP address range can also be set to a desired IP address range. The
internal subnet mask is 255.255.255.0 and cannot be changed.
To activate the changes, a restart of the communication system is required.
The changes to the IP address and internal IP address range remain in effect with
a software update, but will be reset to the default values in the event of a reload.
These changes cannot be stored in a backup set.
Related Topics
10.2.3.1 How to Change the OpenScape Office MX IP Address and Subnet Mask
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) Click Edit to start the Initial Installation wizard.
3) Under OpenScape Office - IP Address, edit the OpenScape Office MX IP
address. The IP address must conform to the IP address scheme of the
internal network and must not have been assigned to any network client,
since this would otherwise result in an IP address conflict. By default, the IP
address 192.168.1.2 is entered here.
4) Under OpenScape Office - Subnet Mask, edit the OpenScape Office MX
subnet mask. The subnet mask must match the IP address scheme of the
internal network. By default, the subnet mask will have been entered as
255.255.255.0.
5) Click OK & Next.
6) Keep clicking OK & Next until you receive a message that the feature has
been installed.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
337
Stations
IP Stations and LAN Telephony (LX/MX)
7) Click Finish.
Related Topics
10.2.3.2 How to Change the OpenScape Office LX IP Address and Subnet Mask
Step by Step
1) Click on Computer in the task bar.
2) Click in the menu tree on System > YaST.
3) Enter the password for the root user and click Continue. The YaST Control
Center is opened.
4) Click on Network Devices in the menu tree.
5) In the Network Devices area, click on Network Settings.
6) Select the desired network card in the Overview window and click on Edit.
7) Enable the radio button Statically assigned IP Address.
8) Under IP address, edit the IP address of the OpenScape Office LX Linux
server. The IP address must conform to the IP address scheme of the internal
network and must not have been assigned to any network client, since this
would otherwise result in an IP address conflict.
9) Under Subnet mask, edit the subnet mask of the OpenScape Office LX Linux
server. The subnet mask must conform to the IP address scheme of the
internal network.
10) Click Next followed by OK.
11) Close the YaST Control Center.
Related Topics
10.2.3.3 How to Change the Internal IP Address Range
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) Click Maintenance > Appl. Diagnostics in the navigation tree.
3) Click in the menu tree on Central Box > Mainboard > internal_IP: set/reset
range functions > Set an individual internal IP range (3 values).
4) Enter the desired IP address range in the Parameter field. The individual
segments must be separated by commas, e.g., 192,168,10 for the IP
address range 192.168.10.xxx.
5) Click Send.
6) Restart OpenScape Office MX.
Related Topics
338
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
IP Stations and LAN Telephony (LX/MX)
10.2.3.4 How to Reset the Internal IP Address Range
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) Click Maintenance > Appl. Diagnostics in the navigation tree.
3) Click in the menu tree on Central Box > Mainboard > internal_IP: set/reset
range functions > Reset the internal IP range to system decided range.
4) Click Send.
5) Restart OpenScape Office MX.
Related Topics
10.2.4 DHCP, Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (LX/MX)
DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol) automatically assigns IP configuration parameters (such as the IP address and default gateway, for example) to
the IP stations of a network (e.g., LAN or Internet) with the help of a DHCP server.
DHCP must also be enabled at the IP stations themselves (e.g., system
telephones, PCs, etc.) in order to receive the IP configuration parameters. This
enables system telephones to be supplied with data for an automatic login and to
be updated automatically with new software updates.
DHCP Server
OpenScape Office MX is configured as a DHCP server by default. For
OpenScape Office LX, the Linux server can be configured as a DHCP server.
Alternatively, any existing DHCP server in the network could also be used (e.g.,
DHCP server of the Internet router). In this case, the DHCP server of the communication system must be disabled, and some IP configuration parameters
(vendor-specific data) must be set in the external DHCP server so that system
telephones can log in automatically and be supplied with new software updates.
The decision as to whether the DHCP server of the communication system or an
external DHCP server (e.g., the DHCP server of the Internet router) is to be used
should be made during the initial startup. The DHCP server of the communication
system can also be enabled or disabled later. In addition, the required IP configuration parameters can be configured.
DHCP Address Pool (IP Address Ranges)
Whenever an IP station logs in at the DHCP server, it receives, among other
things, a dynamically assigned IP address. The administrator can optionally
define an IP address range from which the DHCP server can assign IP addresses
to the IP stations. In this case, for example, not all IP addresses from the range
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
339
Stations
IP Stations and LAN Telephony (LX/MX)
192.168.1.xx are to be assigned, but only those from 192.168.1.50 to
192.168.1.254, since the lower IP addresses up to 192.168.1.49 are to be
reserved for IP stations with static IP addresses.
DHCP Relay Agent
OpenScape Office MX can also be configured as a DHCP relay agent. The DHCP
relay agent is used to forward DHCP requests in a remote network to the actual
DHCP server.
Related Topics
10.2.4.1 How to Deactivate OpenScape Office MX DHCP
The DHCP wizard can be used to deactivate the DHCP server of
OpenScape Office MX.
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Network/Internet.
3) Click Edit to start the Network Configuration wizard.
4) Clear the Enable DHCP Server check box.
5) Keep clicking OK & Next until you receive a message that the feature has
been installed.
6) Click Finish.
Related Topics
10.2.4.2 How to Activate and Configure OpenScape Office MX DHCP
The DHCP wizard can be used to activate and configure the DHCP server of
OpenScape Office MX.
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Network/Internet.
3) Click Edit to start the Network Configuration wizard.
4) Enable the DHCP Server check box.
5) A message appears to notify you that the DHCP server was enabled. Confirm
this message.
340
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
IP Stations and LAN Telephony (LX/MX)
6) Enter the subnet mask of your network in the Subnet Mask field (e.g.,
255.255.255.0).
7) In the field Broadcast Address, enter the Broadcast address (“last” address
of the net or subnet, default: 0.0.0.0) if required.
8) In the field Preferred Gateway, enter the IP address of the default gateway.
As a rule, the IP address for the Internet router is usually 192.168.1.1.
9) If you need a fully qualified domain name for the DHCP server, enter this
under Domain Name (max. 80 characters).
10) In the field Preferred Server, enter the IP address of an available DNS
server, e.g., the IP address of the Internet router, 192.168.1.1.
11) If required, enter the maximum lease time in hours (default: 1 h, 0 = infinite
lease time) in the field Lease Time in hours (0 = infinite).
12) If you want to permit dynamic updates of the DNS server, enable the option
Enable Dynamic DNS Update (default: disabled).
13) Click OK & Next. The settings for the DHCP address pool are displayed.
14) In the Subnet Address field, enter the lowest IP address of the subnet in
which the desired IP address range is located (in our example,
192.168.1.0).
15) Enter the subnet mask of the desired IP address range in the Subnet Mask
field (e.g., 255.255.255.0).
16) Enter the upper and lower threshold for the desired IP address range in the
Address Range 1 field (e.g., 192.168.1.50 to 192.168.1.254).
17) Click OK & Next. The Routing Settings window appears.
18) In the field IP Address of DNS Server, enter the IP address of an available
DNS server, e.g., the IP address of the Internet router, 192.168.1.1.
19) Select the item LAN from the Default Routing via drop-down list.
20) IIf access to the Internet occurs via an Internet router, enter the IP address of
the Internet router (e.g., 192.168.1.1) in the IP address of Default Router
field.
21) Click OK & Next followed by Finish.
Related Topics
10.2.4.3 How to Configure OpenScape Office MX as a DHCP Relay Agent
If OpenScape Office MX is configured as a DHCP relay agent, the communication system relays DHCP requests on to the external DHCP server.
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
341
Stations
IP Stations and LAN Telephony (LX/MX)
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) Click on Telephony > Network Interfaces in the navigation tree.
3) In the menu tree, click on DHCP.
4) Enable the DHCP Relay Agent radio button.
5) Click Apply and confirm with OK.
6) Click DHCP Relay Agent in the menu tree.
7) Enter the IP address of the first DHCP server.
8) Enter the IP address of the second DHCP server.
9) Enter the IP address of the third DHCP server.
INFO: You can enter up to three DHCP servers, but this is not
required. Only the entry of the first DHCP server is mandatory.
10) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
10.2.4.4 How to Activate and Configure OpenScape Office LX DHCP
Step by Step
1) Click on Computer in the task bar.
2) Click in the menu tree on System > YaST.
3) Enter the password for the root user and click Continue. The YaST Control
Center is opened.
4) Click on Network Services in the menu tree.
5) In the Network Services area, click on DHCP Server.
6) Mark the desired network card and click Select.
7) Select the Open Firewall for Selected Interfaces check box.
8) Click Next.
9) If you need a fully qualified domain name for the DHCP server, enter this
under Domain Name (max. 80 characters).
10) In the field Primary Name Server IP, enter the IP address of an available
DNS server, e.g., the IP address of the Internet router, 192.168.1.1.
11) In the field Default Gateway (Router), enter the IP address of the default
gateway. As a rule, the IP address for the Internet router is usually
192.168.1.1.
12) Enter the NTP server configured during initial setup in the NTP Time Server
field.
13) Click Next.
342
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
IP Stations and LAN Telephony (LX/MX)
14) Enter the lower limit of the desired IP address range in the field First IP
Address and its upper limit in the field Last IP Address (e.g.,
192.168.1.50 to 192.168.1.254).
15) Select the Allow Dynamic BOOTP check box.
16) Click Next.
17) Enable the When Booting radio button.
18) Click Finish.
19) Close the YaST Control Center.
Related Topics
10.2.4.5 How to Deactivate OpenScape Office LX DHCP
Step by Step
1) Click on Computer in the task bar.
2) Click in the menu tree on System > YaST.
3) Enter the password for the root user and click Continue. The YaST Control
Center is opened.
4) Click on Network Services in the menu tree.
5) In the Network Services area, click on DHCP Server.
6) Mark the desired network card and click Select.
7) Click Next.
8) Click Next.
9) Click Next.
10) Click on DHCP Servers Expert Configuration.
11) Clear the Start DHCP Server check box.
12) Click Finish.
13) Close the YaST Control Center.
Related Topics
10.2.5 IP Protocols (LX/MX)
IP protocols permit telephony in IP networks by transferring the signals needed
for the call.
Telephone calls consist of three stages: connection setup, voice transmission,
and connection cleardown. The voice signals are combined into individual IP
packets and transmitted via a protocol separate from connection setup and
cleardown (call signaling).
IP protocols for Call Signaling in IP Telephony
The IP protocols for call signaling are based on the following IP protocol:
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
343
Stations
IP Stations and LAN Telephony (LX/MX)
•
TCP (Transmission Control Protocol)
TCP is a reliable, connection-oriented protocol for the transmission of IP
packets. Before transfer starts, a virtual channel is set up between the two
terminal points. Data can be transmitted in both directions on this channel.
TCP is mainly used in the WorldWideWeb and in e-mail and peer-to-peer
networks. It is also used for call signaling in IP telephony because it can
detect and automatically rectify data losses during transmission.
The following IP protocols are used for call signaling:
•
SIP (Session Initiation Protocol)
SIP is usually used in Internet telephony but is not restricted to it. It can also
be used for telephony in the internal network, for example. However, SIP does
not support all telephony features associated with a communication system.
•
Vendor-specific communication system protocol
OpenScape Office MX uses CorNet-IP (CorNet Internet Protocol) for IP
telephony within the internal network. CorNet-IP, which was developed on the
basis of H.323, supports all telephone features in (HiPath ComScendo
functional scope).
The protocol used depends on the IP station used. The communication system’s
own IP phones (system clients) support CorNet-IP and thus provide all the
telephony features of OpenScape Office MX, whereas system phones can only
offer a restricted functional scope.
The SIP protocol is more widely used than H.323 in Internet telephony. The most
important Internet Telephony Service Providers (ITSP) use SIP exclusively.
IP Protocols for Voice Transmission in IP telephony
The IP protocol for transmitting IP voice packets is based on the following IP
protocol:
•
UDP (User Datagram Protocol)
UDP is a reliable, connectionless protocol for the transmission of IP packets.
In contrast to TCP/peer scenarios, a virtual channel is not set up before
transfer starts so that the PCs can start transferring data without delay. In
UDP, the port number of the service that should receive the data is included
when addressing voice packets. It is mainly used in the DNS sector and for
voice transmission in IP telephony. However, since a connectionless protocol
does not check if the peer actually received the data, this option can result in
voice transfer losses.
The following IP protocol is used for the transmission of IP voice packets:
•
RTP (Realtime Transport Protocol)
RTP is a packet-based protocol for the transmission of real-time sensitive
data streams such as video and audio data. It is used, for example, for voice
transmission in IP telephony.
Parameter Settings for H.323
The parameters for the H.323 Standard are appropriately predefined for the
operation of OpenScape Office MX and should not be modified.
344
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
IP Stations and LAN Telephony (LX/MX)
Parameter Settings for SIP
Most of the parameters for the SIP Protocol are appropriately predefined for the
operation of OpenScape Office MX and should not be modified. However, the
value that defines the maximum number of DSL calls that may be conducted
concurrently, even if more bandwidth is available, can be set as required.
Related Topics
10.2.5.1 How to Configure H.323 Parameters
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
INFO: The parameters offered here are only provided for special
configurations and should usually not be changed.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Voice Gateway.
3) Click H.323 Parameters in the menu tree.
4) The parameters offered here are only provided for special configurations and
should usually not be changed.
5) Click OK.
Related Topics
10.2.5.2 How to Configure SIP Parameters
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Voice Gateway.
3) In the menu tree, click SIP Parameters
4) A default value is only entered for the SIP via UDP parameter in special
configurations and, in general, must not be modified.
5) In the Maximum possible Provider Calls field, enter the maximum number
of DSL calls should be conducted concurrently, even if more bandwidth were
available.
6) Click OK.
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
345
Stations
IP Stations and LAN Telephony (LX/MX)
10.2.6 Audio Codecs (LX/MX)
An audio codec (“codec” is created by combining the terms coder and decoder)
is a program that encodes and decodes voice in digital data packets (IP packets).
The encoding operation compresses data; the extent to which this data is
compressed depends heavily on the codec used. The bandwidth requirement for
transferring an IP packet is lower if the packet is compressed. The decoding of
data packets can, however, have a negative impact on voice quality and the
playback continuity.
The recipient and sender must use the same codec to ensure that the data can
be correctly decoded back into voice after transport.
Supported Audio Codecs
The following audio codecs are supported:
•
G.729, G.729A, G.729B, G.729AB: voice encoding with 8 Kbps - good voice
quality.
•
G.711 (A-law and µ-law): voice encoding with 56 or 64 Kbps - very high voice
quality. G.711 is used in fixed networks (ISDN).
The audio codecs can be assigned priorities between 1 (high) and 7 (low).
OpenScape Office MX automatically tries to use the audio codec with the highest
priority available for every connection. Using an audio codec with low voice
compression (good voice quality) increases network load. In the case of intensive
IP telephony, this can lead to diminished voice quality in a network already
overloaded by data transfers.
OpenScape Office MX can enable voice activity detection (VAD) for certain
codecs. This can reduce network load during long voice pauses.
You can specify a frame size (IP packet size) of 10 to 90 msec for every codec.
This specifies the sampling rate at which the audio codec splits the voice signal
into IP packets. While a higher value (90 msec, for instance) results in a better
relationship between payload and the IP packet overhead, it also increases the
transfer delay.
Related Topics
10.2.6.1 How to Configure Audio Codec Parameters
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Voice Gateway.
3) In the menu tree, click Codec Parameters.
4) Assign priority 1 (high) through 7 (low) to the required audio codecs via the
Priority drop-down list.
346
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
IP Stations and LAN Telephony (LX/MX)
5) Activate or deactivate the radio button Voice Activity Detection (VAD) for the
desired audio codecs.
6) Use the Frame Size field for the desired audio codecs to define the frame size
into which the audio codec splits the IP voice packets.
7) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
10.2.6.2 How to Assign Audio Codec Parameters to a Destination
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
INFO: This functionality is not yet implemented. Changing the
parameter has no effect!
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Voice Gateway.
3) In the menu tree, click Destination Codec Parameters.
4) This functionality is not yet implemented. Changing the parameter has no
effect.
5) Click Cancel.
Related Topics
10.2.7 RTP Payload for Telephony Tones According to RFC2833 (LX/MX)
The RTP payload for telephony tones according to RFC2833 transmits tones for
signaling in RTP packets.
As an administrator, you can enable or diable the function for the following types
of tones:
•
DTMF
•
Fax
Related Topics
10.2.7.1 How to Enable or Disable Transmission of DTMF Tones According to RFC2833
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
347
Stations
IP Stations and LAN Telephony (LX/MX)
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Voice Gateway.
3) In the menu tree, click Codec Parameters.
4) Select one of the following options:
•
If you want to enable the function, select the Transmission of DTMF
Tones according to RFC2833 check box.
•
If you want to disable the function, clear the Transmission of DTMF
Tones according to RFC2833 check box.
5) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
10.2.7.2 How to Enable or Disable Transmission of Fax/Modem Tones According to
RFC2833
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Voice Gateway.
3) In the menu tree, click Codec Parameters.
4) Select one of the following options:
•
If you want to enable the function, select the Transmission of Fax/
Modem Tones according to RFC2833 check box.
•
If you want to disable the function, clear the Transmission of Fax/
Modem Tones according to RFC2833 check box.
5) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
10.2.8 Quality of Service (LX/MX)
Quality of Service (QoS) encompasses various procedures for guaranteeing the
highest possible quality and integrity during the transmission of data packets (IP
packets). For good voice quality during voice transmission, QoS is used in the IP
network to give IP voice packets priority over IP data packets from other applications.
The IP packets are assigned a special marker (code point) for prioritization. The
marker is set in the IP-packet control information. Categorization in different
classes is performed based on priority information. If the components available in
348
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
IP Stations and LAN Telephony (LX/MX)
the IP network (communication system, SIP stations, and Internet routers, for
instance) support QoS, you can assign different bandwidth to these classes and
thus transport the IP voice packets first.
AF/EF Code Points
For DiffServ-based prioritization, two different code points are defined so that IPpacket transmission can be split into different classes.
•
Expedited Forwarded (EF) Code point: guarantees constant bandwidth. The
bandwidth is always the same for IP packets marked with this code point.
•
Assured Forwarding (AF) Code point: guarantees minimum bandwidth. IP
packets that are marked with this code point have a lower priority than EF and
must share the bandwidth not used by EF. Once the set value is reached, all
IP packets that exceed this bandwidth are rejected.
The four classes AF1x (highest priority) through AF4x (lowest priority) are
reserved for AF; x stands for “dropping level”. A “dropping Level” can be
defined for every class and specifies how long IP packets can be buffered if
the system is unable to forward them fast enough.
–
1 (low): IP packets are buffered for a long time.
–
2 (medium), IP packets are buffered for a medium length of time.
–
3 (high): IP packets are only buffered for a short length of time and then
discarded.
You can set the code point used for marking the IP packets to be transmitted for
the following transmission types.
•
Signaling Data: for the transmission of signaling data for connection startup
and cleardown in IP telephony
•
Voice Payload: for voice transmission in IP telephony. Code point EF is the
recommended setting here.
•
Fax-/Modem-Payload: for fax/modem data transmission in IP networking, for
example
•
Network Control: for transmitting SNMP traps, for example
The AF/EF code points can be displayed in the form of hexadecimal values.
Priority classes
The priority classes for transmission types can be set in both of the following
forms:
•
•
Layer 3 Prioritization - EF/AF code points:
Application in the WAN, e.g., preferred transmission of IP packets via a router.
The following values can be set in addition to the EF/AF code points:
–
Best Effort: Best Effort can be used to mark packets that do not require
any prioritization, e.g., for the administration.
–
CS7: Class Selector 7 can be used to mark important network services
such as SNMP packets, for instance.
Layer 2 Prioritization - Layer 2 QoS values from 0 To 7:
Application in the VLAN, e.g.,preferred transmission of IP packets between
switches.
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
349
Stations
IP Stations and LAN Telephony (LX/MX)
10.2.8.1 How to Configure Quality of Service (QoS
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) Click Telephony > Basic Settings in the navigation tree.
3) In the menu tree, click Quality of Service.
4) Select the priority class you want in the Priority Class for Signaling Data
drop-down list.
5) Select the priority class you want in the Priority Class for Fax/Modem
Payload drop-down list.
6) Select the priority class you want in the Priority Class for Network Control
drop-down list.
7) Select the priority class you want in the Priority Class for Voice Payload
drop-down list.
8) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
10.2.8.2 How to Display AF/EF Codepoints
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) Click Telephony > Basic Settings in the navigation tree.
3) In the menu tree, click AF/EF Code points. The AF/EF Code points window
appears. The AF/EF code points appear in the form of hexadecimal values.
Related Topics
10.2.9 CorNet-IP Security (LX/MX)
With CorNet-IP Security, sent messages are checked for integrity.
If CorNet-IP Security is to be activated in the IP network, the following settings
must match for all the components involved. Otherwise, communication between
the IP stations cannot occur.
•
350
H.323/TS - Security
Two security modes are available for CorNet-IP Security: Reduced Security
and Full Security.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
IP Stations and LAN Telephony (LX/MX)
–
Reduced security: The IP stations send a realtime stamp (called a crypto
token), and the gatekeeper checks this realtime stamp. However, the
gatekeeper does not send any such token of its own.
–
Full Security: Both sides send and verify tokens (realtime stamps).
•
Global Gatekeeper ID
The global gatekeeper identity is specified here. If multiple gatekeepers are
available in a network, all gatekeepers must use the same gatekeeper ID.
•
Password for Trunking
All systems that communicate with one another in the network must use the
same password.
•
Security time window
This value defines the time for monitoring the lifetime of IP packets. This
means that a check is performed in the gateway to ensure that the incoming
IP packets are not older than the current time plus the specified time. The size
of the Security time depends on the dynamic runtimes in the IP network. If the
selected time is too small, and long runtimes occur, disruptions may be noted
in the VoIP traffic. A value of 90 seconds should work without problems in
most cases.
Gatekeeper
OpenScape Office MX has the integrated functionality of a gatekeeper, i.e.,
OpenScape Office MX functions as a gatekeeper. Signals for setting up and
controlling calls are transmitted via the gatekeeper. In addition, the gatekeeper
also translates IP addresses into E.164 addresses (phone numbers).
The predefined ID H323-ID for the internal gatekeeper is significant for the
operation of OpenScape Office MX and should not be changed.
Related Topics
10.2.9.1 How to Configure CorNet-IP Security
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Voice Gateway.
3) Click Gatekeeper in the menu tree.
4) Click Internal Gatekeeper.
5) Select a security mode from the H.323/TS - Security drop-down list.
•
Reduced security
•
Full Security
Further parameters are displayed.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
351
Stations
IP Stations and LAN Telephony (LX/MX)
6) Specify the parameters for CorNet-IP Security in the same way as was set or
will be set for other components in the IP network.
7) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
10.2.9.2 How to Change the ID of the Internal Gatekeeper
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
INFO: The parameters offered here are only provided for special
configurations and should usually not be changed.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Voice Gateway.
3) Click Gatekeeper in the menu tree.
4) Click Internal Gatekeeper.
5) The parameters offered here are only provided for special configurations and
should usually not be changed.
6) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
10.2.10 Key Programming (LX/MX)
Every system phone comes with a certain number of function keys. A number of
these function keys are programmed by default with functions. You can modify
this default setting and program the remaining function keys that were not preprogrammed.
System phones with display allow you to program certain function keys directly at
the phone.
Users of the applications myPortal, myPortal for Outlook and myAttendant
can also program the keys on their phone via these applications (see the
respective User Guide of the application).
A system phone is always assigned to an IP station. The system phone’s key
layout can be preconfigured for an IP station, even if a system phone is not yet
connected.
352
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
IP Stations and LAN Telephony (LX/MX)
Programming Function Keys on Different Levels
The function keys of the OpenStage phones can be programmed twice, that is, on
the first and second levels. You can program all available functions on the first
level. You can program external phone numbers on the second level. The Shift
key must be programmed on the system phone before you can use the second
level. The function key LEDs are always assigned to the first level.
Related Topics
10.2.10.1 How to Program Function Keys on System Phones
You can use the Key Programming wizard to configure the function keys on the
system phones.
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Telephones / Stations.
3) Click Edit to start the Key Programming wizard. A list of all IP stations is
displayed.
4) Click Edit in the row containing the IP station you want.
5)
Assign the system phone to the IP station:
•
If a system telephone is already connected for the IP station, you will be
presented with a simplified display of the system telephone.
•
If no system telephone is connected for The IP station as yet, select the
system telephone to be connected from the drop-down list. You will then
be presented with a simplified display of the system telephone.
6) Click in the simplified display of the system telephone on the desired key field.
The function keys of the selected key field will be displayed with the currently
assigned functions.
7) Assign functions to the function keys:
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
353
Stations
ISDN Stations and Analog Stations
a) Click on the key symbol for the function key to be assigned. A drop-down
list with the available functions appears.
b) Select one of the offered choices Select Function drop-down list.
c) Some functions require additional information. Select this as needed or
enter the required data.
d) Click Save.
e) If required, edit the function key label in the Change predefined label
field.
INFO: If you have a system telephone with automatic key labeling
(such as an optiPoint 420 Standard, for example), this text will
appear in the display of the function key.
f)
Click Save.
g) If you want to add further function keys, repeat step 7 .
8) If you programmed a function key as the Shift Key, select the Shift Key
check box. Program the second level of the function keys with the external call
numbers as described below under step 7.
9) Click Save Keypad.
10) If you want to apply the key assignment just completed to several or all
system telephones, enable the check box for the desired system phones and
then click on Apply, OK and OK & Next.
11) If you want to apply the key assignment just completed to only the selected
system telephone, first click on Deselect all stations to be on the safe side
and then on OK & Next.
12) Click Next followed by Finish.
Related Topics
10.3 ISDN Stations and Analog Stations
ISDN stations and analog stations cannot be integrated in the internal network via
the LAN ports. With hardware-based communication systems, they are
connected directly to additionally required gateway modules or boards. With
software-based communication systems, these stations are connected to
additionally required gateways or adapters.
Related Topics
10.3.1 ISDN Stations (LX/MX)
An ISDN station uses the 0 bus for transmitting digital signals and is therefore
often referred to an S0 station The ISDN station is connected to the communication system via the S0 interfaces
The following ISDN stations can be connected:
354
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
ISDN Stations and Analog Stations
•
ISDN phone
•
Fax Group 4
•
ISDN modem
•
PC with ISDN card
A maximum of 48 ISDN stations can be set up in OpenScape Office MX. By
default, the first 25 ISDN stations are assigned the station numbers from 275 to
299.
The following types of ISDN stations can be defined:
•
Default: for ISDN phone, Fax Group 4, ISDN modem or PC with ISDN card
•
Fax: prerequisites for setting up the “Info from Fax/Answering Machine” key.
If a PC with an ISDN card and Fax software is attached to the S0 bus and
assigned the type “Fax”, for example, then an “Info from Fax/Answering
Machine” key could be set up on every device. When this key lights up, this
indicates that a fax has been received.
•
Answering machine: prerequisites for picking up a call when the answering
machine has already accepted it If a Gigaset ISDN phone with an answering
machine is connected and assigned the type “Answering Machine”, for
example, a call that has already been accepted by the answering machine
can be picked up at any terminal. To do this, the terminal must be
programmed with the internal call number of the Gigaset.
Connecting ISDN Stations to the S0 Port
To be able to connect an ISDN station to the communication system, you must
configure at least one of the S0 ports that are used for the ISDN subscriber line or
the ISDN point-to-point connection as an internal S0 bus (S0 EURO bus).
INFO: If there is more than one ISDN station connected to an S0
port (up to 8 ISDN stations are possible) in an ISDN point-to-multipoint connection, each individual ISDN station must be assigned
to a unique MSN. This assignment must be made in the configuration menu of the ISDN station.
Configuring ISDN stations
The following configurations can be performed for an ISDN station:
•
Configuration of standard parameters with the ISDN Devices wizard (see
How to Configure ISDN Stations ).
•
Configuration of all parameters (standard and advanced parameters) via
Expert mode (see Configuring Stations in Expert Mode (LX/MX) ).
Allowing only Configured Numbers for MSNs
The administrator can specify that further MSNs at an S0 bus may only be
configured for call numbers that already exist there. This prevents subscribers
from adding an MSN without authorization through an outgoing seizure of the S0
bus with a further MSN. Without this restriction, the communication system would
normally assign a free internal call number to the S0 bus for that MSN.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
355
Stations
ISDN Stations and Analog Stations
Terminal Portability
The communication system supports Terminal Portability (TP), that is, it lets you
park a call on the S0 bus, unplug the terminal, and plug it back in at a new location
to resume the call. The parked station receives a message indicating that the user
is porting. Three minutes are available for the entire operation.
The feature is not supported for services such as telefax, teletex or data transfer.
Related Topics
10.3.1.1 How to Configure the S0 Interface for ISDN Stations
You can use the CO Trunk ISDN / Analog wizard to configure one or more S0
ports so that ISDN phones can be connected to them.
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
•
One of the GMS or GMSA gateway modules is inserted.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Central Telephony.
3) Click Edit in the CO Trunk ISDN / Analog wizard.
4) Click OK & Next. You will receive a list of which gateway modules (slots) are
installed and how many S0 interfaces (S0 ports) are contained in these
gateway modules.
5) Do not alter the setting for the check box No call via ISDN trunk line (S0).
6) Activate the Internal S0 connection radio button for the desired S0 ports.
INFO: These S0 ports can no longer be used for ISDN trunk
access.
7) Keep clicking OK & Next until you receive a message that the editing of the
feature has been completed.
8) Click Finish.
Related Topics
10.3.1.2 How to Allow only Configured Numbers for MSNs
Prerequisites
•
356
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
ISDN Stations and Analog Stations
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) Click Telephony > Basic Settings in the navigation tree.
3) In the menu tree, click Basic Settings > System > System Flags.
4) If you want to allow only configured numbers for MSNs, enable the check box
Use only default number for MSN.
5) If you do not want to allow only configured numbers for MSNs, clear the check
box Use only default number for MSN.
6) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
10.3.2 Analog Stations (LX/MX)
An analog station uses a two-core analog cable to transmit analog signals. The
communication system connects the analog station via the analog ports.
Typical analog stations include the following:
•
Standard (analog telephone)
•
Fax (Group 3)
•
Answering Machine
•
Modem, 9600 bps or higher
•
Loudspeaker
A maximum of 72 analog stations can be set up in OpenScape Office MX. By
default, the first 25 analog stations are assigned the station numbers from 250 to
274. With OpenScape Office LX, analog stations can be added via adapters or
gateways.
Analog modems with a fixed speed of 56 kbps or higher are not supported, since
speeds of 56 kbps or higher cannot be processed.
For multibox systems, analog modems must be connected to the central box,
where the external lines are also connected. In addition, the station type Modem
must be assigned to the associated analog port (see How to Configure Analog
Stations ).
DTMF must be enabled for analog stations.
Configuring Analog Stations
The following configurations can be performed for an analog station:
•
Configuration of standard parameters with the Analog Devices wizard (see
How to Configure Analog Stations ).
•
Configuration of all parameters (standard and advanced parameters) via
Expert mode (see Configuring Stations in Expert Mode (LX/MX) ).
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
357
Stations
Users of the UC Suite
10.4 Users of the UC Suite
Users of the advanced unified communications solution UC Suite are subscribers
that use the UC Suite communication clients, such as myPortal for Desktop or
myPortal for Outlook, for example. The users of the UC Suite can be IP stations
and analog stations, for example.
All users of the UC Suite are listed in the user directory. For proper operation,
additional user data must be configured in the user directory (see Configuring
Users of the UC Suite ).
Related Topics
10.5 Virtual Stations
Virtual stations behave like real stations, but have no physical telephones
assigned to them.
Virtual stations are only set up for special functions:
•
In the case of Mobility Entry, virtual stations are used for the integration of
mobile phones.
•
During call forwarding, virtual stations such as real stations are configured so
that they can be used, for example, for signaling calls.
Related Topics
10.5.1 Virtual Stations for Mobility Entry
Virtual stations for Mobility Entry are mobile stations used for integrating mobile
phones (GSM phones) in the communication system. Mobile stations are treated
like internal stations, so the features of the communication system can be used
from mobile phones.
For an overview of the possible system features and the configuration of mobile
subscribers, see Mobility .
Related Topics
10.5.2 Virtual stations for call forwarding
Virtual stations are needed for call forwarding. These stations must be configured
like real stations so that they can be used for the signaling of calls, for example.
A maximum of 70 virtual stations can be set up.
Configuring Virtual Stations for Call Forwarding
The parameters associated with a virtual station are configured in Expert mode
(see Configuring Stations in Expert Mode (LX/MX) ).
Related Topics
358
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
Station and User Profiles
10.6 Station and User Profiles
The values and properties of subscribers are stored in profiles. One or more
subscribers (members) can be assigned to a profile. The same values and
properties then apply to all members of that profile.
A distinction is made between two profiles:
•
Station Profiles
Station profiles are assigned to the IP stations. Up to 10 station profiles can
be created. The station profiles can be exported or imported individually or
collectively. The files are of type xml.
•
User Profiles
User profiles are assigned to the users of OpenScape Office clients.
Every subscriber can be a member of exactly one profile. If the values and
properties of a station that is a member of a profile are changed directly, i.e., not
through the profile, the station is deleted from the profile.
Related Topics
10.7 Configuring Stations
You can define specific values (for example, phone number, name, and DID
number) and properties (for example, type of call signaling) for the station.
Station configuration is split into standard configuration and advanced configuration. The default settings for IP stations, ISDN stations and analog stations are
configured via wizards (possible with an administrator ID). The advanced settings
are configured using Expert mode (only possible with a service technician ID).
Virtual stations and mobile stations are configured entirely in Expert mode (both
the standard and advanced settings). The default settings can be conveniently
edited in a list for all stations of a station type (e.g., IP stations or analog stations).
The Customer administrator account cannot be used to configure stations, but
can be used to define the names of stations.
A dial plan should be available for the stations connected to the communication
system.
Station numbers, names and DID numbers of subscribers can be retrieved via the
dial plan in the Service Center.
Classes of Service
IP stations, ISDN stations and analog stations can be assigned classes of service.
The following classes of service are possible:
•
Internal: the subscriber may only make internal calls.
•
Incoming: the subscriber can receive external calls but is not authorized to
make external calls (= outward-restricted trunk access).
•
Blocked Phone Numbers: the subscribers is not authorized to dial blocked
phone numbers. Blocked phone numbers can be defined with the Class of
Service wizard.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
359
Stations
Configuring Stations
•
Allowed Numbers: the subscriber is authorized to dial only Allowed
numbers. Blocked phone numbers can be defined with the Class of Service
wizard.
•
International: the subscriber may make both internal and external calls (=
unrestricted).
•
Emergency calls: the subscriber may only dial emergency numbers.
Emergency numbers can be defined with the Class of Service wizard.
Speed-dial destinations can always be used, regardless of the assigned class of
service.
Related Topics
10.7.1 Configuring Stations Using Wizards (LX/MX)
You can use wizards to configure the standard settings of IP stations, ISDN
stations and analog stations.
Default Settings
The default settings should be verified for every station and adapted if required.
360
•
Station Number, Name, DID Number
Every station is assigned a station number by default (such as 101). The
station can be reached internally under this call number. In system phones,
this phone number appears both on the actual display and the communication
partner’s display. If a station number other than the actual station number is
to be displayed at the external station called, this number can be defined here.
You can also assign a DID number to each station. The station can be
accessed directly from an external location with the DID number. The station
can be reached internally via the call number 101, for example, and externally
via the DID number 3654321 (MSN in a point-to-multipoint connection) or
<PABX number>-101 (in a point-to-point connection). In the case of a pointto-point connection, you can configure whether the internal phone number
should be automatically entered as a DID number during initial startup. The
DID number may also differ from the phone number. If you are using Internet
telephony, you can also define a DID number that can be used to reach the
station via Internet telephony. This phone number is made available by the
Internet Telephony Service Provider.
You can also assign a name to each station. This name appears on the
communication partner’s display (system phones only).
If a dial plan exists, the phone numbers, DID numbers, and names of the
subscribers should be adjusted based on the dial plan.
•
Type
The station type can be selected for every station. The station type of an IP
client could be system client or SIP client, for example.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
Configuring Stations
•
License type (IP phones only)
A system phone can be assigned the functional scope of a Comfort User or
Comfort Plus User. Appropriate licenses are needed for this.
INFO: For information on the functional scope of a Comfort User
or Comfort Plus User, see Licenses .
•
Classes of Service
Different classes of service may be assigned to a station. The classes of
service Internal, Incoming and International can be used to define whether
the subscriber can accept and conduct external calls. Similarly, the classes of
service Blocked Phone Numbers, Allowed Numbers and Emergency
Numbers can be used to define Allowed and Denied lists to control which
phone numbers may or may not be dialed by subscribers (see Classes of
Service, Toll Restriction (LX/MX) ).
•
Call pickup group
Every station can be assigned to a call pickup group.
•
Language, call signaling
The language used for the menu controls of the attached system telephones
can be set.
The ring tone for an internal or external call can be selected.
Related Topics
10.7.1.1 How to Configure IP Stations
You can use the IP Telephones wizard to configure the IP stations (LAN phones
and WLAN phones) connected to the communication system.
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
•
A functional wireless LAN network is needed to operate WLAN phones.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Telephones / Stations.
3) Click Edit to start the IP Telephones wizard. A list of all IP stations appears.
4) If you want the internal call number to be automatically assigned to the station
as the direct inward dialing number, activate the radio button Take DID from
changed call number.
5) If you want a different direct inward dialing number for the station than the call
number, enter a DID number for the station under DID in the row of the desired
station:
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
361
Stations
Configuring Stations
•
Only for a point-to-point connection:
Click in the desired field and type in the DID number using the keyboard.
The DID number may also be identical to the internal station number.
•
Only for a point-to-multipoint connection:
Select an MSN in the desired field via the drop-down list. The station can
be internally reached via the internal station number 101, for example,
and externally via the MSN 654321.
•
For a point-to-point and point-to-multipoint connections:
Select the entry xxx - modifiable (xxx is the internal station number) via
the drop-down list in the desired field and type in the DID number using
the keyboard or select an MSN from the drop-down list.
6) If you want an Internet telephony phone number to be assigned to the station
as the direct inward dialing number, leave the radio button Take DID from
changed call number unselected, and select the Internet Telephony Service
Provider from the list next to the radio button instead. Then select the Internet
Telephony phone number from the DID drop-down list in the row of the
desired station.
7) Enter the internal station number for the subscriber under Call No in the
appropriate row of the desired subscriber. You can use the preset phone
number or assign some other free number.
8) In the row of the desired station, under Name, enter a name in the format
Last Name, First Name or First Name Last Name.
INFO: The name can consist of up to 16 characters, but must not
include any diacritical characters such as umlauts or special
characters.
9) Select the type of IP station (e.g., “System Client“, “SIP Client “ or “RAS
User“) from the Type drop-down list in the row of the desired station.
10) From the License Type drop-down list in the row of the desired station, select
whether the IP station is to be operated as a Comfort User or a Comfort Plus
User. The IP station will only be operational if one of the two license types has
been selected. For details on the different functional scopes offered by the two
license types, see Licenses .
INFO: You can use this procedure to configure as many Comfort
User and Comfort Plus User stations as the number of licenses
purchased. In the Licensed column you will see if the subscriber
is successfully licensed.
11) If you want to set up a fax box for the subscriber (which can be used with the
UC clients myPortal for Desktop or myPortal for Outlook, for example, but
is only possible as Comfort Plus Users), proceed as follows:
362
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
Configuring Stations
a) In the row of the desired station, in the Fax No. field, enter the desired
internal fax number at which the user can receive internal fax messages.
b) If you want to configure a DID number for the fax box, enter the desired
external fax number under which the subscriber can receive external fax
messages in the Fax DID field in the row of the desired subscriber.
12) Choose the desired Class of Service group in the row of the desired
subscriber from the Class of Service drop-down list.
13) To add the subscriber to a call pickup group, select a call pickup group from
the Call pickup group drop-down list in the row of the desired subscriber.
14) Make any further settings if required:
a) Click in the row of the desired IP station on the pencil icon Edit.
b) Assign one DID number each for Internet telephony to the station and, if
desired, to its fax box in the Direct inward dialing for Internet
Telephony area. To do this, select the DID numbers from the drop-down
lists of the desired ITSPs. For every active ITSP, you will be presented
with one drop-down list for the station and one drop-down list for its fax
box.
INFO: The DID for Internet Telephony field is not visible if
Internet telephony is not configured or if no Internet Telephony
Service Provider has been activated.
c) In the Clip/Lin field, enter a phone number (DID number or MSN) to be
displayed at the called party’s extension instead of the own phone number
in the case of an external call.
INFO: This feature must be released by the network provider.
d) Select the language for the menu controls on the phone from the
Language drop-down list.
e) From the Call signaling internal drop-down list, select and assign one of
a total of eight possible acoustic call signals for internal calls. The station
then will then send the modified ringing tone to other internal stations,
thus enabling its calls to be distinguished from other internal stations
(default: Ring type 1).
f)
From the Call signaling external drop-down list, select and assign one
of a total of three possible acoustic call signals for external calls (default:
Ring type 1).
g) Click OK & Next.
15) If you want to configure another IP station, repeat steps 8 through 14.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
363
Stations
Configuring Stations
16) Click OK & Next. A list of all configured stations appears. This list is effectively a dial plan.
In addition, you will see how many user Comfort User or Comfort Plus User
licenses are available and how many of those are already being used. The
number of configured license types includes all the configured stations for the
license type. Consequently, there could be more stations configured as
Comfort Plus Users, for example, than the number of licenses available for it.
17) Click Print to print out the data of the configured stations.
18) Click OK & Next followed by Finish.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Fax box
10.7.1.2 How to Configure ISDN Stations
The ISDN Devices wizard can be used to configure the ISDN stations (e.g., ISDN
phone or ISDN fax) connected to OpenScape Office MX.
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
•
A gateway module with four S0 ports is plugged in, and at least one of the S0
ports is configured as an internal S0 port.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Telephones / Stations.
3) Click Edit to start the ISDN Devices wizard. A list of all ISDN stations
appears.
4) If you want the direct inward dialing number of the station to be automatically
adapted to its call number, activate the radio button ports is configured as
an interTake DID from changed call number.
5) If you want a different direct inward dialing number for the station than the call
number, enter a DID number for the station under DID in the row of the desired
station:
•
Only for a point-to-point connection:
Click in the desired field and type in the DID number using the keyboard.
The DID number may also be identical to the internal station number.
•
Only for a point-to-multipoint connection:
Select an MSN in the desired field via the drop-down list. The station can
be internally reached via the internal station number 101, for example,
and externally via the MSN 654321.
364
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
Configuring Stations
•
For a point-to-point and point-to-multipoint connections:
Select the entry xxx - modifiable (xxx is the internal station number) via
the drop-down list in the desired field and type in the DID number using
the keyboard or select an MSN from the drop-down list.
6) Enter the internal station number for the subscriber under Call No in the
appropriate row of the desired subscriber. You can use the preset phone
number or assign some other free number.
7) In the row of the desired station, under Name, enter a name in the format
Last Name, First Name or First Name Last Name.
INFO: The name can consist of up to 16 characters, but must not
include any diacritical characters such as umlauts or special
characters.
8) Choose one of the Class of Service groups in the row of the desired
subscriber from the Class of Service drop-down list:
9) To add the subscriber to a call pickup group, select a call pickup group from
the Call pickup group drop-down list in the row of the desired subscriber.
10) Make any further settings if required:
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
365
Stations
Configuring Stations
a) Click in the row of the desired ISDN station on the pencil icon Edit.
b) In the Clip/Lin field, enter a phone number (DID number or MSN) to be
displayed at the called party’s extension instead of the own phone number
in the case of an external call.
INFO: This feature must be released by the network provider.
c) Select the type of ISDN terminal from the Extension Type drop-down list.
d) Do not change the default selection in the Language drop-down list. This
setting has no relevance for ISDN terminals.
e) Select a DID number from the drop-down list in the Direct inward dialing
for Internet Telephony area. A drop-down list is displayed for every
active ITSP.
INFO: The DID for Internet Telephony field is not visible if
Internet telephony is not configured or if no Internet Telephony
Service Provider has been activated.
f)
From the Call signaling internal drop-down list, select and assign one of
a total of eight possible acoustic call signals for internal calls. The station
then will then send the modified ringing tone to other internal stations,
thus enabling its calls to be distinguished from other internal stations
(default: Ring type 1).
g) From the Call signaling external drop-down list, select and assign one
of a total of three possible acoustic call signals for external calls (default:
Ring type 1).
h) Click OK & Next.
11) If you want to configure another ISDN station, repeat steps 7 through 10.
12) Click OK & Next. If required, you can print the list of ISDN stations with Print.
13) Click OK & Next followed by Finish.
Related Topics
10.7.1.3 How to Configure Analog Stations
You can use the Analog Devices wizard to configure the analog stations (e.g.,
analog phone or fax) connected to OpenScape Office MX.
Prerequisites
•
366
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
One gateway module with analog interfaces is inserted.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
Configuring Stations
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Telephones / Stations.
3) Click Edit to start the Analog Terminals wizard. A list of all analog stations
appears.
4) If you want the direct inward dialing number of the station to be automatically
adapted to its call number, activate the radio button Take DID from changed
call number.
5) If you want a different direct inward dialing number for the station than the call
number, enter a DID number for the station under DID in the row of the desired
station:
•
Only for a point-to-point connection:
Click in the desired field and type in the DID number using the keyboard.
The DID number may also be identical to the internal station number.
•
Only for a point-to-multipoint connection:
Select an MSN in the desired field via the drop-down list. The station can
be internally reached via the internal station number 101, for example,
and externally via the MSN 654321.
•
For a point-to-point and point-to-multipoint connections:
Select the entry xxx - modifiable (xxx is the internal station number) via
the drop-down list in the desired field and type in the DID number using
the keyboard or select an MSN from the drop-down list.
6) Enter the internal station number for the subscriber under Call No in the
appropriate row of the desired subscriber. You can use the preset phone
number or assign some other free number.
7) In the row of the desired station, under Name, enter a name in the format
Last Name, First Name or First Name Last Name.
INFO: The name can consist of up to 16 characters, but must not
include any diacritical characters such as umlauts or special
characters.
8) Choose one of the Class of Service groups in the row of the desired
subscriber from the Class of Service drop-down list:
9) To add the subscriber to a call pickup group, select a call pickup group from
the Call pickup group drop-down list in the row of the desired subscriber.
10) Make any further settings if required: - For an analog modem, the station type
Modem must be selected here:
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
367
Stations
Configuring Stations
a) Click in the row of the desired analog station on the pencil icon Edit.
b) In the Clip/Lin field, enter a phone number (DID number or MSN) to be
displayed at the called party’s extension instead of the own phone number
in the case of an external call.
INFO: This feature must be released by the network provider.
c) Select the analog terminal type (fax, for instance) in the Extension Type
drop-down list.
If an analog modem is to be set up, the station type Modem must be
selected here.
d) Do not change the default selection in the Language drop-down list. This
setting has no relevance for analog terminals.
e) Select a DID number from the drop-down list in the Direct inward dialing
for Internet Telephony area. A drop-down list is displayed for every
active ITSP.
INFO: The DID for Internet Telephony field is not visible if
Internet telephony is not configured or if no Internet Telephony
Service Provider has been activated.
f)
From the Call signaling internal drop-down list, select and assign one of
a total of eight possible acoustic call signals for internal calls. The station
then will then send the modified ringing tone to other internal stations,
thus enabling its calls to be distinguished from other internal stations
(default: Ring type 1).
g) From the Call signaling external drop-down list, select and assign one
of a total of three possible acoustic call signals for external calls (default:
Ring type 1).
h) Click OK & Next.
11) If you want to configure another analog station, repeat steps 7 through 10.
12) Click OK & Next. If required, you can print the list of analog stations with
Print.
13) Click OK & Next followed by Finish.
Related Topics
10.7.1.4 How to Define Station Names
The Station Name and Release wizard can be used to define the names of
stations.
Prerequisites
•
368
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
Configuring Stations
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > User Telephony.
3) Click Edit to start the Station Name and Release wizard.
4) Click in the Name column in the field of the desired subscriber and enter a
subscriber name in the format Last Name, First Name or First Name
Last Name.
INFO: The name can consist of up to 16 characters, but must not
include any diacritical characters such as umlauts or special
characters.
5) If you want to define the names of further stations, repeat step 4.
6) Click OK & Next followed by Finish.
Related Topics
10.7.2 Configuring Stations in Expert Mode (LX/MX)
You can configure all settings for all types of stations in Expert mode. The default
settings should be verified for every station and adapted if required. The
advanced settings can be left unaltered for default operation and only have to be
changed if required.
Configuring Parameters (Default Settings)
With three exceptions, the station parameters correspond to the default settings
as they can be configured via the wizards. Explanations for the default settings
can be found under the topic Configuring Stations using Wizards.
The following settings can still be configured:
•
LCR Class of Service
You can use the LCR class of service to permit or deny subscribers access to
certain outdial rules/routes. Every subscriber is assigned a class of service
(COS), 15 being the highest and 1 the lowest class of service.
•
Hotline
You can activate the Hotline function for every station. You can also define
whether the connection to the hotline destination should be established as
soon as you lift the handset (hotline) or after a short delay (off-hook alarm
after timeout).
•
Signaling & Payload Encryption (SPE)
Phone calls are encrypted with SPE. This requires SPE to be enabled at the
phones involved. SPE can be enabled or disabled per phone. optiPoint 410/
420 phones do not support SPE.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
369
Stations
Configuring Stations
Activating or Deactivating Features (Advanced Settings)
Different features can be activated or deactivated for each station. These features
are listed as station flags. The explanations of these features can be found in the
Administrator documentation by searching for the name of the feature.
Configuring IP Parameters (Advanced Settings)
Special IP parameters can only be configured for system clients and SIP clients.
The following IP parameters can be configured:
•
Status Display (for system clients only)
You can activate status transfer to system phones. If a system phone fails, for
example, it is flagged as inactive after four minutes.
INFO: If a system phone is configured as a teleworker, status
transmission should be inactive. This reduces the number of
messages between the communication system and the system
phone.
•
Authentication at the communication system
If you want the IP client to be able to identify himself/herself at the communication system with a password, authentication must be activated and a
password set. This is an advantage especially for clients that are not
connected to the internal LAN, but that dial in from outside. You can also set
restrictions for SIP clients, specifying that login is only permitted by an SIP
client with a specific IP address.
•
Mobile System Client (for system clients only)
Normally, the phone number is permanently assigned to the IP telephone of
a system clients (type: “non mobile”). A system client may not be permanently
assigned to an IP station (“mobile” type). A subscriber can log into any other
IP phone using the login procedure (*9419) and the phone number of the
mobile system client. The type “non mobile and blocked” must not be set,
however, at this IP telephone.
INFO: To guarantee correct initialization, the first time every
system client logs on to the system they must log in as “nonmobile” system clients; only thereafter can they be configured as
“mobile”.
If “non mobile and blocked” is set as the type for a system client, a subscriber
cannot log into this IP telephone with a mobile system client.
370
•
Defining a redundant gatekeeper (secondary system)
If the internal IP network contains a redundant gatekeeper, you can program
the IP client to redirect to this redundant gatekeeper if the original gatekeeper
fails.
•
Special SIP parameters (for SIP clients only)
SIP clients must log into an SIP registrar. This can be the internal SIP registrar
of OpenScape Office or an external SIP registrar. Depending on what the SIP
registrar demands for login, the user ID and the associated realm must also
be specified.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
Configuring Stations
Setting Classes of Service (Advanced Settings)
Every subscriber can be assigned one class of service for day and another for
night. There are 15 classes of service to choose from. You will find more information in the topic Operation, Optimization and Monitoring - CO Call Privileges,
Toll Restriction.
Defining the Call Pickup Groups (Advanced Settings)
Every station can be assigned to a call pickup group. There are 32 call pickup
groups to choose from.
Configuration before gateway modules are inserted
In Expert mode, the call numbers and names of stations can be configured even
if the associated gateway modules have not yet been inserted. When inserting the
gateway modules, care must be taken to ensure that they are inserted in the order
in which the phone numbers and station names were configured (e.g., the
gateway modules with the S0 ports should be inserted first, and then the modules
with the analog interfaces). A new gateway module may only be inserted after the
previously inserted module has been recognized in the system.
Related Topics
10.7.2.1 How to Configure Standard Parameters for a Station
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Stations.
3) Navigate in the menu tree under Stations > Station > … down to the desired
station (Index - Station Number - Name).
4) Click the Edit Station Parameters tab.
5) Enter an internal phone number for the station in the Phone Number field.
You can use the preset phone number or assign some other free number.
6) In the Name field, enter a name in the format Last Name, First Name or
First Name Last Name.
INFO: The name can consist of up to 16 characters, but must not
include any diacritical characters such as umlauts or special
characters.
7) Enter a DID number for the station in the Direct inward dialing field.
•
Only for a point-to-point connection:
Type in the DD number using the keyboard. The DID number may also be
identical to the internal station number.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
371
Stations
Configuring Stations
•
Only for a point-to-multipoint connection:
Select an MSN via the drop-down list. The station can be internally
reached via the internal station number 101, for example, and externally
via the MSN 654321.
•
For a point-to-point and point-to-multipoint connections:
Select the entry xxx - modifiable (xxx is the internal station number) via
the drop-down list and type in the DID number by using the keyboard or
select an MSN from the drop-down list.
8) If you want another phone number (DID number or MSN) to be displayed at
the called party’s extension instead of the own phone number in the case of
an external call, enter this number under Clip/Lin.
INFO: This feature must be released by the network provider.
9) If you want to set up a fax box for the subscriber (which can be used with the
UC clients myPortal for Desktop or myPortal for Outlook, for example, but
is only possible as Comfort Plus Users), proceed as follows:
a) Enter the desired internal fax number at which the user can receive
internal fax messages under Phone No. in the Fax area.
b) If you want to configure a direct inward dialing number for the fax box,
enter the desired external fax number under which the subscriber can
receive external fax messages under DID in the Fax area.
10) Select a DID number from the drop-down list in the Direct inward dialing for
DSL Telephony area. A drop-down list is displayed for every active ITSP.
INFO: The DID for Internet Telephony field is not visible if
Internet telephony is not configured or if no Internet Telephony
Service Provider has been activated.
11) Select the type of assigned terminal from the Extension Type drop-down list.
12) Select the language for the menu controls on the phone in the Language
drop-down list.
13) In the Call signaling internal or Call signaling external drop-down list,
select the ring tone for an internal or external call (default: external/internal
call type 1).
14) Select one of the 15 LCR classes of service in the Class of Service (LCR)
drop-down list.
15) If required, enable the Hotline function in the Hotline Mode drop-down list
and select one of the six hotline destinations in the Hotline drop-down list.
16) For IP stations only: Use the License-Type drop-down list to select whether
the IP station should be assigned the functional scope of a Comfort User or a
Comfort Plus User.
372
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
Configuring Stations
17) The Payload Security drop-down list can be used to select whether or not
the phone conversations are to be encrypted (Signaling & Payload
Encryption, SPE). In order to use encryption, SPE must also be enabled at
the remote site.
18) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
10.7.2.2 How to Configure Standard Parameters for all Stations of a Station Type
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Stations.
3) Navigate in the menu tree under Stations > Station > … down to the desired
station (Index - Station Number - Name).
4) Only for IP clients: Click the Change Station tab.
5) Change the data for the station you want. For an explanation of this data, see
Configuring Stations Using Wizards (LX/MX) .
6) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
10.7.2.3 How to Activate or Deactivate Features
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Stations.
3) Navigate in the menu tree under Stations > Station > … down to the desired
station (Index - Station Number - Name).
4) Click the Edit Station Flags tab.
5) Activate or deactivate the desired features (Station flags).
6) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
373
Stations
Configuring Stations
10.7.2.4 How to Configure IP Parameters
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Stations.
3) Navigate in the menu tree under Stations > Station > … down to the desired
station (Index - Station Number - Name).
4) Click the Edit Workpoint Client Data tab.
5) Only for system clients: If required, activate the status transmission by
enabling the Status message check box.
6) If the IP station should log in at the communication system with a password,
authentication must be activated.
a) Enable the Authentication active check box.
b) Enter the password for the authentication in the Password and Confirm
password fields.
c) Only for SIP clients: Enter the user ID for the authentication in the SIP
User ID / Username field.
d) Only for SIP clients: Enter the associated zone for the authentication in
the Realm field.
e) Only for SIP clients: Select the Use Fixed IP Address check box and
enter the IP address of the SIP client in the IP Address field. This ensures
that only this SIP client can log in using the IP address specified above.
7) Only for system clients: Select the type of system client from the Type dropdown list (Mobile, Non-mobile or Non-mobile and blocked).
8) If required, enter the IP address of the redundant gatekeeper in the
Secondary system ID field.
9) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
10.7.2.5 How to Define Class of Service Groups for Day and Night
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Stations.
374
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
Configuring Stations
3) Navigate in the menu tree under Stations > Station > … down to the desired
station (Index - Station Number - Name).
4) Click the Edit Group/CFW tab.
5) Select a class of service group for day mode in the Day drop-down list.
6) Select a class of service group for night mode from the Night drop-down list.
7) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
10.7.2.6 How to Configure a Call Pickup Group
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Stations.
3) Navigate in the menu tree under Stations > Station > … down to the desired
station (Index - Station Number - Name).
4) Click the Edit Group/CFW tab.
5) Use the Group drop-down list to assign the stations to a call pickup group.
6) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
10.7.2.7 How to Display the Station Overview
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Stations.
3) Navigate in the menu tree to Stations > Direct inward dialing-Phone
Numbers-Overview.
The phone numbers, DID numbers, and names of all configured stations are
displayed in a list.
4) Click OK when finished.
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
375
Stations
Configuring Stations
10.7.3 Configuring Users of the UC Suite
The values and settings of users of the UC Suite can be configured via the User
Directory.
The User Directory contains a list of all stations in the communication system. The
symbol in the first column of the list shows you the presence status of the user.
The administrator can change this presence status for every user. If names were
defined when setting up the stations, the names are also transferred over to the
user directory.
The following information is displayed in the user directory for every user:
•
Symbol for presence status
Shows the current presence status of the user
•
Extension
Shows the internal call number of the user The internal call number cannot be
edited in the user directory.
•
Username
Shows the user name, which can be freely defined for every user.
•
Name
Shows the first name and last name of the user.
•
Department
Shows the associated department (if a department was configured and
assigned to the user)
•
E-mail
Shows the e-mail address of the user
•
Is Agent
Shows if the user was configured as an agent for the multimedia Contact
Center.
•
voicemail
Shows if the user can receive voicemails.
•
Call Forwarding
Shows whether call forwarding was configured for the user.
The following values and settings can be configured:
Values and settings
Keywords
Personal details
376
My Personal Details
Own name, user name, password, e-mail address,
department, additional phone number, XMPP ID
My Picture
My Picture
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
Configuring Stations
Values and settings
User Level
Keywords
Receiving voicemails: see How to Enable or Disable
the Feature to Receive Voicemails for Users of the UC
Suite
User as Attendant Console: see How to Configure
Users of the UC Suite as Attendants
User as agent: see How to Configure Users of the UC
Suite as Agents
My Preferences
Appearance
Skin colors, language of the user interface
Notifications
Screen pops
Outlook connectivity
Automatic creation of Outlook appointments when
absent, automatic update of presence status via Outlook appointments
Hotkeys
Hotkey for functions
Miscellaneous
Automatic reset of the presence status, transfer
method, retention period for Journal entries, server
address, function keys of the telephone
Call Rules
Forwarding destinations
Status-based Call Forwarding
Rules Engine
Rule-Based Call Forwarding
Communications
Voicemail settings
Recording or announcement mode, language of the
voicemail box
VM Notification
Notification Service for Messages
Fax Notification
Notification Service for Messages
Profiles
Busy, No Answer, Meeting, Sick, profile for personal AutoAttendant
Break, Away, Vacation, Lunch,
Home Ph.
Sensitivity
Security and Access
Retrieval of your voice and fax messages by the Attendant; password check for the voicemail box
Presence Visibility
Visibility of your Presence Status for Others
VoiceMail Presence
Announcement of your presence status for external
callers; announcement of your presence status for
specific callers
myAttendant
LAN Messages
Text module for Instant Messaging
DIDs
MSN
Communications
Call forwardings
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
377
Stations
Configuring Stations
More detailed information on the values and settings of the users can be found in
the User Guides of the communications clients myPortal for Desktop,
myPortal for Outlook and myAttendant under the keywords listed in the table.
The length of the password for using the communications clients is 6 characters
by default. The password length can, however, be adapted as required. (min. six
digits; max. ten digits). An administrator with the Advanced profile can reset the
password of a user (if the user has forgotten it, for example).
INFO: The First Name and Last Name of a user are overwritten
in the User Directory when they are changed by using a wizard or
in Expert mode. By contrast, if the First Name and Last Name of
a user are changed in the User Directory, the user data displayed
when using a wizard or in Expert mode are not overwritten. This
results in the existence of two different user names for the same
user.
Subscribers for whom an e-mail address has been configured and who use the
communications clients myPortal for Desktop or myPortal for Outlook receive
a welcome e-mail with Getting Started Instructions.
Resetting User Data
All entered data for users can be deleted, and the changed settings can be reset
to their default values. Note that the voicemails, journal entries, scheduled conferences, e-mails, faxes and personal announcements for the voicemail box are also
deleted for the selected user in the process.
Related Topics
10.7.3.1 How to Configure Users of the UC Suite
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) Click in the navigation tree on Wizards > UC Suite.
3) Click on Edit to start the User Directory wizard. All existing users are
displayed.
4) Mark the desired user and click Edit.
5) Edit the data of the user.
6) Click Save. The window is automatically closed. All existing users are
displayed.
7) If you want to configure another user, repeat steps 4 through 6.
Related Topics
378
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
Configuring Stations
10.7.3.2 How to Reset Users of the UC Suite
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) Click in the navigation tree on Wizards > UC Suite.
3) Click on Edit to start the User Directory wizard. All existing users are
displayed.
4) Mark the desired user and click Reset User.
5) Click Save. The window is automatically closed. All existing users are
displayed.
6) If you want to reset another user, repeat steps 4 and 6.
Related Topics
10.7.3.3 How to Configure Users of the UC Suite as Agents
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) Click in the navigation tree on Wizards > UC Suite.
3) Click on Edit to start the User Directory wizard. All existing users are
displayed.
4) Select the Is Agent check box of the desired user.
5) Select the desired UCD ID for this agent in the drop-down list.
The UCD ID determines to which UCD group this agent is assigned in the
event of a failure at the Contact Center (fallback solution). The UCD IDs are
assigned to the UCD groups when configuring the UCD groups (see How to
Configure UCD Groups for the OpenScape Office MX Contact Center ).
6) Click Save, followed by OK.
7) If you want to configure another user as an agent, repeat steps 4 through 6.
Related Topics
10.7.3.4 How to Configure Users of the UC Suite as Attendants
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
379
Stations
Configuring Stations
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) Click in the navigation tree on Wizards > UC Suite.
3) Click on Edit to start the User Directory wizard. All existing users are
displayed.
4) Mark the desired user and click Edit.
5) Click in the menu tree on Personal Details > User Level.
6) Select the Attendant Console check box.
7) Click Save. The window is automatically closed. All existing users are
displayed.
8) If you want to configure another user as an Attendant, repeat steps 4 through
6.
Related Topics
10.7.3.5 How to Enable or Disable the Feature to Receive Voicemails for Users of the UC
Suite
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) Click in the navigation tree on Wizards > UC Suite.
3) Click on Edit to start the User Directory wizard. All existing users are
displayed.
4) If the user is to be able to receive voicemails, select the Voicemail check box.
5) If the user is not to receive any voicemails, clear the Voicemail check box.
6) If you want to configure another subscriber to receive voicemails, repeat step
4 or 5.
Related Topics
10.7.3.6 How to Change the Presence Status for Users of the UC Suite
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) Click in the navigation tree on Wizards > UC Suite.
380
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
Configuring Stations
3) Click on Edit to start the User Directory wizard. All existing users are
displayed.
4) Select the desired user.
5) Select the desired presence status and enter the time of return for the user in
the format yyyy/mm/dd hh:mm if required, e.g., 2010/05/05 09:00. The
time must also be specified.
6) Click OK.
7) If you want to change the presence status for another user, repeat steps 4
through 6.
8) Close the window.
Related Topics
10.7.3.7 How to Reset the Password for Users of the UC Suite
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) Click in the navigation tree on Wizards > UC Suite.
3) Click on Edit to start the User Directory wizard. All existing users are
displayed.
4) Mark the desired user and click Edit.
5) Under Password, click on Change.
6) Enter the new password under New and Confirm.
7) Click OK. The window is automatically closed. All existing users are
displayed.
8) If you want to reset the password of another user, repeat steps 4 through 6.
9)
Notify the affected users of the new password.
Related Topics
10.7.3.8 How to Configure the Password Length for Users of the UC Suite
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Applications > UC Suite.
3) Click Server.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
381
Stations
Configuring Stations
4) Click on the General Settings tab.
5) Enter the new maximum password length in the Length of Password field.
The default value is 6. The minimum possible length is six digits; the
maximum is ten digits.
6) Click Save.
Related Topics
10.7.4 Exporting Subscriber Data
Important data of subscribers can be exported to a CSV file.
In addition to the names and station numbers of subscribers, the CSV file may
also include other subscriber data such as their license types and e-mail
addresses, for example.
A sample CSV file with the appropriate explanations can be found in the
OpenScape Office Assistant Administration Program under Service Center >
Download Center > CSV Templates.
Structure of a CSV file:
•
Column A contains the call number (possible values: 0-9,*,#)
•
Column B contains the DID number (possible values: 0-9,*,#)
•
Column C contains the name (in the format First Name Last Name or
Last Name, First Name)
The name of a subscriber can consist of up to 16 characters, but must not
include any diacritical characters such as umlauts or special characters.
•
Column D contains the subscriber type (e.g., 1=System Client, 2=SIP User,
3=SIP Fax, 4=RAS User, 5=Analog, 6=Analog Fax, ...)
•
Column E contains the license type (<no entry> or 0=No Licence, 1=Comfort
User, 2=Comfort Plus User)
•
Column F contains the e-mail address
Users of the UC Suite are automatically sent an e-mail with a link to the installation file(s) if their respective e-mail addresses were imported via the CSV
file.
•
Column G contains the mobile number (possible values: 0-9,*,#)
•
Column H contains the private number (possible values: 0-9,*,#)
•
Column I contains the node ID (possible values: 0-999)
This column must be assigned a value; otherwise, no import will occur. If the
system is not networked, 0 must be entered here.
•
Column J contains the IP address of the second gateway
IMPORTANT:
CSV files must be available in ANSI/ASCII format.
CSV files of older OpenScape Office versions are not supported.
Related Topics
382
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
Configuring Station and User Profiles
10.7.4.1 How to Export Station data
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) Click Maintenance > Configuration in the navigation tree.
3) Click on Configuration > Port Configuration in the menu tree.
4) Click on the Export Configuration tab.
5) Click on the Download button.
6) Confirm the prompt with OK.
7) Click Save and select the storage location of the CSV file.
8) Then click Save.
Related Topics
10.8 Configuring Station and User Profiles
The values and properties stored in profiles can be configured here. The profiles
of the stations and users of the OpenScape Office clients can be configured.
Related Topics
10.8.1 Configuring Station Profiles (LX/MX)
The values and properties of IP stations are stored in station profiles.
Using the Profiles wizard, an administrator with the Advanced profile can
perform the following configuration tasks:
•
Create a new profile
•
Display profiles and their members
•
Add members to a profile
•
Delete members from a profile
•
Export or import a single profile
In Expert mode, an administrator with the Expert profile can also perform the
following configuration tasks:
•
Change values and settings of a station profile
•
Export or import all profiles
Station profiles that have already been created cannot be deleted, but can be
overwritten.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
383
Stations
Configuring Station and User Profiles
Related Topics
10.8.1.1 How to Create a New Station Profile
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > User Telephony.
3) Click on Edit to start the Station Profiles wizard. All existing station profiles
and their members are displayed.
4) In the row of the desired station profile, in the Name column, enter a name of
your choice for the profile (max. 16 characters).
5) Click Assign Stations in the row of the desired station profile.
6) Select the desired members from the Profile Members table (multiple selections are allowed) and click on Add. These stations are now assigned to the
station profile and cannot be assigned to any further station profile.
7) Click OK.
8) Click OK & Next. All existing station profiles and their members are displayed.
9) Click OK & Next followed by Finish.
Related Topics
10.8.1.2 How to Display Station Profiles and their Members
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > User Telephony.
3) Click on Edit to start the Station Profiles wizard. All existing station profiles
and their members are displayed.
Related Topics
10.8.1.3 How to Add Members to a Station Profile
Prerequisites
•
384
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
Configuring Station and User Profiles
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > User Telephony.
3) Click on Edit to start the Station Profiles wizard. All existing station profiles
and their members are displayed.
4) Click Assign Stations in the row of the desired station profile.
5) Select the desired members from the Profile Members list (multiple selections are allowed) and click on Add. These stations are now assigned to the
station profile and cannot be assigned to any further station profile.
6) Click OK.
7) Click OK & Next. All existing station profiles and their members are displayed.
8) Click OK & Next followed by Finish.
Related Topics
10.8.1.4 How to Delete Members from a Station Profile
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > User Telephony.
3) Click on Edit to start the Station Profiles wizard. All existing station profiles
and their members are displayed.
4) Click Assign Stations in the row of the desired station profile.
5) Select the desired members from the Members list (multiple selections are
allowed) and click on Delete. These subscribers can now be reassigned to
another station profile.
6) Click OK.
7) Click OK & Next. All existing station profiles and their members are displayed.
8) Click OK & Next followed by Finish.
Related Topics
10.8.1.5 How to Export or Import a Single Station Profile
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
385
Stations
Configuring Station and User Profiles
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > User Telephony.
3) Click on Edit to start the Station Profiles wizard. All existing station profiles
and their members are displayed.
4) Click Import/Export Profile in the row of the desired station profile.
5) If you want to export the station profile to a file, click on Download and save
the file in a directory of your choice.
6) If you want to import a station profile from a file, click Browse, navigate to the
storage location of the file and load the file into the communication system.
7) Click OK.
8) Click OK & Next. All existing station profiles and their members are displayed.
9) Click OK & Next followed by Finish.
Related Topics
10.8.1.6 How to Change Values and Settings of a Station Profile
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Stations.
3) In the menu tree, click Stations > Profiles/Templates.
4) Click on a station profile number (955-964).
5) If required, edit the name of the station profile (up to 16 characters are
possible) on the Station Parameters tab in Name field and click Apply.
6) If required, edit the desired station parameters for the station profile on the
Station Parameters tab and click Apply.
7) If required, edit the desired station flags for the station profile on the Station
Flags tab and click Apply.
8) If required, edit the desired call forwardings for the station profile on the
Groups/RNA tab and click Apply.
9) Click Apply.
Related Topics
10.8.1.7 How to Export or Import All Station Profiles
Prerequisites
•
386
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
Configuring Station and User Profiles
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Stations.
3) In the menu tree, click Stations > Profiles/Templates.
4) Click on the Import/Export All Profiles tab.
5) If you want to export all station profiles to a file, click on Download and save
the file in a directory of your choice.
6) If you want to import all station profiles from a file, click Browse, navigate to
the storage location of the file and load the file into the communication
system.
Related Topics
10.8.2 Configuring the User Profiles of UC Clients
All relevant values and properties of the users of the UC clients are stored in the
user profiles of the UC clients.
The following values and settings can be configured:
Menu items
Values and settings for
Personal details
My Personal Details
Visibility of phone numbers
My Preferences
Appearance
Skin colors, language of the user interface
Notifications
Screen pops
Outlook connectivity
Automatic creation of Outlook appointments
when absent, automatic update of presence status via Outlook appointments
Miscellaneous
Automatic reset of the presence status, transfer
method, retention period for Journal entries,
server address
Call Rules
Forwarding destinations
Status-based call forwarding
Communications
Voicemail settings
Recording or announcement mode, language of
the voicemail box
VM Notification
Notification Service for Messages
Fax Notification
Notification Service for Messages
Profiles
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
387
Stations
Configuring Station and User Profiles
Menu items
Values and settings for
Busy, No Answer, Meeting, Sick,
Break, Away, Vacation, Lunch, Home
Ph.
profile for personal AutoAttendant
Sensitivity
Security and Access
Retrieval of your voice and fax messages by the
Attendant; password check for the voicemail box
Presence Visibility
Visibility of your Presence Status for Others
VoiceMail Presence
Announcement of your presence status for
external callers; announcement of your presence status for specific callers
More detailed information on the values and settings of the profiles can be found
in the User Guides of the UC clients and under the keywords listed in the table.
Related Topics
10.8.2.1 How to Create a New User Profile
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) Click in the navigation tree on Wizards > UC Suite.
3) Click on Edit to start the Profiles wizard. All existing user profiles and their
members are displayed.
4) Click Add.
5) Enter a freely selectable name for the profile in the Name field and click Save.
6) Configure the values and properties of the user profile as desired.
7) Click Save and close the window.
Related Topics
10.8.2.2 How to Display User Profiles and their Members
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) Click in the navigation tree on Wizards > UC Suite.
3) Click on Edit to start the Profiles wizard. All existing user profiles and their
members are displayed.
Related Topics
388
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Stations
Configuring Station and User Profiles
10.8.2.3 How to Add Members to a User Profile
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) Click in the navigation tree on Wizards > UC Suite.
3) Click on Edit to start the Profiles wizard. All existing user profiles and their
members are displayed.
4) Select the desired user profile and click Assign Users.
5) Select the desired members from the Available Users list (multiple selections
are allowed) and click on <- to transfer them to the Assigned Users list.
These users are now assigned to the user profile and cannot be assigned to
any further user profile.
All existing station profiles and their members are displayed again.
6) Close the window.
Related Topics
10.8.2.4 How to Delete Members from a User Profile
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) Click in the navigation tree on Wizards > UC Suite.
3) Click on Edit to start the Profiles wizard. All existing user profiles and their
members are displayed.
4) Select the desired user profile and click Assign Users.
5) Select the desired members from the Assigned Users list (multiple selections are allowed) and click on -> to transfer them to the Available Users list.
These users can now be reassigned to another user profile.
All existing station profiles and their members are displayed again.
6) Close the window.
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
389
Stations
Configuring Station and User Profiles
10.8.2.5 How to Change the Values and Settings of a User Profile
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) Click in the navigation tree on Wizards > UC Suite.
3) Click on Edit to start the Profiles wizard. All existing profiles and their users
are displayed.
4) Select the desired profile.
5) Click Edit.
6) Change the desired values and settings.
INFO: Before navigating to the next menu item, click on Save to
ensure that the changes you made will be applied.
7) Then click Save and close the window.
Related Topics
10.8.2.6 How to Delete a User Profile
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) Click in the navigation tree on Wizards > UC Suite.
3) Click on Edit to start the Profiles wizard. All existing user profiles and their
members are displayed.
4) Select the desired user profile and click Remove.
5) Click OK to confirm your selection. All existing station profiles and their
members are displayed again.
6) Close the window.
Related Topics
390
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Licensing
Licensing Procedure
11 Licensing
Licensing is mandatory for the operation of OpenScape Office. Following the
initial startup, the licensing must be completed within 30 days (called the Grace
Period); otherwise, when this period expires, the system will only operate in
restricted emergency mode.
Related Topics
11.1 Licensing Procedure
Licensing is handled via a centralized License Management procedure for the
administration and activation of licenses. The product/feature is supplied together
with a License Authorization Code (LAC) with which a license file is obtained from
the Central License Server (CLS). This license file is used for activating licenses.
This procedure provides protection against any potential manipulation of the
licenses.
The license activation for OpenScape Office LX/MX and OpenScape Office HX
occurs with the administration program OpenScape Office Assistant and HiPath
3000 Manager E, respectively.
INFO: In order to successfully activate additional licenses, the
license for the basic package must already have been activated in
advance or be activated at the same time as the additional
licenses.
Related Topics
11.1.1 License Server (Central License Server, CLS)
The Central License Server (CLS) generates and manages the license files.
A license file is generated when the License Authorization Code is sent to the CLS
by the communication system. The transmission of the license file to the communication system occurs automatically via the Internet or ISDN. If an automatic
transmission is not possible, the license file can also be loaded manually into the
communication system.
Every customer or sales partner has a separate license account on the CLS. The
accounts can be maintained at the CLS via a separate web-based user interface.
All available and already purchased licenses can be displayed.
To reach the CLS, enter the address https://www.central-licenseserver.com or the IP address https://188.64.16.4 in a web browser.
INFO: The IP address of the CLS (Central License Server) can
be checked via the WBM under License Management >
Settings and changed if required.
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
391
Licensing
Licensing Procedure
11.1.2 Grace Period
After installing the software or upgrading the software from V2 to V3, the license
activation must be completed made within a period of 30 days (grace period). The
product is fully functional during the grace period.
IMPORTANT: If the licensing is not completed before the grace
period expires, the system will only operate in Emergency mode
thereafter. In Emergency mode, the external functionality is
restricted to one IP client (with the default station number 100)
with access to the communication system via Remote Access. All
other IP clients can only make internal calls.
Related Topics
11.1.3 MAC Address
MAC addresses are unique worldwide, and every communication system may be
associated with one or more MAC addresses. To ensure unique licensing, these
MAC addresses are used in the licensing process.
For an OpenScape Office MX multi-box system, the licenses are always bound to
the MAC address of the central box. If OpenScape Office MX is in the grace
period, a wrong MAC address may possibly be shown under the license information. The correct MAC address can be checked via the Service Center under
Inventory.
For OpenScape Office LX/HX, the licenses are bound to the MAC address of the
network card in the Linux server. If the Linux server has multiple network cards,
the network card that was used at the initial startup of the Linux server must be
selected.
Related Topics
11.1.3.1 How to Check the MAC Address of OpenScape Office MX
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) Click Service Center on the navigation bar.
2) In the navigation tree, click Inventory. An overview of all system boxes and
gateway modules belonging to the communication system will be displayed.
3) Click OK & Next. Information on the hardware and software for system box 1
(central box) appears. The MAC address of OpenScape Office MX can be
found under MAC ID for license.
392
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Licensing
Licensing Procedure
4) Click on Cancel to close the window.
Related Topics
11.1.3.2 How to Check the MAC Address of OpenScape Office LX/HX
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) Click Service Center on the navigation bar.
2) In the navigation tree, click Inventory. Information on the software of the
communication system, the available and used hard disk storage and on the
application status will be displayed. The MAC address of
OpenScape Office LX or OpenScape Office HX can be found under MAC ID
for license.
Related Topics
11.1.4 Advanced Locking ID (LX)
The Advanced Locking ID of OpenScape Office LX is required when
OpenScape Office LX is operated in a virtualized environment. An Advanced
Locking ID is generated at the CLS using the ALI Calculator from a variety of
system and network parameters and is used for licensing instead of the MAC
address of the server PC.
The following system and network parameters must be configured, since they are
used to generate the 24-digit Advanced Locking ID.
•
IP address of the default gateway (Linux server)
•
Hostname of the Linux server
•
IP address of the Linux server
•
IP address of the DNS server (configured on the Linux server)
•
Time zone (Linux server)
If one or more of these system and network parameters are not set, then the
Advanced Locking ID cannot be generated.
The Advanced Locking ID is displayed in the OpenScape Office Assistant. In
some cases, it is possible that the ALI which was generated at the CLS for the
license file may differ from the ALI which is displayed during the activation period
in the WBM. The license file containing the deviant ALI is accepted by the system
anyway.
If any of the system and network parameters listed above changes, OpenScape
Office LX reverts to the remaining term of the grace period, and a new locking
Advanced ID is generated. To be able to use the purchased license file again, a
rehost from the old to the new Advanced Locking ID must be conducted at the
Central License Server (CLS).
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
393
Licensing
Licenses
11.1.4.1 How to Check the Advanced Locking ID of OpenScape Office LX
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant.
›
Click on License Management in the navigation bar. All existing licenses are
displayed. If OpenScape Office LX is being operated in a virtualized
environment, the advanced locking ID can be found under Locking ID.
Step by Step
Related Topics
11.1.5 Licensing Process using OpenScape Office MX as an Example
The licensing process is presented below with an example of OpenScape Office
MX using OpenScape Office Assistant and the License Authorization Code
(LAC).
1. On purchasing OpenScape Office MX, the customer receives a License
Authorization Code (LAC). The information on the licenses purchased (basic
licenses and extension licenses, if any) are stored in the database of the CLS.
2. The customer or service technician installs OpenScape Office MX. The grace
period begins (period of 30 days in which the licensing must be completed).
3. The customer or service technician transfers the License Authorization Code
to the CLS via the Internet or ISDN by using OpenScape Office Assistant.
Some customer-specific hardware data (such as the MAC address of
OpenScape Office MX) is sent to the CLS along with the LAC. The CLS uses
the License Authorization Code and the customer-specific hardware data to
generate a license file and then sends this back to
OpenScape Office Assistant in an encrypted format. The license file contains
the procured licenses.
4. OpenScape Office Assistant checks whether the MAC address saved in the
license file matches the MAC address of OpenScape Office MX. If the check
is successful, the license is activated, and OpenScape Office MX is ready for
use. Is the check fails, OpenScape Office MX continues to run in the grace
period until it expires and then only in emergency mode.
Related Topics
11.2 Licenses
In order to use the communication system after the grace period, licenses are
required. The licenses define the scope of features available at the communication system. As soon as the license is activated, the corresponding feature can
be used.
394
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Licensing
Licenses
For OpenScape Office V3, different basic license packages are available for
basic operation. To expand OpenScape Office V3, additional licenses (e.g., 5
additional Comfort User licenses) can be purchased. If the OpenScape Office
Contact Center is to be used, additional licenses are required for it. An upgrade
license is needed to upgrade to the latest version.
Regardless of the selected basic license package, OpenScape Office MX can be
expanded to a maximum of 150 IP stations, and OpenScape Office LX/HX to a
maximum of 500 IP stations. For every IP station, a Comfort User or Comfort Plus
User license is required. Analog stations are automatically recognized as Comfort
User devices. No Comfort User or Comfort Plus User license is required for this.
The Comfort User and Comfort Plus User licenses are assigned permanently to
individual IP stations with OpenScape Office Assistant. The number of IP stations
licensed cannot exceed the number of available licenses. The assignment of
other licenses occurs dynamically, i.e., depending on the requirements and availability, licenses are assigned for the components that require them.
Related Topics
11.2.1 Basic Licenses
A basic license consists of the system license and extension licenses. Every basic
license includes different extension licenses.
The following basic licenses are available:
•
•
•
•
•
OpenScape Office V3 MX Base 10 Plus
–
1 x system license for the operation of OpenScape Office MX
–
10x licenses for Comfort Plus User
–
1x license for OpenScape Office Directory Service
OpenScape Office V3 MX Base 20 Plus
–
1 x system license for the operation of OpenScape Office MX
–
20x licenses for Comfort Plus User
–
1x license for OpenScape Office Directory Service
OpenScape Office V3 MX Base 5 Plus
–
1 x system license for the operation of OpenScape Office LX
–
5x licenses for Comfort Plus User
–
1x license for OpenScape Office Directory Service
OpenScape Office V3 LX Basic 20 Plus
–
1 x system license for the operation of OpenScape Office LX
–
20x licenses for Comfort Plus User
–
1x license for OpenScape Office Directory Service
OpenScape Office V3 HX Base 5
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
395
Licensing
Licenses
•
–
1 x system license for the operation of OpenScape Office HX
–
5x Licenses for Standard User
–
1x license for OpenScape Office Directory Service
OpenScape Office V3 HX Base 10
–
1 x system license for the operation of OpenScape Office HX
–
10x Licenses for Standard User
–
1x license for OpenScape Office Directory Service
Related Topics
11.2.2 Extension Licenses
Extension licenses are needed to expand the communication system. Some
extension licenses are also offered in packages of 100 units.
The following extension licenses are available:
•
OpenScape Office V3 LX/MX Comfort User
–
Usage of all communication functions of OpenScape Office
–
Unified Communications functions via myPortal for Desktop.
–
Voicemail box (Voicemail)
Comfort User licenses are permanently bound to the stations.
•
OpenScape Office V3 LX/MX Comfort Plus User
–
Usage of all communication functions of OpenScape Office
–
Unified Communications functions via myPortal for Desktop
–
Voicemail box (Voicemail)
–
Fax box
–
Conference management
–
Mobility Entry, incl. myPortal for Mobile/Tablet PC web client
Comfort Plus User licenses are permanently bound to stations.
•
OpenScape Office V3 HX Standard User
–
Usage of all communication functions of OpenScape Office
–
Unified Communications functions via myPortal for Desktop.
–
Voicemail box (Voicemail)
–
Fax box
Standard user licenses are permanently bound to the stations.
396
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Licensing
Licenses
•
OpenScape Office V3 myPortal for Outlook (Outlook Integration)
For the use of unified communications functions through Microsoft Outlook.
The licenses for myPortal for Outlook are “floating” licenses, i.e., are not
permanently bound to the subscribers; however, the maximum number of
subscribers who can log in simultaneously is restricted to the number of
available licenses. myPortal for Outlook additionally requires a Comfort Plus
User license (LX/MX) or a Standard User license (HX). A maximum of 150
myPortal for Outlook users can be licensed for OpenScape Office MX, and a
maximum of 500 myPortal for Outlook users can be licensed for OpenScape
Office LX/HX.
•
OpenScape Office V3 myPortal for Zimbra
For the use of unified communications functions through Zimbra. The licenses
for myPortal for Zimbra are “floating” licenses, i.e., are not permanently bound
to the subscribers; however, the maximum number of subscribers who can log
in simultaneously is restricted to the number of available licenses. myPortal
for Zimbra additionally requires a Comfort Plus User license (LX/MX) or a
Standard User license (HX). A maximum of 100 myPortal for Zimbra users
can be licensed for OpenScape Office MX, and a maximum of 200 myPortal
for Zimbra users can be licensed for OpenScape Office LX/HX.
•
OpenScape Office V3 myAttendant
For using a PC attendant (Attendant Console). The licenses for myAttendant
“floating” licenses, i.e., are not permanently bound to the subscribers;
however, the maximum number of subscribers who can log in simultaneously
at the Attendant Console is restricted to the number of available licenses. The
myAttendant license also includes the required Comfort User license. A
maximum of 20 myAttendants can be licensed.
•
OpenScape Office V3 CSTA Application Interface (free of charge)
For a CSTA connection to enable the use of CSTA applications. A total of 7
CSTA connections may be licensed. For every CSTA connection, a separate
CSTA license is required. Different priorities (levels) are assigned to the CSTA
applications.
–
OpenScape Office: Level 1
–
TAPI 170 V2 R1: Level 2
–
DSS Server: Level 3
– Other CSTA applications: Level 3
If all CSTA connections are in use and a further CSTA application is started,
the CSTA application with the lowest priority is automatically terminated. If the
new CSTA application has the lowest priority or an equivalent level to one of
the other applications, the new application is not started. This automatic prioritization ensures that the OpenSape Office application can always be used
even if all CSTA connections are already in use.
•
OpenScape Office V3 OpenDirectory Connector
For using the OpenScape Office Directory Service (ODS) so that the UC Suite
can also be connected to an external database.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
397
Licensing
Licenses
•
OpenScape Office V3 Application Launcher
For call-related control of applications on a client PC during incoming and
outgoing calls, e.g., launching an application or displaying caller information.
The usage of Application Launcher is licensed per user. Application Launcher
additionally requires a Comfort Plus User license (LX/MX) or a Standard User
license (HX).
•
OpenScape Office V3 Gate View Cameras
For video surveillance, which provides real-time video images on your
OpenStage phone, PC or iPhone. Each camera requires its own license. A
maximum of 2 cameras can be connected to an OpenScape Office V3 MX,
and a maximum of 8 cameras can be connected to an OpenScape Office V3
LX/HX.
•
OpenScape Office V3 HX VoiceMail
For using the voicemail box of OpenScape Office without having to purchase
an OpenScape Office HX Standard User license. Only the functions operated
via the telephone can be used.
Related Topics
11.2.3 Licenses for Multimedia Contact Center
In order to use the Multimedia Contact Center, additional licenses are required.
The following licenses are available for the Multimedia Contact Center:
•
•
398
OpenScape Office V3 Contact Center Basic License Package
–
1x license for usage of the contact center
–
4x licenses for Contact Center agents (myAgent), incl. the 4 required
Comfort User licenses
OpenScape Office V3 myAgent
For use of one myAgent user (Agent or Supervisor) in the Contact Center. The
licenses for agents are “floating” licenses and not permanently bound to the
agents. Any number of subscribers can be set up as agents, but the maximum
number of agents who can log in simultaneously is restricted to the number of
available licenses. The Contact Center basic license package is a prerequisite. Together with the myAgent license, a Comfort User license for the
device is acquired. The Comfort User license must be assigned to the device.
A maximum of 64 agents can be licensed. For OpenScape Office MX one-box
systems, a maximum of 10 agents can be licensed.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Licensing
Licenses
•
OpenScape Office V3 myReports
To use the extended reporting functionality (report analysis and creation) for
the Contact Center. Standard reporting is already included in myAgent.
myReports can only be started once per system, so only one license is
required for it.
•
OpenScape Office V3 Contact Center Fax
For setting up one or more fax boxes to send and receive faxes for Contact
Center agents. One license per system is required for this purpose. The
Contact Center basic license package is a prerequisite.
•
OpenScape Office V3 Contact Center E-Mail
For setting up one or more e-mail boxes to send and receive e-mails for
Contact Center agents. One license per system is required for this purpose.
The Contact Center basic license package is a prerequisite.
Related Topics
11.2.4 Evaluation Licenses
An evaluation license can be used to test applications with full functionality over
a fixed time period (called the evaluation period) free of charge. If regular licenses
for the application are activated during the evaluation period, the evaluation
license is disabled.
The evaluation period is 90 days. After 60 days, the remaining time in days is
counted backwards on the display of system telephones. When the evaluation
period expires, the application is automatically disabled.
The activation of the license occurs at the Customer License Server (CLS) and
can only be performed once.
The following evaluation licenses are available:
•
OpenScape Office V3 Contact Center Evaluation License (free of
charge)
–
1x license for usage of the contact center
–
64x licenses for Contact Center agents (myAgent), incl. the 64 required
Comfort User licenses
–
1x license for Contact Center reporting (myReports)
–
1x Contact Center Fax license
–
1x Contact Center E-mail license
–
1x license for OpenDirectory Connector
–
20x licenses for Application Launcher
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
399
Licensing
Licenses
–
2x licenses for Gate View cameras
This evaluation license is intended for customers who are already using
OpenScape Office and want to test the Multimedia Contact Center. All
features of the Multimedia Contact Centers can be used with the evaluation
license.
INFO: If the Multimedia Contact Center is not licensed within the
evaluation period, the administrator must undo the Contact
Center settings (e.g., delete schedules and queues, deactivate
agents, etc.) before the evaluation license expires. Otherwise,
errors may occur in OpenScape Office.
•
OpenScape Office V3 HX Evaluation License (free of charge)
This Evaluation License is intended for HiPath 3000 customers who have not
used OpenScape Office HX in the past. All OpenScape Office HX features
can be used with this evaluation license. The activation of the license occurs
via the Customer License Agent ( CLA ). In order to enable all the features of
OpenScape Office HX to be used, the number of HG 1500 B channels for an
HG 1500 board is increased to 30 during the evaluation period.
Related Topics
11.2.5 Upgrade Licenses
Upgrade licenses are required to upgrade the product or feature to the latest
version.
The following upgrade licenses are available:
•
OpenScape Office V3 MX Upgrade from OSO MX V2
For the upgrade from HiPath OpenOffice ME V1 and OpenScape Office MX
V2 to OpenScape Office V3 MX. HiPath OpenOffice ME V1 must be first
upgraded to OpenScape Office MX V2 software. It is not possible to directly
upgrade the software from HiPath OpenOffice ME V1 to OpenScape Office
V3 MX.
With this license, all purchased licenses are converted to V3 licenses. HiPath
OpenOffice ME V1 licenses can be upgraded to OpenScape Office V3 MX
licenses directly at the CLS.
INFO: In V3, the licenses for the Contact Center Basic License
Package, myAgent and myAttendant include the required Comfort
User licenses, which had to be ordered separately for V2. When
upgrading to V3, only the licenses for the Contact Center Basic
400
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Licensing
Activating and Updating Licenses
License Package, myAgent and myAttendant need to be
upgraded; the total number of Comfort User licenses available
remains the same.
INFO: After an upgrade to OpenScape Office V3 MX, 15 Comfort
User licenses from the OpenScape Office MX V2 basic package
are converted to Comfort Plus User licenses.
•
OpenScape Office V3 LX/MX Upgrade from Comfort to Comfort Plus
User
For upgrading a Comfort User to a Comfort Plus User
An upgrade from OpenScape Office HX V2 to OpenScape Office HX V3 occurs
automatically with the upgrade from HiPath 3000 to Version 9.
Related Topics
11.3 Activating and Updating Licenses
Products or features must be enabled via licenses. Following a hardware defect,
these licenses must be updated.
The license activation and license upgrade should be done outside of business
hours, since licensed features such as the UC Suite are automatically restarted
after the license activation. Existing telephone connections are disconnected.
The activation and updating of licenses for OpenScape Office HX are performed
using HiPath 3000 Manager E and a license file. This type of licensing is
described in the HiPath 3000 Manager E documentation. The following sections
explain the licensing of OpenScape Office MX and OpenScape Office LX with the
aid of the WBM.
Related Topics
11.3.1 Activating Licenses (MX/LX)
After purchasing a product or feature, you must activate the licenses provided
with the product or feature to enable it. The License Authorization Code (LAC) or
the license file itself is required for this purpose.
Licenses can be activated by one of the following two methods:
•
Activating a License using the License Authorization Code
License activation via the LAC is the standard method. Using the LAC, a
license file is generated at the Central License Server (CLS) and forwarded
to OpenScape Office Assistant. The license file is used to activate the
associated license and release the product. To access the CLS, you will need
an Internet connection or an ISDN connection. The IP address of the CLS or
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
401
Licensing
Activating and Updating Licenses
the phone number for the ISDN connection is stored in
OpenScape Office Assistant under License Management > Settings and
can be changed by an administrator with the Expert profile if required.
•
Activating a License via a License File
License activation via a license file is needed if a license file is directly
available instead of a LAC. The license file was generated at the Central
License Server (CLS) earlier and downloaded. The license file is used to
activate the associated license and release the product. The IP address of the
CLS is saved in OpenScape Office Assistant under License Management >
Settings.
If the communication system is to be expanded, further licenses (e.g., 5 additional
Comfort User licenses) can be purchased. On purchasing more licenses, an
additional License Authorization Code (LAC) with which the newly procured
licenses can be activated is supplied. After activation, all features for which a
license is required will be available.
INFO: In order to successfully activate additional licenses, the
license for the basic package must already have been activated in
advance or be activated at the same time as the additional
licenses.
Assigning the Licenses
The Comfort User and Comfort Plus User licenses are assigned permanently to
individual IP stations with OpenScape Office Assistant. The number of IP stations
licensed cannot exceed the number of available licenses. The assignment of
other licenses occurs dynamically, i.e., depending on the requirements and availability, licenses are assigned for the components that require them.
Connecting to the License Server without Internet Access
As a rule, the connection to the Central License Server (CLS) is set up via the
Internet. If no Internet access is available or configured, the connection to the CLS
is automatically established via ISDN. The correct license station number must be
configured and selected for this purpose. Logging on to the CLS then occurs
automatically. The license station number for the CLS is saved in
OpenScape Office Assistant under License Management > Settings and can
be changed by an administrator with the Expert profile if required.
Related Topics
11.3.1.1 How to Activate a License using the License Authorization Code
Prerequisites
402
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
•
You know the License Authorization Code (LAC) needed to release the
license.
•
In order to access the License server, the communication system must have
access to the Internet or be connected via an ISDN line.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Licensing
Activating and Updating Licenses
Step by Step
1) Click on License Management in the navigation bar.
2) In the navigation tree, click Activate License Online.
3) Enter the appropriate LAC in the License Authorization Code (LAC) field.
4) Leave the check boxes for accessing the License server via a user name and
password disabled. Access to the Licensing Server occurs automatically.
(The input of a user name and password is only required for sales partners.)
5) Click Activate. The connection to the License Server is established, and the
license is transferred to the communication system. Following the successful
release, the connection is automatically reestablished.
Related Topics
11.3.1.2 How to Activate a License via a License File
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
•
The license file was generated earlier at the Central License Server and
saved. You know the storage location of the license file.
Step by Step
1) Click on License Management in the navigation bar.
2) In the navigation tree, click Activate License File.
3) Under License File, click Browse and select the storage location of the
license file.
4) Click Activate.
Related Topics
11.3.1.3 How to License IP Stations
The IP Telephones wizard can be used to license one or more IP stations.
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Telephones / Stations.
3) Click Edit to start the IP Telephones wizard. A list of all IP stations appears.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
403
Licensing
Activating and Updating Licenses
4) From the License Type drop-down list in the row of the desired IP station,
select whether the IP station is to be assigned the functionality of a Comfort
User or Comfort Plus User.
INFO: In order to assign Comfort User or Comfort User Plus
licenses, the appropriate licenses should be present. For information on the functional scope of a Comfort User or Comfort Plus
User, see Licenses .
5) If you want to license additional IP stations, repeat step 4.
6) Click OK & Next. The IP stations are assigned the license type.
7) Click OK & Next followed by Finish.
Related Topics
11.3.1.4 How to Check or Change the IP Address of the License Server
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
•
If the IP address of the Central License Server has changed, you will need to
know the current IP address.
Step by Step
1) Click on License Management in the navigation bar.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Settings. The IP address of the Central
License Server (CLS) appears in the IP address of the Central License
Server field. The currently valid IP address is 188.64.16.4.
3) If you need to change the IP address of the Central License Server, enter the
new IP address of the Central License Server in the corresponding IP
address of the Central License Server field in the format
123.124.125.126.
4) Click Activate.
Related Topics
11.3.1.5 How to Check or Change the Call Number for the ISDN Connection to the
License Server
Prerequisites
404
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
•
If the phone number for the ISDN connection to the Central License Server
has changed, you will need to know the current phone number.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Licensing
Activating and Updating Licenses
Step by Step
1) Click on License Management in the navigation bar.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Settings.
3) If you want to change the station number for the Central License Server, enter
the current station number of the Central License Server in the Call No of
License Server field.
4) Click Activate.
Related Topics
11.3.2 Updating a License (MX/LX)
Licenses must be updated whenever any hardware that has a MAC address (e.g.,
the motherboard of OpenScape Office MX, network card or the Linux server of
OpenScape Office LX) is replaced at the communication system. To perform the
update, the License Authorization Code (LAC) and the login details for the Central
License Server (CLS) are required.
After replacing the hardware, the configuration data must be restored using the
latest backup set (see Restore ).
Since the licenses are bound to the MAC address of the hardware, the MAC
address changes on replacing the hardware, and the licenses are thus are no
longer valid. After the hardware is replaced, the communication system reverts to
the grace period. The LAC must therefore be transferred to the CLS again. The
LAC of the basic license or the LAC of a further product/feature of
OpenScape Office MX may be used for this purpose. The new license file, which
is bound to the new MAC address, is transferred to the communication system,
and all existing licenses are then automatically activated.
For OpenScape Office MX, the MAC address of the first system box is used
(visible as a sticker on the front of the device). For OpenScape Office MX, the
MAC address of the network card of the Linux server, which was selected on
installing the Linux operating system (visible via YaST), is used. The MAC
address can also be read by using OpenScape Office Assistant.
INFO: Before the licenses can be updated, a rehost must be
performed at the CLS. Every rehost is logged. A license can be
used for a rehost up to three times.
INFO: The IP address of the CLS (Central License Server) can
be checked via OpenScape Office Assistant under License
Management > Settings and changed if required.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Immediate Backup
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
405
Licensing
Licensing in an Internetwork
11.3.2.1 How to Update a License
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
•
The hardware has been replaced, and you have performed a rehost at the
CLS.
•
The configuration data has been restored using the latest backup set.
•
You know the License Authorization Code (LAC) needed to release the
license.
•
In order to access the License server, the communication system must have
access to the Internet or be connected via an ISDN line.
Step by Step
1) Click on License Management in the navigation bar.
2) In the navigation tree, click Activate License Online.
3) Enter the appropriate LAC in the License Authorization Code (LAC) field.
4) Leave the check boxes for accessing the License server via a user name and
password disabled. Access to the Licensing Server occurs automatically.
(The input of a user name and password is only required for sales partners.)
5) Click Activate. The connection to the license server is established and the
license is released. Following the successful update, the connection is
reestablished automatically.
6) Restart the communication system.
Next steps
Save your configuration data in a new backup set (see Immediate Backup ).
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Immediate Backup
11.4 Licensing in an Internetwork
If multiple OpenScape Office (nodes) systems are combined into an internetwork,
licensing occurs centrally via the master node.
The master node contains the central license agent (central CLA; central
Customer License Agent). All other nodes (slave nodes) in the internetwork use
this CLA for the licensing. To enable this, the IP address of the master node must
be made known to the slave nodes using OpenScape Office Assistant.
406
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Licensing
Licensing in an Internetwork
Only one network license file exists for the entire internetwork. This license is
bound to the MAC address of the master node and stored in the central CLA. The
network license file contains all the license information in the internetwork and can
only be activated at the master node using OpenScape Office Assistant. Only the
master node has access to the CLS; at all other nodes, the access is disabled.
The network license file includes two types of licenses:
•
Bound licenses
Bound licenses are bound to the MAC address of a node and can only be
used from that node. All basic licenses and licenses for the UC clients such
as myPortal for Outlook or myAttendant are bound licenses. If bound
licenses are to be used from another node, they must first be shifted with the
aid of the CLS. The basic licenses for OpenScape Office cannot be shifted.
•
Unbound licenses
Unbound licenses can be used from all nodes in the internetwork. The
Comfort User and Comfort Plus User licenses are unbound licenses (except
for those included in the basic licenses). The Comfort User and Comfort Plus
User licenses are assigned to IP stations. These licenses can be reassigned
to other nodes without being shifted. This is achieved by unassigning the
licenses from the IP stations at the old node and assigning them to the IP
stations at the new node.
Figure: Overview of Bound and Unbound Licenses
LAN
OpenScape Office MX
MAC Address
OpenScape Office LX
MAC Address
OpenScape Office MX
MAC Address
OpenScape Office MX
Basis 20 Plus
OpenScape Office LX
Basis 20 Plus
OpenScape Office MX
Basis 10 Plus
myPortal for Outlook
myPortal for Outlook
myPortal for Outlook
myAttendant
Contact Center Basis
myAgent
Comfort Plus User
Bound Licenses
Unshiftable
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Bound Licenses
Shiftable
Comfort User
Unbound Licenses
407
Licensing
Licensing in an Internetwork
Shifting Licenses
One or more licenses can be shifted from one node to another. The transfer of
licenses is performed at the CLS. The CLS generates a new network license file,
which must then be loaded into the central CLA.
Combining Licenses
If one or more nodes that have already been licensed are to be combined into an
internetwork, the administrator must combine the individual license files via the
CLS into a single license file and load it into the central CLA. The IP address of
the master node with the central license agent must then be entered at all other
nodes by using the Networking wizard of OpenScape Office Assistant.
Behavior during Network Problems (Failover)
If the connection to the master node and thus to the central CLA fails, the
message “Failover Period” appears on the displays of the system telephones.
During this failover period (max. 30 days), all nodes and their features continue
to operate normally. Once the network problems have been resolved and the
connection to the central CLA is restored, all nodes revert to the regular license
status.
If the network problems cannot be resolved within the failover period, the nodes
switch to operating in emergency mode. The entire internetwork will then need to
be relicensed.
Related Topics
11.4.1 Licensing Process in the Internetwork
The licensing process for a sample internetwork consisting of one
OpenScape Office LX and two OpenScape Office MX systems is illustrated
below:
1. On purchasing the communication systems, the customer receives a License
Authorization Code (LAC). The information on the licenses purchased (basic
licenses and extension licenses, if any) are stored in the database of the CLS.
2. Using the network wizard of OpenScape Office Assistant, the customer or
service technician first installs the OpenScape Office LX as a master node.
The system runs in the Grace Period (period of 30 days during which the
licensing has to be completed).
For a description, see Configuring Scenario 3
3. Using the network wizard of OpenScape Office Assistant, the customer or
service technician then installs the two OpenScape Office MX systems. The
system runs in the Grace Period
For a description, see Configuring Scenario 3
4. After the customer or service technician has installed all the systems in the
internetwork, he or she generates a network license file at the CLS with the
License Authorization Code and uploads this to the master node with the help
of OpenScape Office Assistant. The network license file contains all the
408
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Licensing
Licensing in an Internetwork
customer-specific hardware information (such as the MAC addresses or the
Advanced Locking IDs of all systems in the internetwork) and all associated
licenses.
For a description, see How to License an Internetwork
5. OpenScape Office Assistant checks whether the MAC addresses or
Advanced Locking IDs stored in the license file match those of the systems.
If the check is successful, the licenses are activated, and the systems switch
to the regular license status. If the check is not successful, the systems
continue to run in the Grace Period until it expires and then only in emergency
mode.
Related Topics
11.4.2 How to License an Internetwork
This example describes the licensing of an internetwork consisting of one
OpenScape Office LX as a master node (Node 1) and two further
OpenScape Office MX systems (Node 2 and Node 3). The licenses are assigned
to the individual nodes at the CLS. Subsequently, a joint network license file is
downloaded and activated on the master node.
Prerequisites
•
Access to the CLS exists.
•
All nodes are installed and networked with one another; see Scenario 3:
Networking of OpenScape Office LX and OpenScape Office MX (Single
Gateway) .
Step by Step
1) Log into the CLS with your user name and password.
2) Under Licenses, select the item Generate and download license key.
3) Enter the License Authorization Code (LAC) under LAC and click Search.
4) Open the OpenScape Office LX product and select the features to be
assigned to Node 1.
5) Click Generate License Key.
6) Enter the MAC address or the Advanced Locking ID of OpenScape Office LX
(Node 1) under MAC Address and then enter the MAC address or the
Advanced Locking ID of OpenScape Office LX of Node 1 (master node) again
under MAC Address of the Network CLA.
INFO: The MAC address of OpenScape Office LX is the MAC
address of the network card of the OpenScape Office LX Linux
server that was used when installing the Linux operating system.
The Advanced Locking ID of OpenScape Office LX is used
instead of the MAC address when OpenScape Office LX is
operated in a virtualized environment.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
409
Licensing
Licensing in an Internetwork
7) Enter the desired number for the features and click Next.
8) Verify the customer data and click Next.
9) Read through the legal notification and then click Yes, I agree to the terms
of use!.
10) Click Execute to generate the license key.
11) For Node 2, under Licenses, select the item Generate and download
license key.
12) Enter the License Authorization Code (LAC) again under LAC and click
Search.
13) Open the OpenScape Office MX product and select the features to be
assigned to Node 2.
14) Click Generate License Key.
15) Enter the MAC address of Node 2 under MAC Address and then enter the
MAC address of Node 1 (master node) under MAC Address of the Network
CLA.
16) Enter the desired number for the features and click Next.
17) Click Next.
18) Confirm the legal notification by selecting the check box Yes, I agree to the
terms of use!.
19) Click Execute to generate the license key.
20) Repeat steps 11 through 19 for Node 3.
21) Click License Key and then on Download to download the network license
file.
22) Save the network license file.
23) Log into the OpenScape Office Assistant of the master node by calling up the
address https://<IP address of the master node> in your web
browser and then entering your user name and password.
24) Click on License Management in the navigation bar.
25) In the navigation tree, click Activate License File.
26) Under License File, click Browse and select the storage location of the
network license file.
27) Click Activate.
Related Topics
11.4.3 How to Shift Licenses
Bound licenses can be shifted from one node to another with the aid of the CLS.
410
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Licensing
Licensing in an Internetwork
Prerequisites
•
Access to the CLS exists.
•
All nodes are installed and networked with one another; see Scenario 3:
Networking of OpenScape Office LX and OpenScape Office MX (Single
Gateway) .
Step by Step
1) Log into the CLS with your user name and password.
2) Select the Licenses > Shift menu item.
3) Enter either the System ID or the Locking ID (MAC address) of the node from
which the licenses should be taken and click on Search. The license information for the desired node is displayed.
4) Click on Shift, followed by Next. A new window opens.
5) In the row of the desired product/feature, under Quantity to Shift, enter the
number of bound licenses to be shifted.
6) Click Next.
7) Enter either the System ID or the Locking ID (MAC address) of the node to
which the licenses should be assigned and click on Search. The license information for the desired node is displayed.
8) Click Next. The numbers of licenses for both nodes before and after moving
the licenses are displayed.
9) Check the values again to ensure that they are correct.
10) If the values are OK, enter the reason for shifting the license in the Transaction note (Reason for shift) field and click Finish.
11) Click on <Product> License Key to download the new network license file.
12) Save the network license file.
13) Close the window and log out of the CLS.
14) Log into the OpenScape Office Assistant of the master node by calling up the
address https://<IP address of the master node> in your web
browser and then entering your user name and password.
15) Click on License Management in the navigation bar.
16) In the navigation tree, click Activate License File.
17) Under License File, click Browse and select the storage location of the
network license file.
18) Click Activate.
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
411
Licensing
Licensing in an Internetwork
11.4.4 How to Combine License Files into a Network License File
If several nodes that were previously not networked are subsequently integrated
into an internetwork, the license files of the individual nodes must be combined
into a common network license file with the help of the CLS.
Prerequisites
•
Access to the CLS exists, and you have the access rights for the license
packages of the individual nodes.
•
All nodes are installed and networked with one another; see Scenario 3:
Networking of OpenScape Office LX and OpenScape Office MX (Single
Gateway) .
Step by Step
1) Log into the CLS with your user name and password.
2) Under Network Licensing, select the item Add/Remove System.
3) Select the MAC address of the node that is to be integrated in the internetwork.
4) Click on the Rehost.
5) Enter the MAC address of the node under MAC Address.
6) Enter the MAC address of the master node under MAC Address of the
Network CLA. As a rule, OpenScape Office LX is the master node.
INFO: The MAC address of OpenScape Office LX is the MAC
address of the network card of the OpenScape Office LX Linux
server that was used when installing the Linux operating system.
7) Click Next.
8) Verify the customer data and click Next.
9) Read through the legal notification and then click Yes, I agree to the terms
of use!.
10) Click Execute to generate the license key.
11) Repeat steps 2 through 10 for further nodes .
12) Click License Key and then on Download to download the network license
file.
13) Save the network license file.
14) Log into the OpenScape Office Assistant of the master node by calling up the
address https://<IP address of the master node> in your web
browser and then entering your user name and password.
15) Click on License Management in the navigation bar.
16) In the navigation tree, click Activate License File.
412
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Licensing
Licensing in an Internetwork
17) Under License File, click Browse and select the storage location of the
network license file.
18) Click Activate.
Related Topics
11.4.5 How to Change the Connection to the Central License Agent
Every node in the internetwork requires the connection to the Central CLA on the
master node. This connection is automatically established by
OpenScape Office Assistant on running the Network wizard. If the IP address of
the master node changes, the connection to the central CLA must be reconfigured at all slave nodes.
Prerequisites
•
The communication system is located in an internetwork.
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant of the desired node.
Step by Step
1) Click on License Management in the navigation bar.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Settings.
3) Enable the Central License Agent radio button and enter the IP address of
the master node (node 1) under IP address of Central License Agent in the
format 123.124.125.126.
4) Click Activate.
Related Topics
11.4.6 How to Configure the Connection to the Local License Agent
When a node is removed from the internetwork, the connection to the central CLA
must be cleared. The local CLA installed on the node is used instead.
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant of the desired node.
Step by Step
1) Click on License Management in the navigation bar.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Settings.
3) Enable the Customer License Agent (CLA) Local Host radio button.
4) Click Activate.
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
413
Licensing
License Information in OpenScape Office Assistant
11.5 License Information in OpenScape Office Assistant
Information on the available and assigned licenses, products and features is
displayed with OpenScape Office Assistant. The license information on all
licenses available in the internetwork can be retrieved.
The following information can be displayed:
•
MAC Address: MAC address of OpenScape Office MX or the
OpenScape Office Linux server to which the licenses are bound.
INFO: If OpenScape Office MX is in the grace period, a wrong
MAC address may possibly be shown here. The correct MAC
address can be checked via the Service Center under Inventory
(How to Check the MAC Address of OpenScape Office MX ).
•
Locking ID: Advanced Locking ID of OpenScape Office LX in a virtualized
environment, to which the licenses are bound.
•
Node: Name of the communication system to which the license is bound.
•
Product Name: Name of the product for which the license is assigned.
•
Feature: Feature for which the license has been assigned.
•
Used licenses: Shows the number of used and available licenses.
•
Available for distribution: Shows the licenses still available in the internetwork.
•
Status: Status of the license.
Related Topics
11.5.1 License Information without a Network (Standalone)
All licenses permanently assigned to the communication system can be
displayed.
Related Topics
11.5.1.1 How to Display Information on Licenses
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant.
›
Click on License Management in the navigation bar. All existing licenses are
displayed.
Step by Step
Related Topics
11.5.2 License Information in an Internetwork
All existing licenses in an internetwork and the relevant information on them can
be displayed.
414
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Licensing
License Information in OpenScape Office Assistant
The display of the license information in the internetwork is grouped as follows:
•
Display of bound licenses
These are licenses that are permanently assigned to a single communication
system (node).
•
Display of unbound licenses
These are licenses that are not permanently assigned to any communication
system and can be freely distributed in the internetwork.
•
Display of local licenses
These are licenses that are permanently assigned to the local communication
system, including the free unbound licenses.
Related Topics
11.5.2.1 How to Display Information on Bound Licenses
Prerequisites
•
The communication system is located in an internetwork.
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant.
Step by Step
1) Click on License Management in the navigation bar.
2) In the navigation tree, click on License Information.
3) Click on the desired node (communication system). The licenses bound to the
communication system you selected will be displayed.
Related Topics
11.5.2.2 How to Display Information on Unbound Licenses
Prerequisites
•
The communication system is located in an internetwork.
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant.
Step by Step
1) Click on License Management in the navigation bar.
2) In the navigation tree, click on License Information.
3) Click on Floating. All unbound licenses are displayed.
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
415
Unified Communications
UC Clients
12 Unified Communications
Unified Communications offers features such as the Presence status and CallMe,
conferencing (not with OpenScape office HX), as well as voicemail and fax
functionality in the myPortal for Desktop and myPortal for Outlook clients.
myAttendant also provides Attendant Console functions.
INFO: For more information on the clients myAgent and
myReports, see Multimedia Contact Center .
Related Topics
12.1 UC Clients
UC clients provide subscribers with convenient user interfaces for unified communications.
The system offers the following UC clients for the following devices:
Client type
Client
Communications Cli- myPortal for Desktop
ent
myPortal for Outlook
Device
PC
Fax Printer
(see Voice and Fax Messages )
myAttendant
Mobile Client
myPortal for OpenStage
OpenStage telephone
myPortal for Mobile
Mobile Phone
(see Multimedia Contact Center )
Contact Center Client myAgent
PC
(see Multimedia Contact Center )
myReports
(see Multimedia Contact Center )
Subscribers with a configured e-mail address receive a welcome e-mail with
Getting Started Instructions.
Custom Settings
The custom (i.e., subscriber-specific) settings for myPortal for Desktop are stored
in ini files on the PC. A separate ini file is created for every user. The custom
settings for myPortal for Outlook, myAttendant and Fax Printer are stored in the
registry of the PC. This enables different users to use the myPortal for Desktop,
myPortal for Outlook, myAttendant and Fax Printer applications on a single PC
416
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
UC Clients
(Desk Sharing) and also the deployment in Windows Terminal Server and Citrix
Server environments. This allows different users to access the applications from
their PCs without a local installation.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Multimedia Contact Center
•
Mobility
12.1.1 myPortal for Desktop
myPortal for Desktop is a client for unified communications on your PC. Besides
convenient dialing aids via phone directories and favorites and information on the
presence status of other subscribers, users can, for example, also access their
voicemails and fax messages.
myPortal for Desktop provides the following features:
•
Directories
•
Favorites List
•
Journal
•
Desktop Dialer
•
Screen pops
•
Presence Status
•
CallMe service with ONS (One Number Service)
•
Status-based call forwarding
•
Personal AutoAttendant
•
Conference management (LX/MX)
•
Record conferences (LX/MX)
•
Record calls
•
Instant Messaging
•
Voice and Fax Messages
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Prerequisites for UC PC Clients
12.1.1.1 How to Customize the Alternative Modern User Interface for
myPortal for Desktop
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
417
Unified Communications
UC Clients
You can customize the appearance of the alternative modern user interface for
myPortal for Desktop by performing the following steps:
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) Click in the navigation tree on Wizards > UC Suite.
3) Click Edit to start the Skin Settings wizard.
4) Click Browse and select the desired file.
5) Click Upload.
6) Select one of the following options for the font color to be used:
•
If you want to use the white font, select the Use white font check box.
•
If you want to use the black font, select the Use black font check box.
Related Topics
12.1.1.2 How to Delete the Alternative Modern User Interface for myPortal for Desktop
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) Click in the navigation tree on Wizards > UC Suite.
3) Click Edit to start the Skin Settings wizard.
4) Click Delete.
Related Topics
12.1.2 myPortal for Outlook
myPortal for Outlook is the client for unified communications in Microsoft Outlook
(plug-in) and is analogous to myPortal for Desktop.
myPortal for Outlook provides the following features in addition to those of
myPortal for Desktop:
•
How to Call an Outlook Contact
•
How to Create an Outlook Contact from the Sender of a Voice Message
•
How to Send a Voice Message as an E-mail
•
How to Send a Fax Message as an E-mail
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Prerequisites for UC PC Clients
418
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
UC Clients
12.1.3 myPortal for Zimbra
myPortal for Zimbra is a web-based client for unified communications in the Web
Client of the Zimbra Collaboration Suite (plug-in). Besides convenient dialing aids
via phone directories and favorites and information on the presence status of
subscribers, you can, for example, also access your voicemails.
myPortal for Zimbra offers the following features in addition to telephony:
•
Directories
•
Favorites List
•
Journal
•
Presence Status
•
Status-based call forwarding
•
Voicemail
Other features you can use with myPortal for Desktop.
Related Topics
12.1.3.1 How to Provide the Zimlet for myPortal for Zimbra on the Zimbra Server
Prerequisites
•
The Zimbra server must be able to reach the communication system via port
8801.
•
You have downloaded the Zip file of the zimlet for myPortal for Zimbra from
the download area of the Service Center.
›
Upload the zimlet to the Zimbra server (https://<IP address of the Zimbra
server>) with the option Flush Zimlet cache.
Step by Step
Related Topics
12.1.4 myPortal for OpenStage
myPortal for OpenStage is the user portal for accessing the system’s unified
communications functions on your OpenStage telephone.
myPortal for OpenStage can be configured via the OpenStage telephone as well
as OpenStage Manager web browsers.
myPortal for OpenStage provides the following features:
•
Presence status
•
Voicemail
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Prerequisites for myPortal for OpenStage
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
419
Unified Communications
UC Clients
12.1.5 Fax Printer
Fax Printer is an application for sending fax messages with individually created
cover sheets from Windows applications such as Microsoft Word, for example.
Fax Printer consists of the following components:
•
Fax Printer Cover Editor
•
Fax-Drucker-Treiber
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Prerequisites for UC PC Clients
12.1.6 myAttendant
myAttendant is a unified communications solution for Attendant functions.
Besides convenient Attendant functions, dialing aids via phone directories and
information on the presence status of other subscribers, myAttendant can, for
example, also be used to access voicemails and faxes. Instant Messaging
supports the communication with internal subscribers.
myAttendant provides the following features:
•
Attendant functions
•
Directories
•
Journal
•
Pop-up windows
•
Presence status
•
Record calls
•
Message Center
•
User Buttons
•
Voice and Fax Messages
•
Instant Messaging
•
Team functions
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Prerequisites for UC PC Clients
12.1.7 Prerequisites for UC PC Clients
In order to use UC PC clients, the client PC must be equipped with the appropriate
hardware and software configurations. Depending on the configuration, administration rights are required for the installation and automatic updates. The available
functionality depends on the licenses being used.
420
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
UC Clients
INFO: Please make sure that you refer to the notes in the
ReadMe first.rtf file.
Telephones
myPortal for Desktop, myAttendant and myPortal for Outlook can be used in
combination with the following telephones:
•
OpenStage HFA
•
OpenStage T (HX)
•
optiPoint 410 HFA
•
optiPoint 420 HFA
•
optiPoint 500 (HX)
•
optiPoint WL2 professional HFA
•
SIP Phone
•
Analog telephone
•
HiPath Cordless IP
•
HiPath Cordless Office (HX)
•
optiClient 130 HFA
•
OpenScape Personal Edition HFA
•
OpenScape Personal Edition SIP
INFO: For analog and DECT telephones, the Message Waiting
Indication (MWI) is not supported, and only limited support is
available for displaying information on the phone.
Operating System
myPortal for Desktop, myAttendant, myPortal for Outlook and Fax Printer can be
used in combination with the following web browsers:
•
Microsoft Windows 7
•
Microsoft Windows Vista
•
Microsoft Windows XP
Local administration rights on a client PC are required for the installation, but not
for automatic updates. The Russian and Chinese user interfaces of myPortal for
Outlook require a Windows installation in the same language.
myPortal for Desktop can also be used with the following operating systems:
•
Apple Mac OS X v10.7 Lion
Windows Update
The PCs always need the current status of all available updates, including
Service Packs.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
421
Unified Communications
UC Clients
Web Browsers
myPortal for Desktop, myPortal for Outlook and Fax Printer can be used in
combination with the following web browsers:
•
Microsoft Internet Explorer Version 7
•
Microsoft Internet Explorer Version 8 in compatibility mode
•
Microsoft Internet Explorer Version 9
•
Mozilla Firefox Version 4 or later
Additional Software
Additional Software
Java >= 1.6.031 (see Service Center > Download
Center)
myPortal myAtten- myPortal
for Deskt
dant
for Outlo
op
ok
X
X
X
Microsoft Office 2010 or
Microsoft Office 2007(32 bit) with installed .NET components for Outlook or
Microsoft Office 2003 (32 bit)
Microsoft Office 365
Access to Microsoft Exchange Server or Outlook 365 X
(for Outlook contacts and appointments)
X
Microsoft .NET Framework >= 3.5 (>= 4.0 with Microsoft Office 2010)
X
INFO: In order to use the Exchange Calendar integration with
Microsoft Small Business Server, FBA (Form Based Authentication) may need to be disabled there under some circumstances.
Minimum Hardware Requirements
422
•
2 GHz CPU
•
RAM: 2 GB
(Microsoft Windows XP: 1 GB)
(Microsoft Windows 2003 Server: 1 GB)
•
100 Mbps LAN
•
XGA (1024x768) screen resolution, myPortal for Outlook: SVGA (800x600)
screen resolution
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
UC Clients
Microsoft Terminal Server, Citrix Server
myAttendant, myPortal for Desktop, myPortal for Outlook and Fax Printer can be
used in Microsoft Terminal Server and Citrix Server environments under the
following preconditions:
INFO: Terminal Server and Citrix Server environments, including
hosted services and virtual environments are the responsibility of
the customer.
INFO: Citrix server environments can’t decode some regional
characters (e.g., German umlauts) correctly.
Operating System:
•
Microsoft Windows 2008 R2 Server (64 bit) with
Citrix XenApp 6.0 Server (Desktop Mode)
•
Microsoft Windows 2008 R2 Server (64 bit) with
Citrix XenApp 5.0 Server (Desktop Mode)
•
Microsoft Windows 2008 R2 Server (64 bit) as
Microsoft Terminal Server
•
Microsoft Windows 2008 Server as
Microsoft Terminal Server
•
Microsoft Windows 2003 Server as
Microsoft Terminal Server
Office applications:
•
Microsoft Office 2010
•
Microsoft Office 2007 (32 bit)
•
Microsoft Office 2003 (32 bit)
Hardware Prerequisites: The number of installable clients depends on the server
performance and on the amount of available memory. If the server is also being
used for other applications, their memory requirements must also be taken into
account. More information on the configuration of Citrix XenApp Server can be
found under:
http://wiki.unify.com/wiki/OpenScape_Office
Installation Files
The following options are available for providing installation files to users:
•
The administrator downloads the installation files from the Download Center
and provides them to users via a network drive, for example.
•
They can access the installation files directly via a network drive connected
with \\<IP address of communication system>\applications
(User: hoome, Password: hoomesw). The installation files are located in the
install-common folder.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
423
Unified Communications
UC Clients
Related Topics
Related Topics
• myPortal for Desktop
•
myPortal for Outlook
•
Fax Printer
•
myAttendant
•
Silent installation/Uninstallation for UC PC Clients
•
Automatic Updates
12.1.8 Prerequisites for myPortal for Zimbra
In order to use myPortal for Zimbra, the client PC must be equipped with the
appropriate hardware and software.
Web Browsers
myPortal for Desktop, myPortal for Outlook and Fax Printer can be used in
combination with the following web browsers:
•
Microsoft Internet Explorer Version 8 in compatibility mode
•
Microsoft Internet Explorer Version 9
•
Mozilla Firefox Version 3 or later
•
Safari 4 or later
•
Chrome
Zimbra
Access to the Zimbra Collaboration Suite is available via the Web Client.
Web Services for Mobile Phones
Web services for mobile phones must be enabled in the system. The ports
configured in the system must be opened in the firewalls on the LAN and possibly
the client PCs.
Related Topics
12.1.9 Prerequisites for myPortal for OpenStage
In order to use myPortal for OpenStage, the phone must be equipped with the
appropriate hardware and software.
Telephones
myPortal for OpenStage can be used with the following telephones:
424
•
OpenStage 60 V2 and later
•
OpenStage 80 V2 and later
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
UC Clients
Web Browsers
myPortal for OpenStage can be used in combination with the following web
browsers (for configuration and administration):
•
Microsoft Internet Explorer Version 7
•
Microsoft Internet Explorer Version 8 in compatibility mode
•
Microsoft Internet Explorer Version 9 in compatibility mode
•
Mozilla Firefox Version 4 or later
Related Topics
Related Topics
• myPortal for OpenStage
12.1.10 Silent installation/Uninstallation for UC PC Clients
Silent installation/uninstallation is a command-line based method to automatically
install, uninstall or modify UC PC clients on a PC without requiring any further
user inputs.
INFO: Please make sure that you refer to the notes in the
ReadMe first.rtf file.
The silent installation/uninstallation option is available as of V3 and requires local
administration rights on the relevant PC. The silent installation/uninstallation
process can also be logged in a file.
The following parameters are available for silent installations / uninstallations:
Parameters
ALL
Components
• myPortal for Desktop / myAttendant
• myPortal for Outlook
• Fax Printer
• myAgent
• Automatic Updates
myPortal
myPortal for Desktop / myAttendant
OutlookIntegration
myPortal for Outlook
FaxPrinter
Fax Printer
myAgent
myAgent
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Prerequisites for UC PC Clients
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
425
Unified Communications
UC Clients
12.1.10.1 How to Perform a Silent Installation
Prerequisites
•
Your PC meets the requirements described under Prerequisites for UC PC
Clients .
•
You have local administration rights on the client PC.
•
The file CommunicationsClients.exe is available on the client PC.
INFO: Please make sure that you refer to the notes in the
ReadMe first file.
Use the command line in accordance with the following patterns in a batch file or
in a window with the DOS command prompt.
Step by Step
1) If you do not want to log the process, select one of the following command
lines:
INFO: Note the correct notation for parameters in uppercase and
lowercase letters.
•
If you want to install all components:
CommunicationsClients.exe /passive ADDLOCAL=ALL
•
If you want to install multiple components, specify their corresponding
parameters as a comma-separated list after ADDLOCAL=, e.g.,
myPortal for Desktop / myAttendant and Fax Printer:
CommunicationsClients.exe /passive
ADDLOCAL=myPortal,FaxPrinter
•
If you want to install only one component, enter the appropriate parameter
after ADDLOCAL=, e.g., myPortal for Desktop / myAttendant:
CommunicationsClients.exe /passive ADDLOCAL=myPortal
2) If you want to log the process in a file, e.g., in C:\ccinstall.log, select
one of the following command lines:
INFO: Note the correct notation for parameters in uppercase and
lowercase letters.
•
If you want to install all components:
CommunicationsClients.exe /passive /L*V
“C:\ccinstall.log” ADDLOCAL=ALL
426
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
UC Clients
•
If you want to install multiple components, specify their corresponding
parameters as a comma-separated list after ADDLOCAL=, e.g.,
myPortal for Desktop / myAttendant and Fax Printer:
CommunicationsClients.exe /passive /L*V
“C:\ccinstall.log” ADDLOCAL=myPortal,FaxPrinter
•
If you want to install only one component, enter the appropriate parameter
after ADDLOCAL=, e.g., myPortal for Desktop / myAttendant:
CommunicationsClients.exe /passive /L*V
“C:\ccinstall.log” ADDLOCAL=myPortal
Related Topics
12.1.10.2 How to Perform a Silent Uninstallation
Prerequisites
•
Your PC meets the requirements described under Prerequisites for UC PC
Clients .
•
You have local administration rights on the client PC.
•
The file CommunicationsClients.exe is available on the client PC.
INFO: Please make sure that you refer to the notes in the
ReadMe first file.
Use the command line in accordance with the following patterns in a batch file or
in a window with the DOS command prompt.
Step by Step
1) If an update to OpenScape Office was performed after the last silent installation, repeat exactly the same command line with the new CommunicationsClients.exe file as was done with the earlier
CommunicationsClients.exe file (i.e., as if you wanted to reinstall the
components installed earlier with the new CommunicationsClients.exe
file. It is only then that a silent uninstallation will be possible.
2) If you do not want to log the process, select one of the following command
lines:
INFO: Note the correct notation for parameters in uppercase and
lowercase letters.
•
If you want to uninstall all the components:
CommunicationsClients.exe /passive REMOVE=ALL
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
427
Unified Communications
UC Clients
•
If you want to uninstall multiple components, specify their corresponding
parameters as a comma-separated list after REMOVE=, e.g.,
myPortal for Desktop / myAttendant and Fax Printer:
CommunicationsClients.exe /passive
REMOVE=myPortal,FaxPrinter
•
If you want to uninstall only one component, enter the appropriate
parameter after REMOVE=, e.g., myPortal for Desktop / myAttendant:
CommunicationsClients.exe /passive REMOVE=myPortal
3) If you want to log the process in a file, e.g., in C:\ccuninstall.log, select
one of the following command lines:
INFO: Note the correct notation for parameters in uppercase and
lowercase letters.
•
If you want to uninstall all the components:
CommunicationsClients.exe /passive /L*V “C:\ccuninstall.log” REMOVE=ALL
•
If you want to uninstall multiple components, specify their corresponding
parameters as a comma-separated list after REMOVE=, e.g.,
myPortal for Desktop / myAttendant and Fax Printer:
CommunicationsClients.exe /passive /L*V “C:\ccuninstall.log” REMOVE=myPortal,FaxPrinter
•
If you want to uninstall only one component, enter the appropriate
parameter after REMOVE=, e.g., myPortal for Desktop / myAttendant:
CommunicationsClients.exe /passive /L*V “C:\ccuninstall.log” REMOVE=myPortal
Related Topics
12.1.11 Automatic Updates
Automatic updates keep Windows applications (e.g., UC clients, Application
Launcher) up to date.
If an application determines that there is a newer version than the one currently
running, it is automatically updated. If required, a message that the application
must be exited in order to perform the automatic update appears.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Prerequisites for UC PC Clients
428
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Presence Status and CallMe Service
12.2 Presence Status and CallMe Service
The Presence status and CallMe service display and optimize the availability of
subscribers. The Presence status enables simple status-based call forwarding as
well as rule-based call forwarding, which can be flexibly configured with
myPortal for Desktop or myPortal for Outlook.
Related Topics
12.2.1 Presence Status
The Presence status indicates the availability of internal subscribers (including
Mobility Entry subscribers) in the Favorites list, the internal directory, the virtual
conference room (not for OpenScape Office HX) and via voicemail announcements. In addition, the Presence status controls the availability of internal
subscribers with status-based call forwarding, rule-based call forwarding and the
personal AutoAttendant.
As a subscriber, you can change your Presence status in myPortal for Desktop
and myPortal for Outlook or via the phone menu of the voicemail box. Deactivating call forwarding at the telephone returns you to the Office presence status.
For every change in the Presence status (except for Office and CallMe), you also
define the scheduled time of your return to the Office or CallMe status.
As a subscriber, you can select the following statuses:
•
Office
•
Meeting
•
Sick
•
Break
•
Gone Out
•
Vacation
•
Lunch
•
Gone Home
•
Do Not Disturb
(not available for Mobility Entry or MULAP)
Mapping of the External XMPP Status Internally
Subscribers can see the presence status of external XMPP communication
partners in the Favorites list or in the external directory, for example, provided
XMPP has been configured. The following mappings apply (from left to right):
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
429
Unified Communications
Presence Status and CallMe Service
XMPP status
Represented as presence status
Online
Office
DND
Meeting
Away
Out of the Office
Extended Away
Vacation
INFO: Outlook contacts must include the XMPP ID In the IM
address in accordance with the following pattern:
xmpp:[email protected]
Mapping of the Internal Presence Status Externally
External XMPP communication partners can see the XMPP status of internal
subscribers, provided XMPP has been configured. The following mappings apply
(from left to right):
Presence status
Represented as XMPP status
Office
Online
Meeting
DND
Sick
Away
Break
Away
Out of the Office
Away
Lunch
Away
Gone Home
Away
Vacation
Extended Away
Call Forwarding to the Voicemail Box
If the presence status of a subscriber is not Office or CallMe, the communication
system redirects calls for him or her to the voicemail box by default and notifies
the callers via status-based announcements about the nature of absence and the
scheduled time for return.
INFO: The presence-based “Busy” greeting is not associated
with the ringing state of the called party. If a subscriber has set his
or her presence status to not be displayed to external callers, the
external caller will always receive the “Busy” greeting for all
presence states other than “Office” even if the called subscriber
may not be actually busy in some cases. The subscriber should
therefore set up an announcement for the “Busy” greeting to
indicate that he or she cannot accept the call.
430
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Presence Status and CallMe Service
Info Text
You can enter any info text for your current presence status, e.g., “I am in Room
No. ...” when attending a meeting. The info text is displayed in the Favorites list,
in the internal directory and in the virtual conference room (not with OpenScape
Office HX). The info text is deleted when you change your presence status.
Automatic Reset of the Presence Status
As a subscriber, you can have your Presence status automatically reset to Office
at the end of your scheduled absence. Otherwise, the system extends the current
Presence status in increments of 15 minutes until you change it yourself.
Visibility of your Presence Status
As a subscriber, you can specify for each subscriber in the internal directory
whether or not that subscriber can see your Presence status other than Office
and CallMe as well as the scheduled time of your return and any info text you may
have entered.
Automatic Update of Presence Status via Outlook Appointments (Windows)
As a subscriber, you can automatically control your Presence status via Outlook
appointments by using the specific keywords in the Subject line: You can choose
between the following calendars:
•
Exchange calendar (on the Exchange Server)
The automatic update of the presence status via Outlook appointments
occurs independently, regardless of whether or not your PC is running. The
administrator must configure the Exchange Calendar Integration for this
function.
INFO: Appointments from a Microsoft Exchange Server 2003 that
were created with Outlook Web Access are not visible for the
system.
•
Outlook calendar
The automatic update of the presence status via Outlook appointments
requires myPortal for Desktop or myPortal for Outlook to have been started
on your PC.
You can use the following keywords:
•
Meeting
•
Sick
•
Break
•
Gone Out
•
Vacation
•
Lunch
•
Gone Home
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
431
Unified Communications
Presence Status and CallMe Service
The keywords depend on the language set for the user interface. The keywords
may be located anywhere in the Subject line. If the Subject line contains more
than one such keyword, only the fist takes effect. When this function is enabled,
your Presence status changes automatically at the start and end time of the
relevant appointment.
Note: When enabling this function, please bear in mind that any
Outlook appointments with these keywords in the Subject line
could lead to undesirable changes in your Presence status.
Consequently, you may nee to change the Subject line if needed.
Automatic Creation of Outlook Appointments when Absent)
As a subscriber, you can have appropriate Outlook appointments created
automatically when you are absent by a change in your Presence status. The
Subject line of the corresponding Outlook appointment consists of your Presence
status and the text “(Auto)”, for example: “Meeting (Auto)”. The start and end
times for the appointment involved correspond to your entries in myPortal for
Desktop or myPortal for Outlook. The end time of the Outlook appointment
remains unchanged in the event of a possibly delayed return. You can define
whether the Outlook appointments should be stored in the local PST file or on the
Exchange server. If you are using a local PST file, your Outlook must be open
when creating the Outlook appointments. If you are using a PST file on the
Exchange server, the Outlook appointments are created, regardless of whether
or not your Outlook is open. The administrator must configure the Exchange
Calendar Integration for this function.
Screen Pops on Changing the Presence Status
As a subscriber, you can have changes to your Presence status indicated by a
screen pop.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• CallMe Service
•
Status-based call forwarding
•
Rule-Based Call Forwarding
12.2.1.1 How to Configure Exchange Calendar Integration
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Applications > UC Suite.
432
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Presence Status and CallMe Service
3) Click Servers in the menu tree.
4) Click on the Exchange tab.
5) Enable the Exchange Calendar Integration check box.
6) Select one of the following options in the “Exchange Calendar Integration”
area, depending on the version of Microsoft Exchange Server being used:
•
For Microsoft Exchange Server 2010:
Enter the Server URL (e.g., https://<server_name>/ews/
exchange.asmx).
•
For Microsoft Exchange Server or Microsoft Exchange Server 2003:
Enter the Server URL (e.g., https://<server_name>/exchange),
User Name and Password of the Exchange calendar.
INFO: If the integration with the <server-name> specified in the
Server URL does not work, enter the ...<IP address>
instead.
7) Enter the User Name of the Exchange Calendar in the Exchange Calendar
Integration area.
8) Enter the Password of the Exchange Calendar in the Exchange Calendar
Integration area.
9) Click Save.
INFO: Information on the usage of Microsoft Exchange Server
can be found under: http://wiki.unify.com/wiki/
OpenScape_Office.
Related Topics
12.2.2 CallMe Service
The CallMe service enables subscribers to define any phone at an alternative
workplace as the CallMe destination at which they can be reached through their
own internal phone numbers. The subscriber can use myPortal for Desktop or
myPortal for Outlook at his or her alternative workplace exactly as in the office and
thus also make outgoing calls from the CallMe destination.
Inbound Calls
Inbound calls to the internal phone number are forwarded to the CallMe destination. The internal phone number of the called subscriber is displayed to the
caller. Unanswered calls are forwarded to the voicemail box after 30 seconds.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
433
Unified Communications
Presence Status and CallMe Service
Outbound Calls
For outbound calls with myPortal for Desktop or myPortal for Outlook, the
communication system sets up two connections. It first calls the subscriber at the
CallMe destination. If the call is answered, the communication system then calls
the desired destination and connects the subscriber with it. The internal phone
number of the caller is displayed at the destination (One Number Service).
Presence Status
When the CallMe service is enabled, the message “CallMe active“ appears in
the display of the relevant phone (not for analog and DECT phones). Other
subscribers see the presence status Office.
Activation
As a subscriber, you can activate the CallMe service manually. In addition, the
Call-Me service is also reActivated by an automatic reset of the Presence status
following an absence, provided it was active earlier. Then following types of
CallMe destinations are not supported:
•
Group
•
Redirected telephone
Displaying the CallMe Destination in the Favorites List
As a subscriber, you can have the number of your CallMe destination displayed
in the Favorites list of other subscribers instead of your own phone number.
Deactivation
The CallMe service remains active until your Presence status changes.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Presence Status
•
Status-based call forwarding
•
Rule-Based Call Forwarding
12.2.3 Status-based call forwarding
Status-based call forwarding enables subscribers to forward calls based on their
Presence status to one of their additional phone numbers or their voicemail box.
As a subscriber, you can configure status-based call forwarding for every
presence status except Office, CallMe and Do Not Disturb. When you change
your Presence status, the communication system activates call forwarding to the
destination defined by you for this purpose. For example, if you are away from the
office, to your mobile phone or if you are on vacation, to your representative.
434
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Presence Status and CallMe Service
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Presence Status
•
CallMe Service
•
Rule-Based Call Forwarding
12.2.4 Rule-Based Call Forwarding
Rules-based call forwarding enables subscribers to forward calls based on
numerous conditions and exceptions even more flexibly than with status-based
call forwarding.
In addition, rule-based call forwarding also supports:
•
Any destinations
•
Presence status Office, CallMe and Do Not Disturb
As a subscriber, you can define rules and activate or deactivate them at any time
by using the Rules wizard. A rule can only be active if your phone has not been
forwarded. Status-based call forwarding (except to the voicemail box) overrides
rule-based call forwarding.
When a call forwarding rule is active, its name appears on the display of your
telephone.
When an inbound call is received, the communication system checks the applicability of the active rule in accordance with its sequential order in the Rules wizard.
Only the first applicable rule is executed. In this case, your phone will ring once,
and the communication system will then forward your call to the defined destination.
You can define several types of conditions and exceptions (except when ...) in
one rule. However, you cannot define a condition with an exception of the same
type. For example, it is not possible to define a condition of the type “On certain
weekdays” together with an exception of the type “Except on certain weekdays”.
Types of Conditions and Exceptions
•
(except) for certain Presence status
•
(except) from certain people (in the internal directory, external directory,
personal directory or from any station number)
•
(except) when transferred to you from certain people (in the internal directory,
external directory, personal directory or from any station number)
•
(except) from a certain type, i.e., internal, external or Unknown Contact
•
(except) on a certain date (also on multiple dates)
•
(except) on certain weekdays
•
(except) between a certain Start and End date
•
(except) between a certain Start and End time
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
435
Unified Communications
Directories and Journal
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Presence Status
•
CallMe Service
•
Status-based call forwarding
12.3 Directories and Journal
Directories, the Favorites List and the Journal organize contacts and calls.
Related Topics
12.3.1 Directories
Directories are used to organize the contacts of subscribers. Subscribers can
access these contacts with myPortal for Desktop or myPortal for Outlook and via
system phones with displays.
The system provides the following directories, which support the following
functions:
436
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Directories and Journal
Directory
myPortal for Desktop,
my Attendant, Fax Printer
myPortal for Outlook
Contains the personal contacts
of a subscriber. Only the subscriber involved had write
access to this data.
System telephone with a display
Outlook contacts
If required, the subscriber can
import Outlook contacts on starting myPortal for Desktop when
using Microsoft Windows.
Personal directory
The subscriber can either import Outlook contacts on starting
myPortal for Desktop or maintain
personal contacts manually.
Imported Outlook contacts cannot be edited.
-
Internal Directory
Contains all internal subscribers, possibly with additional phone
numbers, provided the subscriber has made this information visible
to other internal subscribers. Internal subscribers (with system telephones) are displayed with their Presence status and can be contacted through Instant Messaging. The Presence status of a
subscriber can only be shown if allowed by that subscriber. If relevant, the scheduled time of return and any info text that may have
been entered by the subscriber are also displayed. A subscriber is
only provided read-access to this directory.
Contains all internal subscribers. The administrator can
enable and disable the display of
the internal directory for system
telephones.
External directory
Contains contacts from a corporate directory and must be configured by the administrator. A subscriber is only provided readaccess to this directory.
-
Public Exchange
Contains contacts of the public Exchange folder if configured by
folder (not usable with the administrator. These are shown in the external directory.
Office 365)
-
-
External Offline Direc- Contains contacts from the LDAP corporate directory and must be configured by the administrator.
tory (LDAP)
The external offline directory can only used for searches. The administrator can enable and disable
the display of the external offline directory for system telephones.
System Directory
-
Includes all internal stations and
all central speed-dial numbers.
The administrator can enable
and disable the display of a subscriber in the system directory.
INFO: Phone numbers in directories should always be entered in
canonical format.
Simple Search
As a subscriber, you can search the directories by First Name, Last Name or a
call number. The directories are searched in the order shown in the table above.
The search can be conducted using whole words and also with partial search
terms such as a part of a station number, for example. The set search options
remain in effect for subsequent searches. Al search terms used are saved. You
can optionally delete the list of search terms used.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
437
Unified Communications
Directories and Journal
Advanced Search
You can selectively search in the Title, First Name, Last Name, Company,
Extension, Company Ph., Business Ph. 1, Business Ph. 2, Home Ph. 1,
Home Ph. 2, Mobile Number and E-mail fields and limit the maximum number
of hits. The modern interface of myPortal for Desktop does not support the
advanced search.
Sorting
The contacts of a myPortal for Desktop and myPortal for Outlook directory can be
sorted by any column in ascending or descending alphanumeric order. The
modern interface of myPortal for Desktop does not support sorting.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• System Directory
•
Internal Directory
•
External directory
•
External Offline Directory (LDAP)
•
OpenScape Office Directory Service
12.3.1.1 How to Configure Directories for System Telephones
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
You can select which directories are to be made available on system telephones
with displays.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) Click Telephony Server > Basic Settings in the navigation tree.
3) In the menu tree, click on System > Display.
4) Select one of the following options in the Directory (phone book) drop-down
list:
•
If both the internal directory and the external offline directory are to be
made available, select All.
•
If only the internal directory is to be made available, select Internal.
•
If only the external directory is to be made available, select LDAP.
•
If no directory is to be made available, select No.
5) Click Apply.
438
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Directories and Journal
Next steps
If you have selected All or LDAP, make sure that an external offline directory
(LDAP) is available for the system telephones; see How to Add an External Offline
Directory (LDAP) for System Telephones .
Related Topics
Related Topics
• How to Add an External Offline Directory (LDAP) for System Telephones
12.3.1.2 How to Enable or Disable the Integrated Public Exchange Folder
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Applications > UC Suite.
3) Click Servers in the menu tree.
4) Click on the Exchange tab.
5) Select one of the following options:
•
If you want to activate the integration of the public Exchange folder, select
the Enable search in public Exchange folder check box.
•
If you want to deactivate the integration of the public Exchange folder,
clear the Enable search in public Exchange folder check box.
6) If you want to activate the integration of the public Exchange folder, select one
of the following options in the “Enable search for Exchange public folder”
area, depending on the version of Microsoft Exchange Server being used:
•
For Microsoft Exchange Server 2010:
Enter its Server URL (e.g., https://<server_name>/ews/
exchange.asmx).
•
For Microsoft Exchange Server or Microsoft Exchange Server 2003:
Enter its Server URL (e.g., https://<server_name>/public).
INFO: If the integration with the <server-name> specified in the
Server URL does not work, enter the ...<IP address>
instead.
7) If you want to activate the integration of the public Exchange folder, enter the
User Name for accessing the public Exchange folder in the “Enable
Exchange calendar integration” area.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
439
Unified Communications
Directories and Journal
8) If you want to deactivate the integration of the public Exchange folder, enter
the Password for accessing the public Exchange folder in the “Enable
Exchange calendar integration” area.
9) Click Save.
INFO: Information on the usage of Microsoft Exchange Server
can be found under: http://wiki.unify.com/wiki/
OpenScape_Office.
Related Topics
12.3.2 Internal Directory
The internal directory contains the contact details of the internal subscribers of the
communication system.
As a subscriber, you have read access to the contact details of other subscribers
and write access to your own contact details with myPortal for Desktop,
myPortal for Outlook and myAttendant. For your additional station numbers, you
can define whether or not these numbers should be made visible in the internal
directory. As an administrator, you have unrestricted access to all data in the
internal directory. As a subscriber, you can dial from the internal directory.
The administrator can disable the display for all analog stations or for analog
stations without an associated name. Subscribers whose names begin with - are
not displayed in the latter case.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Directories
•
System Directory
•
External directory
•
External Offline Directory (LDAP)
•
OpenScape Office Directory Service
12.3.2.1 How to Enable or Disable the Display of Analog Stations in the Internal Directory
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Applications > UC Suite.
3) Click Servers in the menu tree.
4) Click on the General Settings tab.
440
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Directories and Journal
5) In the Analog Extensions area, select one of the following options from the
Analog User Mode drop-down list.
•
If all the analog stations are to be displayed in the internal directory, select
Show all.
•
If only analog stations with a name are to be displayed in the internal
directory, select Show named only.
INFO: Analog stations with names beginning with ‘-’ are not
displayed in the latter case.
•
If no analog stations are to be displayed in the internal directory, select
Not shown.
6) Click Save.
Related Topics
12.3.3 External directory
The external directory includes contacts from outside the communication system.
The data of the external directory is available to all subscribers in myPortal for
Desktop, myPortal for Outlook, myPortal for Mobile, Fax Printer, myAttendant,
myAgent and on phones equipped with a display. Subscribers can dial from the
external directory. Users with myAttendant and myAgent can also edit data in the
external directory.
Importing Data from a CSV File
As an administrator, you can import contacts from a CSV file in UTF-8 encoding
into the external directory.
A header in the CSV file allows the mapping of field names in the CSV file to fields
in the system. A typical CSV file may be structured as follows:
•
Header line:
“Customer ID”,”Last Name”,”First Name”,”Company Phone
Number”,”Company Name”:
•
Data line:
“987654”,”Dubios”,”Natalie”,”+4989700798765”,”Unify”
You can map the data being imported from the CSV file to the following fields in
the system:
•
Customer ID
•
Title
•
First Name
•
Last Name
•
Company
•
Business Ph.
•
Business Ph2
•
Mobile Ph.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
441
Unified Communications
Directories and Journal
•
Home
•
XMPP ID
•
Fax Ph.
•
E-mail
•
City
If you want the import to overwrite data, the corresponding Customer IDs should
be identical.
A CSV template in UTF-8 format for importing data into the external directory can
be found under Service Center > Download Center > CSV Templates.
The associated description file provides information about the syntax to be used
and the procedure for saving the file in UTF-8 format.
Note: After processing the CSV template, the file must be in
saved in UTF-8 format in order to ensure the correct import of any
existing special characters.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Directories
•
System Directory
•
Internal Directory
•
External Offline Directory (LDAP)
•
OpenScape Office Directory Service
12.3.3.1 External Directory: How to Import a CSV File
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
•
A suitable CSV file in UTF-encoding with data for the external directory is
available.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) Click in the navigation tree on Wizards > UC Suite.
3) Click Edit to start the External Directory wizard.
4) Click in the Source File area on Browse and select the desired file.
5) Enter the number of header rows in the CSV file in the Header Rows field.
6) Enter the Delimiter used in the CSV file.
7) In the Duplicated Customer ID area, select how the system should respond
when trying to import data with existing customer IDs:
442
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Directories and Journal
•
If you want the data with existing customer IDs to be overwritten by the
data from the CSV file, select Update existing customer.
•
If you want to stop the import at some position, select Stop importing
current record.
8) Click Next.
9) Select the fields of the CSV file to be mapped to corresponding fields in the
system sequentially from the drop-down lists. If the appropriate fields do not
exist or if you do not want to import the data, click on No Mapping.
10) Click Next.
11) Click Import. Do not close this window while the data is still being imported.
On completing the import, the number of imported records is displayed.
Related Topics
12.3.3.2 External Directory: How to Add Access to an External Database
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
•
The required data for accessing the external database is available.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) Click in the navigation tree on Wizards > UC Suite.
3) Click Edit to start the External Directory wizard.
4) Click in the Source File area on Browse and select the desired file.
Related Topics
12.3.4 External Offline Directory (LDAP)
The external offline directory (LDAP) contains contacts from an LDAP server for
myPortal for Desktop, myAgent, Fax Printer, myPortal for Outlook and for system
telephones with displays.
The system supports LDAP Version 2 with authentication.
LDAP (Lightweight Directory Access Protocol) is a TCP/IP-based directory
access protocol for accessing network directory services. LDAP has a unique
format world-wide in which all names can be represented. It provides for different
layouts and enables unique associations between names and their internal representation. This data is defined by the administrator together with the IT administrator of the customer when planning and setting up a project. LDAP can be used
under the MS Windows and Linux operating systems.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
443
Unified Communications
Directories and Journal
In a Microsoft environment, the Active Directory Server (ADS) or the Exchange
Server also serves as the LDAP server. Under Microsoft Windows, user data can
be administered with the Active Directory (AD) application or ESTOS Metadir, for
example. The administration of this data is generally performed by the IT administrator of the customer.
Under Linux, the user data can be administered with OpenLDAP, for example.
Setting up an LDAP directory service can be simplified with an LDAP browser
(e.g., the freeware from Softerra).
Phone numbers on the LDAP server may only include “-” and blanks as delimiters.
Other delimiters cannot be filtered out by the system.
As an administrator, you can adapt the mapping of fields to the names of the used
LDAP server during the configuration of an external offline directory. Deleted
fields are ignored when searching for names via phone numbers. The search
always occurs with the last 4 positions of the phone number preceded by a
wildcard. You can deactivate the search for names via phone numbers for
incoming calls.
If the default port 389 is already being used, some other port must be configured
INFO: More detailed information can be found on the Internet
under: http://wiki.unify.com/wiki/
OpenScape_Office_Interaction_with_3rd_Party_App
lications.
The data of the external directory is available to subscribers in
myPortal for Desktop, myAttendant, Fax Printer and myPortal for Outlook during
the search.
System Telephones with Displays
As a subscriber, you can select between the internal directory and the LDAP
directory via the menu., provided these have been configured for system
telephones. The LDAP directory supports searches in the appropriate contacts
and the subsequent calling of a contact.
The name information provided by the LDAP server is not displayed in ringing or
call status. The call numbers for incoming calls are also not replaced by the name
information provided by the LDAP server (as when call numbers are replaced by
SSD names).
A system subscriber can only be reached from the LDAP directory if a DID
number was configured for him or her and if this entry corresponds to the entry in
the LDAP database. Call numbers provided by the LDAP server can only be
routed within the network if the internal call number and the DID number are
identical.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Directories
•
444
System Directory
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Directories and Journal
•
Internal Directory
•
External directory
•
OpenScape Office Directory Service
12.3.4.1 How to Add the External Offline Directory (LDAP) for UC PC Clients
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
•
You know the required access data for LDAP server.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Applications > UC Suite.
3) Click the External Providers Config tab.
4) Select one of the following options:
•
If you want to enable the resolution of phone numbers into names in the
journal for external incoming calls, select the Search by phone number
check box.
•
If you want to disable the resolution of phone numbers into names in the
journal for external incoming calls, clear the Search by phone number
check box.
5) Click Add.
6) Enter the access data of the LDAP server.
a) Enter a name for this external offline directory under Name.
b) Enter the name or the IP address of the LDAP server under Server.
c) Enter the port number of the LDAP server under Port.
d) Under LDAP Basic DN, enter the LDAP Base Distinguished Name, e.g.,
dc=example-for-a-domain, dc=net.
e) Enter the User Name.
f)
Enter the Password.
7) Enter the corresponding field designation of the LDAP server for the following
fields: Title, First Name, Last Name, Business Ph. 1, Business Ph. 2,
Home, Mobile, Company, Company Ph., Postal Address, State, province
or county, Country, Postal Code, E-mail, Pager, Fax Number, XMPP-ID
and City.
8) Click Save.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• How to Add an External Offline Directory (LDAP) for System Telephones
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
445
Unified Communications
Directories and Journal
12.3.4.2 How to Delete the External Offline Directory (LDAP) for UC PC Clients
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Applications > UC Suite.
3) Click the External Providers Config tab.
4) Click on the external offline directory to be deleted.
5) Click Remove.
Related Topics
12.3.4.3 How to Add an External Offline Directory (LDAP) for System Telephones
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
•
You know the required access data for LDAP server.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) Click Telephony Server > Basic Settings in the navigation tree.
3) In the menu tree, click on System > LDAP.
4) Enter the IP address of the LDAP server.
5) Enter the Port number for LDAP access.
6) Enter the User Name.
7) Enter the Password.
8) Enter the password again in the Confirm password field.
9) Under Basic DN, enter the LDAP Base Distinguished Name of the LDAP
server, e.g., dc=example-for-a-domain, dc=net.
10) Under Search query, enter the search string for the LDAP server, e.g.:
cn=$*.
11) Enter the Result attribute, Name for the LDAP server, e.g.: cn.
12) Enter the Result attribute, Station number for the LDAP server, e.g.:
telephoneNumber.
13) Select one of the following options for sorting the search results:
•
446
If you want to have the search results sorted, select the Sort search
results check box.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Directories and Journal
•
If you do not want to have the search results sorted, clear the Sort search
results check box.
14) Enter the LDAP seizure code.
15) Enter the LDAP station number prefix.
16) Click Apply.
Next steps
How to Configure Directories for System Telephones
Related Topics
Related Topics
• How to Configure Directories for System Telephones
•
How to Add the External Offline Directory (LDAP) for UC PC Clients
12.3.5 System Directory
The system directory contains all internal stations and every central speed-dial
number for which a name was assigned. System telephones with a display can
access the system directory.
The administrator individually disable the display for every subscriber and every
speed-dial number with a name.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Directories
•
Internal Directory
•
External directory
•
External Offline Directory (LDAP)
•
OpenScape Office Directory Service
12.3.5.1 How to Activate or Deactivate the Display of a Subscriber in the System
Directory
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony > Stations.
3) Navigate in the menu tree under Stations > Station > … down to the desired
station (Index - Station Number - Name).
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
447
Unified Communications
Directories and Journal
4) Click the Edit Station Flags tab.
5) Select one of the following options:
•
If you want the name of the subscriber to be displayed in the system
directory of the system telephones, enable the check box Entry in
telephone directory.
•
If you do not want the name of the subscriber to be displayed in the
system directory of the system telephones, clear the Entry in telephone
directory check box.
6) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
12.3.6 Departments
Departments classify subscribers in the internal directory into groups based on
their organizational affiliation. The internal directory allows you to search and sort
by department.
Related Topics
12.3.6.1 How to Add a Department
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) Click in the navigation tree on Wizards > UC Suite.
3) Click on Edit to start the Departments wizard.
4) Click Add.
5) Enter the Name of the Department.
6) Enter the Group number.
7) Click Save.
Related Topics
12.3.6.2 How to Assign Stations to a Department
Prerequisites
•
448
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Directories and Journal
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Applications > UC Suite.
3) Click User Directory.
4) Select the relevant station.
5) Click Edit.
6) Select the desired department from the list box in the Dept field.
7) Then click Save.
Related Topics
12.3.6.3 How to Edit a Department
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) Click in the navigation tree on Wizards > UC Suite.
3) Click on Edit to start the Departments wizard.
4) Click in the list of departments on the appropriate department.
5) Click Edit.
6) Enter the Name of the Department.
7) Enter the Group number.
8) Click Save.
Related Topics
12.3.6.4 How to Remove a Department
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) Click in the navigation tree on Wizards > UC Suite.
3) Click on Edit to start the Departments wizard.
4) Click in the list of departments on the appropriate department.
5) Click Remove.
6) Click OK.
Related Topics
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
449
Unified Communications
Directories and Journal
12.3.7 OpenScape Office Directory Service
OpenScape Office Directory Service is an open, integrated metadirectory service
that can be accessed by several different types of clients, applications and
communication devices in a company. The OpenScape Office Directory Service
performs two functions: it enables additional contact data from external
databases to be integrated in the directories of the system, while also making the
directories available to clients, communication devices and applications.
OpenScape Office Directory Service runs as a separate service based on
OpenLDAP. Firewalls must be open for port 389. OpenScape Office Directory
Service is disabled by default.
Internal Data Sources
The following data sources are available by default in the OpenScape Office
Directory Service:
•
•
OpenScape Office: This includes
–
internal directory
–
External directory
central speed-dial numbers
For these data sources, the field names are permanently mapped to the data
schema of the OpenScape Office Directory Service.
These data sources cannot be deleted or modified.
External Data Sources
As an administrator, you can integrate contact information from the following
types of databases as data sources for read-only access via ODBC.
•
Microsoft SQL Server
•
mySQL
•
PostgreSQL
•
Sybase SQL Server
Maximum number of different types of databases: 4
Maximum number of external data sources: 10
Make sure that the OpenScape Office Directory Service is authorized to access
the external database. Contact the responsible database administrator in
advance to ensure that this is the case. A separate user may need to be added in
the external database for access by the system.
External data sources can be used in the context of both directory searches and
the resolution of call numbers into names.
You can configure direct access to a database table from an external data source
or a custom SQL query for the data source.
Custom SQL Queries for External Data Sources
Custom SQL queries also support related tables, e.g.:
450
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Directories and Journal
SELECT * FROM users LEFT OUTER JOIN phonenumbers ON users.id
= phonenumbers.uid;
The data structure must be of the type 1:1 or n:1, i.e., each record can have only
a single row.
Access via custom SQL queries can sometimes run much slower than direct
access to a database table.
Custom SQL queries with potential security risks are not executed, for example:
•
Modifying data
•
Stopping the SQL server
•
Running programs via the SQL server
•
Changing user rights
Custom SQL queries with the following SQL commands are therefore not
executed:
•
CHECKPOINT
•
CLOSE
•
CLUSTER
•
COMMIT
•
COPY
•
CREATE
•
DEALLOCTAE
•
DECLARE
•
DELETE
•
DISCARD
•
DO
•
DROP
•
END
•
EXECUTE
•
EXPLAIN
•
FETCH
•
GRANT
•
INSERT
•
LOAD
•
LOCK
•
MOVE
•
PREPARE
•
REASSIGN OWNED
•
REINDEX
•
RELEASE SAVEPOINT
•
RESET
•
REVOKE
•
SAVEPOINT
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
451
Unified Communications
Directories and Journal
•
SECURITY LABEL
•
SELECT INTO
•
SET
•
SHOW
•
START TRANSACTION
•
TRUNCATE
•
UNLISTEN
•
UPDATE
•
VACUUM
•
VALUES
Field Mapping for Data Sources
For these data sources, you can customize the mapping of field names to the data
schema of the OpenScape Office Directory Service. You can assign each field in
the data schema of the OpenScape Office Directory Service to no more than one
field of the external data source. However, you can assign a field of the external
data source to multiple fields in the data schema of the OpenScape Office
Directory Service.
LDAP Data Output Mappings
An LDAP data output mapping determines which of the fields in the data schema
of the OpenScape Office Directory Service are to be output via LDAP, e.g., for
specific LDAP clients or for different groups of subscribers who do not want to see
all the details, but only a defined subset.
The LDAP data output mapping web is available by default and cannot be deleted
or changed. All fields of the data schema in the OpenScape Office Directory
Service are permanently assigned to the LDAP output in it. You can also
configure other LDAP data output mappings.
LDAP clients can access a specific LDAP data output mapping via the dc
parameter in the LDAP login, for example: dc=web.
Normalization of Phone Numbers in the Canonical Format
For each data source, you can configure the normalization of phone numbers in
the canonical format. During this process, blanks, parentheses, hyphens and
commas are removed. This is required to correctly identify the caller’s name and
for desktop dialing. You should not skip the normalization, unless the phone
numbers used in the data source are already present in canonical format. You can
have the normalization-related values such as the area code, etc., entered
automatically from the system. If the external database is located at a different
site than the system, you may need to adjust these values.
Status of Data Sources
The status display under OpenDirectory > Data Sources has the following
significance:
452
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Directories and Journal
Color
Status
green
active
red
ODBC and LDAP is not OK, wrong configuration or data source unavailable
yellow
LDAP not ok: restart the OpenScape Office
Directory Service
gray
Configuration incomplete
Provision of directories
The following types of clients, communication devices and applications can use
the directories provided by the OpenScape Office Directory Service: UC
•
Clients
•
System Directory
•
OpenStage with local LDAP support
•
DECT IP phones (via LDAP)
•
SIP phones (via LDAP)
•
Applications, e.g., CRM Suites such as Microsoft Dynamics CRM (via LDAP,
ODBC or OpenLDAP CSV export)
OpenScape Office Directory Service can identify in the search results from which
data source a hit is obtained.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Directories
•
System Directory
•
Internal Directory
•
External directory
•
External Offline Directory (LDAP)
12.3.7.1 How to Enable or Disable the OpenScape Office Directory Service
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Applications > Open Directory Service.
3) Click on Open Directory > Basic Settings in the menu tree.
4) Select one of the following options:
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
453
Unified Communications
Directories and Journal
•
If you want to enable the OpenScape Office Directory Service, select the
check box Active.
•
If you want to disable the OpenScape Office Directory Service, clear the
check box Active.
5) Click Save.
6) Click OK.
7) Click OK.
Related Topics
12.3.7.2 How to Restart the OpenScape Office Directory Service
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
•
OpenScape Office Directory Service is enabled.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Applications > Open Directory Service.
3) Click on Open Directory > Maintenance in the menu tree.
4) Click Restart.
5) Click OK.
Related Topics
12.3.7.3 How to Configure the LDAP Password for Access to the OpenScape Office
Directory Service
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Follow these steps to set the password with which clients, communication devices
and applications can access the OpenScape Office Directory Service using
LDAP.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Applications > Open Directory Service.
3) Click on Open Directory > Basic Settings in the menu tree.
4) Enter the desired Password.
5) Click Save.
6) Click OK.
Related Topics
454
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Directories and Journal
12.3.7.4 How to Add an External Data Source for the OpenScape Office Directory Service
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
•
The access data of the external database is available.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Applications > Open Directory Service.
3) Click on Open Directory > Data Sources in the menu tree.
4) Click Add.
5) Click on the Database tab.
6) Enter the Name of the data source.
7) Enter a Description for the data source.
8) In the ODBC driver drop-down list, select the desired type.
9) Enter the PV4 address of the database under Database Server Address.
10) Specify the Database Server Port.
11) Enter the Database Name in the correct case.
12) If you selected the type Microsoft SQL Server in the ODBC driver dropdown list, enter the TDS protocol version in the TDS Protocol Version field.
13) Enter the Database login in the correct case.
14) Enter the Database password in the correct case.
15) Click on Check database access to test the access.
16) Click OK.
17) Click on the Data access tab.
18) Select one of the following options:
•
If you want to use a database table, click on Simple selection - access
one table.
•
If you want to use a custom SQL query, click on Self-defined SQL query.
19) Select one of the following options:
•
If you want to use a database table, click on Query database tables and
select the desired table in the Database tables list.
•
If you want to use a custom SQL query, enter it in the Define SQL query
field.
20) If you want to display a preview to check the data, choose one of the following
options:
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
455
Unified Communications
Directories and Journal
•
If you are using a database table, click on Preview database table and
navigate through the records in the preview with the aid of the appropriate
buttons.
•
If you are using a custom SQL query, click on Preview query results and
navigate through the records in the preview with the aid of the appropriate
buttons.
21) Click on the Field mappings tab.
INFO: All columns of the selected table and all columns returned
by the custom SQL queries are available for field mappings.
22) Click on Add Field Mapping.
23) Select the field of each external data source in the drop-down list on the left
and then select the corresponding field to be mapped in the data schema of
the OpenScape Office Directory Service via the drop-down list on the right in
the same row. For verification purposes, a preview of the relevant records
appears on the right, which you can navigate by using the appropriate
buttons.
24) If you want to remove a row of field assignments, click on the Trash icon on
the left.
25) Click on the Number conversion tab.
26) Select the Active check box.
27) Click on Query System Settings.
28) If the external database is located at a different site than the system:
a) Enter the Country Code.
b) Enter the Local Area Code.
c) Enter the Central Office Number.
d) Enter the National Prefix.
e) Enter the National Prefix.
f)
Enter the Maximum internal number length.
29) Select one of the following options:
•
If you want to remove any dial-out prefix (CO code) that may be present
in the external data source, select the Remove dialout prefix check box.
•
If you do not want to remove the dial-out prefix, clear the Remove dialout
prefix check box.
30) Click Save.
31) Click OK.
456
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Directories and Journal
Next steps
Restart the OpenScape Office Directory Service for the change to take effect.
Preview the LDAP search result.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• How to Preview LDAP Search Results for the OpenScape Office Directory
Service
•
How to Enable or Disable an External Data Source for the OpenScape Office
Directory Service
•
How to Delete an External Data Source for the OpenScape Office Directory
Service
12.3.7.5 How to Preview LDAP Search Results for the OpenScape Office Directory
Service
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Follow these steps to check whether an LDAP search result of the OpenScape
Office Directory Service returns records in the desired form and with the correct
number format.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Applications > Open Directory Service.
3) Click in the menu tree under Open Directory > Data Sources on the desired
data source.
4) Click on the LDAP test tab.
5) Click Run test. The preview of the search result will appear under LDAP
Search Result.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• How to Add an External Data Source for the OpenScape Office Directory
Service
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
457
Unified Communications
Directories and Journal
12.3.7.6 How to Enable or Disable an External Data Source for the OpenScape Office
Directory Service
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Applications > Open Directory Service.
3) Click on Open Directory > Data Sources in the menu tree.
4) Select one of the following options in the row of the relevant data source in
the workspace:
•
If you want to enable the data source, select the check box in the Active
column.
•
If you want to disable the data source, clear the check box in the Active
column.
5) Click OK.
Next steps
Restart the OpenScape Office Directory Service for the change to take effect.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• How to Add an External Data Source for the OpenScape Office Directory
Service
•
How to Delete an External Data Source for the OpenScape Office Directory
Service
12.3.7.7 How to Delete an External Data Source for the OpenScape Office Directory
Service
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Applications > Open Directory Service.
3) Click on Open Directory > Data Sources in the menu tree.
4) Click on the relevant data source in the workspace.
458
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Directories and Journal
5) Click Delete.
6) Click OK.
Next steps
Restart the OpenScape Office Directory Service for the change to take effect.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• How to Add an External Data Source for the OpenScape Office Directory
Service
•
How to Enable or Disable an External Data Source for the OpenScape Office
Directory Service
12.3.7.8 How to Add the Data Output Mappings for the OpenScape Office Directory
Service
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Applications > Open Directory Service.
3) Click on Open Directory > Data output mappings in the menu tree.
4) Click Add.
5) Enter the Name of the LDAP data output mapping.
6) Select the respective field of OpenScape Office Directory Service in the dropdown list on the left and then select the desired assigned field in the dropdown list on the right in the same row. For verification purposes, a preview of
the relevant records appears on the right, which you can navigate by using
the appropriate buttons.
7) If you want to remove a row of field assignments, click on the Trash icon on
the left.
8) Click New data output mapping.
9) Click Save.
10) Click OK.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• How to Enable or Disable the Data Output Mappings for the OpenScape
Office Directory Service
•
How to Delete the Data Output Mappings for the OpenScape Office Directory
Service
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
459
Unified Communications
Directories and Journal
12.3.7.9 How to Enable or Disable the Data Output Mappings for the OpenScape Office
Directory Service
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Applications > Open Directory Service.
3) Click on Open Directory > Data output mappings in the menu tree.
4) Select one of the following options in the row of the relevant LDAP data output
mappings in the workspace:
•
If you want to enable the LDAP data output mappings, select the check
box in the Active column.
•
If you want to disable the LDAP data output mappings, clear the check
box in the Active column.
5) Click OK.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• How to Add the Data Output Mappings for the OpenScape Office Directory
Service
•
How to Delete the Data Output Mappings for the OpenScape Office Directory
Service
12.3.7.10 How to Delete the Data Output Mappings for the OpenScape Office Directory
Service
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Applications > Open Directory Service.
3) Click on Open Directory > Data output mappings in the menu tree.
4) Click on the relevant data output mapping in the workspace.
5) Click Delete.
6) Click OK.
460
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Directories and Journal
Related Topics
Related Topics
• How to Add the Data Output Mappings for the OpenScape Office Directory
Service
•
How to Enable or Disable the Data Output Mappings for the OpenScape
Office Directory Service
12.3.8 Favorites List
The Favorites list provides you (as a subscriber) with a constant view of selected
contacts. These contacts can also be called very easily directly from the Favorites
list. All internal subscribers with system telephones and external XMPP communication partners are shown together with their Presence status and can be
contacted via instant messaging.
As a subscriber, you can add contacts from all directories to the Favorites list. For
favorites that do not come from the internal directory, instead of the symbol for the
Presence status, the symbol for the source of the contact is displayed.
The Favorites list manages contacts in groups. The contacts in all groups can be
sorted by First Name, Last Name or their original sorting order.
When an internal subscriber is absent, you can determine the scheduled time of
his or her return by positioning the mouse pointer over the entry for that
subscriber, provided the subscriber has allowed his or her Presence status to be
visible to you.
For favorites with multiple phone numbers, you can specify a default number with
which the contact is to be called. The default phone number of a favorite can be
determined in the context menu from the symbol with the activated check box.
Related Topics
12.3.9 Journal
The journal is the list of all incoming and outgoing calls of a subscriber. It enables
subscribers to quickly and easily respond to missed calls and call back their
contacts or call them again directly from within the journal.
Folder for Call Types
The calls are arranged in the following groups:
•
Open
Contains the unanswered missed calls for which a call number was transmitted. As soon as one of these calls is answered, all associated entries with
that call number are dropped from the list.
•
All calls
•
Missed
•
Answered
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
461
Unified Communications
Directories and Journal
•
Internal
•
External
•
Inbound
•
Outbound
•
Scheduled
Contains all the calls that you (as a subscriber) have scheduled for specific
dates/times. The Scheduled Calls feature is not available to Contact Center
agents. In order for the communication system to execute a scheduled call,
myPortal for Desktop or myPortal for Outlook must be open at the scheduled
time; your presence status must be Office or CallMe, and you must confirm
the execution of the call in a dialog. If you are busy at the time the scheduled
call is to be made, the system defers the scheduled call until you are free
again. myPortal for Desktop or myPortal for Outlook informs you of any
pending scheduled calls on exiting the program. On starting the application,
myPortal for Desktop or myPortal for Outlook notifies you about any
scheduled calls for which the scheduled time has elapsed. You can then
either delete such calls or save them with a new scheduled time.
Not all folders for call types are available in the modern user interface myPortal
for Desktop.
Retention Period
The system saves a record of the calls in the Journal for a maximum period of
time, which can be configured by the administrator. As a subscriber, you can
reduce this time. After the retention period expires, the system automatically
deletes all associated entries.
INFO: The retention period also determines the maximum time
period for evaluations with myReports.
Grouped by time period
The calls in each group are arranged by time: Today, Yesterday, etc., Last Week,
Last Month and Older. Your administrator can set the duration for which calls
should be saved in the Journal. After this set time period expires, the entries are
automatically deleted. The grouping by time period is not available in the modern
user interface of myPortal for Desktop.
Call Details
Every call is shown with the Date and Time and, if available, with the call number.
If a directory contains further details on the call number such as the Last Name,
First Name and Company, then this information is also shown. In addition, the
Direction, Duration and Call Complete columns are also displayed in most
folders. Not all call details are available in the modern user interface of myPortal
for desktop.
Sorting
You can sort the calls in the Journal by any column in ascending or descending
alphanumeric order.
462
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Calls
You can jump within the Journal to the first call whose entry begins with a specific
character in the sorted column, e.g., to the first Last Name beginning with “P”. By
entering subsequent characters, you can then narrow the search. Sorting is not
available in the modern user interface of myPortal for Desktop.
Export
As a subscriber, you can export the journal as a CSV file using
myPortal for Desktop or myPortal for Outlook:
Related Topics
12.3.9.1 How to Change the Maximum Retention Period for the Journal
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Applications > UC Suite.
3) Click Server.
4) Click on the Maintenance tab.
5) Enter the desired duration in days in the Keep call history for field.
INFO: The retention period also determines the maximum time
period for evaluations with myReports.
6) Click Save.
Related Topics
12.4 Calls
For calls, convenient features such as a desktop dialer, screen pops and the
option to record calls and conferences (LX/MX) are available to subscribers.
Related Topics
12.4.1 Call Number Formats
Call numbers can be specified in different formats.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
463
Unified Communications
Calls
Format
Description
Example
Canonical
Begins with + and always
+49 (89) 7007-98765
includes the country code, area
code and the full remaining station number. Blanks and the
special characters + ( ) / - : ; are
allowed.
Dialable
Exactly as you would dial the call • 321 (internal)
number on the phone, always
• 0700798765 (own local network)
with the trunk access code.
• 0089700798765 (external local
network)
• 0004989700798765 (international)
INFO: If possible, you should always use the canonical call
number format. This ensures that a phone number is always
complete, unique and consistent in any situation, even in a
network.
When dialing an external station (dialable format) manually, the CO access code
must always be dialed as well. The CO access code must likewise also be
specified when manually entering the destination number for the CallMe service
in myPortal for Desktop and myPortal for Outlook.
When dialing an external phone number in dialable format from a directory and
when using the Desktop Dialer and Clipboard Dialer, the communication system
automatically adds the CO access code (route 1). The automatic addition of the
CO access code also occurs when you select a phone number of your own
personal data (Mobile number, Private Number, External Number 1, External
Number 2, etc.) as a destination number for the CallMe service.
INFO: For calls within the USA via CSTA to a number in
canonical format, phone numbers are converted to the dialable
format.
Related Topics
12.4.2 Desktop Dialer and Clipboard Dialer
The Desktop Dialer and Clipboard Dialer enable users with myPortal for Desktop
(Windows) or myPortal for Outlook to call a selected destination or a destination
copied to the Windows clipboard via a key combination from many Windows
applications, e.g., from an Outlook e-mail.
Depending on the type of string used, the Dialer works as follows:
464
•
A phone number in dialable or canonical format is dialed directly.
•
A station number in dialable format is dialed directly if the communication
system can decide whether an internal or external destination is involved.
Otherwise, the user is asked to make the appropriate selection.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Calls
•
A string containing letters is searched in the directories as a first name or
company.
Windows applications that were implemented with standard Windows-compliant
components usually support the Desktop Dialer and Clipboard Dialer, but 16-bit
applications do not.
Related Topics
12.4.3 Screen pops
Screen pops in myPortal for Desktop and myPortal for Outlook offer you convenient ways to respond to incoming calls or new voicemails with a single mouse
click, for example.
Some buttons in the screen pops change, depending on the situation.
Screen pops for calls show the caller’s phone number and name (if the name
details are available in a directory). The directories are searched in a specific
order: The first hit, if found, appears in the screen pop.
As a subscriber, you can activate or deactivate the following screen pops (also
called pop-up windows or tray pops):
Screen pops
myPortal for Deskt
op
myPortal for Outlo
ok
Inbound call
x
x
Outbound call
x
-
New voicemail
x
x
New fax message
x
x
Change of own Presence status
x
-
Open personal contact on incoming call
x
Opening Outlook Contacts for Incoming Calls
x
Related Topics
12.4.4 Record calls
A subscriber can record calls. Recorded calls appear in the voicemail box.
INFO: Note that in most countries you are legally required to
notify the other party that you are recording the call. In some
countries (such as France, for example), the other party is
automatically notified by the system.
As an administrator, you can allow or prevent the recording of calls and conferences (LX/MX) on a system-wide basis. In addition, you can optionally configure
the playback of an announcement or warning tone at the start of the recording.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
465
Unified Communications
Calls
As a subscriber, you can control the recording of calls via myPortal for Desktop or
myPortal for Outlook. Recorded calls are identified in the voicemail box with a red
dot and show the call number of the other party if available.
Ongoing recordings are automatically stopped by a consultation hold, placing a
call on hold, transfers and the initiation of a conference.
Related Topics
12.4.4.1 How to Activate or Deactivate the Recording of Calls
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Applications > UC Suite.
3) Click Server.
4) Click on the General Settings tab.
5) Select one of the following options:
•
If you want to allow the recording of calls and conferences (LX/MX), select
the Record Call check box.
•
If you want to prevent the recording of calls and conferences, clear the
Record Call check box.
6) Click Save.
Related Topics
12.4.4.2 How to Activate or Deactivate the Recording Announcement
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Applications > UC Suite.
3) Click Server.
4) Click on the General Settings tab.
5) Select one of the following options:
466
•
If you want to play an announcement at the start of a recording, select the
Play prompt before recording check box.
•
If you do not want to play an announcement at the start of a recording,
clear the Play prompt before recording check box.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Conferences
6) Click Save.
Related Topics
12.4.4.3 How to Activate or Deactivate the Warning Tone for Recording
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Applications > UC Suite.
3) Click Server.
4) Click on the General Settings tab.
5) Select one of the following options:
•
If you want to play a warning tone at the start of a recording, select the
Play pip tone before recording check box.
•
If you do not want to play a warning tone at the start of a recording, clear
the Play pip tone before recording check box.
6) Click Save.
Related Topics
12.5 Conferences
In a conference, multiple participants (including external parties) can communicate with one another at the same time.
Related Topics
12.5.1 Conference Management (LX/MX)
Conference management enables subscribers to use different types of conferences.
Types of Conferences
The different types of conferences offer the following features:
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
467
Unified Communications
Conferences
Ad-hoc
Usage
• Phone-controlled
• Applicationcontrolled
Scheduled
Permanent
Open
• Applicationcontrolled
• Applicationcontrolled
• Applicationcontrolled
Start
• Manually
• Scheduled
• Manually
• Manually
End
• Manually
• Scheduled
• Manually
• Manually
• Manually
Duration of the reserva- • 1 hour by default
tion of conference
channels
• Scheduled
• Until the deactivation or deletion of
the conference
• Until the deactivation or deletion of
the conference
Extension
x
x
-
-
Recurrence
• Manually
• Scheduled
-
-
Direction of connection
setup from the viewpoint of
OpenScape Office
• Outbound
• Outbound
• Inbound
• Inbound
Set of participants
• Fixed
• Fixed
• Fixed
• Open
Authentication of conference participants
-
• Individual
conference ID
(optional)
• Individual
conference ID
(optional)
• Shared conference
ID (optional)
• Inbound
• Password (optional) • Password (optional)
Recording, if enabled in • Manually (On
OpenScape Office
Demand
Conference
Recording)
• Automatically (Auto
Conference
Recording)
• Automatically (Auto
Conference
Recording)
• Automatically (Auto
Conference
Recording)
• Manually (On
Demand
Conference
Recording)
• Manually (On
Demand
Conference
Recording)
• Manually (On
Demand
Conference
Recording)
Invitation by E-mail
with:
• Conference Name
• Conference Name
• Conference Name
• Dial-in number
• Dial-in number
• Conference ID
• Conference ID
• Password
• Password
• Password
• Date and time of the
start and end of the
conference
• Link for Web Collaboration session
• Conference Name
• Link for Web Collab- • Dial-in number
oration session
• Conference ID
• Link for Web Collaboration session
Outlook appointment as an e-mail attachment
(.ics)
x
-
-
Application-controlled conference
As a subscriber, you can initiate, control and manage a conference with the
Conference Management feature of myPortal for Desktop or
myPortal for Outlook.
468
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Conferences
Phone-controlled Conference
As a subscriber, you can initiate a phone-controlled conference and then control
it via the phone by the following methods:
•
Call the desired conference participant and connect him or her to the
conference
•
Extend a consultation call into a conference
•
Extend a second call into a conference
Virtual conference room
The virtual conference room enables you to follow a conference and its participants in a graphical environment (for application-controlled conferences) and to
also manage the conference if you are the conference controller. The virtual
conference room shows the phone number, name and presence status to the
conference participants, where available.
Dial-in number
As an administrator, you can change the conference dial-in numbers that were set
up during basic installation. As a subscriber, you can display the dial-in number
for a conference.
Conference Controller
The initiator of the conference is automatically the conference controller until this
is explicitly changed. Depending on the type of conference, the controller can:
•
Add or remove conference participants (for application-controlled conferences):
Removed participants do not remain in the conference.
•
Disconnect or reconnect conference participants:
Disconnected participants remain in the conference. When the conference
controller is connecting a conference participant, all other conference participants remain connected to one another. If there is only one participant
connected, that participant will hear music on hold.
•
Record a conference
Recorded conferences are identified in the voicemail box with a red dot and
show the call number of the first conference participant, if available. Conferences in which a participant is on hold cannot be recorded.
•
Set another internal participant on the same node as the conference
controller
•
Extend the conference
•
Leave the conference without ending it:
The longest attending internal participant of the conference automatically
becomes the conference controller.
•
End the conference
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
469
Unified Communications
Conferences
Conference Participants
Conference participants can leave the conference and optionally dial-into it again
(scheduled and permanent conferences). As long as a conference has only one
participant, the participant hears music on hold. As an administrator, you can
specify whether multiple external conference participants are allowed. The
maximum number of external conference participants is determined, among other
things, by the number of available trunks.
Conference Tone
When connecting or disconnecting a conference participant, the other participants hear the conference tone. As an administrator, you can activate or
deactivate the conference tone.
Automatic Termination without a Conference Controller
If there are only external subscribers left in a conference, the participants will hear
an alert tone after a specified time period. Following a further timeout, the
conference is automatically terminated by OpenScape Office. As an administrator, you can edit these time values.
Notification by E-mail and Outlook Appointment
OpenScape Office can automatically notify conference participants by e-mail and,
for scheduled conferences, additionally through an Outlook appointment as an
attachment (.ics).
Event
New conference
Notified conference participants
All
Outlook appointment
Automatic creation
Delete the conference
Automatic deletion
Reschedule the conference
Automatic update
Adding conference participants
Remove conference participants
Those affected
Automatic creation (those
affected)
Automatic deletion (those
affected)
This requires the administrator to have configured the sending of e-mails. In
addition, an internal conference participant must have specified his or her e-mail
address. For external conference participants, the initiator of the conference must
enter their individual e-mail addresses.
INFO: For e-mail notifications, no return acknowledgments are
obtained for failed deliveries or absence messages, since the emails are sent directly from OpenScape Office due to the
integration of Web Collaboration.
470
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Conferences
Further Calls
While participating in a conference, making a call or accepting another call
disconnects the participant from the conference.
Park, Toggle/Connect
The Park and Toggle/Connect features are not available in a conference.
Call Charges
Toll charges are assigned to the party who set up the toll call. When a conference
is transferred to another conference controller, all further charges are assigned to
that controller.
System Load
As an administrator, you can display both active and saved conferences.
INFO: Permanent conferences occupy system resources permanently. Since every subscriber can configure permanent conferences with myPortal for Desktop or myPortal for Outlook, you
should, as the administrator, review the saved conferences
regularly to avoid resource bottlenecks.
Video Monitoring
Any ongoing video transmission, e.g., with OpenScape Personal Edition, must be
terminated before participating in a conference.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Ad-hoc conference (LX/MX)
•
Scheduled Conference (LX/MX)
•
Permanent Conference (LX/MX)
•
Open Conference (LX/MX)
•
Web Collaboration Integration
•
Configuration Limits and Capacities
12.5.1.1 How to Change the Dial-in Number for a Virtual Conference Room
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click Telephony Server > Stations.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
471
Unified Communications
Conferences
3) Navigate in the menu tree to Stations > Application Suite > Conference.
The call numbers of the virtual conference room is displayed in the work area.
The last of these is the one for scheduled and permanent conferences.
4) In the menu tree, click on the relevant entry (Index - Call number).
5) Click the Edit Station Parameters tab.
6) Enter the new dial-in number in the Phone Number field. The dial-in number
may only include the digits 0-9.
7) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
12.5.1.2 How to Allow or Prevent Multiple External Conference Participants
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) Click Telephony > Basic Settings in the navigation tree.
3) Navigate in the menu tree to System > System Flags.
4) Select one of the following options:
•
If you want to allow multiple external conference participants, enable the
check box More than 1 external conference member.
•
If you want to prevent multiple external conference participants, clear the
check box More than 1 external conference member.
5) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
12.5.1.3 How to Activate and Deactivate the Conference Tone
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) Click Telephony > Basic Settings in the navigation tree.
3) Navigate in the menu tree to System > System Flags.
4) Select one of the following options:
•
472
If you want to activate the conference tone, enable the Conference tone
check box.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Conferences
•
If you want to deactivate the conference tone, clear the Conference tone
check box.
5) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
12.5.1.4 How to Change the Time Interval for the Automatic Termination of a Conference
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) Click Telephony > Basic Settings in the navigation tree.
3) Navigate in the menu tree to System > Time Parameters.
4) In the Time until warning tone in main station interface transit connections row, under Base and Factor, select the desired time period between
the time the last conference controller leaves the conference and the alert
tone.
5) In the Time from warning tone until release... row, select the desired time
from the alert tone till the automatic termination of the conference.
6) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
12.5.1.5 How to Display the Details of a Conference
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) Click in the navigation tree on Wizards > UC Suite.
3) Click Edit to start the Conferencing wizard.
4) Click on the relevant user conference.
5) Click Display.
Related Topics
12.5.1.6 How to Enable or Disable the Recording of Conferences (LX/MX)
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
473
Unified Communications
Conferences
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Applications > UC Suite.
3) Click Server.
4) Click on the General Settings tab.
5) Select one of the following options:
•
If you want to allow the recording of calls and conferences, select the
Record Call check box.
•
If you want to prevent the recording of calls and conferences, clear the
Record Call check box.
6) Select one of the following options:
•
If you want to enable the playback of an appropriate announcement
before the recording of calls and conferences, select the check box Play
prompt before recording.
•
If you want to disable the playback of an appropriate announcement
before the recording of calls and conferences, clear the check box Play
prompt before recording.
7) Select one of the following options:
•
If you want to enable the playback of an alert tone during the recording of
calls and conferences, select the check box Play pip tone during
recording.
•
If you want to disable the playback of an alert tone during the recording of
calls and conferences, clear the check box Play pip tone during
recording.
8) Click Save.
Related Topics
12.5.2 Ad-hoc conference (LX/MX)
An ad-hoc conference occurs spontaneously and is started manually by the
conference controller. The conference controller can save ad-hoc conferences in
order to set them up again at some later point in time.
Starting the Conference
The system opens the window with the virtual conference room automatically for
all internal conference participants, provided they have started
myPortal for Desktop with the classic user interface or myPortal for Outlook. The
system calls all conference participants simultaneously. On joining the
conference, each conference participant hears a greeting announcement with the
name of the conference controller.
474
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Conferences
Recording the Conference
Conference controllers can record a conference manually for themselves or for all
connected internal conference participants, provided the live recording of calls
has been activated in the system. Participants located in the own node receive
the recording in the voicemail box; participants in other nodes, via e-mail. The
duration of the recording is only limited by the available storage capacity of the
system.
Ending the Conference
The conference controller can end the conference in the client or simply hang up.
Alternatively, the conference ends when all conference participants have left the
conference.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Conference Management (LX/MX)
•
Scheduled Conference (LX/MX)
•
Permanent Conference (LX/MX)
•
Open Conference (LX/MX)
•
Web Collaboration Integration
12.5.3 Scheduled Conference (LX/MX)
A scheduled conference (Meet-Me conference) occurs at a pre-defined point in
the future with a defined duration and may be set up to recur repeatedly at the
same time.
A scheduled conference will run for the entire scheduled duration even if there are
no connected participants. The conference controller saves a scheduled
conference under a specified name.
Options for Configuring a Scheduled Conference
The initiator of the conference can define the following properties:
•
Start time and End time
•
Recurring conference
•
Presence of conference controller required
•
Authentication of conference participants on joining the conference required
(by entering a conference ID and password via the phone keypad).
INFO: Mobility Entry users must enter the code for DTMF suffix
dialing before their authentication.
The default password for conferences is 123456. The conference controller
can change this for the conference participants individually.
•
Language of announcements before the conference begins
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
475
Unified Communications
Conferences
•
Direction for the connection setup for each conference participant (default:
outbound).
Starting the Conference
The system opens the window with the virtual conference room at the scheduled
time automatically for all internal conference participants, provided they have
started myPortal for Desktop with the classic user interface or
myPortal for Outlook. If the presence of the conference controller is required, the
system first calls the controller. After the successful authentication of the
controller, all the other conference participants are called simultaneously.
Conference participants who have forwarded their calls to their voicemail boxes
or who are determined to be absent by their presence status are not called.
Depending on how the connection setup has been configured, the system calls
the conference participants or the participants can dial in themselves. The system
announces every participant who joins the conference by name, as in: “... has
joined the conference”, provided the initiator has recorded his or her name
announcement.
INFO: Conference participants of a scheduled conference
without authentication can only hear the announcement with the
name of the conference controller at the start of the conference,
provided they have already initiated a conference with authentication earlier on one occasion.
Dialing In
Every conference participant can use the dial-in number to dial into the
conference within the scheduled time period, regardless of which direction for the
conference setup was set for that participant. Attempts to dial into the conference
outside the scheduled time period result in a corresponding announcement. To
dial in via an ITSP, the ITSP must support RFC 2833 (DTMF characters).
Forcing Authentication with the Star (*) Key
The conference controller can set the conference so that each conference participant is forced to provide authentication by at least by pressing the * key. This
ensures that only the participants who are actually present are connected to the
conference, as opposed to a voicemail box, for example.
Extending the Conference
Ten minutes before the scheduled end of the conference, the participants hear an
announcement indicating that the conference is about to end and are offered the
option of extending the conference by dialing a specific digit. Any conference
participant can extend the conference by dialing that specific digit. The
conference controller can extend the conference in myPortal for Outlook at any
time.
476
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Conferences
Recording the Conference
Conference controllers can record a conference automatically or manually for
themselves or for all connected internal conference participants, provided the live
recording of calls has been activated in the system. Participants located in the
own node receive the recording in the voicemail box; participants in other nodes,
via e-mail. The duration of the recording is only limited by the available storage
capacity of the system.
Ending the Conference
The conference ends at the time scheduled for the end of the conference or if the
conference controller terminates the conference.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Conference Management (LX/MX)
•
Ad-hoc conference (LX/MX)
•
Permanent Conference (LX/MX)
•
Open Conference (LX/MX)
•
Web Collaboration Integration
12.5.4 Permanent Conference (LX/MX)
A permanent conference is not subject to time restrictions. The conference participants can dial in at any time.
The conference controller saves a permanent conference under a specified
name. The conference is retained until it is explicitly deleted.
Options for Configuring a Scheduled Conference
The initiator of the conference can specify:
•
whether the conference participants need to authenticate themselves by
entering a conference ID and password via the phone keypad when joining
the conference.
INFO: Mobility Entry users must enter the code for DTMF suffix
dialing before their authentication.
The default password for conferences is 123456. The conference controller
can change this for the conference participants individually.
•
in which language the announcements before the start of then conference are
to be made.
Starting the Conference
As soon as the first conference participant dials in, the system opens the window
with the virtual conference room automatically for all internal conference participants, provided they have started myPortal for Desktop or myPortal for Outlook.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
477
Unified Communications
Conferences
All conference participants dial in themselves. The system announces every
participant who joins the conference, as in: “... has joined the
conference.”
Dialing In
Every conference participant can use the dial-in number to dial into the
conference at any time. To dial in via an ITSP, the ITSP must support RFC 2833
(DTMF characters).
Recording the Conference
Conference controllers can record a conference automatically or manually for
themselves or for all connected internal conference participants, provided the live
recording of calls has been activated in OpenScape Office. Participants located
in the own node receive the recording in the voicemail box; participants in other
nodes, via e-mail. The duration of the recording is only limited by the available
storage capacity of OpenScape Office.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Conference Management (LX/MX)
•
Ad-hoc conference (LX/MX)
•
Scheduled Conference (LX/MX)
•
Open Conference (LX/MX)
•
Web Collaboration Integration
12.5.5 Open Conference (LX/MX)
Open conferences are intended for a fixed number of arbitrary participants. Any
participant who has the requisite access data can dial into them.
The conference controller saves an open conference under a specified name.
The conference is retained until it is explicitly deleted.
Options for Configuring an Open Conference
The initiator of the conference can specify:
•
The number of conference participants (max. 16).
•
whether the conference participants need to authenticate themselves by
entering a conference ID and password via the phone keypad when joining
the conference.
INFO: Mobility Entry users must enter the code for DTMF suffix
dialing before their authentication.
The default password for conferences is 123456. The conference controller
can change this for the conference participants individually.
•
478
what common conference ID is valid for all conference participants.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Conferences
•
in which language the announcements before the start of then conference are
to be made.
Starting the Conference
All conference participants dial in themselves. The system announces every
internal participant who joins the conference, as in: “... has joined the
conference.”
Dialing In
Every conference participant can use the dial-in number to dial into the
conference at any time. To dial in via an ITSP, the ITSP must support RFC 2833
(DTMF characters).
Recording the Conference
Conference controllers can record a conference automatically or manually for
themselves or for all connected internal conference participants, provided the live
recording of calls has been activated in the system. Participants located in the
own node receive the recording in the voicemail box; participants in other nodes,
via e-mail. The duration of the recording is only limited by the available storage
capacity of the system.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Conference Management (LX/MX)
•
Ad-hoc conference (LX/MX)
•
Scheduled Conference (LX/MX)
•
Permanent Conference (LX/MX)
12.5.6 Web Collaboration Integration
Together with myPortal for Desktop (Windows) and myPortal for Outlook, the
system also supports the convenient integration of the separate product
OpenScape Web Collaboration for simultaneous multi-media collaboration during
phone calls as well as phone-controlled and application-controlled (LX/MX)
teleconferences. This gives you quick access to functions such as desktop and
application sharing, file sharing, co-browsing, whiteboarding, URL Push, IM chat
and video chat with multiple participants.
Supported Types of Connections
The Web Collaboration integration supports phone calls as well as the following
types of application-controlled phone conferences of the system:
•
Ad-hoc conference (LX/MX)
•
Scheduled conference (LX/MX)
•
Permanent conference (LX/MX)
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
479
Unified Communications
Conferences
On initiating or configuring a telephone conference, the conference controller can
start one Web Collaboration session for simultaneous use with the same participants. On rescheduling, deleting or ending a conference call, the related Web
Collaboration session is also rescheduled or deleted automatically.
FastViewer
Web Collaboration includes FastViewer as a client. No local installation of
FastViewer is required. More information can be found in the Web Collaboration
product documentation.
INFO: In order to enable clients to start FastViewer automatically,
proxy authentication must be disabled on the FastViewer server.
Connecting to the Web Collaboration Session (LX / MX)
Internal conference participants with UC PC clients are automatically connected
to the appropriate Web Collaboration session on starting the conference. To do
this, FastViewer is automatically downloaded and opened in the background,
which may take several seconds. External conference participants with known email addresses receive an e-mail with an appropriate link to the Web Collaboration session.
INFO: Users of a Mac OS must copy the link for the Web Collaboration session into the web browser.
For a scheduled conference, it is possible to connect to the Web Collaboration
session as early as 5 minutes before the start of the scheduled conference.
Conference ID and Password (LX/MX)
The conference ID and password for a Web Collaboration session are identical to
the conference ID and password of the associated phone conference.
Instant Messaging and Web Collaboration
Note that Instant Messaging of the system and Instant Messaging of a
Web Collaboration session are mutually independent, i.e.: the instant messages
from a UC client do not appear in a Web Collaboration session of the same participant, and vice versa.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• Conference Management (LX/MX)
480
•
Ad-hoc conference (LX/MX)
•
Scheduled Conference (LX/MX)
•
Permanent Conference (LX/MX)
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Voice and Fax Messages
12.5.6.1 How to Configure the Integration of Web Collaboration
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Applications > Web Services.
3) Navigate in the menu tree down to Web Services > Web Collaboration.
4) Enter either the URL or IP address of the appropriate Web Collaboration
server in the URL / IP Address field in accordance with the following pattern:
http://<URL of Web Collaboration Server>:5004/OscInterface or http://<IP address of OpenScape
Web Collaboration Server>:5004/OscInterface.
5) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
12.6 Voice and Fax Messages
The Voicemail and Fax services integrated in the system (not for
OpenScape Office HX) enable subscribers to receive and manage voicemails
and fax messages via myPortal for Desktop and myPortal for Outlook. Fax
messages can be sent by subscribers using Fax Printer.
Related Topics
12.6.1 Voicemail Box
The voicemail box records central voicemail and recorded calls. Subscribers can
access it via myPortal for Desktop and myPortal for Outlook.
Only voice messages longer than two seconds are recorded.
Managing Voicemail Messages
As a subscriber, you can listen to your voicemails:
•
via a PC with myPortal for Desktop or myPortal for Outlook
•
via your phone if your Presence status is Office or CallMe
•
via any external telephone
Using myAttendant, the Attendant can also listen to voicemails of other
subscribers who have explicitly allowed this.
The subscriber uses folders such as Inbox, Played, Saved or Deleted to manage
incoming voicemail messages.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
481
Unified Communications
Voice and Fax Messages
Voice messages can also be played back, paused and forwarded to another
subscriber. The subscriber can also save voicemail messages in .wav format and
redirect them to any selected e-mail account.
The voicemail box can also be used by subscribers to manage recorded calls.
Recorded calls are identified in the voicemail box by an appropriate symbol.
callback from voicemail box
When listening to a voicemail, the subscriber can directly call back the person
who left a message.
As an administrator, you can configure on a system-wide basis whether or not
callbacks can be executed from the voicemail box
•
from any phone number.
•
only from phone numbers entered under My Personal Details in the myPortal
for Desktop, myPortal for Outlook, myAttendant and/or myAgent clients of the
subscriber. The following are taken into account: Extension, Mobile
number, External Number 1, External Number 2, Private Number and
Assistant Number.
Example: Subscriber X uses myPortal for Desktop and has configured the
following phone numbers under My Personal Details: Extension = call number
of his or her office telephone, Mobile number = call number of his or her mobile
phone, External Number 1 = call number of the phone in the conference room
The following options are available:
•
If Allow callback out of VM with any calling number is enabled:
Subscriber X can listen to voice messages from any telephone and directly
call back the person who left a message.
•
If Allow callback out of VM with any calling number is disabled (default
setting):
Subscriber X can listen to voice messages from any telephone. but can
directly call back the person who left a message only when listening to a voice
message on his or her office phone, mobile phone or the phone in the
conference room.
Retention Period
As an administrator, you can configure the retention period for voice messages.
Prioritizing voicemail messages
Callers can flag their voicemail messages as normal, urgent or private.
In myPortal for Desktop and myPortal for Outlook, the prioritization of existing
voicemail messages is represented by different colors.
Subscribers who listen to their voicemail messages through the phone are first
notified how many messages are urgent, private and normal. Urgent messages
are played back first.
If the voicemail messages are forwarded as e-mails, the voicemails identified as
urgent are flagged as e-mails with high priority.
482
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Voice and Fax Messages
Functionality of the Voicemail Box
The administrator can define the scope of the voicemail box. He or she can
choose between:
•
Full
Full functionality of the voicemail box (default value)
•
Short Menu
•
After the status-based or personal announcement is made, a connection to
the operator is offered.
•
No Menu
•
After the greeting announcement is played, the caller is directly taken to
record a message.
Displaying New Messages at the Telephone
Voicemail messages are signaled at the telephone. As soon as the voicemail has
been played, the indicators are deleted.
The type of signaling used for new voicemail messages depends on the phone
•
For all telephones, acoustic signaling occurs using a special dial tone.
•
For system telephones without a display, the Mailbox key also lights up (if
configured).
•
For system telephones with a display, the Mailbox key lights up (if configured),
and a message appears on the display.
Notification Service
Subscribers who are using myPortal for Desktop or myPortal for Outlook can
define whether the notification about the arrival of new voicemails should be
forwarded and, if so, to what destination.
Subscribers can also define whether the message should be forwarded as an email. In addition, they can choose to be notified about the arrival of new voicemails by a phone call or an SMS.
Language of the Voicemail Box
As an administrator, you can select the default language of the voicemail box for
the menu prompts and the internal system announcements on a system-wide
basis.
Dependencies
Topic
Dependency
Playing a message over the Subscribers can play back voicemails through the phone
phone
only in the Office or CallMe presence status. For all other
settings, the message can only be played back via the PC.
Related Topics
Related Topics
• AutoAttendant
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
483
Unified Communications
Voice and Fax Messages
12.6.1.1 How to Configure a Callback from the Voicemail Box
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Applications > UC Suite.
3) Click Server.
4) Click on the General Settings tab.
5) Select one of the following options:
•
If callbacks from the voicemail box are to be allowed from any phone
number, select the Allow callback out of VM with any calling number
check box.
•
If callbacks from the voicemail box are to be allowed only from the
numbers entered under My Personal Details in the myPortal for Desktop,
myPortal for Outlook, myAttendant and/or myAgent clients of the
subscriber, clear the Allow callback out of VM with any calling number
check box.
6) Click Save.
12.6.1.2 How to Configure Station Numbers for Voicemail (LX/MX)
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Central Telephony.
3) Click Edit to start the Voicemail wizard.
4) Enter the VoiceMail Number.
5) Click OK & Next followed by Finish.
Related Topics
12.6.1.3 How to Configure Call Forwarding to a Voicemail Box (LX/MX)
You can use the Call Forwarding wizard to configure call forwarding for a
subscriber to his or her voicemail box.
484
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
Unified Communications
Voice and Fax Messages
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > User Telephony.
3) Click Edit to start the Call Forwarding wizard. The Configure the ‘Call
Forwarding - No Answer’ feature window appears.
4) Select the desired station in the Select Station / Group area.
5) Drag the Voicemail box with the mouse and drop it into the Edit Call
Forwarding area.
6) If required, edit the time until call forwarding occurs (default: 15 seconds).
7) Click OK & Next followed by Finish.
Related Topics
12.6.1.4 How to Configure Parameters for the Voicemail Box
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Applications > UC Suite.
3) Click Server.
4) Click on the VoiceMail tab.
5) In the field Voicemail Message Play Order, specify in which order the
messages should be played.
6) Enter the duration in seconds in the Voicemail message recording time
field.
7) Specify the scope of your voicemail box in the VoiceMail Mode field.
8) Click Save.
Related Topics
12.6.1.5 How to Configure Retention Periods for Voicemail
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documentation
485
Unified Communications
Voice and Fax Messages
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) In the navigation tree, click on Applications > UC Suite.
3) Click Server.
4) Click on the Maintenance tab.
5) Enter the respective retention periods in days in the fields under Message.
6) Click Save.
Related Topics
12.6.1.6 How to Configure an Info for Received Voicemails (LX/MX)
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Expert profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Expert Mode.
2) Click Telephony Server > Basic Settings in the navigation tree.
3) Click System in the menu tree.
4) Click Display in the menu tree.
5) Enable the Status display for info message check box in the Switches
area.
6) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
12.6.1.7 How to Configure a Mailbox Key to Check Voicemail (LX/MX)
Prerequisites
•
You are logged on to OpenScape Office Assistant with the Advanced profile.
Step by Step
1) In the navigation bar, click Setup.
2) In the navigation tree, click Wizards > Telephones / Stations.
3) Click Edit to start the Key Programming wizard.
4) Select the relevant station.
5) Select the relevant key in the first column.
6) Select the Mailbox function in the Key feature column.
7) Click Apply followed by OK.
Related Topics
486
A31003-P1030-M100-14-76A9, 03/2014
OpenScape Office V3, Administrator Documenta